Guide To RRB Non Technical Recruitment Exam
Guide To RRB Non Technical Recruitment Exam
Guide To RRB Non Technical Recruitment Exam
RRB
NON TECHNICAL
Recruitment Exams
Current
Affairs
F General Intelligence & Reasoning Updated
F Arithmetic
F General Awareness
F General Science
Covers
100%
Syllabus
• Head Office : B-32, Shivalik Main Road, Malviya Nagar, New Delhi-110017
• Sales Office : B-48, Shivalik Main Road, Malviya Nagar, New Delhi-110017
Tel. : 011-26691021 / 26691713
DISHA PUBLICATION
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
© Copyright Publisher
No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form without prior permission of the publisher. The author and the
publisher do not take any legal responsibility for any errors or misrepresentations that might have crept in. We have
tried and made our best efforts to provide accurate up-to-date information in this book.
1. History 1-10
2. Geography 11-20
3. Indian Polity 21-30
4. Miscellaneous 31-40
5. Railways 41-44
6. Current Affairs 45-50
PHYSICS
1. Mechanics 1-11
2. Properties of matter 12-16
3. Heat 17-22
4. Sound 23-25
5. Optics 26-31
6. Electricity32-38
7. Magnetism 39-42
8. Semiconductor Electronics 43-48
CHEMISTRY
1. Nature of Matter49-52
2. Structure of Atom 53-56
3. Classification of Elements and Periodicity in Properties 57-61
4. Acids, Bases and Salts 62-66
5. Metals & Non-Metals 67-72
6. Environmental Pollution 73-78
7. General Concepts of Chemistry 79-83
8. Some Important Man-Made Materials 84-88
9. General Organic Chemistry 89-92
BIOLOGY
1. Diversity in Living Organisms 93-99
2. Cells and Tissues 100-104
3. Plant Physiology 105-110
4. Human Physiology 111-117
5. Genetics and Evolution118-122
6. Biology in Human Welfare 123-126
7. Diseases and their Defence
Mechanism127-130
8. Ecology & Environment Awareness 131-136
Current Affairs Update 1
CHAPTER
Alphabet & Numbers
1 Arrangement
TYPES OF PROBLEMS
(1) General series of alphabet (2) Random series of alphabet
(3) Words in alphabetical order (4) Problems of word formation
(5) Problems of letter gap (6) Rule identification problems
EXTRA TIPS
I: While solving the problems based on alphabet, you must have in your mind the exact positions of every letters of alphabet
in forward order as well as in backward or reverse order as given below:
Letters positions in forward alphabetical order:
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
Letters positions in backward or reverse alphabetical order:
Z Y X W V U T S R Q P O N M L K J I H G F E D C B A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
II: Just keep in mind, the following positions of the letters in the English alphabet (forward order).
E J O T Y
5 10 15 20 25
III: mth element to be counted from left to right of a series of x characters is equal to (x + 1 – m)th element to be counted from right
to left of that series. This rule can be better illustrated by an example which is given below:
Let us take the forward order alphabet series,
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
As we know that English alphabet has 26 characters, hence, we have x = 26.
Now suppose, we have to find out the position of K in the above given series counting from right to left.
Position of ‘K’ in the English alphabet from left to right is 11. Thus m = 11
\ Position of K in the above given series from right to left would be (26 + 1 – 11) = 16
A-2 Alphabet & Numbers Arrangement
EXERCISE
1. How many such pairs of letters are there in the word STRIVE 9. How many meaningful five-letter words can be formed with
each of which has as many letters between them in the word the letters SLIKL using each letter only once ?
as in the English alphabet ? (a) One (b) Two
(a) One (b) Two (c) Three (d) More than three
(c) Three (d) Four 10. If the first three letters of the word COMPREHENSION are
2. The serial order of how many letters in the word CLIENT reversed, then the last three letters are added and then the
will not differ than their serial order in the arrangement where remaining letters are reversed and added, then which letter
the letters of the word are arranged alphabetically? will be exactly in the middle ?
(a) Four (b) One (a) H (b) N
(c) Three (d) Two (c) R (d) S
3. If it is possible to make only one meaningful word from the 11. If the positions of the first and the fifth digits of the number
second, the third, the sixth and the eighth letters of the 83721569 are interchanged, similarly, the positions of the
word DEVIATION, the first letter of the meaningful word is second and the sixth digits are interchanged, and so on,
your answer. If more than one such word can be formed which of the following will be the third from the right end
your answer is `A' and if no such word can be formed your after the rearrangement?
answer is 'B'. (a) 6 (b) 3
(a) V (b) T (c) 2 (d) 7
(c) E (d) A 12. The positions of the first and the sixth digits in the number
4. If all the letters in the word ARGUMENT are rearranged in 3597280164 are interchanged. Similarly, the positions of the
alphabetical order and substituted by the letter immediately second and the seventh digits are interchanged, and so on.
following it in the English alphabet, what will be the new Which of the following will be the fourth digit from the right
arrangement of letters? end after the rearrangement?
(a) BFHNOSUV (b) BFHONSWV (a) 5 (b) 3
(c) BFHNOUSV (d) BFHNOQUV (c) 9 (d) 4
5. How many three - letter meaningful words can be formed DIRECTIONS (Qs. 13 & 14) : Answer these questions referring
from the word TEAR beginning with 'A' without repeating to the symbol-letter-number sequence given below:
any letter within that word? 13. If the first half of the English alphabet is reversed and so is
(a) One (b) Three the second half, then which letter is seventh to the right of
(c) Five (d) Two twelfth letter from the left side?
6. If the letters of the word ARROGANCE are interchanged, ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
first with fifth, second with sixth, third with seventh, fourth (a) S (b) V
with eighth and the position of the ninth remains unchanged, (c) U (d) T
then what will the new arrangement of letters be? 14. In the alpha-numerical sequence/series given below, how
(a) GANACRROE (b) GANCRAROE" many numbers are there which are (i) immediately followed
(c) GNACORRAE (d) GANCARROE by a letter at the even place in English alphabet and (ii) not
7. In the word FLOURISH, all the vowels are first arranged immediately preceded by a letter at the odd place in the
alphabetically and then all the consonants are arranged English alphabet?
alphabetically and then all the vowels are replaced by the W2 N1 V9 G2 P4 X6 K7 R1 T 8 L3 H5 Q8 U2 J
previous letter and all the consonants are replaced by the (a) 3 (b) 5
next letter from the English alphabet. Which letter will be (c) 2 (d) 4
third from the right end? DIRECTIONS (Qs. 15 & 16) : Following questions are based
(a) I (b) S on English alphabet.
(c) M (d) V ABCDE FGHIJK LMNO PQRSTUVWXYZ
8. How many meaningful English words can be made with the 15. If the letters from T to Z are interchanged by the letters A to
letters ARTSE using each letter only once in each word? G in such a way that A takes the position of T and so on,
then which will be the third letter to the left of 18th letter
(a) More than one (b) One
from right?
(c) Two (d) Three (a) Y (b) U
(c) B (d) C
Alphabet & Numbers Arrangement A-3
16. If first 6 letters shall be written in opposite order, then the (c) 9
next 6 letters shall be written in opposite order and so on, (d) No such number can be made
and at the end Y will be interchanged by Z then which will 19. The positions of the first and the sixth digits in the number
be the fourth letter to the right of 13th letter from left? 3597280164 are interchanged. Similarly, the positions of the
(a) J (b) H second and the seventh digits are interchanged, and so on.
(c) I (d) None of these Which of the following will be the fourth digit from the right
17. How many such pairs of letters are there in the word end after the rearrangement?
PRODUCTION each of which has as many letters between (a) 5 (b) 3
them in the word as in the English alphabet? (c) 9 (d) 4
(a) One (b) Two 20. If the positions of the first and the sixth digits of the group
(c) Three (d) None of these of digits 5904627813 are interchanged, similarly, the
18. If it is possible to make a number which is perfect square of positions of the second and the seventh are interchanged,
a two-digit odd number with the second, the sixth and ninth and so on, which of the following will be the fourth from the
digits of the number 187642539. which of the following is right end after the rearrangement?
the digit in the unit’s place of that two-digit odd number ? (a) 4 (b) 9
(a) 1 (c) 1 (d) 0
(b) 7
ANSWER KEY
1 (a) 5 (b) 9 (b) 13 (c) 17 (c)
2 (a) 6 (d) 10 (d) 14 (b) 18 (b)
3 (d) 7 (c) 11 (b) 15 (a) 19 (a)
4 (a) 8 (e) 12 (a) 16 (d) 20 (b)
2 Analogy/Classification
EXERCISE
1. 'Footwear' is related to `Cobbler' in the same way as 'Furniture' 14. (a) 115 (b) 161
is related to (c) 253 (d) 345
(a) Mason (b) Goldsmith 15. (a) NPQ (b) HJK
(c) Carpenter (d) Potter (c) TVW (d) LMO
2. 'BEAN' is related to 'NEAB' and 'SAID' is related to 'DAIS' in 16. (a) GIJK (b) DFGH
the same way as 'LIME' is related to (c) CEFG (d) ABCD
(a) MLEI (b) ELMI 17. (a) 39 (b) 27
(c) FIML (d) EIML (c) 48 (d) 42
3. `Captain' is related to `Team' in the same way as 'Director' is 18. Which of the following is related to ‘Melody’ in the same
related to which of the following? way as ‘Delicious’ is related to ‘Taste’?
(a) Supervisor (b) Employee (a) Memory (b) Highness
(c) Voice (d) Speak
(c) Organisation (d) Union
19. Which of the following does not have the same relationship
4. ‘FI’ is related to ‘LO’ in the same way as ‘PS’ is related
as that of Cloth : Garments?
to…?......
(a) Leather : Footwear (b) Wood : Furniture
(a) VY (b) VZ
(c) Earthen pots : Clay (d) Gold : Ornaments
(c) WZ (d) UX 20. ‘Clock’ is related to ‘Time’ in the same way as ‘Vehicle’ is
5. Which of the following pairs have the same relationship as related to which of the following?
FERAL : TAME ? (a) Driver (b) Road
(a) rancid : rational (c) Passenger (d) Journey
(b) repetitive : recurrent 21. By following certain logic ‘THEIR’ is written as ‘TRIHE’
(c) nettlesome : annoying and ‘SOLDIER’ is written ‘SROLIED’. How is CUSTOM
(d) ephemeral : immortal written in that logic?
6. Which of the following pairs have the same relationship as (a) UTSOMC (b) CTSUOM
EXPLORE : DISCOVER ? (c) CUTSOM (d) YUSOMC
(a) read : skim (b) research : learn Directions (Q. 22 - 25): In each of the following questions,
(c) write : print (d) think : relate there are two words / set of letters / numbers to the left of the
sign :: which are connected in some way. The same relationship
7. Which one of the following is related to : obtains between the third words / set of letters / numbers and
Clutch : Brake :: Horn one of the four alternatives under it. Find the correct alternative
(a) Stand (b) Steering in each question.
(c) Car (d) Accident 22. Flying : Bird :: Creeping : ?
Directions (Q. 8 - 17): In each of the questions given below, four (a) Aeroplane (b) Snail
of the five options are alike in a certain way and so form a group. (c) Ground (d) Flower
Which option does not belong to the group? 23. Bank : River :: Coast : ?
8. (a) Table (b) Chair (a) Flood (b) Waves
(c) Cupboard (d) Computer (c) Sea (d) Beach
9. (a) Hill (b) Valley 24. Oxygen : Burn : : Carbon dioxide : ?
(c) Dam (d) River (a) Isolate (b) Foam
10. (a) June (b) August (c) Extinguish (d) Explode
(c) December (d) January 25. Tuberculosis : Lungs :: Cataract : ?
11. (a) 17 (b) 19 (a) Ear (b) Throat
(c) 23 (d) 27 (c) Skin (d) Eye
12. (a) Picture (b) Painting 26. Four of the following five are alike in a certain way and so
form a group. Which is the one that does not belong to that
(c) Sketch (d) Paint
group?
13. (a) Cricket (b) Volley ball (a) Food : Hunger (b) Water : Thirst
(c) Chess (d) Tennis (c) Air : Suffocation (d) Talent : Education
A-6 Analogy/Classification
27. Four of the following five are alike in a certain way and 29. Four of the following five are alike in a certain way and so
hence form a group. Find the one which is different from the form a group. Which is the one that does not belong to that
other four. group?
(a) Rice (b) Wheat (a) Volume (b) Size
(c) Barley (d) Mustard (c) Large (d) Shape
28. Four of the following five are alike in a certain way and so 30. Four of the following five are alike in a certain way and so
form a group. Which is the one that does not belong to the from a group. Which is the one that does not belong to that
group? group?
(a) 169 (b) 179 (a) Aluminium (b) Copper
(c) 135 (d) 149 (c) Mercury (d) Iron
ANSWER KEY
1 (c) 7 (c) 13 (c) 19 (c) 25 (d)
2 (d) 8 (d) 14 (d) 20 (d) 26 (d)
3 (c) 9 (c) 15 (d) 21 (a) 27 (d)
4 (a) 10 (a) 16 (d) 22 (b) 28 (a)
5 (d) 11 (d) 17 (b) 23 (c) 29 (c)
6 (b) 12 (d) 18 (c) 24 (c) 30 (c)
3 Series/Coding-
Decoding
SERIES
A series that is A series that is A series in A series which A series of letters, A series consists of
made by only made by only which both is created by which follow a three sequence with
alphabets and the combination certain pattern, is three different
number or digit alphabetic letters of two or more
numbers are given with four / elements (for ex.
than two series five times blank capital letters,
used
1. Ascending series spaces in between. numbers and small
2. Descending series The order of letters). An element
missing letters of each sequence is
3. Oscillating series correspond to the
is correct answer.
element of other
sequence on the
basis of the similarity
in position.
In number series, relationship between the terms is of any kind. TYPE III (CODING BASED ON NUMBERS)
For example. Pattern 1: When numerical values are given to words.
(1) Consecutive even nunbers
Pattern 2: When alphabetical code value are given for numbers.
(2) Consecutive odd numbers
(3) Consecutive prime numbers TYPE IV (MATHEMATICAL OPERATIONS WITH THE
(4) Square of numbers POSITION NUMBERS OF LETTERS)
(5) Cubes of numbers Sample Example: In a certain code, if ‘TALE’ is written as 38, then
(6) Square root of numbers how will you code ‘CAME’ using the same coding scheme?
(7) Omission of certain number of letter in any consecutive Explanation : Look at the numbered alphabet and write down the
order number corresponding to the letters of the word ‘TALE’.
(8) Addition /subtraction/ multiplication/ division by some T A L E
number (For Ex. A.P & G.P) or any other relation. 20 1 12 5
TYPES OF CODING-DECODING The fact that the code for ‘TALE’ is 38, gives you a clue that the
TYPE I (CODING BY LETTER SHIFTING) code is probably obtained by performing an arithmatical
Pattern 1: Coding in forward sequence operations of the numbers of each other. Let us see :
Pattern 2: Coding in backward sequence. 20 + 1 + 12 + 5 = 38
Pattern 3: Coding based on skipped sequence. Thus, the code for ‘CAME’ is
TYPE II (CODING IN FICTIONS LANGUAGE) C A M E
In some cases of coding-decoding, fictions language is used to 3 + 1 + 13 + 5 = 22
code some words. In such questions, the codes for a group of \ Code for ‘CAME’ = 22
words is given. In such types of problems, codes for each word
can be found by eliminating the common words.
A-8 Series/Coding-Decoding
EXERCISE
1- If REMIT is written as *£3 7 and CONSUL is written as 9. 364279
= %8 b $5; then OCELOT will be written as (a) ©H$Q%© (b) #H$Q%@
(c) ©H$Q%# (d) #H$Q%©
(a) %=3587 (b) %=£5%7
10. 592476
(c) %=35% (d) %35%7 (a) H COQ$%T (b) Q$% oT
2. If AMONG is written as NAOGM and SPINE is written as (c) H©Q$%OO (d) None of these
NSIEP, then LAMON will be written as 11. 468910
(a) OALNM (b) MLONA (a) $HJ©KL (b) LHJ@K$
(c) OLMNA (d) OLNMA (c) *HJ@K$ (d) $HJ@K*
3. In a certain code language `PULSE' is written as `DRKTO' 12. In a certain code, MIGHT is written as LHFGS. How is BELOW
and 'NEW is written as `VDM'. How will 'PROBES' be written written in that code?
in that code language? (a) CFMPX (b) ADJNU
(a) RDANQO (b) QSPCFT (c) ADKMV (d) ADKNV
(c) TFCPSQ (d) OPNADR 13. In a certain code HOUSE is written as FTVPI how is CHAIR
4. In a certain code SEAL is written as $75@ and DOSE is written in that code?
written as #8$7. How is SOLD written in that code? (a) DIBJS (b) SBJID
(a) $8@# (b) #87$ (c) SHBGD (d) SJBID
(c) #8$7 (d) $5@# 14. In a certain code,'LOCK' is written as `MPBJ'' and `BLOW' is
5. In a certain code BOND is written as 1543 and DEAN is written as `CMNV'. How is 'WINE' written in that code?
written as 3 864. How is BED written in that code? (a) VHOF (b) XJMD
(a) 153 (b) 183 (c) XJOR (d) VHMD
(c) 138 (d) 143 Directions (Q15-20) : In each of the questions given below, a
6. In a certain code `go home' is written as `ta na' and 'nice little group of digits is given followed by four combinations of letters/
home' is written as `na ja pa'. How is 'go' written in that code? symbols numbered (a), (b),(c) and(d). You have to find out which
(a) ta (b) na of the four combinations correctly represents the group of digits
(c) ja (d) na or to based on the letter/symbol codes and the conditions given below.
7. If 'table' is called 'chair'; 'chair' is called `cupboard', 'cupboard' Digit 2 8 3 9 4 7 6 5 1
is called 'chalk', 'chalk' is called 'book', 'book'
is called 'duster' and 'duster' is called 'table', what does the Code B = T @ K $ © P C
teacher use to write on the black board? Conditions:
(a) book (b) cupboard (i) If the first digit is odd and last digit is even, the codes
(c) table (d) duster for the first and the last digits are to be interchanged.
(ii) If the first as well as the last digit is even, both are to
Directions (Q. 8-14): In each of these questions, a group of digits be coded by the code for last digit.
is given followed by four combinations of letters and symbols
(iii) If the first as well as the last digit is odd, both are to
numbered (a), (b), (c) and (d). The group of digits is to be coded as
be coded as X.
per the scheme and conditions given below. The serial number of
(iv) If the first digit is even and last digit is odd, both are
the combination which correctly represents the group of digits is
to be coded by the code for the first-digit.
your answer.
15. In a certain coding system, RBM STD BRO PUS means ‘the
Digits 5 8 4 3 6 2 9 0 7 1 cat is beautiful’. TNH PUS DIM STD means ‘the dog is
Code T J $ # H Q @ L % K brown’. PUS DIM BRO PUS CUS means ‘the dog has the
cat’. What is the code for ‘has’ ?
Conditions:
(a) CUS (b) BRO
(i) If the first as well as the last digit is odd, both are to be
(c) DIM (d) STD
coded as ©.
(ii) If the first as well as the last digit is even, their codes are to 16- What will come in place of the question mark (?) in the
be swapped. following alphabet series ?
(iii) If '0' is the last digit, it is to be coded as *. AC EH IM MR ?
8. 270514 (a) MI (b) IL
(a) ©%LTK© (b) $%LTKQ (c) IM (d) QW
(c) Q%LTK$ (d) $%*TKQ
Series/Coding-Decoding A-9
17. Which of the following will come in place of the question 26. If the digits of the number 5726489 are arranged in ascending
mark(?) in the order given below? order, how many digits will remain at the same position?
A B A B C B C B C D C D? (a) One (b) Two
(a) D (b) E (c) Three (d) More than three
(c) C (d) F 27. If two is subtracted from each odd digit and three is added to
18. What should come next in the following letter series ? each even digit in the number 3675249, how many digits will
HG FEDCBAHGFEDCBHGFE DC H appear twice in the new number thus formed ?
(a) F (b) G (a) One (b) Two
(c) B (d) A (c) Three (d) Four
19. Which one of the followong is the correct order of missing 28. In a certain code OVER is written as ‘PWFSQ’ and BARE
letters in the series given below ? is written as ‘CBSFD’. How is OPEN written in that code?
(a) PQFOM (b) NODMO
_ tu _ rt _ s _ _ usrtu _
(c) PQFOO (d) POFMM
(a) rtusru (b) rsutrr
29. If ‘white’ is called ‘rain’, ‘rain’ is called ‘green’, ‘green’ is
(c) rsurtr (d) rsurts called blue’, ‘blue’, is called ‘cloud’, ‘cloud’ is called ‘red’,
20. Which one of the following is the correct order of missing ‘red’ is called ‘sky’, ‘sky’ is called ‘yellow’ and ‘yellow’ is
letters in the series given below ? called’ ‘black’, what is the colour of ‘blood’?
_ _aba _ _ ba _ ab (a) Red (b) Blue
(a) abbba (b) abbab (c) Cloud (d) Sky
30. In a certain code language ‘POETRY’ is written as
(c) baabb (d) bbaba
‘QONDSQX’ and ‘OVER’ is written as ‘PNUDQ’. How is
Directions (Q. 21-25): Study of the following arrangement
‘MORE’ written in that code?
carefully and answer the questions given below.
(a) NNNQD (b) NLPQD
Q E * PM 8 RA@ C 9 UHW# J Z S ßYN 5 $ G IT
(c) NLNQD (d) LNNQD
21. How many such vowels are there in the above arrangement 31. In a certain code language ‘MOTHERS’ is written as
each of which is immediately followed by a symbol ‘OMVGGPU’. How is ‘BROUGHT’ written in that code?
(a) One (b) Three (a) CPRTIEV (b) DPQSIFV
(c) More than three (d) None of these (c) DPRTIDV (d) DPQTIFV
22. What should come in place of the question mark (?) in the 32. In a certain code ‘PENCIL’ is written as ‘RCTAMJ’ then in
following series based on the above arrangement ? that code ‘BROKEN’ is written as
QP@ MAH @UZ ? (a) SPFLIM (b) SVFLIN
(a) H#Y (b) WZY (c) FVSMGL (d) None of these
33. In a certain code language the word FUTILE is written as
(c) HJN (d) 9#S
HYVMNI. How will the word PENCIL be written in that
23. Which of the following is eighth to the right of the thirteenth
language?
element from the left end of the arrangement?
(a) OIFRLT (b) OIFRLS
(a) M (b) N (c) OLFRIT (d) None of these
(c) 5 (d) 8 34. In a certain code language the word ‘NUMBER’ is written as
24. Which of the following is exactly in the middle between the ‘UMHTEL’. How will the word ‘SECOND’ be written in that
twelfth from the right and the seventh from the left end? language?
(a) 3 (b) # (a) CTQDRB (b) GRQDRB
(c) U (d) 9 (c) CTQFRB (d) GRQFRB
25. Which of the following will be the middle digit of the second 35. In a certain code ‘SENSITIVE’ is written as ‘QHLVGWGYC’.
lowest number among the five numbers given below? How is ‘MICROSOFT’ written in that code?
(a) KGAPMQMDT
317 528 439 254 861
(b) QKETQUQHV
(a) 1 (b) 2
(c) KLAUMVMIR
(c) 3 (d) 5 (d) LKBTNUNHS
A- 10 Series/Coding-Decoding
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 7 (a) 13 (d) 19 (d) 25 (a) 31 (d)
2 (c) 8 (b) 14 (b) 20 (b) 26 (c) 32 (d)
3 (a) 9 (a) 15 (a) 21 (d) 27 (b) 33 (d)
4 (a) 10 (d) 16 (d) 22 (c) 28 (a) 34 (b)
5 (b) 11 (d) 17 (b) 23 (b) 29 (d) 35 (c)
6 (a) 12 (d) 18 (b) 24 (d) 30 (c)
% = £ 5 % 7 6. (a) go home ® ta na
2. (c)
1 2 3 4 5 4 1 3 5 2 nice little home ® na ja pa
A M O N G ® N A O G M Hence, code of 'go' is 'ta'
1 2 3 4 5 4 1 3 5 2 7. (a) Teacher write on blackboard with chalk, here chalk is
S P I N E ® N S I E P called book, hence here the code of chalk is book.
Hence, 8. (b) 2 7 0 5 1 4
1 2 3 4 5 4 1 3 5 2
$%L T KQ
L A M O N ® O L M N A
3. (a) As, condition (ii) is applied
9. (a)
P U L S E and N E W 3 6 4 2 7 9
-1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1
O T K R D M D V ©H$ Q%©
condition (i) is applied
reverse order reverse order 10. (d) 5 9 2 4 7 6
D R K T O V D M
Similarly, T@Q $%H
P R O B E S 11. (d) 4 6 8 9 1 0
-1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1
$ H J @ K«
O Q N A D R
condition (iii) is applied
reverse order 12. (d) As, Similarly,
R D A N Q O -1 -1
M ¾¾ ®L B ¾¾ ®A
Hence, required code : RDANQO -1 -1
I ¾¾ ®H E ¾¾ ®D
4. (a) S E A L and D O S E -1 -1
G ¾¾ ®F L ¾¾ ®K
¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ -1 -1
H ¾¾ ®G O ¾¾ ®N
$ 7 5 @ # 8 $ 7 -1 -1
T ¾¾ ®S W ¾¾ ®V
Hence,
Series/Coding-Decoding A- 11
+1
30. (c) | –1| –1| –1| –1| –1| –1
B L O W Q O N D S Q X
+1 +1 -1 -1
Similarly,
C M N V
O V E R
Similarly,
+1
| –1| –1| –1| –1
W I N E P N U D Q
+1 +1 -1 -1 Similarly, MORE will be coded as follows:
X J M D M O R E
+1
15. (a) RBM STD BRO PUS º the cat is beautiful ....(i) | –1| –1| –1| –1
TNH PUS DIM STD º the dog is brown ....(ii) N L N Q D
PUS DIM BRO PUS CUS º the dog has the cat ....(iii) 31. (d) M O T H E R S
+2 –2 +2 –1 +2 –2 +2
(i) and (ii) Þ STD PUS º is the
O M VG G P U
(ii) and (iii) Þ PUS DIM º the dog Similarly, BROUGHT be coded as follows:
(i) and (iii) Þ PUS BRO º the cat B R O U G H T
\ From (iii), CUS º has +2 –2 +2 –1 +2 –2 +2
D P Q T I F V
16. (d) First letter of each term is + 4 letters ahead of the
32. (d) The first three letters of the word are reversed. Thus
previous term. Similarly second letter is + 5 letters ahead
PENCIL becomes NEPCIL. Now add 4 to odd-
of the previous term.
positioned letters and subtract 2 from even-positioned
17. (b) A B A, B C B, C B C, D C D, E D E.
ones. Similarly, BROKEN becomes ORBKEN. Then we
18. (b) H G F E D C B A
do the calculations: O + 4, R – 2, B + 4, K – 2, E + 4, N
HG FE D CB
– 2, i.e. SPFIIL.
HGF E DC
33. (d) Odd-placed letters are coded as two places forward
H G FED and even-placed letters are coded as four places
19. (d) The series is: rtus/rtus/rtus/rtus. forward as in English alphabet.
20. (b) The series is: ab/ab/ab/ab/ab/ab 34. (b) A real tough one! If we number the letters of the word
21. (d) VOWEL SYMBOL from 1 to 6, first rearrange the letters in the order 615243.
Such combinations are: Next, to this reversed order of letters, apply the
following alternately: move three letters ahead; go one
E A@ letter backward.
22. (c) +4 +4 +4 Thus NUMBER first becomes RNEUBM. Then
Q ¾¾ ® M ¾¾ ® @ ¾¾ ®H
+4 +4 +4
R + 3 = U, N – 1 = M,
P ¾¾ ® A ¾¾ ® U ¾¾ ®J E + 3 = H, U – 1 = T, B + 3 = E, M – 1 = L. So the final
+4
@ ¾¾ +4
® H ¾¾ +4
® Z ¾¾ ®N code is UMHTEL.
Similarly, SECOND ® DSNEOC ® GRQDRB
23. (b) 8th to the right of 13th from the left means 21st from
35. (c) The letters at odd-numbered positions (1st, 3rd, ...)
left. 21st from left Þ N
move two letters backward. While those at even
24. (d) RA@C 9 UHW# numbered positions (2nd, 4th, ...) move three letters
25. (a) Second smallest number = 317 forward.
CHAPTER
Direction/Time
4 Sequence, Number and
Ranking Test
DIRECTION MAP Important point regarding direction
(1) If our face is towards North, than after left than our face will
North be it towards West while after right turn it will be towards
North-West North-East East.
(2) If our face is towards South, then after left turn our face will
be towards East and after right turn it will be towards West.
West East (3) If our face is towards East, then after left turn our face will
be forwards North and after right turn it will be towards
South.
(4) If our face is towards West, then after left turn our face will
South-West South-East
be towards South and after right turn it will be towards
South North.
Note: (5) If our face is towards North-West, then after left turn our
On paper North is always on top be while South is always in face will be towards South-West and after right turn it will
bottom. be towards North-East.
Concept of Degree
(6) If our face is towards South-West, then after left turn our
Let us see the following picture:
face will be towards South-East and after right turn it will be
360º
0º
360º
0º
towards North-West.
315º (7) If our face is towards South-East, then after left turn our
Anti clockwise (ACW)
Left turn
Right turn
Left turn
P h
(iii) (iv)
Direction/Time Sequence, Number and Ranking Test A- 13
EXERCISE
1. P, Q, R, S and T are sitting around a circular table. R is to the 7. Mohan and Suresh study in the same class. Mohan has
right of P and is second to the left of S. T is not between P secured more marks than Suresh in the terminal examination.
and S. Who is second to the left of R? Suresh’s rank is seventh from top among all the students in
(a) S (b) T the class. Which of the following is definitely true?
(c) Q (d) Data inadequate (a) Mohan stood first in the terminal examination.
2. Alok walked 30 metres towards east and took a right turn (b) There is at least one student between Mohan and
and walked 40 metres. He again took a right turn and walked Suresh in the rank list.
50 metres. Towards which direction is he from his starting (c) There are at the most five students between Mohan
point? and Suresh in the rank list.
(a) South (b) West (d) Suresh is five ranks lower than Mohan in the rank list.
(c) South-West (d) South-East 8. Rajnish is older than Rajesh and Raman. Ramesh is older
3. A boy rode his bicycle northwards, then turned left and than Rajesh but younger than Rajeev. Raman is older than
rode one km and again turned left and rode 2 km. He found Rajeev. Who among them is oldest?
himself exactly one km west of his starting point. How far (a) Rajeev (b) Rajesh
did he ride northwards initially? (c) Rajnish (d) Ramesh
(a) 1 km (b) 2 km 9. In a row of boys Akash is fifth from the left and Nikhil is
(c) 3 km (d) 5 km eleventh from the right. If Akash is twenty-fifth from the right
4. If South-east becomes North, North-east becomes West then how many boys are there between Akash and Nikhil?
and so on, what will West become? (a) 14 (b) 13
(a) North-east (b) North-west
(c) 15 (d) 12
(c) South-east (d) South-west
5. A man is facing north-west. He turns 90° in the clockwise 10. In a shop, there were 4 dolls of different heights M, N, O
direction, then 180° in the anticlockwise direction and then and P. ‘P’ is neither as tall as ‘M’ nor as short as ‘O’. ‘N’ is
another 90° in the same direction. Which direction is he shorter than ‘P’ but taller than ‘O’. If Anvi wants to purchase
facing now? the tallest doll, which one should she purchase?
(a) South (b) South-west (a) Either M or P (b) Either P or N
(c) West (d) South-east (c) Only P (d) Only M
6. Going 60 m to the south of his house. Kiran turn left and 11. A, B, C, D and E, when arranged in descending order of
goes another 20 m, then turning to the North. their weight from top, A becomes third, E is between D and
He goes 40 m and then starting walking to his house. In A, C and D are not at the top. Who among them is the
which direction is his house from there? second?
(a) South-East (b) North (a) C (b) B
(c) East (d) North-West (c) E (d) Data inadequate
A- 14 Direction/Time Sequence, Number and Ranking Test
12. Some boys are sitting in a line. Mahendra is on 17th place 21. Rama remembers that she met her brother on Saturday, which
from left and Surendra is on 18th place from right. There are 8 was after the 20th day of a particular month. If the 1st day of
boys in between them. How many boys are there in the line? that month was Tuesday, then on which date did Rama
(a) 43 (b) 42 meet her brother ?
(c) 41 (d) 44 (a) 24th (b) 23rd
13. In a line of students Madhukar is on 15th position from (c) 25th (d) 26th
right and Dhirendra is on 18th position from left. When they 22. Among M, T, R and P, M is older than only P. T is older than
both interchange their positions then Madhukar is on 20th R. Who among them is the oldest ?
position from right. What will be the position of Dhirendra (a) T (b) R
from left? (c) T or R (d) Data inadequate
(a) 18th (b) 24th 23. L, M, N and P are sitting around a circle and facing the
(c) 23rd (d) 20th centre. P is to the immediate left of N. L is between N & M.
14. In a class of 60, where girls are twice that of boys, kamal What is the position of M?
ranked seventeenth from the top. If there are 9 girls ahead of
(a) To the immediate left of L
kamal, how many boys are after him in rank ?
(b) To the immediate right of P.
(a) 3 (b) 7
(c) 12 (d) 23 (c) In front of P
15. Sachin and Vinod want to visit the museum after their exams. (d) None of these
Sachin's exams finish on 9th April and he is leaving for a 24. Five men A, B, C, D and E read a newspaper. The one who
holiday on 12th April. Vinod's exams will be over by 10th reads first gives it to C. The one who reads last had taken it
April after which he is free. On which of the following dates from A. E was not the first or the last to read. There were two
can the two definitely meet? readers between B and A. B passed the newspaper to whom?
(a) 10th April (b) Either 10th or 11th April (a) A (b) C
(c) l2th April (d) Either 1lth or l2thApril (c) D (d) E
16. Nitin correctly remembers that Nidhi's birthday is before 25. In the Olympic Games, the flags of six nations were flown
Friday but after Tuesday. Derek correctly remembers that on the masts in the following way: The flag of America was
Nidhi's birthday is after Wednesday but before Saturday. to the left of the Indian tricolour and to the right of the flag
On which of the following days does Nidhi's birthday of France. The flag of Australia was on the right of the
definitely fall? Indian flag but was to the left of the flag of Japan, which
(a) Monday (b) Tuesday was to the left of the flag of China. Find the two flags which
(c) Wednesday (d) Thursday are in the centre.
(a) India and Australia (b) America and India
Directions (Q. 17-19) : Study the following information carefully
and answer the given questions. (c) Japan and Australia (d) America and Australia
26. How many 5s are there in the following number sequence
Point D is 14 m towards the West of point A. Point B is 4 m towards
which are immediately preceded by 7 and immediately
the South of point D. Point F is 9 m towards the South of point D.
followed by 6?
Point E is 7 m towards the East of point B. Point C is 4 m towards the
North of point E. Point G is 4 m towards the South of point A. 75 5945 7645 987 5676 4325 78
17. Which of the following points are in a straight line ? (a) 1 (b) 2
(a) D, E, A (b) E, G, C (c) 3 (d) 4
(c) D, B, G (d) E, G, B 27. How many even numbers are there in the following series of
18. A is in which direction with respect to C ? the numbers, each of which is immediately preceded by an
(a) East (b) West odd number, but not immediately followed by an even
(c) North (d) South number?
19. If a person walks 5 m towards North from point F and then 5348971653298735
takes a right turn, which of the following points would he (a) Nil (b) 1
reach first ? (c) 2 (d) 3
(a) G (b) D Directions (Q. 28-29): Following questions are based on the
(c) E (d) A five three-digit numbers given below
20. Five boys are standing in a row facing East. Deepak is to the 519364287158835
left of Sameer, Tushar and Shailendra. Sameer, Tushar and
28. If the positions of the first and the third digit within each
Shailendra are to the left of Sushil. Shailendra is between
number are interchanged, which of the following will be the
Sameer and Tushar. If Tushar is fourth from the left, then third digit of the second lowest number?
how far is Sameer from the right?
(a) 9 (b) 4
(a) First (b) Second
(c) Third (d) Fourth (c) 7 (d) 5
Direction/Time Sequence, Number and Ranking Test A- 15
29. Which of the following is the difference between the second 31. The positions of the first and the sixth digit in the number
digit of the lowest and the highest of these numbers? 5 1 0 9 2 3 8 6 7 4 are interchanged. Similarly, the positions of
(a) 3 (b) 1 the second and the seventh digit are interchanged and so
on. Which of the following will be the third digit from the
(c) 2 (d) 0
right end after the rearrangement?
30. The positions of how many digits in the number 3 5 1 4 6 2 9
8 7 will remain unchanged after the digits are rearranged in (a) 9
ascending order within the number? (b) 0
(a) None (b) One (c) 6
(c) Two (d) Three (d) 3
ANSWER KEY
1 (c) 7 (c) 13 (c) 19 (c) 25 (a) 31 (b)
2 (c) 8 (c) 14 (c) 20 (d) 26 (a)
3 (b) 9 (b) 15 (b) 21 (d) 27 (d)
4 (c) 10 (d) 16 (d) 22 (a) 28 (d)
5 (d) 11 (a) 17 (d) 23 (d) 29 (c)
6 (d) 12 (a) 18 (a) 24 (b) 30 (c)
50 m C 1km B
3. (b) Clearly, the boy rode from A to B, 60 m
2km
then to C and finally up to D. Since 40 m
D lies to the west of A, so required
D 1km A
distance = AB = CD = 2 km.
4. (c) Here, each direction moves 90° + 45° = 135° 20 m
SW N
S N
NW NE
W E
SE NW
W E
SE
SW S S
E
7. (c)
NE 8. (c) Rajnish > Rajesh, Raman... (i)
5. (d) As shown in figure, the man initially faces in the
direction OP. On moving 90° clockwise, he faces in the Rajeev > Ramesh > Rajesh ... (ii)
direction OX. On further moving 180° anticlockwise, Raman > Rajeev ... (iii)
he faces in the direction OY. Finally, on moving 90° Combining all, we get
Rajnish > Raman > Rajeev > Ramesh > Rajesh
A- 16 Direction/Time Sequence, Number and Ranking Test
9. (b) There are (25 – 11– 1 =) 13 boys between Akash and 19. (c) He would reach first at point 'E'.
Nikhil.
20. (d) The boys are standing as follows from L ® R
10. (d) The correct order of dolls according to descending
order of their heights are: E
M> P>N >O Deepak Sameer Shailendra Tushar Sushil N
Therefore, Anvi will purchase the doll M.
11. (a) ------ 21. (d) 1st of the month was Tuesday, hence the date on first
----A---- Saturday was 5th.
DEA - - [It is not possible as D is not at the top.] Hence the other Saturdays of the month are 12, 19, 26.
--- AED Rama met her brother on 26th.
BCAED 22. (a) M > P, T > R
Hence, C is second among them.
T > R > M > P (M is older than only P)
12. (a) Total boys
Hence, T is the eldest.
é ù
ê Mahendra’s Surendra’s ú éê Boys between ùú 23. (d) According to question, Order of position would be as
=ê place + place ú+ follows:
from right ú ëê them ûú
ê from left
ë û
= [17 + 18] + 8 = 43 P
13. (c) Second place of Dhirendra from left
Right N M Left
é ù
ê Difference of First place ú
= ê places of + ú L
ê Madhukar of Dhirendra ú
êë úû 24. (b) From the information given in the question, the
newspaper was read in the following order
= [(20 – 15) + 18] = 23rd
B, C, E, A, D.
14. (c) Let the number of boys be x.
Hence B passed the newspaper to C.
Then, number of girls = 2x.
25. (a) The order in which the six flags were flown from L to R
\ x + 2x = 60 or 3x = 60 or x = 20. is France, America, India, Australia, Japan, China.
So, number of boys = 20 and number of girls = 40. 26. (a) Here, 7 5 5 9 4 5 7 6 4 5 9 8 7 5 6 7 6 4 3 2 5 6 7 8
Number of students behind Kamal in rank (60 – 17) Preceded by 7 and followed by 6.
= 43. So, there is only one such 5.
Number of girls ahead of Kamal in rank = 9. 27. (d) There are three such even numbers, 6 2, 8 each of
Number of girls behind Kamal in rank = (40 – 9) = 31 which is preceded by an odd number and not followed
\ Number of boys behind Kamal in rank by an even number.
= (43 – 31) = 12. 534897163298735
15. (b) Sachin and Vinod can meet on 10th or 11th April. 28. (d) Accoding to the question, after the position of the
16. (d) According to Nitin Þ Wednesday or Thursday first and third digit interchanged new numbers are
According to Derek Þ Thursday or Friday or Saturday 519 915, 364 463, 287 782, 158 851, 835 538.
So, Nidhi’s birthday falls on Thursday So, second lowest number = 538 835
Sol. (17-19): Hence, third digit of the second lowest number = 5
D C A 29. (c) According to the question, difference between the
7m 7m second digit of the lowest and the highest number
4m 4m 4m =5–3=2
7m 30. (c) Hence, 4 and 8 digit remains unchanged after the
B E G
rearrangement.
5m
31. (b) Given number = 5109238674
F According to the question, after interchanging digits,
new number = 3867451092
17. (d) Points B, E, G and A, C, D are in a straight line.
Hence, third digit from the right end = 0
18. (a) A is towards East of C.
CHAPTER
5 Blood Relation
EXERCISE
1. Anil, introducing a girl in a party, said, she is the wife of the 11. If 'P × Q' means `P is wife of Q', 'P + Q' means 'P is father of
grandson of my mother. How is Anil related to the girl? Q' and 'P ÷ Q' means 'P is sister of Q' then in G – H + R ÷ D,
(a) Father (b) Grandfather how is G related to D?
(c) Husband (d) Father-in-law (a) Cannot be determined (b) Mother
2. A man said to a woman, “Your mother’s husband’s sister is (c) Niece (d) Aunt
my aunt.” How is the woman related to the man ? 12. X told Y, “Though I am the son of your father, you are not
(a) Granddaughter (b) Daughter my brother”. How is X related to Y ?
(c) Sister (d) Aunt (a) Sister (b) Son
3. Introducing Rajesh, Neha said, “His brother’s father is the (c) Daughter (d) Father
only son of my grand father”. How Neha is related to Rajesh? 13. A boy goes to see a film and finds a man who is his relative.
(a) Sister (b) Daughter The man is the husband of the sister of his mother. How is
the man related to the boy?
(c) Mother (d) Niece
(a) Brother (b) Nephew
4. Pointing to a photograph, a man said, “ I have no brother or
sister but that man’s father is my father’s son.” Whose (c) Uncle (d) Father
photograph was it? Direction (Q. 14-16) : Study the following information carefully
(a) His own (b) His son’s to answer these questions.
(c) His father’s (d) His nephew’s (i) ‘P × Q’ means ‘P is brother of Q’.
5. A is the brother of B. A is the brother of C. To find what is (ii) ‘P – Q’ means ‘P is sister of Q’.
the relation between B and C. What minimum information (iii) ‘P + Q’ means ‘P is father of Q’.
from the following is necessary? (iv) ‘p ÷ Q’ means ‘P is mother of Q’.
(i) Gender of C (ii) Gender of B 14. Which of the following represents ‘M is nephew of N’ ?
(a) Only (i) (b) Only (ii) (a) N – K + M (b) N × K ÷ M
(c) Either (i) or (ii) (d) both (i) and (ii) (c) N ÷ K × M (d) N – K + M × T
6. If ‘P $ Q’ means ‘P is brother of Q’, ‘P # Q’ means ‘P is mother 15. How is T related to D in the expression :
of Q’ and ‘P*Q’ means ‘P is daughter of Q’, then who is the H+ T÷R– D?
father in ‘A # B $ C * D ’ ? (a) Nephew (b) Niece
(a) D (b) B (c) Nephew or Niece (d) None of these
(c) C (d) Data inadequate 16. Which of the following represents F is daughter of W?
7. A family has a man, his wife, their four sons and their wives. (a) W ÷ R + F (b) W × R × F
The family of every son also have 3 sons and one daughter. (c) W + R × F – T (d) W + R – F + T
Find out the total number of male members in the family. 17. Pointing to a photograph, a lady tells Pramod, “I am the only
(a) 4 (b) 8 daughter of this lady and her son is your maternal uncle,”
(c) 12 (d) 17 How is the speaker related to Pramod’s father?
8. A, B and C are sisters. D is the brother of E and E is the (a) Sister-in-law (b) Wife
daughter of B. How is A related to D? (c) Neither (a) nor (b) (d) Aunt
(a) Sister (b) Cousin 18. Deepak said to Nitin, “That boy playing with the football is
(c) Niece (d) Aunt the younger of the two brothers of the daughter of my
9. P is the brother of Q and R. S is the R’s mother. T is P’s father. father’s wife.” How is the boy playing football related to
Which of the following statements cannot be definitely true? Deepak?
(a) T is Q’s father (b) S is P’s mother (a) Son (b) Brother
(c) T is S’s husband (d) S is T’s son (c) Causin (d) Nephew
10. If 'A « B' means 'A is the father of B', 'A × B' means 'A is the 19. Pointing to a girl, Abhishek said, “She is daughter of the
mother of B' and 'A # B' means 'A is the husband of B', then only child of my father.” How is Abhishek’s wife related to
which of following means P is the grandson of Q? that girl?
(a) Q # R × S « P (b) Q « N × P # R (a) Daughter (b) Mother
(c) Q « L # N × P (d) P # N × M « Q (c) Aunt (d) Sister
Blood Relation A- 19
20. In a joint family there are father, mother, 3 married sons and 25. A man pointing to a photograph says, “The lady in the
one unmarried daughter. Of the sons, 2 have 2 daughters photograph is my nephew’s maternal grandmother and her
each, and one has a son. How many female members are son is my sister’s brother-in-law. How is the lady in the
there in the family? photograph related to his sister who has no other sister?
(a) 2 b) 3 (a) Mother (b) Cousin
(c) 6 (d) 9 (c) Mother-in-law (d) Sister-in-law
21. X and Y are brothers. R is the father of Y. S is the brother of 26. Pointing to a boy, Urmila said, "He is the son of my
T and maternal uncle of X. What is T to R? grandfather's only daughter." How is Urmila related to the
boy?
(a) Mother (b) Wife
(a) Mother (b) Maternal Aunt
(c) Sister (d) Brother
(c) Paternal Aunt (d) None of these
Considering the given options, it may be assumed that T is
27. Madhu said, 'My mother's only son Ashok has no son'.
wife of R.
Which of the following can be concluded?
22. A is the father of B, C is the daughter of B, D is the brother
(a) Ashok has only daughters
of B, E is the son of A. What is the relationship between C
and E? (b) Ashok is not married
(c) Ashok does not have a father
(a) Brother and sister (b) Cousins
(d) None of these
(c) Niece and uncle (d) Uncle and aunt
28. D is brother of B. M is brother of B. K is father of M. T is wife
23. Arun said, “This girl is the wife of the grandson of my
of K. How is B related to T?
mother”. Who is Arun to the girl?
(a) Son (b) Daughter
(a) Grandfather (b) Husband
(c) Son or Daughter (d) Data inadequate
(c) Father-in-law (d) Father
29. Pointing to a girl, Arun said, "She is the only daughter of my
24. Mohan is the son of Arun’s father’s sister. Prakash is the grandfather's son." How is the girl related to Arun?
son of Reva, who is the mother of Vikas and grandmother of
(a) Daughter (b) Sister
Arun. Pranab is the father of Neela and the grandfather of
Mohan. Reva is the wife of Pranab. How is the wife of Vikas (c) Cousin sister (d) Data inadequate
related to Neela? 30. Pointing to a photograph, Rasika said "He is the grandson
(a) Sister of my grandmother's only son". How is the boy in photograph
related to Rasika?
(b) Sister-in-law
(a) Son (b) Nephew
(c) Niece
(c) Brother (d) Cannot be determined
(d) None of these
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 7 (d) 13 (c) 19 (b) 25 (c)
2 (c) 8 (d) 14 (d) 20 (d) 26 (d)
3 (a) 9 (d) 15 (d) 21 (b) 27 (d)
4 (b) 10 (a) 16 (c) 22 (c) 28 (c)
5 (d) 11 (b) 17 (b) 23 (c) 29 (d)
6 (a) 12 (a) 18 (b) 24 (b) 30 (b)
father
parents. Now, A is the mother.,Hence, D must be the
father.
7. (d) The make members in the family are:- M T
(i) The man himself brother
(ii) his four sons; and So, M is nephew of N
(iii) his (3 × 4) = 12 grandsons.
15. (d) H
Hence total numbers of male members
= 1 + 4 + 12 =17
father
8. (d) E is the daughter of B & B is the brother of E. So, D is
the son of B. Also, A is the sister of B. Thus, A is D’s T
Aunt. mo
9. (d) P, Q, R are children of same parent. So, S, who is R’s the R D
r sister
mother and T, who is P’s father will be mother and
father of all three. However, it is not mentioned weather So, T is mother of D.
Q is male or female. So, (d) cannot be definitely true. 16. (c) W
10. (a) Q# R× S «P:
fath
Q Û R
er
(+) (-)
R F T
brother sister
S Û So, F is daughter of W.
(+) 17. (b) Clearly, the speaker’s brother is Pramod’s maternal
uncle. So, the speaker is Pramod’s mother or his father’s
P wife.
18. (b) Father’s wife — Mother; Mother’s daughter — Sister;
The gender of P is unknown, therefore 'p is grandson Sister’s younger brother — His brother. So, the boy is
of Q' is not true Deepak’s brother.
(b) Q « N × P # R : 19. (b) Girl is daughter of the only child of Abhishek’s father
or, Girl is daughter of Abhishek
Q Û Hence, girl is daughter of Abhisek’s wife.
(+) 20. (d) Female members: Mother, 3 daughter-in-law, one
Û daughter, Four grand daughters.
N Thus, there are nine female members.
(-) 21. (b) R is father of X and Y.
P Û R S is maternal uncle of X and Y.
(+) (-) Considering the given options, it may be assumed that
T is wife of R.
(Here, the gender of P is known, therefore 'P is grandson 22. (c) C is the daughter of B and A is father of B.
of Q'). 23. (c) Grandson of Arun’s mother means either son or nephew
11. (b) From given information, of Arun. Therefore, Arun is the father-in-law of that girl.
24. (b) The relations describe in the question can be
G H
(-) (+) represented as follows:
Wife / Husband
Reva Pranab
(Arun’s
R D Grand mother)
(-)
r
ste Neela
Hence, G is the mother of D. Prakash Arun Father Si -law (Daughter of
(Son of Reva) Arun Father’s Sister in Pranab)
12. (a) As X is the son of Y’s father and Y is the sister of X he
So Vikas Vikas
has to be the brother of Y. n (Son of Reva) wife
Arun
13. (c) The sister of one’s mother is one’s maternal aunt. Hence
Mohan
the man is the husband of the boy’s maternal aunt. (Grandson
of Pranab)
Thus wife of Vikas is sister in-law of Neela.
Blood Relation A- 21
25. (c) 27. (d) It is possible that Ashok is married, that he has no
child, etc.
Mother/Photograph
la w 28. (c) K(+) T(–)
in -
ot her-
M
Ne
29. (d) Girl = the only daughter of Arun's grandfather's son.
ph
= the only daughter of Arun's father or uncle
ew
Son
= Arun's sister or cousin
Brother 30. (b) Boy = Grandson of Rasika's grandmother's only son =
Grandson of Rasika's father = Rasika's nephew
26. (d) Boy = son of Urmila's grandfather's only daughter
= son of Urmila's paternal aunt
= Urmila's cousin
Hence, Urmila is also the boy's cousin.
CHAPTER
6 Problem Solving
EXERCISE
Directions (Q. 1-5): Study the following information carefully Directions (11-15) : Study the following information to answer
and answer the questions given below: the given questions :
A, B, C, D, E and F are six students studying in a class. Each of Six plays – A, B, C, D, E and F are to be staged on six days of the
them has a different height and weight. The tallest is not the week starting from Monday and ending on Saturday. Play C is
heaviest. E is taller than only A but lighter than C. B is taller than staged on Tuesday. Plays A, F and B are staged one after the
D and A and heavier than only E and F. A is lighter than only D. E other in the same order. Play D is not staged on Monday or
is heavier than F. D is taller than F and B is not the tallest. Wednesday.
1. How many of them are heavier than E? 11. How many plays are staged after play A is staged ?
(a) One (b) Two
(a) One (b) Two
(c) Three (d) Four
(c) Three (d) None of these
12. Four of the following five form a group based on the days
2. How many of them are shorter than B? that they are staged. Which one of them does not belong to
(a) Two (b) Four that group ?
(c) Three (d) Five (a) EC (b) FD
3. Who among them is the tallest? (c) CA (d) AF
(a) F (b) A 13. Which play is staged immediately before the day play E is
(c) E (d) C staged ?
4. Who, among them is third from top if arranged in descending (a) B (b) A
order of height? (c) F
(a) B (b) F (d) There is no such play staged
(c) D (d) Data inadequate 14. If play D was staged on a Monday, which of the following
5. Who among them is the lightest? plays would definitely be staged on a Saturday (all the other
conditions given above remain the same) ?
(a) F (b) E
(a) B (b) A
(c) A (d) C
(c) E (d) E or B
Directions (Q. 6 - 10): These questions are based on the basis
15. Which play is staged on Thursday ?
of following information. Study it carefully and answer the
(a) B (b) E
questions.
(c) D (d) F
Eight executives J, K, L, M, N, O, P and Q are sitting around a
Directions (Qs.16-20): Study the information given below to
circular table for a meeting. J is second to the right of P who is answer the questions that follow :
third to the right of K. M is second to the left of O who sits (i) There is a family of 5 persons A, B, C, D and E.
between P and J. L is not a neighbour of K or N. (ii) They are working as a doctor, a teacher, a trader, a lawyer
6. Who is to the immediate left of L? and a farmer.
(a) Q (b) O (iii) B, an unmarried teacher, is the daughter of A.
(c) K (d) None of these (iv) E, a lawyer, is the brother of C.
7. Who is to the immediate left of K? (v) C is the husband of the only married couple in the family.
(a) N (b) J (vi) Daughter-in-law of A is a doctor.
(c) Q (d) Cannot be determined 16. Which of the following is a group of female members in the
8. Which of the following is the correct position of N? family ?
(a) Second to the right of K (a) A and D (b) D and E
(b) To the immediate left of K (c) A, C and E (d) Data inadequate
(c) To the immediate right of M 17. Which of the following is the married couple ?
(d) To the immediate right of K (a) A and B (b) C and D
9. Who is third to the right of P ? (c) A and D (d) B and C
(a) L (b) J 18. Which of the following is a group of male members in the
(c) Q (d) N family ?
10. Which of the following groups of persons have the first (a) A, B and C (b) B and D
person sitting between the other two? (c) A, C and E (d) Data inadequate
(a) PJO (b) OPJ 19. Who is the doctor in the family ?
(c) OPM (d) MPO (a) A (b) B
(c) C (d) D
A- 24 Problem Solving
20. Who is the trader in the family ? 30. More than two teachers were teaching which subject?
(a) A (b) B (a) History (b) French
(c) C (d) Data inadequate (c) Hindi (d) Geography
Directions (Qs. 21 - 25) : The questions below are based on the 31. D, B and A were teaching which of the following subjects?
following statements. (a) English only (b) Hindi only
Asha and Charu are good in Mathematics and Athletics. Deepa
(c) Hindi and English (d) English and Geography
and Asha are good in Athletics and Studies, Charu and Beena are
good in General Knowledge and Mathematics. Deepa, Beena and Directions (Qs. 32 - 34) : Study the following information to
Ela are good in Studies and General Knowledge. Ela and Deepa answer the questions that follow:
are good in Studies and Arts. A family consists of seven members P, Q, R, S, T, U and V. While
21. Who is good in Studies, General Knowledge, Athletics and one of them is a student, the other six follow different professions
Arts ? of Architect, Lawyer, Professor, Manager, Doctor and Engineer.
(a) Asha (b) Beena There are two married couples in the family. P and U are Architect
(c) Charu (d) Deepa and Doctor, respectively. S, the father of Q and the grandfather of
22. Who is good in Studies, General Knowledge and V, is an Engineer. No lady in the family is an Engineer or a Lawyer.
Mathematics ? V, who is a student, is the grandson of T.
(a) Asha (b) Beena 32. Which of the following is one of the married couples ?
(c) Charu (d) Deepa (a) Q R (b) Q U
23. Who is good in Studies, Mathematics and Athletics ? (c) P R (d) Data inadequate
(a) Asha (b) Beena 33. How is R related to V ?
(c) Charu (d) Deepa (a) Mother (b) Aunt
24. Who is good in Athletics, General Knowledge and (c) Sister (d) Data inadequate
Mathematics ? 34. What is T’s profession ?
(a) Asha (b) Beena (a) Professor
(c) Charu (d) Deepa (b) Manager
25. Who is good in Studies, General Knowledge and Arts but (c) Professor or Manager
not in Athletics ? (d) Doctor
(a) Asha (b) Beena Directions (Qs. 35 - 37) : Study the information below to answer
(c) Charu (d) Ela these questions:
Directions (Qs. 26 - 27): Study the following information carefully There are six boys in a group. Mahesh and Ramesh are in the
and answer the questions given below: Hockey team together. Parvesh has defeated Ramesh in
(i) Six children B, D, C, M, J and K are split in two groups of badminton but lost to Suresh in tennis. Mahesh and Parvesh are
three each and are made to stand in two rows in such a way in opposite teams of basketball. Naresh represents his state in
that a child in one row is exactly facing a child in the other cricket while Samresh does so at the district level. Boys who play
row. chess don't play football, basketball or volleyball. Mahesh and
(ii) M is not at the ends of any row and is to the right of J, who Parvesh are together in the volleyball team. Boys who play football
is facing C. K is to the left of D, who is facing M. also play hockey. Suresh plays chess and competes with Ramesh.
26. Which of the following groups of children are in the same
Naresh and Samresh are good footballers. Suresh also plays
row?
hockey and tennis quite well.
(a) BMD (b) MJK
35. Name the boys who don't play the game of football.
(c) BDC (d) None of these
(a) Ramesh and Suresh (b) Ramesh and Samresh
27. Who is to the immediate left of B?
(a) M (b) D (c) Suresh and Naresh (d) Ramesh and Naresh
(c) J (d) Data inadequate 36. Which player plays the maximum number of games?
(a) Parvesh (b) Ramesh
Directions (Qs. 28-31) : Read the following information to answer
(c) Samresh (d) Naresh
these questions:
37. Which is the most popular game with this group of boys?
In a school, there were five teachers. A and B were teaching Hindi
(a) Hockey (b) Badminton
and English. C and B were teaching English and Geography. D
and A were teaching Mathematics and Hindi. E and B were teaching (c) Cricket (d) Football
History and French. Directions (Qs. 38-40) : Study the information below to answer
these questions.
28. Who among the teachers was teaching maximum number of
subjects? There are five types of cards namely A, B, C, D and E and there
are in all 15 cards i.e., three cards of each type. These cards are to
(a) A (b) C
be inserted in 15 envelopes. There are three colours of these
(c) B (d) D envelopes namely red, yellow and brown. There are five envelopes
29. Which of the following pairs was teaching both Geography of each colour.
and Hindi? • B, D and E types of cards are inserted in red envelopes.
(a) A and B (b) C and A • A, Band C types of cards are to be inserted in yellow
(c) B and C (d) None of these envelopes.
Problem Solving A- 25
• C, D and E types of cards are to be inserted in brown (a) Red-1, Brown-1, Yellow-1
envelopes. (b) Yellow-1, Brown-2
• Two cards each of B and D types are enclosed in red (c) Red-1, Yellow-2
envelopes. (d) Red-1, Brown-2
38. Which of the following combinations of types of cards and
40. Which of the following combinations of types of cards and
the number of cards are definitely correct in respect of yellow
the number of cards and colour of envelope are definitely
coloured envelopes?
(a) A-3, C-l, B-1 (b) A-2, B-1, C-2 correct?
(c) A-2, E-l, D-2 (d) B-1, C-2, D-2 (a) C-1, D-2, E-2; Brown
39. Which of the following combinations of colour of the (b) C-2, D-1, E-2; Brown
envelope and the number of cards are definitely correct in (c) A-2, B-2, C-1; Yellow
respect of E-type of cards? (d) B-2, D-2, A-1; Red
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 8 (d) 15 (d) 22 (b) 29 (d) 36 (a)
2 (b) 9 (a) 16 (d) 23 (a) 30 (c) 37 (a)
3 (d) 10 (b) 17 (b) 24 (c) 31 (b) 38 (a)
4 (c) 11 (c) 18 (d) 25 (d) 32 (d) 39 (d)
5 (a) 12 (b) 19 (d) 26 (d) 33 (d) 40 (b)
6 (d) 13 (d) 20 (d) 27 (a) 34 (c)
7 (c) 14 (c) 21 (d) 28 (c) 35 (a)
(S
te
on
gh
N
s)
au
(D
(–) B
(Unmarried-
Teacher) (+) (+)
(–) D C E
Doctor) (Unmarried
lawyer)
A- 26 Problem Solving
16. (d) Since gender of A is unknown we cannot conclude Solution for (Qs. 32 - 34) : The given information can be
regarding the options given. summerised in a table that follows:
17. (b) From the above C and D are the married couple.
Members Profession
18. (d) Same reason as in Q. 82. S(t) Û T(-)
P Architect
19. (d) D, the wife of the C is the doctor in the family. ¯
Q ?
20. (d) Professions of A and C are not given. Q
R ?
Solution for (Qs. 21 - 25) : The given information can be S(+) Engineer V(+)
summerised in a table that follows: T(–) Professor or Manager
U Doctor
Students Math Athletics Studies GK Arts V(+) Student
Asha × ×
Charu × × 32. (d) Additional information is required to answer the
Deepa
question.
×
33. (d) Data inadequate.
Beena × ×
34. (c) T is either a professor or a Manager.
Ela × ×
Solution for (Qs. 35 - 37)
shows good Mahesh Hockey, Basketball, Volleyball
× shows not good
Ramesh Hockey, Badminton, Chess
21. (d) From the table above, it is clear that Deepa is good
Parvesh Badminton, Tennis, Basketball,
in Studies, General Knowledge and Arts.
Volleyball
22. (b) Clearly, Beena is good in Studies, General Knowledge
and Mathematics. Suresh Hockey, Tennis, Chess
23. (a) Obviously, Asha is good in Studies, Mathematics and Naresh Hockey, Cricket, Football
Athletics. Samresh Hockey, Cricket, Football
24. (c) Charu is good in Athletics, General Knowledge and
Solution for (Qs. 38-40)
Mathematics.
25. (d) From the last row of the above table, it is clear that Card
Ela is good in Studies, General Knowledge and Arts Envelop colour
1 2 3 4 5
but not in Athletics.
Brown C C D E E
Solution for (Qs. 26 - 27) Red B B D D E
C D K Yellow A A A B C
J M B 38. (a) A – 3, B – 1, C – 1
Solution for (Qs. 28 - 31) 39. (d) Brown – 2, Red – 1
40. (b) C – 2, D – 1, E – 2, Brown
Teacher Subjects
A Hindi, Eng, Math
B Hindi, Eng, Geo, History, French
C Eng, Geo
D Math, Hindi
E History, French
CHAPTER
7 Logical Venn-
Diagrams
Venn diagrams are pictorial way of represent the set of article. 3 ® Farmer
There are different regions which needs proper understanding 4 ® Doctor who is farmer also
for solving problems based on given Venn diagrams. 5 ® Engineer who is doctor also
TYPE- I 6 ® Engineer who is farmer also
Case I:
7 ® Person who is Engineer, doctor and farmer.
P Q Note 1: When one class of items is completely included in the
another class of item and is represented by the given diagram.
I
Here IA represent only A
IB represent only B
IIAB represent A and B
Case II: Three articles Eg: I – Mango
P Q II – Fruit
Here all mango are fruit.
1 5 2 Note 2: If two classes of item are completely different from each
other but they all are completely included in third class then the
7 relationship is represent of the diagram.
6 4
3 III
I II
R
1 – represent P only
2 – represent Q only
3 – represent R only Eg: I – represent potato
4 – represent Q and R (not P) II – represent onion
5 – represent P and Q (not R) III – represent vegetable
6 – represent P and R (not Q) Note 3 : If two group of items having some common relationship
7 – represent P, Q and R and both of them are all included in third class then the relationship
Engineer Doctor is represented by the diagram.
1 5 2 III
7 I II
6 4
Ex:
3
Ex: Brother, Father, Male.
I ® Brother
Farmer II ® Father
1 ® Engineer
III ® Male
2 ® Doctor
Some Brother may be Father and all are male.
A- 28 Logical Venn-Diagrams
Note 4: When one class of item is completely included in another Note 6: When two group of items are completely unrelated to
group while third is not related to both of them then such condition each other while they are partly related with third group of item
are diagrammatically represented by and is shown in.
II
I II III
I
III
Ex: Cloth, Red, Flowers.
Some cloth are Red and also some Flowers are red.
Ex: Cricketer, player and farmer Note 7: When group of items are completely different from each
I – Cricketer other
II – Player
III – Farmer
all cricketer are player and farmer and not. I II
Note 5: If three group of things are related to each other.
I II III
EXERCISE
1. In the given figure in a garden, square represent the area 3. Which are the numbers that makes their presence felt in
where jackfruit trees are grown, circle represent mango trees only one of the geometric figures.
and triangle represent coconut trees. Which number
represent the common area in which all types of trees are (a) 4, 6, 7
grown. 6 1
1 2
(a) 4 8 2 (b) 1, 2, 9
7 3 3 8 7 9
(b) 3 5
9 (c) 3, 7, 9
(c) 7 4
(d) 8 (d) 2, 3, 8
2. The diagram represent the student who are singers, dancers 4. In the following venn diagram identify the better which
and poets. denotes players who are also doctors but not artist.
5. In the given figure, the circle represents body, triangle 10. Which of the diagram represents the given statements:-
represents players and squares represents rural. What Some of the players are tennis players, some tennis players
portion represents rural sports boys. are hockey players. No Cricket player is a hockey players?
(a) E
(b) F B C
(a) (b)
A D
(c) D
E F
(d) B
(c) (d)
6. School children
11. Which of the following diagram represents the country,
a
states and District?
b
d c
f (a) (b)
Artist
e
g
(c) (d)
Singers
Above diagram represents school children, artist and
singers. Study the diagram and identify the region. Which Directions (Qs. 12-15) : In each of these questions, three words
represents those school children who are artist not singers. are related in some way. The relationship among the words in
(a) a (b) b question can best represents by one of the five diagram.
(c) f (d) e
7. Which one of the following Venn diagram represent the
best relationship between Snake, Lizard, Reptiles?
(a) (b)
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
(c) (d)
(e)
8. Which of the following diagram represents correct
relationship Judge, Thief, Criminal? 12. Elephants, Carnivore, Tiger.
13. Hospital, Nurse, Patient.
14. Rings, Ornaments, Diamond Rings.
(a) (b) 15. Furniture, Table, Books.
16. Which diagram correctly represents the relationship
between politicians, poets and women?
(c) (d)
(a) (b)
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
23. How many students take Maths and Physics but not
Spanish? Maths Spanish
(c) (d)
(a) 12 58 3
19. Out of 100 families in the neighbourhood, 50 have radios, 75 7
have TVs and 25 have VCRs. Only 10 families have all three b) 7 12 5
and each VCR owner also has a TV. If some families have
radio only, how many have only TV? (c) 3
(a) 30 (b) 35
(c) 40 (d) 45 (d) 5 Physics
20. Which diagram correctly represents the relationship 24. Which figure represent the relationship among Sun, Moon,
between Human beings, Teachers, Graduates? Molecule?
(c) (d)
(c) (d)
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 6 (b) 11 (c) 16 (d) 21 (d)
2 (b) 7 (d) 12 (d) 17 (b) 22 (c)
3 (b) 8 (c) 13 (c) 18 (c) 23 (a)
4 (c) 9 (b) 14 (b) 19 (c) 24 (c)
5 (c) 10 (c) 15 (d) 20 (a) 25 (b)
Criminal
Judge Thief
Judge Thief
Criminal
Human Beings
Cricket players
Graduates
Teacher
Hockey
10. (c)
Tennis
Cricket
21. (d) Snake is different from Lizard, but both are reptiles.
States
Reptiles
District Country
11. (c) Snake Lizard
23. (a) 12 students take Maths and Physics but not ‘Spanish.
Poets Women 24. (c) Every thing is composed of molecules. Sun is different
from Moon.
Molecules
20
17. (b) 20% of 80 = ´ 80 = 16
100
Sun Moon
50
50% of remaining = (80 – 16) × = 32
100
The families which do not own any vehicle.
= 80 – (32 + 16) = 80 – 48 = 32
18. (c) Judge is different from both the thief and criminal. 25. (b) The required region should be common to circle and
The thief comes under the class criminal. square and outside the triangle. Such region is marked
‘2’.
CHAPTER
8 Syllogism
P
M P and M, P
M
Here, the circle denoting M and P do not intersect at all and [Possibility]
therefore, truely represents
“No M are P” No M are P (E type):
(iii) Representation of “Some M are P” (I type): M P
This representation will be in two ways :
Either (a): Some M are P (I type):
Either:
M P
M P
Here it is clear from the picture that shaded part of M is Some M are P
some part of P and shaded part of P is some part of M. Thus [Some M are not P]
“Some M are P”. Similarly, unshaded part of M is not P and Or :
unshaded part of P is not M. Thus it represents “Some M
are not P”. M
Or (b): P
M
Some M are P
P [All P are M]
Some M are not P (O type):
Here, only shaded part of M is P also. Thus we can say Either:
“Some M are P.”
(iv) Representation of “Some M are not P” (O type): M P
This representation will be in three ways :
Either (a):
Some M are not P
[Some M are P]
M P Or:
P
Here, unshaded part of M is not a part of P. Thus it represents
“Some M are not P.” But the shaded part represents “Some M
M are P”. Some M are not P
[All P are M]
Syllogism A- 33
EXERCISE
Directions (Q. 1 - 25): In each question below, there are two or Conclusions : I Some ledgers are keys.
three statements followed by conclusions numbered I, II or more. II. Some keys are books.
You have to take the given statements to be true even if they 9. Statements : Some roses are thorns.
seem to be at variance from commonly known facts and then All thorns are flowers.
decide which of the given conclusions logically follow from the No flower is a petal.
three statements. Conclusions : I. No petal is a rose.
Give answer (a) if only conclusion I follows. II. Some flowers are roses.
Give answer (b) if only conclusion II follows. 10. Statements: All leaders are good team workers.
Give answer (c) if neither I nor II follows. All good team workers are good orators.
Give answer (d) if both I and II follow. Conclusions: I. Some good team workers are leaders.
1. Statements : II. All good orators are leaders.
Some pencils are knives. 11. Statements:
All knives are papers. All terrorists are human.
Some papers are books. All humans are bad.
Conclusions: Conclusions:
I. Some books are pencils. I. All terrorists are bad.
II. Some papers are pencils. II. No human can be a terrorist.
2. Statements: 12. Statements:
Some roofs are figures. Some teachers are followers.
All figures are lions. Some followers are famous.
All lions are goats. Conclusions:
Conclusions: I. Some teachers are famous.
I. Some goats are roofs. II. Some followers are teachers.
II. All goats are figures 13. Statements:
3. Statements: Some dedicated souls are angels.
All fish are birds. All social workers are angels.
Some hens are fish. Conclusions:
Conclusion: I. Some dedicated souls are social workers.
I. Some hens are birds. II. Some social workers are dedicated souls.
II. No birds are hens; 14. Statements:
4. Statements: All rats are bells.
All bats are boys. All bells are cars.
All boys are gloves. Conclusions:
Conclusions: I. All bells are rats.
I. Some gloves are bats. II. Some cars are neither bells nor rats.
II. All bats are gloves. III. No car is rat.
5. Statements: Some doctors are nurses. (a) Only I (b) Only II
All nurses are patients. (c) Only III (d) None follow
Conclusions: 15. Statements:
I. All doctors are patients. All roads are trees.
II. Some patients are doctors. No tree is soap.
6. Statements : All toys are dolls . Conclusions:
All dolls are jokers. I. No soap is road.
Some toys are cars. II. Some trees are roads.
Conclusions : I. Some cars are jockers. III. No road is soap.
II. Some dolls are cars. (a) Only I (b) Only II
7. Statements : All pens are boxes. (c) Only III (d) All follow
Some boxes are blades. 16. Statements:
Some blades are files. Some spectacles are boxes.
Conclusions : I. Some blades are pens. No bat is a ball.
II. Some pens are files. Some boxes are balls.
8. Statements : All books are ledgers. Conclusions:
All pens are keys. I. Some boxes are not bats.
Some pens are books. II. Some bats are spectacles.
A- 34 Syllogism
III. No bat is a box. Conclusions:
IV. No ball is a spectacle. I. All cricketer are students
(a) Only I follows (b) Only I and III follow II. All children are players.
(c) Only II & III follow (d) Only IV follows (a) Only conclusion I follows.
17. Statements: (b) Only conclusion II follows.
All fans are tubelights. (c) Both conclusions I or II follows.
No pen is a bulb. (d) Neither conclusion I nor conclusion II follows.
Some bulbs are fans. 22. Statements:
Conclusions: 1. No teacher comes to the school on a bicycle.
I. Some pens are tubelights. 2. Anand comes to the school on a bicycle.
II. No pens are tubelights.
Conclusions:
III. Some tubelights are fans.
I. Anand is not a teacher.
IV. All tubelights are fans.
II. Anand is a student.
(a) Only I and II follow (b) Only I, II & III follow
(a) Conclusion I alone can be drawn.
(c) Either I or II & III follow (d) Only III & IV follow
18. Statements: (b) Conclusion II alone can be drawn.
All trucks are vans. (c) Both Conclusions can be drawn.
All vans are cars. (d) Both Conclusions can not be drawn.
All cars are trains. 23. Statements:
Conclusions: 1. Some food are sweet.
I. All trains are trucks. 2. Some food are sour.
II. All cars are trucks. Conclusions:
III. All trucks are trains. I. All food are either sweet or sour.
IV. All vans are trains. II. Some sweets are sour.
(a) All follow (b) Only I and II follow (a) Only Conclusion I follows.
(c) Only II & III follow (d) None of these (b) Only conclusion II follows.
19. Statements: (c) Both Conclusions I and II follows.
1. All poets are intelligent. (d) Neither conclusion I nor II follows.
2. All singers are intelligent. 24. Statements:
Conclusions: 1. Science teachers do not use plastic bags.
I. All singers are poets. 2. Plastic bags are not use by some engineers.
II. Some intelligent persons are not singers. Conclusions:
(a) Only conclusion I follows. I. All Science teachers are engineers.
(b) Only conclusion II follows. II. All Engineers do not use plastic bags.
(c) Either conclusion I or II follows. (a) Only conclusion I follows.
(d) Neither conclusion I nor II follows.
(b) Only conclusion II follows.
20. Statements:
(c) Both conclusions I and II follow.
1. All students are boys.
(d) Neither conclusion I nor II follows.
2. No boy is dull.
25. Statements:
Conclusions:
I. There are no girls in the class. 1. All students are girls.
II. No student is dull. 2. No girl is dull.
(a) Only conclusion I follows. Conclusions:
(b) Only conclusion II follows. I. There are no boys in the class.
(c) Both conclusions I and II follows. II. No student is dull.
(d) Neither conclusion I nor conclusion II follows. (a) Only conclusion II follows.
21. Statements: (b) Both conclusions I and II follow.
1. All children are students. (c) Neither conclusion I nor conclusion II follows.
2. All students are players. (d) Only conclusion I follows.
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 7 (c) 13 (d) 19 (d) 25 (b)
2 (a) 8 (d) 14 (d) 20 (b)
3 (a) 9 (b) 15 (d) 21 (b)
4 (d) 10 (a) 16 (a) 22 (a)
5 (b) 11 (a) 17 (c) 23 (d)
6 (d) 12 (b) 18 (d) 24 (d)
Syllogism A- 35
All boy are gloves. (A-Type) All pens are keys. (A-type)
A + A Þ A type Conclusion. Some books are keys.
\ All bats are gloves. (I + A = I-type conclusion)
This is Conclusion II. Some keys are books.
Conclusion I is Converse of this Conclusion. (Conversion)
5. (b) Some doctors are nurses. (I-Type) \ II follows.
Some pens are books. (I-type)
All nurses are patients. (A-Type) All books are ledgers. (A-type)
I + A Þ I -type Conclusion. Some pens are ledgers.
\ Some doctors are patients.
(I + A = I-type)
Conclusion II is Converse of this Conclusion.
Sol. 6-10 Some ledgers are pens. (conversion) (I-type)
6. (d) All toys are dolls. (A-type)
All pens are keys. (A-type)
All dolls are jokers (A-type) Some ledgers are keys.
All toys are jokers. (I + A = I-type)
[A + A = A-type conclusion] \ I follows.
A- 36 Syllogism
9. (b) Some roses are thorns. (A-type) 18. (d) 1st statement + 2nd statement gives: All trucks are
cars ... (A). Hence II does not follow, on conversion.
(A) + last statement gives conclusion III. III, on
All thorns are flowers. (A-type)
conversion, gives: Some trains are trucks. Hence I does
Some roses are flowers. not follow. The last two statements gives conclusion IV.
(I + A = I-type) 19. (d) Both the Premises are Universal Affirmative (A-type).
Some flowers are roses. (conversion) These two Premises are not aligned. Now take the
Converse of one of the Premises to align them.
Hence, II follows.
No flower is petal. (E-type) All singers are intelligent.
No petal is flower. (conversion)
Some intelligent are poets.
Some flowers are roses. A + I Þ No Conclusion.
Some roses are not petals. (E + I = O*-type) 20. (b) First Premise is Universal Affirmative and the second
Hence, I does not follow. Premise is Universal Negative (E-type).
10. (a) All leaders are good team workers. All students are boys.
Some good team workers are leaders. (conversion)
Hence, I follows.
No boys is dull
All good team workers are good orators.
A + E Þ E-type of Conclusion
Some good orators are good team workers.(conversion) “No student is dull”
Hence, II does not follow. This is conclusion II.
11. (a) A + A = A; i.e. All terrorists are human. 21. (b) Both the Premises are Universal Affirmative (A-type).
12. (b) I does not follow. But II follows because it is conversion All children are students.
of the first statement.
14. (d) Statement (a) + Statement (b) gives the conclusion
“All rats are cars” [ Q A + A = A] Þ “Some cars are All students are players.
rats”. Hence neither conclusion II nor conclusion III A + A Þ A -type of Conclusion.
follows. Conclusion I does not follow from statement I “All children are players.”
since conversion of statement (a) will give the con This is Conclusion II.
clusion “Some bells are rats”. 22. (a) It is clear that Anand is not a teacher. Anand may be
15. (d) Conversion of statement (a) gives conclusion II. Hence, student or clerical staff.
conclusion II follows. Again statement (a) + statement 23. (d) Both the Premises are Particular Affirmative (I-type).
(b) gives conclusion III [Q A + E = E]. Hence, con- No conclusion follows from the two particular Premises.
clusion III follows. Conclusion I follows from 24. (d) From general statements, Universal Conclusion cannot
conversion of conclusion III. Hence, All follow. be drawn.
16. (a) Some boxes are balls + No ball is a bat (conversion of
25. (b) All students are girls.
2nd statement) = Some boxes are not bats [I + E = 0].
Hence, I follows and III does not. Now, some spectacles
are boxes and conclusion I give no conclusion. Hence,
No girl is dull
II and IV do not follow.
17. (c) Some bulbs are fans + All fans are tubelights = Some A + E Þ E-type of Conclusion
bulbs are tubelights ... (a) [I + A = I]. Now, statement (b) “No student is dull”
+ (a) gives: .Some tubelights are not pens. Hence, This is Conclusion II.
conclusions I and II can’t be established. III follows All students, without exception are girls. Therefore,
from first statement on conversion. But IV does not. there are no boys who are students.
But I and II make a complementary pair [I – E pair].
Hence, either I or II follows.
CHAPTER
9 Arithmetical
Reasoning
Arithmetical Reasoning tests the ability to solve basic arithmetic EXAMPLE 3.
problems encountered in everyday life. These problems require
A student got twice as many sums wrong as he got right. If
basic mathematical skills like addition, subtraction, multiplication,
he attempted 48 sums in all, how many did he solve correctly?
division etc. The tests include operations with whole numbers,
rational numbers, ratio and proportion, interest and percentage, (a) 12 (b) 16
and measurement. Arithmetical reasoning is one factor that helps (c) 18 (d) 24
characterize mathematics comprehension, and it also assesses Sol. (b) Suppose the boy got x sums right and 2x sums wrong.
logical thinking. Then, x + 2x = 48 3x = 48 x = 16.
EXAMPLE 1. EXAMPLE 4.
The total of the ages of Amar, Akbar and Anthony is 80 In a group of cows and hens, the number of legs are 14 more
years. What was the total of their ages three years ago ? than twice the number of heads. The number of cows is
(a) 71 years (b) 72 years (a) 5 (b) 7
(c) 74 years (d) 77 years (c) 10 (d) 12
Sol. (a) Sol. (b) Let the number of cows be x and the number of hens be
Required sum = (80 - 3 x 3) years = (80 - 9) years = 71 years. y.
Then, 4x + 2y = 2 (x + y) + 14 4x + 2y = 2x + 2y + 14 2x = 14
EXAMPLE 2.
x = 7.
Two bus tickets from city A to B and three tickets from city
A to C cost Rs. 77 but three tickets from city A to B and two EXAMPLE 5.
tickets from city A to C cost Rs. 73. What are the fares for Rani, Reeta , Sukhada, Jane and Radhika are friends. Reeta
cities B and C from A ? is 18 years of her age, Radhika is younger to Reeta, Rani is
(a) `4, `23 (b) `13, `17 in between Radhika and Sukhada while Reeta is in Between
Jane and Radhika. If there be a difference of two years
(c) `15, `14 (d) `17, `13 between the ages of girls from eldest to the youngest, how
Sol. (b) Let Rs. x be the fare of city B from city A and Rs. y be the old is Sukhada?
fare of city C from city A. (a) 10 years (b) 12 years
Then, 2x + 3y = 77 ...(i) (c) 14 years (d) 16 years
and 3x + 2y = 73 ...(ii) Sol. (b) Arranging them on the basis of their ages,
Multiplying (i) by 3 and (ii) by 2 and subtracting, we get: Jane>Reeta>Radhika>Rani>Sukhada
5y = 85 or y = 17. If Reeta is 18 years old then Sukhada is 12 years
Putting y = 17 in (i), we get: x = 13.
EXERCISE
1. The 30 members of a club decided to play a badminton 2. A tailor had a number of shirt pieces to cut from a roll of
singles tournament. Every time a member loses a game he is fabric. He cut each roll of equal length into 10 pieces. He cut
out of the tournament. There are no ties. What is the at the rate of 45 cuts a minute. How many rolls would be cut
minimum number of matches that must be played to in 24 minutes?
determine the winner? (a) 32 rolls (b) 54 rolls
(a) 15 (b) 29
(c) 61 (d) None of these (c) 108 rolls (d) 120 rolls
A- 38 Arithmetical Reasoning
3. In a class of 60 students, the number of boys and girls (a) ` 4, ` 23 (b) ` 13, `17
participating in the annual sports is in the ratio 3 : 2 (c) ` 15, `. 14 (d) ` 17, `13
respectively. The number of girls not participating in the 12. I have a few sweets to be distributed. If I keep 2, 3 or 4 in a
sports is 5 more than the number of boys not participating pack, I am left with one sweet. If I keep 5 in a pack, I am left
in the sports. If the number of boys participating in the with none. What is the minimum number of sweets I have to
sports is 15, then how many girls are there in the class? pack and distribute ?
(a) 20 (b) 25 (a) 25 (b) 37
(c) 30 (d) Data inadequate (c) 54 (d) 65
4. At a dinner party every two guests used a bowl of rice 13. Mr. X, a mathematician, defines a number as 'connected
between them, every three guests used a bowl of daal with 6 if it is divisible by 6 or if the sum of its digits is 6, or
between them and every four used a bowl of meat between if 6 is one of the digits of the number. Other numbers are all
them. There were altogether 65 dishes. How many guests 'not connected with 6'. As per this definition, the number of
were present at the party ? integers from 1 to 60 (both inclusive) which are not
(a) 60 (b) 65 connected with 6 is
(c) 90 (d) None of these (a) 18 (b) 22
5. In a family, each daughter has the same number of brothers (c) 42 (d) 43
as she has sisters and each son has twice as many sisters 14. A player holds 13 cards of four suits, of which seven are
as he has brothers. How many sons are there in the family? black and six are red. There are twice as many diamonds as
(a) 2 (b) 3 spades and twice as many hearts as diamonds. How many
(c) 4 (d) 5 clubs does he hold ?
6. In a garden, there are 10 rows and 12 columns of mango (a) 4 (b) 5
trees. The distance between the two trees is 2 metres and a (c) 6 (d) 7
distance of one metre is left from all sides of the boundary 15. Nitin's age was equal to square of some number last year
of the garden. The length of the garden is and the following year it would be cube of a number. If
(a) 20 m (b) 22 m again Nitin's age has to be equal to the cube of some number,
(c) 24 m (d) 26 m then for how long he will have to wait?
7. In a family, the father took 1/4 of the cake and he had 3 times (a) 10 years (b) 38 years
as much as each of the other members had. The total number (c) 39 years (d) 64 years
of family members is 16. At the end of a business conference the ten people present
(a) 3 (b) 7 all shake hands with each other once. How many
(c) 10 (d) 12 handshakes will there be altogether ?
8. In three coloured boxes - Red, Green and Blue, 108 balls are (a) 20 (b) 45
placed. There are twice as many balls in the green and red (c) 55 (d) 90
boxes combined as there are in the blue box and twice as 17. Anand, David , Karim and Mano are fans of games. Each
many in the blue box as there are in the red box. How many has a different favourite game among hockey, chess, cricket
balls are there in the green box ? and football. David doesn't watch cricket and hocky
(a) 18 (b) 36 matches. Anand doesn't like hockey, chess and cricket.
(c) 45 (d) None of these Mano doesn't watch cricket. Which is favourite game of
9. A, B, C, D and E play a game of cards. A says to B, "If you karim?
give me 3 cards, you will have as many as I have at this (a) chess (b) cricket
moment while if D takes 5 cards from you, he will have as (c) football (d) hockey
many as E has." A and C together have twice as many cards 18. Six friends are sitting in a circle and playing cards. Kenny is
as E has. B and D together also have the same number of to be the left of Danny. Michael is in between Bobby and
cards as A and C taken together. If together they have 150 Johnny. Roger is in between Kenny and Bobby. Who is
cards, how many cards has C got ? sitting to the right of Michael?
(a) 28 (b) 29 (a) Danny (b) Johnny
(c) 31 (d) 35 (c) Kenny (d) Bobby
10. A man wears socks of two colours - Black and brown. He 19. Akhilesh is taller than Sheebu, Aman is not as tall as
has altogether 20 black socks and 20 brown socks in a Akhilesh but is taller than Tejinder. Sheebu is also not as
drawer. Supposing he has to take out the socks in the dark, tall as Aman but is taller than Tejinder. Who is the tallest?
how many must he take out to be sure that he has a matching (a) Akhilesh (b) Sheebu
pair ? (c) Aman (d) Tejinder
(a) 3 (b) 20 20. F has less money than H but more man G. E has more than F
(c) 39 (d) None of these but less than H. Who is the poorest?
11. Two bus tickets from city A to B and three tickets from city (a) F (b) E
A to C cost Rs. 77 but three tickets from city A to B and two (c) H (d) G
tickets from city A to C cost `73. What are the fares for
cities B and C from A ?
Arithmetical Reasoning A- 39
EXERCISE
1. If the two hands in a clock are 3 minutes divisions apart, 10. At what time between 5.30 and 6 will the hands of a clock be
then the angle between them is at right angles?
(a) 3° (b) 18°
5 7
(c) 24° (d) 60° (a) 43 min. past 5 (b) 43 min. past 5
11 11
2. At what approximate time between 4 and 5 am will the (c) 40 min. past 5 (d) 45 min. past 5
hands of a clock be at right angle?
11. A clock is set right at 1 p.m. If it gains one minute in an hour,
(a) 4 : 40 am (b) 4 : 38 am then what is the true time when the clock indicates 6 p.m. in
(c) 4 : 35 am (d) 4 : 39 am the same day?
3. What will be the acute angle between hands of a clock 5
at 2 : 30? (a) 55 minutes past 5 (b) 5 minutes past 6
61
(a) 105° (b) 115°
1
(c) 95° (d) 135° (c) 5 minutes to 6 (d) 59 minutes past 5
64
4. In 16 minutes, the minute hand gains over the hour
12. A clock gains 15 minutes per day. It is set right at 12 noon.
hand by
What time will it show at 4.00 am, the next day?
(a) 16° (b) 80° (a) 4 : 10 am (b) 4 : 45 am
(c) 88° (d) 96° (c) 4 : 20 am (d) 5 : 00 am
5. Two clocks were set righ t at noon on Sunday. One 13. In a watch, the minute hand crosses the hour hand for the
gains 2 min and the other loses 3 min in 24 hours. third time exactly after every 3 hrs., 18 min., 15 seconds of
What will be the true time when the first clock watch time. What is the time gained or lost by this watch in
indicates 3 pm on Wednesday? one day?
(a) 2:38 pm (b) 2:54 pm (a) 14 min. 10 seconds lost
(c) 2:23 pm (d) 2:48 pm (b) 13 min. 50 seconds lost
6. At what time between 3 and 4’O clock, the hands of a clock (c) 13min. 20 seconds gained
coincide? (d) 14 min. 40 seconds gained
14. A watch which gains uniformly is 2 minutes low at noon on
4 5
(a) 16 minutes past 3 (b) 15 minutes past 3 Monday and is 4 min 48 sec. fast at 2 p.m. on the following
11 61 Monday. When was it correct?
5 4 (a) 2 p.m. on Tuesday (b) 2 p.m. on Wednesday
(c) 15 minutes to 2 (d) 16 minutes to 4
60 11 (c) 3 p.m. on Thursday (d) 1 p.m. on Friday
7. The calendar for the year 2005 is the same as for the year : 15. At what time between 7 and 8 O’clock will the hands of a
(a) 2010 (b) 2011 clock be in the same straight line but, not together?
(c) 2012 (d) 2013
2
8. On January 12, 1980, it was Saturday. The day of the week (a) 5 min. past 7 (b) 5 min. past 7
on January 12, 1979 was – 11
(a) Saturday (b) Friday 3 5
(c) Sunday (d) Thursday (c) 5 min . past 7 (d) 5 min . past 7
11 11
9. What is the angle between the 2 hands of the clock at
16. What will be the day of the week on 1st January, 2010 ?
8:24 pm?
(a) 100° (b) 107° (a) Friday (b) Saturday
(c) 106° (d) 108° (c) Sunday (d) Monday
Clock and Calendar A- 43
17. The calendar for the year 2005 is the same as for the year : 19. What was the day of the week on 15th August, 1947 ?
(a) 2010 (b) 2011 (a) Wednesday (b) Tuesday
(c) 2012 (d) 2013 (c) Friday (d) Thursday
18. If 09/12/2001 happens to be Sunday, then 09/12/1971 would 20. The last day of a century cannot be :
have been at (a) Monday (b) Wednesday
(a) Wednesday (b) Tuesday (c) Friday (d) Tuesday
(c) Saturday (d) Thursday
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 5 (b) 9 (d) 13 (b) 17 (c)
2 (b) 6 (a) 10 (b) 14 (b) 18 (d)
3 (a) 7 (c) 11 (a) 15 (d) 19 (c)
4 (c) 8 (b) 12 (a) 16 (c) 20 (d)
11 Statement &
Conclusions
In this type of questions, a statement is given followed by two Sol. (d) I does not follow because a govt’s policy is not determined
conclusions. We have to find out which of these conclusions definitely merely by people’s needs.
follows from the given statement. II does not follow. Let the present price be x
What is a ‘conclusion’?
x
‘Conclusion’ means a fact that can be truly inferred from the contents of \ Price if subsidy is removed = = 1.49x
0.67
a given sentence.
Hence increase in price will be around 49%
DIRECTIONS (for Examples 1 to 3) : In each of the following questions,
a statement is given followed by two conclusions I and II. Give answer :
DIRECTIONS (for Examples 4 to 5) : In each of the following questions,
(a) if only conclusion I follows;
a statement is given followed by two conclusions I and II. Give answer
(b) if only conclusion II follows; :
(c) if either I or II follows; (a) if only conclusion I follows;
(d) if neither I nor II follows; (b) if only conclusion II follows;
Example 1. (c) if either I or II follows;
Statement : The oceans are a storehouse of practically every (d) if both I and II follow.
mineral including uranium. But like most other minerals, it is found
in extremely low concentration – about three gms per 1000 tonnes
of water. Example 4.
Conclusions : I. The oceans are a cheap source of uranium. Statement : Interest rate will be fixed on the basis of our
bank’s rate prevailing on the date of deposit
II. The oceans harbour radiation hazards.
and refixed every quarter thereafter.
Sol. (d) I can not be concluded as most of the minerals are available
Conclusions : I. It is left to the depositors to guard their
in similar concentration levels in oceans. II is out of context
interest.
of the sentence.
II. The bank’s interest rates are subject to
Example 2.
change on a day-to-day basis depending on
Statement : Today, out of the world population of several market position.
thousand million, the majority of men have to live under government
Sol. (b) I does not follow because the statement is silent about the
which refuse them personal liberty and the right to dissent.
depositors. II follows from the phrase
Conclusions : I. People are indifferent to personal liberty “bank’s rate prevailing on the date of
and the right to dissent. deposit” which means the rates are subject
II. People desire personal liberty and the right to day-to-day changes.
to dissent.
Sol. (b) It is mentioned in the statement that most people are forced Example 5.
to live under Governments which refuse them personal
Statement : The government of country X has recently
liberty and right to dissent. This means that they are not
announced several concessions and offered
indifferent to these rights but have a desire for them. So,
attractive package tours for foreign visitors.
only II follows.
Conclusions : I. Now, more number of foreign tourists will
Example 3.
visit the country.
Statement : It has been decided by the Government to withdraw
II. The government of country X seems to be
33% of the subsidy on cooking gas from the beginning of next
serious in attracting tourists.
month—A spokesman of the Government.
Sol.
Conclusions : I. People no more desire or need such subsidy
from government as they can afford (d) Clearly, the government has taken the step to attract more
increased price of the cooking gas. tourists. So, both I and II follow.
EXERCISE
Directions (Q. 1-49): In each questions below is given a statement
followed by two conclusions numbered I and II. You have to assume II. Whatever is being followed by world’s leading insti tutes
everything in the statement to be true, then consider the two conclusions will definitely be good and useful.
together and decide which of them logically follows beyond a reasonable 8. Statement: The Bank of England’s move to auction 25 metric
doubt from the information given in the statement. Give answer tons of gold drew plenty of bidders looking for a bargain, but was
(a) if only conclusion I follows. criticised by major gold producers worldwide.
(b) if only conclusion II follows. Conclusions:
(c) if either I or II follows. I. The Bank of England should not auction gold which it
(d) if neither I nor Il follows; and possesses to keep steady international prices of gold.
1. Statement: Many people and media alleged that Mr. X, the II. Bidders should quote higher gold prices to retain present
opposition leader, met the Chief Minister yesterday to seek certain value of gold in the international markets.
favours, an allegation which was strongly rejected by Mr X. 9. Statement: The oceans are a storehouse of practically every
Conclusions: mineral including uranium. But like most other minerals, it is found
I. Mr X did meet the Chief Minister yesterday to seek certain in extremely low concentration—about three gms. Per 1000 tonnes
favours. of water.
II. Mr X did not meet the Chief Minister to seek certain favours. Conclusions:
2. Statement: For over three decades company ‘X’ has been totally I. The oceans are a cheap source of uranium.
involved in energy conservation, its efficient use and management. II. The oceans harbour radiation hazards.
Conclusions: 10. Statement: The minister questioned the utility of the space
I. The company has yet to learn and acquire basic things in research programme and suggested its replacement by other areas
this area. of felt national needs.
II. It is dedication that is more important than knowledge and Conclusions:
expertise.
I. Exploring the space does not contribute to critical national needs.
3. Statement: This book ‘Z’ is the only book which focuses its
II. Research should be oriented to national needs.
attention on the problem of poverty in India between 1950 and
11. Statement: The laws and statutes framed by the Government for
1980.
the purpose of providing equal treatment to every citizens, on
Conclusions:
implementation perpetuate corrupt working system.
I. There was no questions of poverty before 1950.
II. No other books deals with poverty in India during 1950 to Conclusions:
1980. I. the laws and statutes should be framed but they should not
4. Statement: On metro section of railways, the motormen are be implemented to avoid corrupt working system.
frequently required to do overtime during May and June though II. There should be obvious method to investigate corrupt
all vacancies are completely filled as per requirement of this section. working system.
Conclusions: 12. Statement: Mrs X is nominated for one of the two posts of
I. Many motormen take leave of shorter or longer duration which one post is reserved by the Managing Committee for the
during this period. female of other religious minority community and the other for
II. Some motormen desire to earn overtime whenever possible. the female of scheduled Castes or Scheduled Tribes.
5. Statement: The President of XYZ party indicated that 25 independent Conclusions:
Members of Legislative Assembly (MLA) are seriously considering I. Mrs X is the member of religious minority community.
various options of joining some political party. But in any case all II. Mrs X is the member of Scheduled Castes or Scheduled
of them collectively will join one party only. Tribes.
Conclusions: 13. Statement: We do not need today in India extraordinary specialists
I. The 25 independent MLAs will join XYZ party in a short but those trained ordinary doctors who are dedicated to their
period of time. profession.
II. The 25 independent MLAs will join some other political Conclusions:
party in a short period of time. I. We should promote medical profession with dedicated
6. Statement: ‘Our approach of fund management is based on science ordinary doctors rather than promoting high specialised
as much as on common sense and discipline because our goal is medical education.
consistent performance in the long term. –Advertisement of a II. Extraordinary specialists are not dedicated to their
mutual fund company. profession.
Conclusions: 14. Statement: The maximum number of vacancies for the
I. Only the approach of science of investment can lead to high clerical cadre is 40, which will be filled through this recruitment
gains in short-term investment. round – An advertisment of Company W.
II. It is not necessary to go for long-term investment when low- Conclusions:
return short-term investment is available. I. The Company ‘A’ may appoint less than 40 clerks in this
7. Statement: ‘We follow some of the best and effective teaching round.
learning practices used by leading institutes all over the world.’ — II. The Company ‘A’ may appoint 40 clerks in this round.
A statement of a Professor of MN Institute.
15. Statement: Global ecological issues have eclipsed local
Conclusions:
environmental problems which are being faced by the poor
I. The MN Institute is one of the leading institutes of the
societies.
world.
Statement & Conclusions A- 47
Conclusions: Conclusions:
I. Poor societies always have to suffer because of their poverty. I. All candidates who have yet to get their master’s degree will
II. Global ecological issues are not so impor tant. Rich societies be there in the list of selected candidates.
can bear with it. II. All candidates having obtained second class master’s degree
16. Statement: People in metropolitan city ‘X’ have wel will be there in the list of selected candidates.
comed the recent Supreme Court order ban ning the registration of 24. Statement: The government-run company had asked its
private vehicles that do not conform to Euro II emission norms employees to declare their income and assets but it has been
with immediate effect for metropolitan city ‘Y’ only. strongly resisted by employees union and no employee is going
Conclusions: to declare his income.
I. City ‘X’ has quite lower level of vehicular pollution than Conclusions:
city ‘Y’. I. The employees of this company do not seem to have any
II. Public vehicles do not contribute to the vehicular pollution. additional undisclosed income besides their salary.
17. Statement: ‘70% of the world’s data is processed on II. The employees’ union wants all senior officers to declare
XYZ company’s platforms’ – An advertise ment of XYZ – a their income first.
computer manufacturing company. 25. Statement: The ‘Official Secrets Act’ (OSA) enacted by the XYZ
Conclusions: government during the war seems to be the source of much
I. There is no other company in the world which produces corruption in the country ‘P’.
platforms of data processing. Conclusions:
II. Company XYZ has to make more efforts to market its I. The Official Secrets Act has to be abolished immediately to
platforms. stop corruption in country ‘P’.
18. Statement: The government of State ‘A’ has sought a II. The XYZ government wanted to encourage corruption in
waiver of outstanding Central loans of ` 4,000 crores and a the government offices.
moratorium on repayment pending the waiver. 26. Statement : After collision of two vessels in the sea all the
Conclusions: crewmen and passengers are declared as missing. A news report
I. Unlike other states, State ‘A’ has no desire to make repayment Conclusions:
of its loans. I. No one from the two vessels has survived after the collision.
II. State ‘A”s financial condition does not appear to be II. A few persons from the two vessels may have survived and
satisfactory. are missing.
19. Statement : My first and foremost task is to beautify this city. If 27. Statement: Good health is a luxury in country ‘P’ where rate of
city ‘X’ and ‘Y’ can do it why can’t we do it? Statement of death is very high compared to other nations of that region.
Municipal Commissioner of city ‘Z’ after taking over charge. Conclusions:
Conclusions : I. People in country ‘P’ cannot afford to have many
I. The people of city ‘Z’ are not aware about the present state luxuries of life.
of ugliness of their city. II. Good health is a gift of nature.
II. The present Commissioner has worked in city ‘X’ and ‘Y’ 28. Statement: Although we have rating agencies like Crisil, ICRA,
and has good experience of beautifying cities. there is demand to have a separate rating agency of IT companies
20. Statement: Women’s organisations in India have welcomed the to protect investors.
amendment of the Industrial Employment Rules 1946 to curb Conclusions :
sexual harassment at the workplace. I. Assessment of financial worth of IT Companies calls for
Conclusions: separate, set of skills, insight and competencies.
I. Sexual harassment of women at workplace more revalent in II. Now the investors investing in IT companies will get
India as compared to other developed countries. protection of their investment.
II. Many organisations in India will stop recruiting women to 29. Statement: Company “Y” will improve the manufacturing
avoid such problems. facilities for the production of shaving kits as a result of which
21. Statement : It has been decided by the Government to withdraw capacity would increase and cost would be reduced. A
33% of the subsidy on cooking gas from the beginning of next spokesperson of the Company “Y”
Conclusions :
month. A spokesman of the Government.
I. The products of Company “Y” will compete the market
Conclusion :
norms in the quality and cost factor.
I. People now no more desire or need such subsidy from
II. There will be demand of shaving kits of Company “Y”.
government as they can af ford increased price of the
30. Statement: During 1997-98 the total loss incurred by the 111
cooking gas.
Public Sector Units was to the tune of ` 6809 crore which was
II. The price of the cooking gas will increase at least by 33%
converted into paid capitals by the Government of its total
from the next month.
investment of ` 5129 crore.
22. Statement: “The Government will review the present policy of
Conclusions :
the diesel price in view of furtherspurt in the international oil
I. The Government is left with only one option, that is, to
prices”.-A spokesman of the Government.
privatise these units.
Conclusions:
II. The Government did not take care in the matter of
I. The Government will increase the price of the diesel after
investments in these public sector units.
the imminent spurt in the international oil prices.
31. Statement: Population increase coupled with depleting resources
II. The Government will not increase the price of the diesel
is going to be the scenario of many developing countries in days to
even after the imminent spurt in the international oil prices.
come.
23. Statement : The eligibility for admission to the course is minimum Conclusions :
second class master’s degree. However, the candidates who have I. The population of developing countries with not continue
appeared for the final year examination of master’s degree can also to increase in future.
apply.
II. It will be very difficult for the governments of developing
countries to provide its people decent quality of life.
A- 48 Statement & Conclusions
32. Statement: Mr. X is one of the probable candidates shortlisted 34. Statement: In order to enforce discipline on transport operators,
for the post of Director of KLM Institute. the state government has decided to impose a fine of ` 5,000 for
Conclusions : the first excess tonne loaded in transport vehicle and ` 1,000 for
I. Mr. X will be selected as Director of KLM Institute. each subsequent tonne.
II. Mr. X will not be selected as Director of KLM Institute. Conclusions :
33. Statement: An advertisement / Interest rate will be fixed I. People will follow some discipline when severe fine is
on the basis of our bank’s rate prevailing on the date of deposit imposed.
and refixed every quarter thereafter. II. The state government has failed to understand the problem
Conclusions: of transport operators.
I. It is left to the depositors to guard their interest. 35. Statement: Book your flat before 15th June and avail interest
II. The bank’s interest rates are subject to change on a day-to- free loan from the builders. An advertisement Conclusions:
day basis depending on market position. I. No flat will be booked afterwards.
II. After 15th June, no loan will be provided.
AN S W E R KE Y
1 (c ) 5 (c ) 9 (d ) 13 (a ) 17 (d ) 21 (d ) 25 (d ) 29 (a) 33 (b )
2 (d ) 6 (d ) 10 (d ) 14 (c ) 18 (b ) 22 (c) 26 (b ) 30 (d ) 34 (a )
3 (d ) 7 (d ) 11 (d ) 15 (d ) 19 (d ) 23 (d ) 27 (a ) 31 (b ) 35 (d )
4 (a ) 8 (d ) 12 (c) 16 (d ) 20 (d ) 24 (d ) 28 (a ) 32 (c)
12 Non-verbal Series
? * X D *
= X ? *
(a) (b) (c) (d)
Sol. (a)
? X = * ? C D
2
TYPE V. (A) (B) (C) (D) (E)
The qualitative characteristic of various elements in the Answer figure
diagrams change to complete the series.
Rotation Type : The various elements in the diagrams move * # C # * C
in a specific manner. They may rotate in clockwise or anti-
D D D D
clockwise direction.
Example 5 : # *
Problem Figures (a) (b) ( c) (d)
EXERCISE
DIRECTIONS (Qs. 1-40) : In each of the questions, which one of
the four figures (a, b, c, d) will continue the same series or
replace the question mark so as to maintain the sequence. O C
1. O C O C C O
(a) (b) (c) (d)
5.
A B C D
A B C D
A B C D A B C D
A B C D
A B C D
4.
(a)
C O
(b) (c)
C
(d)
O
A B
?
C D
O C
C O
A B C D
(a) (b) (c) (d)
A- 52 Non-verbal Series
9. 14. Question-Figures
?
A B C D
Answer-Figures
?
A B C D
Answer-Figures
?
16.
A B C D
Answer-Figures
Answer-Figures
(1)
(a) (2)
(b) (3)
(c) (4)
(d)
Non-verbal Series A- 53
? ?
(A) (B) (C) (D) (A) (B) (C) (D)
Answer figures: Answer figures:
+ +
+ ?
(A) (B) (C) (D)
Answer figures: (a) (b)
+
+ + +
(a) (b) (c) (d) (c) (d)
(c) (d)
? (a) (b)
?
28. Problem Figures
?
Answer Figures
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
(a) (b) (c) (d)
?
?
Answer Figures (A) (B) (C) (D)
Answer Figures
31.
? 35.
(a) (b)
Problem Figures
(c) (d)
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 6 (b) 11 (b) 16 (c) 21 (a) 26 (d) 31 (d) 36 (d)
2 (c) 7 (c) 12 (b) 17 (c) 22 (d) 27 (d) 32 (d) 37 (d)
3 (d) 8 (b) 13 (a) 18 (a) 23 (d) 28 (d) 33 (d) 38 (b)
4 (b) 9 (c) 14 (d) 19 (b) 24 (c) 29 (c) 34 (c) 39 (b)
5 (d) 10 (d) 15 (b) 20 (d) 25 (b) 30 (d) 35 (d) 40 (c)
A- 56 Non-verbal Series
13 Spatial Ability
DOT SITUATION
The problems on dot situation involve the search of similar con-
ditions in the alternative figures as indicated in the problem fig-
ure. The problem figure contains dots placed in the spaces en- (a) (b)
closed between the combinations of square, triangle, rectangle
and circle. Selecting one of these dots we observe the region in
which this dot is enclosed i.e. to which of the four figures (circle,
square, rectangle and triangle) is this region common. Then we
look for such a region in the four alternatives. Once we have
found it we repeat the procedure for other dots, if any. The alter- (c) (d)
native figure which contains all such regions is the answer.
DIRECTIONS (EXAMPLES 1-5) : In each of the following Sol. (b) Figure (X) contains one dot in the region common to
the circle and the triangle, another dot in the region
examples, there is a diagram marked (X), with one or more dots
common to all the three figures and the third dot in the
placed in it. The diagram is followed by four other figures, marked region common to the square and the circle only. In
(a), (b), (c) and (d) only one of which is such as to make possible figures (a) and (d), the region common to the circle and
the placement of the dot. Select this alternative as the answer. the triangle lies within the square. In figure (c), there is
no region common to the circle and the triangle. Only
Example 1 : figure (b) contains all the three types of regions.
Example 3 :
(X)
(X)
(a) (b)
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
Sol. (c) In figure (X), the dot lies in the region common to the
circle and the triangle only. Such a region is present in
figure (c) only.
(c) (d)
Example 2 :
Sol. (a) In figure (X), one of the dots is placed in the region
common to the circle and the triangle and the other dot
is placed in the region common to the triangle and the
square. From amongst the figures (a), (b), (c) and (d),
only figure (a) has both the regions, one common to
(X) circle and triangle and the other common to triangle
and square.
A- 58 Spatial Ability
Example 4 : the circle and the triangle. Figure (a) does contain a
region which lies in the square alone. Figures (b) and
(d) do not contain any region common to the circle
and the triangle. Only figure (c) contains all the three
types of regions.
(c) (d)
Sol. (c) In figure (X), the dot lies in the region common to the
circle and the triangle only. Such a region is present in Answer Figures
figure (c) only.
Example 5 :
EXERCISE
DIRECTIONS (Qs. 1- 30) : In each of the following questions,
from amongst the figures marked (a), (b), (c) and (d), select the 4.
one which satisfies the same conditions of placement of the dot
as in fig. (X).
1.
(X)
(X)
(a) (b)
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
(c) (d)
2.
5.
(X)
3.
(c) (d)
(X)
6.
7.
(c) (d) 8.
9.
20.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
10.
21.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
22.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
13.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
25.
15.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d) (X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
16. 26.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d) (X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
17. 27.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d) (X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
18. 28.
(X) (a) (b) (c) (d) (X) (a) (b) (c) (d)
29.
19.
30. 37.
31. X X X Y W W W W X X
(a) (b) (c) (d)
40.
(a) (b) (c) (d)
32.
(a) (b) (c) (d)
36. 45.
C C C C
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 6 (d) 11 (b) 16 (d) 21 (d) 26 (d) 31 (b) 36 (c) 41 (c)
2 (c) 7 (a) 12 (b) 17 (d) 22 (c) 27 (c) 32 (b) 37 (a) 42 (d)
3 (d) 8 (b) 13 (a) 18 (b) 23 (c) 28 (b) 33 (c) 38 (a) 43 (a)
4 (a) 9 (d) 14 (c) 19 (a) 24 (a) 29 (a) 34 (d) 39 (d) 44 (c)
5 (c) 10 (d) 15 (a) 20 (d) 25 (b) 30 (d) 35 (c) 40 (b) 45 (a)
A- 62 Spatial Ability
1 Number System,
HCF & LCM
EXERCISE
1. The four integers next lower than 81, and the four next higher seats in the stadium were sold, then what fraction of the
than 81, are written down and added together, this sum is unsold seats in the stadium was in the lower deck ?
divisible by, (a) 3/20 (b) 1/6
(a) 7 (b) 9 (c) 1/5 (d) 1/3
(c) 11 (d) 13 6. If a, a + 2 and a + 4 are prime numbers, then the number of
2. How many numbers, between 1 and 300 are divisible by 3 possible solutions for a is
and 5 together? (a) one (b) two
(a) 16 (b) 18 (c) three (d) more than three
(c) 20 (d) 100 7- The product of two consecutive even numbers is 12768.
3. A number when divided by 5 leaves a remainder 3. What is What is the greater number ?
the remainder when the square of the same number is divided
by 5? (a) 110 (b) 108
(a) 9 (b) 3 (c) 114 (d) 112
(c) 0 (d) 4 8. What is 131 times 333 ?
4. If 5432* 7 is divisible by 9, then the digit in place of * is (a) 46323 (b) 43623
(a) 0 (b) 1 (c) 43290 (d) 44955
(c) 6 (d) 8 9. The cost of 3 chairs and 10 tables is ` 9856. What is the cost
5. At a college football game, 4/5 of the seats in the lower deck of 6 chairs and 20 tables?
of the stadium were sold. If 1/4 of all the seating in the (a) `17227 (b) `18712
stadium is located in the lower deck, and if 2/3 of all the
(c) `19172 (d) Cannot be determined
Number System, HCF & LCM B- 3
10. Three friends A, B and C start running around a circular 20. I have a certain number of beads which lie between
stadium and complete a single round in 24, 36 and 30 600 and 900. If 2 beads are taken away the remainder
seconds respectively. After how many minutes will they can be equally divided among 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 12 boys.
meet again at the starting point? The number of beads I have
(a) 12 (b) 6 (a) 729 (b) 842
(c) 8 (d) 15 (c) 576 (d) 961
2 3 4 5 6 21. Three men start together to travel the same way around a
11. If the fractions , , , and are arranged in ascending 1
5 4 5 7 11 circular track of 11 kms. Their speeds are 4, 5 , and 8 kms per
order of their values, which one will be the fourth ? 2
2 3 hour respectively. When will they meet at the starting point?
(a) (b) (a) 22 hrs (b) 12 hrs
5 4
4 (c) 11 hrs (d) 44 hrs
6
(c) (d) 22. A man was engaged for a cetain number of days for Rs.
5 11
404.30 p but being absent for some days he was paid only
12. The difference between a two-digit number and the number
Rs. 279.90p. His daily wages cannot exceed by:
obtained by interchanging the two digits of the number is 9.
(a) Rs. 29.10 p (b) Rs. 31.30 p
The sum of the digits of the number is 15. What is the
(c) Rs. 31.10 p (d) Rs. 31.41 p
product of the two digits of the two-digit number?
23. The L.C.M. of two numbers is 45 times their H.C.F. If one of
(a) 54 (b) 72
the numbers is 125 and the sum of H.C.F. and L.C.M. is 1150,
(c) 56 (d) Cannot be determined the other number is:
13. If (74)2 is subtracted from the square of a number, the answer (a) 215 (b) 220
so obtained is 5340. What is the number? (c) 225 (d) 235
(a) 98 (b) 102 24. There are 4 numbers. The H.C.F. of each pair is 3 and the L.C.M.
(c) 104 (d) 110 of all the 4 numbers is 116. What is the product of 4 numbers?
14. The H.C.F and L.C.M of two numbers are 21 and 4641 (a) 9782 (b) 9396
respectively. If one of the numbers lies between 200 and (c) 9224 (d) 9100
300, then the two numbers are 25. Three wheels can complete respectively 60,36,24 revolutions
(a) 273, 357 (b) 273, 361 per minute. There is a red spot on each wheel that touches
(c) 273, 359 (d) 273, 363 the ground at time zero. After how much time, all these spots
will simultaneously touch the ground again?
15. What is the smallest number which when increased by 5 is (a) 5/2 seconds (b) 5/3 seconds
completely divisible by 8, 11 and 24?
(c) 5 seconds (d) 7.5 seconds
(a) 264 (b) 259 26. In a school there are 391 boys and 323 girls. These are to be
(c) 269 (d) None of these divided into the largest possible equal classes, so that there
16. Which is the least number that must be subtracted from are equal number of boys and girls in each class. How many
1856, so that the remainder when divided by 7, 12 and 16 will classes are possible?
leave the same remainder 4? (a) 32 (b) 37
(a) 137 (b) 1361 (c) 42 (d) 49
27. A shopkeeper has three kinds of sugar 184 kg; 230 kg and
(c) 140 (d) 172
276kg. He wants to store it into minimum number of bags to
17. Three bells chime at an interval of 18, 24 and 32 minutes equal size without mixing. Find the size of the bag and the
respectively. At a certain time they begin to chime together. number of bags required to do the needful.
What length of time will elapse before they chime together (a) 23 kg; 30 (b) 38 kg; 23
again. (c) 46 kg; 15 (d) 46 kg; 25
(a) 2 hours 24 minutes (b) 4 hours 48 minutes 28. The least number which should be added to 2497 so that
(c) 1 hour 36 minutes (d) 5 hours the sum is exactly divisible by 5, 6, 4 and 3 is:
18. The L.C.M. of two number is 630 and their H.C.F. is 9. If the (a) 37 (b) 13
sum of numbers is 153, their difference is (c) 23 (d) 33
(a) 17 (b) 23 29. The H.C.F. of two numbers is 8. Which one of the following
can never be their L.C.M.?
(c) 27 (d) 33
(a) 24 (b) 48
19. Suppose you have 108 green marbles and 144 red marbles. (c) 56 (d) 60
You decide to separate them into packages of equal number 30. The sum of two numbers is 462 and their highest common
of marbles. Find the maximum possible number of marbles factor is 22. What is the maximum number of pairs that
in each package. satisfy these conditions ?
(a) 4 (b) 36 (a) 1 (b) 3
(c) 9 (d) 12 (c) 5 (d) 6
B- 4 Number System, HCF & LCM
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 7 (c) 13 (c) 19 (b) 25 (c)
2 (c) 8 (b) 14 (a) 20 (b) 26 (c)
3 (d) 9 (c) 15 (b) 21 (a) 27 (c)
4 (c) 10 (b) 16 (d) 22 (c) 28 (c)
5 (a) 11 (b) 17 (b) 23 (c) 29 (d)
6 (a) 12 (c) 18 (c) 24 (b) 30 (d)
16. (d) Suppose least no. be x \ 45h + h = 1150 or h = 25. So, l = (1150 – 25) = 1125
we should take n = 5 so that n(336) is nearest to 1856 24. (b) Q Product of ‘n’ numbers = (HCF for each pair)n
and n (336)< 1856 × LCM of ‘n’ numbers
17. (b) L.C.M of 18, 24 & 32 = 288 B makes 6 rev per sec
Hence they would chime after every 288 min. or 4 hrs 10
48 min 4
C makes rev. per sec
18. (c) Let numbers be x and y. 10
Q Product of two numbers = their (LCM × HCF)
In other words A, B and C take 1 , 5 & 5 seconds to
Þ xy = 630 × 9 3 2
Also, x + y = 153 (given) complete one revolution.
5 5 L.C.M. of 1,5,5
since x – y = = (x + y) 2 - 4xy L.C.M of 1, & = =5
3 2 H.C.F. of 1,3,2
Þ x - y = (153) 2 - 4(630 ´ 9) Hence, after every 5 seconds the red spots on all the
three wheels touch the ground
= 23409 - 22680 = 729 = 27 26. (c) The number of boys and girls in each class is the H.C.F.
of 391 and 323 which is 17.
19. (b) Required number = HCF of 108 and 144 = 36
391 323
20. (b) LCM of the numbers = 420. Number of classes = + = 23 + 19 = 42
17 17
Hence there must be (420 × 2) + 2 = 842 beads.
27. (c) Size of the bag is the H.C.F. of the numbers 184, 230,
21. (a) Time taken by them to complete the track 276 which is 46.
11 11 11 11 11 The number of bags
= , , hrs = , 2, hrs
4 11/ 2 8 4 8 184 230 276
= + + = 4 + 5 + 6 = 15
46 46 46
æ 11 11 ö
Required time = LCM of ç , 2, ÷ 28. (c) L.C.M. of 5, 6, 4 and 3 = 60. On dividing 2497 by 60, the
è2 8ø
remainder is 37.
LCM of (11, 2, 11) \ Number to be added = (60 – 37) = 23.
= = 22hrs
HCFof (2,1,8) 29. (d) H.C.F. of two numbers divides their L.C.M. exactly. 8 is
not a factor of 60.
22. (c) His maximum daily wages must be the H.C.F. of 404.30
and 279.90 which is 31.10. 30. (d) There are 6 such pairs :
23. (c) Let H.C.F. be h and L.C.M. be l. Then, l = 45h and l + h (22, 440), (44, 418), (88, 374), (110, 352)
= 1150. (176, 286), (220, 242)
CHAPTER
2 Simplification
BRACKETS
‘M’ stands for “Multiplication”
Types of brackets are : ‘A’ stands for “Addition”
(i) Vinculum or bar – ‘S’ stands for “Subtraction”
(ii) Parenthesis or small or common brackets : ( ) Same order of operations must be applied during simplification.
(iii) Curly or middle brackets : { } Square Root : If x2 = y, we say that the square root of y is x and we
(iv) Square or big brackets : [ ] write, y = x.
The order for removal of brackets is (), {}, []
Thus, 4 = 2, 9 = 3, 196 = 14.
‘BODMAS’ Rule
Now a days it becomes ‘VBODMAS’ where, Cube Root : The cube root of a given number x is the number
‘V’ stands for “Vinculum” whose cube is x. We denote the cube root of x by 3 x .
‘B’ stands for “Bracket” Thus, 3 8 = 3 2 ´ 2 ´ 2 = 2, 3 343 = 3 7 ´ 7 ´ 7 = 7 etc.
‘O’ stands for “Of”
‘D’ stands for “Division”
EXERCISE
1. ? ¸ 46 × 16 = 368
1 2 æ6 5ö
(a) 1124 (b) 1236 7. 1 +1 ¸ ç - ÷ = ?
2 3 è7 6ø
(c) 1058 (d) 966
(a) 71.5 (b) 133
2. ? of 57.75 of 0.8 = 3187.8
19 19
(a) 45 (b) 27 (c) (d)
252 180
(c) 64 (d) 69
8. 11881 ´ ? = 10137
3. 8 + 18 × 368 ÷ 16 = ?
(a) 8649 (b) 9216
(a) 598 (b) 356
(c) 8281 (d) 9409
(c) 648 (d) 422
9. 804357 = ?
3
4. 1181 + 1520 = (26)2 + (?)2
(a) 98 (b) 89
(a) 49 (b) 43 (c) 96 (d) 93
(c) 47 (d) 45
5
5. If x + y = 23 and xy = 126; then (x)2 + (y)2 = ? 10. ? + 136 = 320 of
8
(a) 250 (b) 317 (a) 1936 (b) 4624
(c) 277 (d) Cannot be determined (c) 4196 (d) 4096
1 2 4 11. ? –17 = 22
6. of of of 3750 = ?
2 3 8 (a) 1511 (b) 1531
(a) 625 (b) 312.5 (c) 1515 (d) 1521
(c) 125 (d) 250
Simplification B- 7
12. 49 + ? = 87 23. 49 × 49 × 49 × 49 = 7?
(a) 1444 (b) 1442 (a) 4 (b) 7
(c) 8 (d) 16
(c) 1448 (d) 1456
24. 16.02 × 0.001 = ?
13. 999.99 + 99.99 + 9.99 = ?
(a) 0.1602 (b) 0.001602
(a) 1109.97 (b) 1019.89
(c) 1.6021 (d) 0.01602
(c) 1108.99 (d) 1099.88
? 60.5
14. ? of 57.75 of 0.8 = 3187.8 25. =
50 ?
(a) 45 (b) 27
(a) 55 (b) 1512.5
(c) 64 (d) 69
(c) 52.5 (d) 57.5
15. (?)2 – (12)3 = 976
26. 200 + 5 × 4 = ?
(a) 58 (b) 56
(a) 820 (b) 202
(c) 54 (d) 52
(c) 420 (d) 209
16. 351 ¸ 6 ¸ 0.5 = ?
27. ?% of 360 = 129.6
(a) 117 (b) 119
(a) 277 (b) 36
(c) 121 (d) 123
(c) 64 (d) 72
17. 59475 ¸ ? = 195 × 5 28. What should come in place of question mark (?) in the
(a) 3969 (b) 3481 following equation ?
(c) 4225 (d) 3721 3 2 5 6
27 + 118 – 32 = 11 + ?
18. ? + 29 = 2704 11 5 22 11
(a) 23 (b) 529 9 9
(c) 441 (d) 21 (a) 113 (b) 111
10 11
19. 777.07 + 77.77 + 0.77 + 7.07 + 7 + 77 = ?
9 9
(a) 946.78 (b) 946.68 (c) 90 (d) 101
10 11
(c) 964.68 (d) 946.86
3 1 1 1
¸ ´
20. The value of 3 + 1 is 3 3 3 - 1 =?
3+ 29. 1 1 1 9
1 ¸ of
3+ 3 3 3
3
40 43 (a) 0 (b) 1
(a) (b) 1 1
11 11
(c) (d)
46 41 3 9
(c) (d)
11 11 3.5 ´1.4
30. =?
21. The value of (243)0.16 × (243)0.04 is equal to : 0.7
(a) 0.16 (b) 3 (a) 7.0 (b) 3.5
1 (c) 0.7 (d) 2.4
(c) (d) 0.04
3 31. (800 ¸ 64) ´ (1296 ¸ 36) = ?
995
22. The value of 999 ´ 999 is (a) 420
999 (b) 460
(a) 990809 (b) 998996
(c) 500
(c) 999824 (d) 998999
(d) 450
ANSWER KEY
1 (c) 7 (a) 13 (a) 19 (b) 25 (a) 31 (d)
2 (d) 8 (a) 14 (d) 20 (b) 26 (b)
3 (d) 9 (d) 15 (d) 21 (b) 27 (b)
4 (d) 10 (d) 16 (a) 22 (b) 28 (d)
5 (c) 11 (d) 17 (d) 23 (c) 29 (a)
6 (a) 12 (a) 18 (b) 24 (d) 30 (a)
B- 8 Simplification
RATIO Sol. P = 3, Q = 4, R = 7
The ratio of two terms ‘x’ and ‘y’ is denoted by x : y. P + Q + R 3+ 4 + 7
Then = =2
Compound ratio : R 7
a´c a1 a 2 a 3 a 4 a
The compound of a : b and c : d is , i.e., ac : bd. (ii) If = = = = .... n = K , then a : a
b´d a 2 a3 a 4 a 5 a n +1 1 n+ 1
ê The duplicate ratio of x : y is x2 : y2.
= (K)n
The triplicate ratio of x : y is x3 : y3.
ê A number added or subtracted from a, b, c & d, so that they
The subduplicate ratio of x : y is x : y.
ad - bc
are in proportion = a + d - b + c
The subtriplicate ratio of x : y is 3
x:3 y. ( ) ( )
ê Inverse ratio For example : When a number should be subtracted from 2,
Inverse ratio of x : y is y : x. 3, 1 & 5 so that they are in proportion. Find that number.
PROPORTION 2 ´ 5 - 3 ´1 10 - 3 7
When two ratios are equal, the four quantities composing them Sol. Req. No. = ( 2 + 5 ) - ( 3 + 1) = 7 - 4 = 3
are said to be in proportion.
ê If X part of A is equal to Y part of B, then A : B = Y : X.
a c For example: If 20% of A = 30% of B, then find A : B.
If = , then a, b, c, d are in proportions.
b d 30% 3
Sol. A : B = = =3:2
ê If four quantities are in proportion, the product of the 20% 2
extremes is equal to the product of the means. ê When Xth part of P, Yth part of Q and Zth part of R are
Let a, b, c, d be in proportion, then equal, then find A : B : C.
a c Then, A : B : C = yz : zx : xy
= Þ ad = bc.
b d
ê If three quantities a, b and c are in continued proportion, PARTNERSHIP
then a : b = b : c If the period of investment is the same for each partner, then the
\ ac = b2 profit or loss is divided in the ratio of their investments.
b is called mean proportional. If A and B are partners in a business, then
SHORT CUTS Investment of A Pr ofit of A Loss of A
= or =
Investment of B Pr ofit of B Loss of B
a b c a + b + c + ....
ê (i) If = = =.... , then
K1 K 2 K 3 c If A, B and C are partners in a business, then
Investment of A : Investment of B : Investment of C
K1 + K 2 + K3 + ..... = Profit of A : Profit of B : Profit of C, or
=
K3 = Loss of A : Loss of B : Loss of C
P Q R P+Q+ R
For example: If = = , then find
3 4 7 R
Ratio, Proportion & Partnership B- 11
EXERCISE
1. The fourth proportional to 5, 8, 15 is: 11. In a dairy farm, 40 cows eat 40 bags of husk in 40 days. In
(a) 18 (b) 24 how many days one cow will eat one bag of husk ?
(c) 19 (d) 20 1
3 (a) 1 (b)
2. Given that 24 carat gold is pure gold, 18 carat gold is gold 40
4 (c) 40 (d) 80
5
and 20 carat gold is gold, the ratio of the pure gold in 18 12. In a camp, there is a meal for 120 men or 200 children. If 150
6 children have taken the meal, how many men will be catered
carat gold to the pure gold in 20 carat gold is :
(a) 3 : 8 (b) 9 : 10 to with the remaining meal ?
(c) 15 : 24 (d) 8 : 5 (a) 20 (b) 30
(c) 40 (d) 50
3. A sum of money is to be distributed among A, B, C, D in the
13. If 0.75 : x : : 5 : 8, then x is equal to:
proportion of 5 : 2 : 4 : 3. If C gets ` 1000 more than D, what
(a) 1.12 (b) 1.20 (c) 1.25 (d) 1.30
is B’s share?
14. There are 240 doctors and nurses at a hospital. If the ratio of
(a) ` 500 (b) ` 1500
doctors to nurses is 5 : 7, then the nurses at the hospital are
(c) ` 2000 (d) None of these
(a) 20 (b) 60 (c) 100 (d) 140
4. The sum of three numbers is 98. If the ratio of the first to the
second is 2 : 3 and that of the second to the third is 5 : 8, 15. A bag contains ` 216 in the form of one rupee, 50 paise and
then the second number is : 25 paise coins in the ratio of 2 : 3 : 4. The number of 50 paise
(a) 20 (b) 30 coins is :
(c) 38 (d) 48 (a) 96 (b) 144 (c) 114 (d) 141
5. The ratio of number of ladies to gents at a party was 1 : 2, A B C
16. If A : B : C = 2 : 3 : 4, then : : is equal to :
but when 2 ladies and 2 gents left, the ratio became 1 : 3. B C A
How many people were originally present at the party? (a) 4 : 9 : 16 (b) 8 : 9 : 12
(a) 6 (b) 9 (c) 8 : 9 : 16 (d) 8 : 9 : 24
(c) 12 (d) None of these 17. A sum of money is to be distributed among A, B, C, D in the
6. In an express train, the passengers travelling in A.C. sleeper proportion of 5 : 2 : 4 : 3. If C gets ` 1000 more than D, what
class, First class and Sleeper class are in the ratio 1:2:7, and is B’s share?
rate for each class is in the ratio 5 : 4 : 2. If the total income (a) ` 500 (b) ` 1500
from this train is ` 54, 000, find the income of Indian Railways (c) ` 2000 (d) None of these
from A.C. sleeper class. 18. A began a business with ` 4500 and was joined afterwards
(a) ` 12,000 (b) ` 20,000 by B with ` 5400. If the profits at the end of year was divided
(c) ` 22,000 (d) ` 10,000 in the ratio 2 : 1 then B joined the business after :
7. In a mixture of 45 litres, the ratio of milk and water is 4 : 1. (a) 5 month (b) 4 months
How much water must be added to make the mixture ratio
(c) 6 months (d) 7 months
3:2?
19. on dividing ` 581 among A, B and C such that four times A’s
(a) 72 litres (b) 24 litres share is equal to 5 times B’s share which is equal to seven
(c) 15 litres (d) 1.5 litres
times C’s share. Then share of B is:
8. The monthly income of two persons are in the ratio of 4 : 5 (a) 245 (b) 196
and their monthly expenditures are in the ratio of 7 : 9. If each
(c) 140 (d) 24
saves ` 50 a month, then what are their monthly incomes? 20. If 12 : 18 :: x : 24, then find the value of x.
(a) ` 100, ` 125 (b) ` 200, ` 250
(a) 18 (b) 16
(c) ` 300, ` 375 (d) ` 400, ` 500
(c) 12 (d) 24
9. Salaries of A, B and C were in the ratio 3 : 5 : 7, respectively. 21. The ages of Aarzoo and Arnav are in the ratio of 11:13
If their salaries were increased by 50%, 60% and 50%
respectively. After 7 years the ratio of their ages will be
respectively, what will be the new ratio of the their respective 20:23. What is the difference in years between their ages?
new salaries ?
(a) 4 years (b) 7 years
(a) 4 : 5 : 7 (b) 3 : 6 : 7
(c) 6 years (d) 5 years
(c) 4 : 15 : 18 (d) 9 : 16 : 21 22. The ratio of the radius of two circles is 2 : 5. Find the ratio of
10. Out of a total amount of ` 4,898, B receives 20 % more than their areas.
A and 25% more than C. What is B’s share? (a) 2 : 5 (b) 8 : 20
(a) ` 930 (b) ` 1,860 (c) 4 : 20 (d) 4 : 25
(c) ` 1,400 (d) ` 1, 540
B- 12 Ratio, Proportion & Partnership
23. The sum of two numbers is 60 and their difference is 6. 30. Populations of two villages X and Y are in the ratio of 5 : 7
What is the ratio of the two numbers ? respectively. If the population of village Y increases by
(a) 1 : 10 (b) 9 : 11 25000 and the population of village X remains unchanged
(c) 11 : 9 (d) 10 : 1 the respective ratio of their populations becomes 25 : 36.
24. One litre of water was mixed to 3 litres of sugar solution What is the population of village X?
containing 4% of sugar. What is the percentage of sugar in (a) 6,25,000 (b) 6,75,000
the solution? (c) 8,75,000 (d) 9,00,000
31. In a class of 45 students the ratio of boys and girls is 2 : 3.
(a) 3 (b) 4
How many more boys are to be added to make the ratio 1 : 1?
(c) 6 (d) Insuffficient data
(a) 6 (b) 12
25. A and B enter into partnership with capitals in the ratio 3 : 4.
(c) 15 (d) None of these
At the end of 10 months A withdraws, and the profits now 32. Find the ratio of the perimeter of the triangle and a square if
are divided in the ratio of 5 : 6. Find how long B remained in the each side of triangle and square is equal.
the business? (a) 1 : 1 (b) 3 : 4
(a) 9 months (b) 8 months (c) 1 : 2 (d) Cannot be determined
(c) 6 months (d) 7 months 33. The total number of students in a school is 3250. If the
26. When 50% of one number is added to a second number, the number of girls in the school is 1495, then what is the ratio
second number increases to its four-thirds. What is the of the total number of boys to the total number of girls in
ratio between the first number and the second number? the school?
(a) 3 : 2 (b) 3 : 4 (a) 23 : 27 (b) 25 : 29
(c) 2 : 3 (d) Data inadequate (c) 27 : 23 (d) 29 : 25
27. A and B started a business by investing ` 35,000 and 34- Ninad, Vikas and Manav enter into a partnership. Ninad
` 20,000 respectively. B left the business after 5 months and invests some amount at the beginning. Vikas invests double
C joined the business with a sum of ` 15,000. The profit the amount after 6 months and Manav invests thrice the
earned at the end of the year is ` 84,125. What is B's share amount invested by Ninad after 8 months. They earn a profit
of `45, 000 at the end of the year. What is Manav’s share in
of profit?
the profit?
(a) `14133 (b) `15,000
(a) ` 25]000 (b) ` 15]000
(c) `13,460 (d) Cannot be determined
(c) ` 12]000 (d) ` 9]000
28. A and B rent a pasture for 10 months. A puts in 100 cows for 35. In a mixture of milk and water the proportion of water by
8 months. How many cows can B put in for the remaining weight was 75%. If in the 60 gms of this mixture 15 gm. water
2 months, if he pays half as much as A? was added, what would be the percentage of water?
(a) 300 (b) 600 (a) 75% (b) 80%
(c) 800 (d) 1000 (c) 90% (d) 100%
29. There are two numbers such that the sum of twice the first 36. The largest and the second largest angles of a triangle are
number and thrice the second number is 141 and the sum of in the ratio of 13 : 12. The smallest angle is 20% of the sum
thrice the first number and twice the second number is 174. of the largest and the second largest angles. What is the
Which is the larger number? sum of the smallest and the second largest angles ?
(a) 52 (b) 36 (a) 120° (b) 108°
(c) 48 (d) 24 (c) 100° (d) 102°
AN SWER KEY
1 (b) 7 (c) 13 (b) 19 (b) 25 (a ) 31 (d)
2 (b) 8 (d) 14 (d) 20 (b) 26 (c) 32 (b)
3 (c) 9 (d) 15 (b) 21 (c) 27 (c) 33 (c)
4 (b) 10 (b) 16 (d) 22 (d) 28 (b) 34 (b)
5 (c) 11 (c) 17 (c) 23 (c) 29 (c) 35 (b)
6 (d) 12 (b) 18 (d) 24 (a ) 30 (a ) 36 (d)
Ratio, Proportion & Partnership B- 13
4 Average, Problem
on Ages
AVERAGE
‘Average’ is a very simple but effective way of representing an entire group by a single value.
Sum of given quantities
ê Average or Mean =
Number of quantities
n +1
ê The average of first n natural numbers =
2
ê The average of the first n consecutive even numbers = (n + 1)
ê The average of the first n consecutive odd numbers = n
1
ê The average of the squares of the first n natural numbers can be shown to be (n + 1) (2n + 1)
6
n +1
ê Average of first n natural no. =
2
Average of first n even no. = (n + 1)
Average of first n odd no. = n
2
n ( n + 1)
ê Average of cube of first n natural no. =
4
Average of cube of first n even natural no. = 2n(n + 1) 2
Average of cube of first n odd natural no. = n(2n 2 – 1)
m ( n + 1)
ê Average of first n multiple of m =
2
ê If average of some observations is x and a is added in each observations, then new average is (x + a).
If average of some observations is x and a is subtracted in each observations, then new average is (x – a).
If average of some observations is x and each observations multiply by a, then new average is ax.
x
If average of some observations is x and each observations is divided by a, then new average is .
a
n1A1 + n 2 A 2
If average of n 1 is A1, & average of n2 is A2, then Average of (n 1 + n2) is and
n1 + n 2
n A -n A
Average of (n1 – n 2) is 1 1 2 2
n1 - n 2
ê When a person is included or excluded the group, then age/weight of that person = No. of persons in group × (Increase /
Decrease) in average ± New average.
For example : In a class average age of 15 students is 18 yrs. When the age of teacher is included their average increased by 2
yrs, then find the age of teacher.
Sol. Age of teacher = 15 × 2 + (18 + 2) = 30 + 20 = 50 yrs.
ê When two or more than two persons included or excluded the group, then average age of included or excluded person is
No. of person ´ ( Increase / Decrease ) in average ± New average ´ ( No. of person included or excluded )
=
No. of included or person
For example : Average weight of 13 students is 44 kg. After including two new students their average weight becomes 48 kg,
then find the average weight of two new students.
Sol. Average weight of two new students
13 ´ ( 48 - 44 ) + 48 ´ 2 13 ´ 4 + 48 ´ 2 52 + 96
= = = = 74 kg
2 2 2
B- 16 Average, Problem on Ages
EXERCISE
1. The average of 20 numbers is zero. Of them, at the most, 10. In Arun’s opinion, his weight is greater than 65 kg but less
how many may be greater than zero? than 72 kg. His brother does not agree with Arun and he
(a) 0 (b) 1 thinks that Arun’s weight is greater than 60 kg but less than
(c) 10 (d) 19 70 kg. His mother’s view is that his weight cannot be greater
2. Nine persons went to a hotel for taking their meals. Eight of than 68 kg. If all of them are correct in their estimation, what
them spent ` 12 each on their meals and the ninth spend is the average of different probable weights of Arun?
` 8 more than the average expenditure of all the nine. What (a) 67 kg (b) 68 kg
was the total money spent by them? (c) 69 kg (d) None of these
(a) ` 115 (b) ` 117 11. The average age of a board of 8 functional directors in a
(c) ` 119 (d) ` 122 company is the same as it was 3 years ago, a younger man
3. The average age of a group of person going for picnic is 16 having been substituted for one of the directors. How much
years. Twenty new persons with an average age of 15 years younger was the new man than the director whose place he
join the group on the spot due to which their average took.
becomes 15.5 years. Find the number of persons initially (a) 24 years (b) 26 years
going for picnic. (c) 28 years (d) None of these
(a) 20 (b) 18 12. The average monthly sales for the first eleven months of
(c) 22 (d) None of these the year of a certain salesman were Rs.12000, but due to his
4. A pupil’s marks were wrongly entered as 83 instead of 63. illness during the last month, the average monthly sales for
Due to that the average marks for the class got increased by the whole year came down to Rs.11375. What was the value
half. The number of pupils in the class is: of sales during the last month ?
(a) 10 (b) 20 (a) 2100 (b) 875
(c) 40 (d) 73 (c) 700 (d) 4500
5. In the first 10 overs of a cricket game, the run rate was only 13. The average age of a group of person going for picnic is 16
3.2. What should be the run rate in the remaining 40 overs years. Twenty new persons with an average age of 15 years
to reach a target of 282 runs ? join the group on the spot due to which their average
(a) 6.25 (b) 6.50 becomes 15.5 years. Find the number of persons initially
(c) 6.75 (d) 7.00 going for picnic.
6. The average expenditure of a labourer for 6 months was ` (a) 20 (b) 18
85 and he fell into debt. In the next 4 months by reducing his (c) 22 (d) None of these
monthly expenses to ` 60 he not only cleared off his debt 14. The average age of 36 students in a group is 14 years. When
but also saved ` 30. His monthly income is teacher’s age is included to it, the average increases by
(a) `70 (b) ` 72 one. What is the teacher’s age in years?
(c) ` 75 (d) ` 78 (a) 31 (b) 36
7. A batsman makes a score of 87 runs in the 17th inning and (c) 51 (d) cannot be determined
thus increases his average by 3. Find his average after 17th 15. A batsman in his 12th innings makes a score of 65 and
inning. thereby increases his average by 2 runs. What is his average
(a) 36 (b) 39 after the 12th innings if he had never been ‘not out’?
(a) 42 (b) 43
(c) 42 (d) 45
(c) 44 (d) 45
8. A car owner buys petrol at Rs 7.50, Rs 8.00 and Rs 8.50 per
16. The average number of printing error per page in a book of
litre for three successive years. What approximately is his
512 pages is 4. If the total number of printing error in the
average cost per litre of petrol if he spends Rs 4000 each
first 302 pages is 1,208, the average number of printing errors
year ?
per page in the remaining pages is
(a) ` 8 (b) ` 9 (a) 0 (b) 4
(c) ` 7.98 (d) ` 8.50 (c) 840 (d) 90
9. The average of two numbers is XY. If one number is X, then 17. The average of a batsman for 40 innings is 50 runs. His
the other number is highest score exceeds his lowest score by 172 runs. If these
Y two innings are excluded, his average drops by 2 runs. Find
(a) Y (b) his highest score.
2
(a) 172 (b) 173
(c) 2XY – X (d) X (Y – 1)
(c) 174 (d) 175
Average, Problem on Ages B- 17
18. A batsman makes a score of 87 runs in the 17th inning and 24. The average of 10 numbers is 40.2. Later it is found that two
thus increases his average by 3. Find his average after 17th numbers have been wrongly copied. The first is 18 greater
inning. than the actual number and the second number added is 13
(a) 36 (b) 39 instead of 31. Find the correct average.
(c) 42 (d) 45 (a) 40.2 (b) 40.4
19. Nine men went to a hotel. 8 of them spent ` 3 each over their
(c) 40.6 (d) 40.8
meals and the ninth spent Rs 2 more than the average
25. If a, b, c, d, e are five consecutive odd numbers, then the
expenditure of all the nine. The total money spent by all of
them was average in terms of ‘a’ will be –
(a) ` 26 (b) ` 40 (a) a + 2 (b) a + 3
(c) ` 29.25 (d) ` 27 (c) a + 4 (d) a
20. The mean of 30 values was 150. It was detected on 26. If the mean score in mathematics of a class of 50 students is
rechecking that one value 165 was wrongly copied as 135 45, then the total marks obtained by them are :
for the computation of the mean. Find the correct mean. (a) 45 (b) 95
(a) 151 (b) 149 (c) 2250 (d) 50
(c) 152 (d) None of these 27. The average age of 80 boys in a class is 15. The average age
21. A car owner buys petrol at Rs 7.50, Rs 8.00 and Rs 8.50 per of a group of 15 boys in the class is 16 and the average age
litre for three successive years. What approximately is his of another 25 boys in the class is 14. What is the average
average cost per litre of petrol if he spends Rs 4000 each
age of the remaining boys in the class ?
year ?
(a) 15. 25 (b) 14
(a) ` 8 (b) ` 9
(c) ` 7.98 (d) ` 8.50 (c) 14. 75 (d) Cannot be determined
22. A family consists of grandparents, parents and three 28. The average of four consecutive odd numbers is 36. What
grandchildren. The average age of the grandparents is 67 is the smallest of these numbers ?
years, that of the parents is 35 years and that of the (a) 31 (b) 35
grandchildren is 6 years. What is the average age of the (c) 43 (d) None of these
family? 29. The total of the ages of a class of 75 girls is 1050, the average
4 5 age of 25 of them is 12 yrs and that of another 25 is 16 yr.
(a) 28 years (b) 31 years Find the average age of the remaining girls.
7 7
1 (a) 12 yrs (b) 13 yrs
(c) 32 years (d) None of these (c) 14 yrs (d) 15 yrs
7
23. The average of two numbers is XY. If one number is X, then 30. The average age of a group of 16 persons is 28 yrs and 3
the other number is months. Two persons each 58 yrs old left the group. The
Y average age of the remaining persons is
(a) Y (b) (a) 26 (b) 24
2
(c) 22 (d) 20
(c) 2XY – X (d) X (Y – 1)
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 7 (b) 13 (a) 19 (c) 25 (c)
2 (b) 8 (c) 14 (c) 20 (a) 26 (c)
3 (a) 9 (c) 15 (b) 21 (c) 27 (a)
4 (c) 10 (d) 16 (b) 22 (b) 28 (d)
5 (a) 11 (a) 17 (c) 23 (c) 29 (c)
6 (d) 12 (d) 18 (b) 24 (a) 30 (b)
B- 18 Average, Problem on Ages
19. (c) Let the average expenditure of all the nine be Rs x 24. (a) Sum of 10 numbers = 402
Then, 3 × 8 + x +2 = 9x Þ x = 3.25 Corrected sum of 10 numbers
\ Total money spent = 9x = 9 × 3.25 = Rs. 29.25 = 402 – 13 + 31 – 18 = 402
150 ´ 30 – 135 + 165 Hence, new average = 402 = 40.2
20. (a) Corrected mean =
30 10
25. (c) If you assume the first number to be a, naturally next
4500 – 135 + 165 4530
= = = 151 number would be 2 more than a and so on
30 30
Þ The numbers are : a, a + 2, a + 4, a + 6, a + 8.
21. (c) Let average cost of petrol per litre be Rs x
Hence, their average = Sum/5 = (a + 4)
12000 26. (c) Total marks = 45 × 50 = 2250
Then x =
4000 4000 4000 27. (a) Average age of the remaining boys
+ +
7.5 8 8.5
(80 ´15 ) - (15 ´16 + 25 ´14 ) 1200 - 590
= 15.25
= =
3 6120 40 40
= = = Rs 7.98 per litre
2 1 2 767 28. (d) x + x + 2 + x + 4 + x + 6 = 4 × 36
+ +
15 8 17 Þ 4x + 12 = 144 Þ 4x = 144 – 12
132
æ 67 ´ 2 + 35 ´ 2 + 6 ´ 3 ö Þ 4x = 132 Þ x = = 33
22. (b) Required average = ç ÷ 4
è 2+ 2+3 ø
29. (c) Average age of the remaining girls.
æ 134 + 70 + 18 ö 222 5 1050 - ( 25 ´ 12 + 25 ´ 16 ) 1050 - ( 300 + 400 )
=ç ÷= = 31 years. = =
è 7 ø 7 7 25 25
CHAPTER
5 Percentage,
Profit & Loss
EXERCISE
1. 11% of which number is 33? (a) 10 (b) 20
(a) 300 (b) 330 (c) 30 (d) 40
(c) 110 (d) None of these 3. The digit at unit place of a two-digit number is increased by
2. If two numbers are respectively 20% and 50% of a third 100% and the digit at ten places of the same number is
number, what is the percentage of the first number to the increased by 50%. The new number thus formed is 19 more
second ? than the original number. What is the original number?
Percentage, Profit & Loss B- 21
(a) 22 (b) 63 14. If the radius of a circle is diminished by 10%, the area is
(c) 24 (d) None of these diminished by
4. The owner of a boutique decides to calculate the per centage (a) 36% (b) 20%
of customers who purchase hats. If 40 per cent of the store’s (c) 19% (d) 10%
customers decide to purchase items, and of those customers 15. A screw driver and a hammer currently have the same price.
15 percent purchase hats, then what per cent of the store’s If the price of a screw driver rises by 5% and the price of
customers purchase hats ? hammer goes up by 3%, then how much more will it cost to
(a) 4% (b) 6% buy 3 screw drivers and 3 hammers ?
(c) 15% (d) 24% (a) 3% (b) 4%
5. 10% of the inhabitants of a village having died of cholera, a (c) 5% (d) 8%
panic set in, during which 25% of the remaining inhabitants 16. What is the total number of candidates at an examination, if
left the village. The population is then reduced to 4050. 31% fail, and the number of those who pass exceeds the
Find the number of original inhabitants. number of those who fail by 247?
(a) 5000 (b) 6000 (a) 605 (b) 560
(c) 7000 (d) 8000 (c) 650 (d) 1,650
17. 40% of the people read newspaper X, 50% read newspaper
6. When the price of a pressure cooker was increased by 15%,
Y and 10% read both the papers. What percentage of the
the sale of pressure cookers decreased by 15%. What was
people read neither newspaper?
the net effect on the sales?
(a) 10% (b) 15%
(a) 15% decrease (b) no effect
(c) 20% (d) 25%
(c) 2.25% increase (d) 2.25% decrease
18. If the manufacturer gains 10%, the wholesale dealer 15%
7. In a housing society, 30 per cent of the residents are men and the retailer 25%, then find the cost of production of a
over the age of 18 and 40 per cent are women over the age of table, the retail price of which is ` 1265?
18. If there are 24 children living in the housing society,
(a) ` 800 (b) ` 1000
then how many total residents live ?
(a) 32 (b) 80 (c) ` 900 (d) ` 600
(c) 94 (d) 112 19. A man buys 50 pencils for Rs 100 and sells 45 pencils for
8. A scooter costs ` 25, 000 when it is brand new. At the end ` 90. Find his gain or loss %.
of each year, its value is only 80% of what it was at the (a) 20% (b) 35%
beginning of the year. What is the value of the scooter at (c) 25% (d) No gain or loss
the end of 3 years? 20. Kaberi buys a radio three-fourths of its value and sells it for
(a) ` 10,000 (b) `12,500 20% more than its value. What will be its profit percentage?
(c) ` 12,800 (d) ` 12,000 (a) 50% (b) 40%
9. A student X passes his examination with 515 marks, having (c) 60% (d) 70%
scored 3% above the minimum.If Y had obtained 710 marks, 21. A person sells 36 oranges per rupee and suffers a loss of
what % would have been above the minimum? 4%. Find how many oranges per rupee to be sold to have a
(a) 40% (b) 42% gain of 8%?
(c) 50% (d) Cannot be determined (a) 30 (b) 31
10. Ravi’s salary is 150% of Amit’s salary. Amit’s salary is 80% (c) 32 (d) 33
of Ram’s salary. What is the ratio of Ram’s salary to Ravi’s 22. A shopkeeper’s price is 50% above the cost price. If he
salary ? allows his customer a discount of 30% what profit does he
(a) 1 to 2 (b) 2 to 3 make?
(c) 5 to 6 (d) 6 to 5
(a) 5% (b) 10%
28 (c) 15% (d) 20%
11. The sum of two numbers is of the first number. The
25 23. A man buys milk at Rs 6 per litre and adds one third of water
second number is what percent of the first? to it and sells mixture at Rs 7.20 per litre. The gain is
(a) 12% (b) 14% (a) 40% (b) 80%
(c) 16% (d) 18% (c) 60% (d) 25%
12. An inspector rejects 0.08% of the metres as defective. How 24. A dishonest fruit seller professes to sell his goods at the
many metres will he examine to reject 2 metres? cost price but weighs 800 grams for a kg weight. Find his
(a) 200 m (b) 250 m gain percent.
(c) 2500 m (d) 3000 m (a) 100% (b) 150%
13. A positive number is by mistake divided by 6 instead of
(c) 50% (d) 200%
being multiplied by 6. What is the % error on the basis of
correct answer? 25. A shopkeeper purchased 150 identical pieces of calculators
at the rate of ` 250 each. He spent an amount of ` 2500 on
(a) 3 (b) 97
transport and packing. He fixed the labelled price of each
(c) 17 (d) 83
B- 22 Percentage, Profit & Loss
calculator at ` 320. However, he decided to give a discount 30. A single discount equal to a discount series of 10% and
of 5% on the labelled price. What is the percentage profit 20% is
earned by him ? (a) 25% (b) 28%
(a) 14 % (b) 15 % (c) 30% (d) 35%
(c) 16 % (d) 20 % 31. The list price of a watch is ` 160. A retailer bought the same
26. A man sold two steel chairs for ` 500 each. On one he gains watch ` 122.40. He got two successive discounts one at
20% and on other, he loses 12%. How much does he gain or 10% and the other at a rate which was not legible. What is
lose in the whole transaction? the second discount rate?
(a) 1.5% gain (b) 2% gain (a) 12% (b) 14%
(c) 1.5% loss (d) 2% loss (c) 15% (d) 18%
27. A man sells an article at a gain 15%. If he had bought it at 32. For a certain article, if discount is 25%, the profit is 25%. If
10% less and sold it for ` 4 less, he would have gained 25%. the discount is 10%, then the profit is
Find the cost price of the article. (a) 10% (b) 20%
(a) ` 150 (b) ` 160 (c) 35% (d) 50%
(c) ` 170 (d) ` 180 33. A wholesaler sells 30 pens at the price of 27 pens to a retailer.
28. Five kg of butter was bought by a shopkeeper for ` 300. The retailer sells the pens at their market price. The profit
One kg becomes unsaleable. He sells the remaining in such for the retailer is
a way that on the whole he incurs a loss of 10%. At what (a) 11% (b) 10%
price per kg was the butter sold? 1 1
(a) ` 67.50 (b) ` 52.50 (c) 11 % (d) 9 %
9 11
(c) ` 60 (d) ` 72.50 34. If a merchant estimates his profit as 20% of the selling price,
29. By selling 66 metres of cloth a man loses the selling price of what is his real profit per cent?
22 metres. Find the loss per cent. (a) 18% (b) 20%
(a) 20% (b) 25% (c) 25% (d) 28%
(c) 30% (d) 35%
ANSWER KEY
1 (a) 7 (b) 13 (b) 19 (d) 25 (a) 31 (c)
2 (d) 8 (c) 14 (c) 20 (c) 26 (a) 32 (d)
3 (d) 9 (b) 15 (b) 21 (c) 27 (b) 33 (c)
4 (b) 10 (c) 16 (c) 22 (a) 28 (a) 34 (c)
5 (b) 11 (a) 17 (c) 23 (b) 29 (b)
6 (d) 12 (c) 18 (a) 24 (a) 30 (b)
6 Time, Speed
& Distance
The rate at which any moving body covers a particular distance completely. It implies that the total length of the train has crossed
is called its speed. the total length of the object.
Distance Distance ê Time taken by a train to cross a pole/a standing man
Speed = ; Time = ;
Time Speed Length of train
= .
Distance = Speed × time Speed of train
Unit : SI unit of speed is metre per second (mps). It is also ê Time taken by a train to cross platform/bridge etc. (i.e. a
measured in kilometers per hour (kmp) or miles per hour (mph). stationary object with some length)
Conversion of units : length of train + length of platform/bridge etc.
= .
(i) 1 hour = 60 minutes = 60 × 60 seconds. speed of train
1 km = 1000 m ê When two trains with lengths L1 and L2 and with speeds
1 km = 0.6214 mile S1 and S2 respectively, then
Þ 1 mile = 1.609 km, i.e. 8 km = 5 miles (a) When they are moving in the same direction, time taken
1 yard = 3 feet by the faster train to cross the slower train
1 foot = 12 inches L1 + L2
= .
5 difference of their speeds
1 km/h = m/sec, (b) When they are moving in the opposite direction, time
18
18 taken by the trains to cross each other
1 m/sec = km/h
5 L1 + L 2
= .
22 sum of their speeds
1 miles/hr = ft/sec.
15
ê Suppose two trains or two bodies are moving in the same
Total Distance direction at u km/hr and v km/hr respectively such that u > v,
ê Average speed =
Total time then
ê If a certain distance (d), say from A to B, is covered at ‘a’ their relative speed = (u – v) km/hr.
km/hr and the same distance is covered again say from B to If their lengths be x km and y km respectively, then time
A in ‘b’ km/hr, then the average speed during the whole taken by the faster train to cross the slower train (moving in
journey is given by : æx+yö
the same direction) = ç ÷ hrs.
æ 2ab ö km è u-vø
Average speed = ç ÷
è a + b ø hr ê Suppose two trains or two bodies are moving in opposite
... (which is the harmonic means of a and b directions at u km/hr and v km/hr, then their relative speed
= (u + v) km/hr.
ê If a person with two different speeds U & V cover the If their lengths be x km & y km, then :
same distance, then required distance æx+yö
time taken to cross each other = ç ÷ hrs.
U´V èu+vø
= ´ Difference between arrival time
U-V ê If a man is running at a speed of u m/sec in the same direction
U´V in which a train of length L meters is running at a speed
Also, required distance = Total time taken ´ v m/sec, then (v – u) m/sec is called the speed of the train
U+V
relative to man. Then the time taken by the train to cross the
TRAINS
1
A train is said to have crossed an object (stationary or moving) man = seconds
only when the last coach of the train crosses the said object v-u
B- 26 Time, Speed & Distance
ê If a man is running at a speed of u m/sec in a direction Flow of water
opposite to that in which a train of length L meters is running
with a speed v m/sec, then (u + v) is called the speed of the Boat
Upstream Downstream
train relative to man. Boat
Then the time taken by the train to cross the man
1 Let the speed of a boat (or man) in still water be X m/sec
= seconds. and the speed of the stream (or current) be Y m/sec. Then,
v+u
ê If two trains start at the same time from two points A and B ê Speed of boat with the stream (or downstream or D/S)
towards each other and after crossing, they take a and b = (X + Y) m/sec.
hours in reaching B and A respectively. Then, ê Speed of boat against the stream (or upstream or U/S)
A’s speed : B’s speed = ( )
b: a . ê
= (X – Y) m/sec.
Speed of boat in still water is
BOATS AND STREAMS (X + Y) + (X – Y) Upstream + Downstream
Stream : It implies that the water in the river is moving or flowing. X= =
2 2
Upstream : Going against the flow of the river. (X + Y) – (X – Y)
Downstream : Going with the flow of the river. ê Speed of the stream or current is Y =
2
Still water : It implies that the speed of water is zero (generally, in Downstream - Upstream
=
a lake). 2
EXERCISE
1. A car travels a distance of 45 kms at the speed of 15 kmph. It 7. On a journey across Bombay, a tourist bus averages
covers the next 50 kms of its journey at the speed of 25 kmph 10 km/h for 20% of the distance, 30 km/h for 60% of it and 20
and the last 25 kms of its journey at the speed of 10 kmph. km/h for the remainder. The average speed for the whole
What is the average speed of the car? journey was
(a) 16 kmph (b) 24 kmph (a) 10 km/h (b) 30 km/h
(c) 15 kmph (d) 18 kmph
(c) 5 km/h (d) 20 km/h
2. A 200 meter long train crosses a platform double its length in
8. A man rides a horse at the rate of 11 miles an hour, but stops
36 seconds. What is the speed of the train in km/hr ?
for 5 min to change horse at the end of every seventh mile.
(a) 60 (b) 48
How long will he take to cover a distance of 96 miles ?
(c) 64 (d) 66 (Approx.)
3. Excluding the stoppages, the speed of a bus is 64 km/hr and (a) 7 hr. 20 min. (b) 6 hr. 25 min.
including the stoppages the speed of the bus is 48 km/hr.
(c) 8 hr. 42 min. (d) 9 hr. 48 min.
For how many minutes does the bus stop per hour?
(a) 12.5 minutes (b) 15 minutes 9. A man starts from B to K and another from K to B at the
(c) 10 minutes (d) 18 minutes same time. After passing each other they complete their
1 4
4. A car covers a distance of 540 km in 9 hours. Speed of a train journeys in 3 and 4 hours, respectively. Find the speed
is double the speed of the car. Two-third the speed of the 3 5
of the second man if the speed of the first is 12 km/hr.
train is equal to the speed of a bike. How much distance will
the bike cover in 5 hours ? (a) 12.5 kmph (b) 10 kmph
(a) 450 km (b) 360 km (c) 12.66 kmph (d) 20 kmph
(c) 400 km (d) 500 km 10. A monkey ascends a greased pole 12 meters high. He ascends
5. A 300 meter long train moving with an average speed of 126 2 meters in the first minute and slips down 1 meter in the next
km/hr crosses a platform in 24 seconds. A man crosses the minute and so on . In which minute does it he reaches the
same platform in 5 minutes. What is the speed of the man in top?
meters/second (a) 21st (b) 22nd
(a) 1.8 m/s (b) 1.2 m/s (c) 23rd (d) 24th
(c) 1.5 m/s (d) Cannot be determined 11. A boat running downstream covers a distance of 16 km in 2
6. Train A crosses a stationary train B in 35 seconds and a pole hours while for covering the same distance upstream, it takes
in 14 seconds with the same speed. The length of the train A 4 hours. What is the speed of the boat in still water?
is 280 meters. What is the length of the stationary train B ?
(a) 4 km/h (b) 6 km/h
(a) 420 meters (b) 480 meters
(c) 8 km/h (d) Data inadequate
(c) 400 meters (d) Cannot be determined
Time, Speed & Distance B- 27
12. R and S start walking towards each other at 10 AM at the 22. In a 800 m race around a stadium having the circumference
speeds of 3 km/h and 4 km/h respectively. They were initially of 200 m, the top runner meets the last runner on the 5th
17.5 km apart. At what time do they meet? minute of the race. If the top runner runs at twice the speed
(a) 2 : 30 PM (b) 11 : 30 AM of the last runner, what is the time taken by the top runner to
(c) 1 : 30 PM (d) 12 : 30 PM finish the race ?
(a) 20 min (b) 15 min
13. In a 800 m race around a stadium having the circumference
(c) 10 min (d) 5 min
of 200 m, the top runner meets the last runner on the 5th
23. A man walks half of the journey at 4 km/h by cycle does one
minute of the race. If the top runner runs at twice the speed
third of journey at 12 km/h and rides the remainder journey
of the last runner, what is the time taken by the top runner to
in a horse cart at 9 km/h, thus completing the whole journey
finish the race ?
in 6 hours and 12 minutes. The length of the journey is
(a) 20 min (b) 15 min
1332
(c) 10 min (d) 5 min (a) 36 km (b) km
67
14. Mohan travels 760 km to his home, partly by train and partly (c) 40 km (d) 28 km
by car. He takes 8 hours if he travels 160 km by train and the 24. R and S start walking each other at 10 AM at the speeds of
rest by car. He takes 12 minutes more if he travels 240 km by 3 km/h and 4 km/h respectively. They were initially 17.5 km
train and the rest by car. The speed of the train and the car, apart. At what time do they meet?
respectively are: (a) 2 : 30 PM (b) 11 : 30 AM
(a) 80 km/h, 100 km/h (b) 100 km/h, 80 km/h (c) 1 : 30 PM (d) 12 : 30 PM
(c) 120 km/h, 120 km/h (d) 100 km/h, 120 km/h 25. If I walk at 4 km/h, I miss the bus by 10 minutes. If I walk at 5
15. A boy rows a boat against a stream flowing at 2 kmph for a km/h, I reach 5 minutes before the arrival of the bus. How far
distance of 9 km, and then turns round and rows back with I walk to reach the bus stand ?
the current. If the whole trip occupies 6 hours, find the boy’s (a) 5 km (b) 4.5 km
rowing speed in still water. 1
(c) 5 km / h (d) Cannot be determined
(a) 4 kmph (b) 3 kmph 4
(c) 2 kmph (d) 5 kmph 26. Without stoppages, a train travels certain distance with an
16. A man walking at the rate of 5 km/h crosses a bridge in 15 average speed of 80 km/h, and with stoppages, it covers the
minutes. The length of the bridge (in metres) is : same distance with an average speed of 60 km/h. How many
(a) 600 (b) 750 minutes per hour the train stops ?
(c) 1000 (d) 1250 (a) 15 (b) 18
17. A cyclist covers a distance of 750 m in 2 min 30 sec. What is (c) 10 (d) None of these
the speed in km/h of the cyclist ? 27. If a man walks to his office at 3/4 of his usual rate, he reaches
(a) 18 km/h (b) 15 km/h office 1/3 of an hour later than usual. What is his usual time
(c) 20 km/h (d) None of these to reach office.
18. An aeroplane flies along the four sides of a square at the 1
speeds of 200, 400, 600 and 800 km/h. Find the average speed (a) hr (b) 1 hr
2
of the plane around the field.
3
(a) 384 km/h (b) 370 km/h (c) hr (d) None of these
(c) 368 km/h (d) None of these 4
1 28. A train running between two stations A and B arrives at its
19. A man walks a certain distance and rides back in 6 h. He destination 10 minutes late when its speed is 50 km/h and
3 4
can walk both ways in 7 h. How long it would take to ride 50 minutes late when its speed is 30km/h. What is the
both ways ? 4 distance between the stations A and B ?
1 (a) 40 km (b) 50 km
(a) 5 hours (b) 4 hours (c) 60 km (d) 70 km
2
3 29. A thief goes away with a Maruti car at a speed of 40 km/h.
(c) 4 hours (d) 6 hours The theft has been discovered after half an hour and the
4
20. There are 20 poles with a constant distance between each owner sets off in another car at 50 km/h. When will the owner
pole. A car takes 24 seconds to reach the 12th pole . How overtake the thief from the start.
much time will it take to reach the last pole? 1
(a) 2 hours (b) 2 hr 20 min
(a) 25.25 s (b) 17.45 s 2
(c) 35.75 s (d) 41.45 s (c) 1 hr 45 min (d) cannot be determined
21. On a journey across Bombay, a tourist bus averages 30. A long distance runner runs 9 laps of a 400 metres track
10 km/h for 20% of the distance, 30 km/h for 60% of it and 20 everyday. His timings (in minutes) for four consecutive days
km/h for the remainder. The average speed for the whole are 88, 96, 89 and 87 resplectively. On an average, how many
journey was metres/minute does the runner cover ?
(a) 10 km/h (b) 30 km/h (a) 40 m/min (b) 45 m/min
(c) 5 km/h (d) 20 km/h (c) 38 m/min (d) 49 m/min
B- 28 Time, Speed & Distance
AN SWER KEY
1 (a) 7 (d) 13 (c) 19 (c) 25 (a)
2 (a) 8 (d) 14 (a) 20 (d) 26 (a)
3 (b) 9 (b) 15 (a) 21 (d) 27 (b)
4 (c) 10 (a) 16 (d) 22 (c) 28 (b)
5 (a) 11 (b) 17 (a) 23 (a) 29 (a)
6 (a) 12 (d) 18 (a) 24 (d) 30 (a)
12. (d) Let them meet after t hours, then, Time taken to covers the total distance of 19x
3t + 4t = 17.5 Þ t = 2.5 19 x ´ 24
\ Time = 10 am + 2.5 h = 12 : 30pm = = 41.45 s
11x
13. (c) After 5 minutes (before meeting), the top runner covers
2 rounds i.e., 400 m and the last runner covers 1 round 21. (d) Let the average speed be x km/h.
i.e., 200 m. and Total distance = y km. Then,
\ Top runner covers 800 m race in 10 minutes. 0.2 0.6 0.2 y
y+ y+ y=
14. (a) Let speed of the train be x km/h and that of the car be y 10 30 20 x
km/h.
1
160 600 Þx= = 20km / h
Now, + =8 …(i) 0.05
x y 22. (c) After 5 minutes (before meeting), the top runner covers
2 rounds i.e., 400 m and the last runner covers 1 round
240 520 41
and + = …(ii) i.e., 200 m.
x y 5 \ Top runner covers 800 m race in 10 minutes.
Solving (i) and (ii), we have x = 80 km/h and 23. (a) Let the length of the journey =x km.
y = 100 km/h.
æ 1 1ö
\ Journey rides by horse cart = x ç1 - - ÷
15. (a) Let the speed of rowing be X. Then the equation formed
è 2 3ø
9 9
is + = 6. 1
X-2 X+2 = x km.
6
On solving, we get the value of X as 4.
31
æ 5ö 25 Then, total time taken to complete journey = hr
16. (d) Speed = ç 5 ´ ÷ m / sec = m / sec. 5
è 18 ø 18
31
Distance covered in 15 minutes Þ t1 + t 2 + t 3 =
5
æ 25 ö x 1 x 1 x 31
= ç ´15 ´ 60 ÷ m = 1250 m. Þ ´ + ´ + =
è 18 ø 2 4 3 12 6 ´ 9 5
æ 750 ö Þx=
31 216
´ = 36.2km » 36km
17. (a) Speed = ç ÷ m / sec = 5 m / sec 5 37
è 150 ø
24. (d) Let after t hours they meet then,
æ 18 ö 3t + 4t = 17.5 Þ t = 2.5
= ç 5 ´ ÷ km / hr = 18 km / hr.
è 5ø \ Time = 10 am + 2.5 h = 12 : 30pm
18. (a) Let each side of the square be x km and let the average é difference of time ù
speed of the plane around the field be y km/h. Then, 25. (a) d = product of speed ê ú
ë difference of speed û
x x x x 4x
+ + + = [Here, –ve sign indicates
200 400 600 800 y 4 ´ 5 é10 – (–5) ù
d=
60 êë 5 – 4 úû before the schedule time]
25x 4x æ 2400 ´ 4 ö Þ d = 5 km
Þ = Þ y=ç ÷ = 384.
2400 y è 25 ø 26. (a) Due to stoppages, it covers 20 km less .
\ Average speed = 384 km/h.
19. (c) We know that, the relation in time taken with two Time taken to cover 20km = 20 h = 1 h
80 4
different modes of transport is
twalk both + tride both = 2 (twalk + t ride) 1
= ´ 60 min = 15 min
31 25 4
+ t ride both = 2 ´
4 4 a
27. (b) If new speed is of original speed, then
25 31 19 3 b
Þ t ride both = – = = 4 hrs
2 4 4 4 æb ö
usual time × ç – 1 ÷ = change in time
20. (d) Let the distance between each pole be x m. èa ø
Then, the distance up to 12th pole = 11 x m
æ4 ö 1
11x \ usual time × ç - 1÷ =
Speed = m/s è3 ø 3
24
B- 30 Time, Speed & Distance
1 Let after time 't', owner catches the thief.
Þ usual time = ´ 3 = 1 hr
3 æ 1ö
28. (b) Let the distance between the two stations be x km. \ 40 ´ t = 50 ç t – ÷
è 2ø
x 10 x 50
Then, - = - 5 1
50 6 30 6 Þ 10t = 25 Þ t = hr = 2 hr
2 2
x 1 x 5 Total distance
Þ - = - Average speed =
50 6 30 6 30. (a)
Total time
x x 2 400 ´ 4 ´ 9 400 ´ 4 ´ 9
or - = or x = 50 km
30 50 3 = =
88 + 96 + 89 + 87 360
Thus distance between the station A and B = 50 km = 40 metres /minutes
29. (a) Distance to be covered by the thief and by the owner
is same.
CHAPTER
Simple Mixture : When two different ingredients are mixed Let Mixture 1 has ingredients A and B in ratio a : b
together, it is known as a simple mixture. and Mixture 2 has ingredients A and B in ratio x : y.
Compound Mixture : When two or more simple mixtures are mixed Now, M unit of mixture 1 and N unit of mixture 2 are mixed to
together to form another mixture, it is known as a compound form compound mixture. Then, in the resultant mixture, the
mixture. ratio of A and B is
Alligation : Alligation is nothing but a faster technique of solving æ a ö æ x ö
problems based on the weighted average situation as applied to
Mç ÷ + Nç ÷
Quantity of ingredient A q A èa+bø èx+yø
the case of two groups being mixed together. (i) = =
Quantity of ingredient B q B æ b ö æ y ö
The word ‘Alligation’ literally means ‘linking’. Mç ÷ + Nç ÷
è a + b ø èx+yø
ê Alligation rule : It states that when different quantities of
the same or different ingredients of different costs are mixed And,
together to produce a mixture of a mean cost, the ratio of qA
Quantity of A in resultant mixture = ´ (M + N)
their quantities is inversely proportional to the difference in qA + q B
their cost from the mean cost. qB
Quantity of Cheaper Price of Dearer - Mean Price Quantity of B in resultant mixture = ´ (M + N)
= qA + q B
Quantity of Dearer Mean Price - Price of Cheaper
(ii) When qA and qB are known and M and N have to be found
Graphical representation of Alligation Rule : out
Quantity Quantity
a b æ x ö æ qA ö
ç ÷-ç ÷
Quantity of mixture 1 Q1 è x + y ø è q A + q B ø
Mean = =
Average (d) Quantity of mixture 2 Q 2 æ qA ö æ a ö
ç ÷-ç ÷
è qA + qB ø è a + b ø
And,
b–d d–a
Quantity of mixture 1
Quantity of a b - d
= Q1
Quantity of b d - a = × Quantity of resultant mixture
Q1 + Q 2
Price of the Mixture : Quantity of mixture 2
ê When quantities Qi of ingredients Mi’s with the cost Ci’s
Q2
are mixed then cost of the mixture Cm is given by = × Quantity of resultant mixture
Q1 + Q 2
å Ci Q i
Cm = Removal and Replacement
å Qi
(i) Let a vessel contains Q unit of mixture of ingredients A and
Straight line approach of Alligation B. From this, R unit of mixture is taken out and replaced by
Let Q1 and Q2 be the two quantities, and n1 and n2 are the num- an equal amount of ingredient B only.
ber of elements present in the two quantities respectively, If this process is repeated n times, then after n operations
Q1 Q2 n
Av Quantity of A left æ Rö
= ç1 - ÷
Quantity of A originally present è Q ø
n1 n2 and Quantity of B left = Q – Quantity of A Left
(ii) Let a vessel contains Q unit of ingredient A only. From this
where Av is the average of the new group formed then n 1 corre- R unit of ingredient A is taken out and replaced by an equal
sponds to Q 2 – Av, n 2 corresponds to Av – Q 1 and amount of ingredient B.
(n1 + n2) corresponds to Q2 – Q1.
If this process is repeated n times, then after n operations,
Let us consider the previous example. n
æ Rö
ê Alligation Rule for Compound Mixture : Remember that in Quantity of A left = Q ç1 - ÷
compound mixture, same mixtures i.e., mixtures of same è Qø
ingredients are mixed together in different proportion to Quantity of B = 1 – Quantity of A left
make a new mixture.
B- 32 Mixture & Alligation
EXERCISE
1. Gold is 19 times as heavy as water and copper is 9 times 10. Sameer bought 10 kg of tea at ` 45 per kg and 8 kg at ` 50
heavy. In what ratio must these metals be mixed so that the per kg. He mixed both the brands and sold it at a total profit
mixture may be 15 times as heavy as water? of ` 32. What was the selling price per kg of the mixture?
(a) 2 : 3 (b) 3 : 2 (a) ` 48 (b) ` 50
(c) 1 : 3 (d) 2 : 1
(c) ` 49 (d) ` 47
2. Six litres of a 20% solution of alcohol in water are mixed with
4 litres of a 60% solution of alcohol in water. The % alcoholic 11. Five litres of water is added to a certain quantity of pure
strength of the mixture is milk costing ` 3 per litre. If by selling the mixture at the same
(a) 80 (b) 40 price as before, a profit of 20% is made, what is the amount
(c) 36 (d) 48 of pure milk in the mixture?
3. A merchant lent out `1,000 in two parts, one at 8% and the (a) 22 litres (b) 25 litres
other at 10% interest. The yearly average comes out to be (c) 27 litres (d) None of these
9.2%. Find the amount lent in two parts. 12. A jar full of whisky contains 40% alcohol. A part of this
(a) ` 400, ` 600 (b) ` 500, ` 500 whisky is replaced by another containing 19% alcohol and
(c) ` 300, ` 700 (d) cannot be determined now the percentage of alcohol was found to be 26%. The
4. How many kg of salt at 42 paise per kg must a man mix with quantity of whisky replaced is:
25 kg of salt at 24 paise per kg so that he may, on selling the
mixture at 40 paise per kg gain 25% on the outlay? 1 2
(a) (b)
(a) 15 kg (b) 18 kg 3 3
(c) 20 kg (d) 24 kg
5. Alcohol cost ` 3.50 per litre and kerosene oil cost ` 2.50 per 2 3
(c) (d)
litre. In what proportion these should be mixed so that the 5 5
resulting mixture may be ` 2.75 per litre?
13. How many kg of custard powder costing ` 40 kg must be
(a) 2 : 5 (b) 1 : 3
mixed with 16 kg of custard powder costing ` 55 kg so that
(c) 4 : 7 (d) 2 : 3 25% may be gained by selling the mixture at ` 60 kg?
6. Two liquids are mixed in the proportion of 3 : 2 and the
(a) 11 kg (b) 14 kg
mixture is sold at ` 11 per kg at a 10% profit. If the first liquid
costs ` 2 more per kg than the second, what does it cost per (c) 12 kg (d) 20 kg
litre? 14. From a cask full of milk, 10 litres are taken out of 50 litres and
(a) ` 11 (b) ` 10.50 is filled with water. This was done twice. What is the quantity
(c) ` 11.50 (d) ` 10.80 of milk now left in the cask?
7. A chemist has 10 litres of a solution that is 10 per cent nitric (a) 20 litres (b) 32 litres
acid by volume. He wants to dilute the solution to 4 per cent
(c) 25 litres (d) 30 litres
strength by adding water. How many litres of water must he
add ? 15. Two equal glasses filled with mixtures of alcohol and water
(a) 15 (b) 20 in the proportions of 2 : 1 and 1 : 1 respectively were emptied
(c) 18 (d) 25 into third glass. What is the proportion of alcohol and water
8. A mixture of glycerine and water contains 35% glycerine by in the third glass?
weight. Twenty five grams of water is added to such 100 (a) 5 : 7 (b) 7 : 5
grams of mixture. What % of glycerine by weight is there in (c) 7 : 6 (d) 6 : 7
the new mixture? 16. A butler stole wine from a butt of sherry which contained
(a) 25 (b) 23 32% of spirit and then replaced what he stole, by wine
(c) 29 (d) 28 containing only 18% spirit. The butt was then of 24%
9. A and B are two alloys of gold and copper prepared by strength only. How much of the butt had he stolen?
mixing metals in the ratio 7 : 2 and 7 : 11 respectively. If equal
quantities of the alloys are melted to form a third alloy C, 3 5
(a) (b)
then the ratio of gold and copper in alloy C will be 8 7
(a) 5 : 7 (b) 5 : 9 4 7
(c) 7 : 5 (d) 9 : 5 (c) (d)
7 11
Mixture & Alligation B- 33
17. Several litres of acid were drawn off from a 54 litre vessel, 19. An alloy contains copper and zinc in the ratio 5 : 3 and
full of acid and and equal amount of water was added. Again another alloy contains copper and tin in the ratio 8 : 5. If
the same volume of the mixture was drawn off and replaced equal weights of both the alloys are melted together, then
by water. As a result now, the vessel contained 24 litres of the weight of tin in the resulting alloy per kg will be:
pure acid. How much of the acid was drawn off initially ?
26 5
(a) 12 L (a) (b)
5 26
(b) 16 L
(c) 18 L 7 40
(d) 24 L (c) (d)
40 7
18. The number of millilitres of water added to reduce 9 ml of 20. A mixture of Nitric acid and Sulfuric acid is taken in the ratio
aftershave lotion, containing 50% alcohol, to a lotion of 1 : 2 and another mixture of the same is taken in the ratio
containing 30% alcohol is 2 : 3. How many parts of the two mixtures must be taken to
(a) 3 attain a new mixture consisting of Nitric acid and Sulfuric
(b) 4 acid in the ratio of 3 : 5 ?
(c) 5 (a) 3 : 5 (b) 5 : 3
(d) 6 (c) 2 : 3 (d) 3 : 2
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 6 (d) 11 (b) 16 (c)
2 (c) 7 (a) 12 (b) 17 (c)
3 (a) 8 (d) 13 (b) 18 (d)
4 (c) 9 (c) 14 (b) 19 (b)
5 (b) 10 (c) 15 (b) 20 (a)
100 2.5
6. (d) C.P. of mixture = ´ 11 = ` 10 \ Ratio of pure milk and water in mixture = = 5 :1
100 + 10 0.5
Let the cost of second liquid be ` x.
For five litres of water, quantity of pure milk
Then, cost of first liquid be ` (x + 2).
= 5 × 5 = 25 litres
(x + 2) ´ 3 + 2x
\ 10 = 12. (b) By the rule of alligation, we have :
5
Þ 5x + 6 = 50 Þ x = ` 8.8
\ cost of first liquid = ` (8.8 + 2) = ` 10.80 Strength of Strength of
first jar 2nd jar
7. (a) Out of 10 litre of solution, there is 1 litres of nitric acid 40% 19%
and 9 litres of water.
Let x litres of water be added to the solution so that the Mean
diluted solution is of 4% strength. strength
\ 4% of (10 + x) = 1 Þ x = 15. 26%
8. (d) % of glycerine in new mixture
7 14
Original % of glycerine
= × 100
mixture weight + water added
So, ratio of 1st and 2nd quantities = 7 : 14 = 1 : 2.
35 2
= ´ 100 = 28% \ Required quantity replaced = .
100 + 25 3
9. (c) Gold Copper
100 ´ 60
Type A 14 4 13. (b) C. P. of mixture = = ` 48
(100 + 25)
Type B 7 11
Type C 21 15 Let x kg be mixed. Then,
\ The ratio of the Gold and Copper in the type C
alloy = 7 : 5. 40 ´ x + 55 ´16
48 =
16 + x
10. (c) C. P. of mixture of 18 kg = 10 × 45 + 8 × 50 = ` 850
\ S. P. = C. P. + Profit = 850 + 32 = ` 882 Þ 8x = 16[55 - 48] Þ x = 14 kg
\ S. P. = ` 882 for 18 kg
10 1
882 14. (b) Q 10 litres are withdrawn = = of the whole
\ S. P. for 1 kg. = ` = ` 49 50 5
18
11. (b) Here, S. P. of mixture = C. P. of pure milk = ` 3 per litre Quantity of milk after 2nd operation
100 + 20 æ 1ö
2
16
Now, S. P. of mixture = ´ C.P. of mixture = 50 ç1 - ÷ = ´ 50 = 32 litres
100 è 5ø 25
3×100
Þ C.P. of mixture = = Rs 2.5 per litre 2 1
120 15. (b) Alcohol in 1st glass = ; water in 1st glass =
3 3
Also, C. P of water = ` 0
By the rule of alligation : 1 1
Alcohol in 2nd glass = ; water in 2nd glass =
C.P. of pure milk C.P. of water 2 2
`3 `0
\ In 3rd glass,
2 1 7 1 1 5
Alcohol = + = ; water = + =
2.5 (mixture) 3 2 6 3 2 6
7 5
\ Required ratio = : = 7 :5
6 6
2.5 0.5
Mixture & Alligation B- 35
16. (c) By the rule of alligation, 18. (d) The given solution has 50% alcohol. Water which is to
be added has 0% alcohol concentration.
Alcohol concentration :
Wine containing Wine containing
32% spirit 18% spirit
Original solution water
50% 0%
Wine containing
24 % spirit
30% (mixture)
6 8
30 20
or æ y ö 2 x 1
ç 1 - ÷ = or =
è 54 ø 3 54 3
or y = 18 litres
CHAPTER
TIMEAND WORK Inlet : A pipe connected with a tank (or a cistern or a reservoir) is
In most of the problems on time and work, either of the following called an inlet, if it fills it.
basic parameters are to be calculated : Outlet : A pipe connected with a tank is called an outlet, if it
TIME: empties it.
ê If A can do a piece of work in X days, then A’s one day’s ê If a pipe can fill a tank in x hours, then the part filled in 1 hour
1 1
work = th part of whole work. =
X x
1 ê If a pipe can empty a tank in y hours, then the part of the full
ê If A’s one day’s work = th part of whole work, then A can
X
finish the work in X days. 1
tank emptied in 1 hour = .
ê If A can do a piece of work in X days and B can do it in Y y
days then A and B working together will do the same work ê If a pipe can fill a tank in x hours and another pipe can empty
XY the full tank in y hours, then the net part filled in 1 hour,
in days.
X+Y
æ1 1ö
ê If A, B and C can do a work in X, Y and Z days respectively when both the pipes are opened = ç x – y ÷ .
è ø
then all of them working together can finish the work in
XYZ \ Time taken to fill the tank, when both the pipes are
days.
XY + YZ + XZ xy
opened = .
ê A and B can do a work in ‘X’ and ‘Y’ days respectively. y–x
They started the work together but A left ‘a’ days before ê If a pipe can fill a tank in x hours and another can fill the
completion of the work. Then, time taken to finish the work
xy
Y(X + a) same tank in y hours, then time taken to fill the tank = ,
is y+x
X+Y
when both the pipes are opened
ê If ‘A’ is ‘a’ times efficient than B and A can finish a work in
X days, then working together, they can finish the work in ê If a pipe fills a tank in x hours and another fills the same tank
is y hours, but a third one empties the full tank in z hours,
aX and all of them are opened together, then net part filled in 1
days.
a +1
é1 1 1ù
ê If A is ‘a’ times efficient than B and working together they hr = ê + – ú
finish a work in Z days then, time taken by A = ëx y zû
Z(a + 1) xyz
days. and time taken by B = Z(a + 1) days. \ Time taken to fill the tank = hours.
a yz + xz – xy
ê If A working alone takes ‘x’ days more than A and B together, ê A pipe can fill a tank in x hrs. Due to a leak in the bottom it is
and B working along takes ‘y’ days more than A and B filled in y hrs. If the tank is full, the time taken by the leak to
together then the number of days taken by A and B working xy
empty the tank = hrs.
together is given by [ xy] days. y–x
PIPES AND CISTERNS ê A cistern has a leak which can empty it in X hours. A pipe
The same principle of Time and Work is employed to solve the which admits Y litres of water per hour into the cistern is
problems on Pipes and Cisterns. The only difference is that in turned on and now the cistern is emptied in Z hours. Then
this case, the work done is in terms of filling or emptying a cistern X+Y+Z
(tank) and the time taken is the time taken by a pipe or a leak the capacity of the cistern is litres.
Z-X
(crack) to fill or empty a cistern respectively.
Time & Work B- 37
EXERCISE
1. ‘A’ can complete a piece of work in 12 days. ‘A’ and ‘B’ 6. A sum of ` 25 was paid for a work which A can do in 32 days,
together can complete the same piece of work in 8 days. In B in 20 days, B and C together in 12 days and D in 24 days.
how many days can ‘B’ alone complete the same piece of How much did C receive if all the four work together?
work?
14 16
(a) 15 days (b) 18 days (a) ` (b) `
3 3
(c) 24 days (d) 28 days
15 17
2. 12 Men can complete one-third of the work in 8 days. In how (c) ` (d) `
many days can 16 men complete that work? 3 3
(a) 18 (b) 12 7. Sunil and Pradeep can complete a work in 5 days and 15
(c) 24 (d) Cannot be determined days respectively. They both work for one day and then
3. A can finish a work in 18 days and B can do the same work in Sunil leaves. In how many days will the remaining work be
half the time taken by A. Then, working together, what part completed by Pradeep ?
of the same work can they finish in a day? (a) 11 days (b) 12 days
(c) 15 days (d) 8 days
1 1
(a) (b) 8. If 6 men and 8 boys can do a piece of work in 10 days while
6 9
26 men and 48 boys can do the same in 2 days, the time taken
2 2 by 15 men and 20 boys in doing the same work will be:
(c) (d) (a) 4 days (b) 5 days
5 7
4. A and B can finish a work in 10 days while B and C can do it (c) 6 days (d) 7 days
in 18 days. A started the work, worked for 5 days, then B 9. 12 men complete a work in 9 days. After they have worked
worked for 10 days and the remaining work was finished by for 6 days, 6 more men join them. How many days will they
C in 15 days. In how many days could C alone have finished take to complete the remaining work?
the whole work ? (a) 2 days (b) 3 days
(a) 30 days (b) 15 days (c) 4 days (d) 5 days
(c) 45 days (d) 24 days 10. Three taps A, B and C can fill a tank in 12, 15 and 20 hours
5. Two pipes A and B can fill a cistern in 10 and 15 minutes respectively. If A is open all the time and B and C are open
respectively. Both fill pipes are opened together, but at the for one hour each alternately, then the tank will be full in :
end of 3 minutes, ‘B’ is turned off. How much time will the
2
cistern take to fill ? (a) 6 hrs. (b) 6 hrs.
3
(a) 6 min (b) 8 min
(c) 10 min (d) 12 min 1
(c) 7 hrs. (d) 7 hrs.
2
B- 38 Time & Work
11. 26 men can complete a piece of work in 17 days. How many 21. Two pipes A and B can fill a tank in 15 and 12 hours
more men must be hired to complete the work in 13 days ?
3
(a) 9 (b) 8 respectively. Pipe B alone is kept open for of the time and
(c) 6 (d) 18 4
12. Work done by A in one day is half of the work done by B in both pipes are kept open for the remaining time. In how
one day. Work done by B is half of the work done by C in many hours will the tank will be full ?
one day. If C alone can complete the work in 7 days, in how (a) 18 h (b) 20 h
many days can A, B and C together complete the work? (c) 10 h (d) 13.5 h
(a) 28 (b) 14 22. If 6 men and 8 boys can do a piece of work in 10 days while
(c) 4 (d) 21 26 men and 48 boys can do the same in 2 days, the time
13. 16 men can complete a piece of work in 8 days. In how many taken by 15 men and 20 boys in doing the same work will be:
days can 12 men complete the same piece of work? (a) 4 days (b) 5 days
1 (c) 6 days (d) 7 days
(a) 10 (b) 9 23. 12 men complete a work in 9 days. After they have worked
3
for 6 days, 6 more men join them. How many days will they
2 take to complete the remaining work?
(c) 10 (d) Cannot be determined
3 (a) 2 days (b) 3 days
14. ‘A’ can complete a piece of work in 12 days. ‘A’ and ‘B’ (c) 4 days (d) 5 days
together can complete the same piece of work in 8 days. In 24. Three taps A, B and C can fill a tank in 12, 15 and 20 hours
how many days can ‘B’ alone complete the same piece of respectively. If A is open all the time and B and C are open
work? for one hour each alternately, then the tank will be full in :
(a) 15 days (b) 18 days 2
(a) 6 hrs. (b) 6 hrs.
(c) 24 days (d) 28 days 3
15. 12 Men can complete one-third of the work in 8 days. In
1
how many days can 16 men complete that work? (c) 7 hrs. (d) 7 hrs.
(a) 18 (b) 12 2
(c) 24 (d) Cannot be determined 25. Two pipes A and B when working alone can fill a tank in 36
16. Computer A takes 3 minutes to process an input while min. and 45 min. respectively. A waste pipe C can empty the
computer B takes 5 minutes. If computers A, B and C can tank in 30 min. First A and B are opened. After 7 min., C is
process an average of 14 inputs in one hour, how many also opened. In how much time will the tank be full ?
minutes does Computer C alone take to process one input ? (a) 39 min. (b) 30 min.
(a) 10 (b) 4 (c) 20 min. (d) 36 min.
(c) 6 (d) 8 26. A is half good a workman as B and together they finish a job
17. 21 binders can bind 1400 books in 15 days. How many binders in 14 days. In how many days working alone will B finish
will be required to bind 800 books in 20 days? the job.
(a) 7 (b) 9 (a) 20 days (b) 21 days
(c) 12 (d) 14 (c) 22 days (d) None of these
18. A and B can finish a work in 10 days while B and C can do it 3
27. A can do of a work in 12 days. In how many days can he
in 18 days. A started the work, worked for 5 days, then B 4
worked for 10 days and the remaining work was finished by 1
finish of the work?
C in 15 days. In how many days could C alone have finished 8
the whole work ? (a) 6 days (b) 5 days
(a) 30 days (b) 15 days (c) 3 days (d) 2 days
(c) 45 days (d) 24 days 28. A man is twice as fast as a woman. Together the man and
19. A is 30% more efficient than B. How much time will they, the woman do the piece of work in 8 days. In how many
working together, take to complete a job which A alone could days each will do the work if engaged alone?
have done in 23 days? (a) man-14 days, woman-28 days
(a) 11 days (b) 13 days
(b) man-12 days, woman-24 days
3 (c) man-10 days, woman-20 days
(c) 20 days (d) None of these
17 (d) None of these
20. Sunil and Pradeep can complete a work in 5 days and 15 29. 24 men working 8 hours a day can finish a work in 10 days.
days respectively. They both work for one day and then Working at the rate of 10 hours a day, the number of men
Sunil leaves. In how many days will the remaining work be required to finish the same work in 6 days is :
completed by Pradeep ? (a) 30 (b) 32
(a) 11 days (b) 12 days (c) 34 (d) 36
(c) 15 days (d) 8 days
Time & Work B- 39
30. A tyre has two punctures. The first puncture along would 39. Pipe A can fill a tank in 5 hours, pipe B in 10 hours and pipe
have made the tyre flat in 9 minutes and the second alone C in 30 hours. If all the pipes are open, in how many hours
would have done it in 6 minutes. If air leaks out at a constant will the tank be filled ?
rate, how long does it take both the punctures together to (a) 2 (b) 2.5
make it flat? (c) 3 (d) 3.5
1 1 40. Two taps can fill a tank in 12 and 18 minutes respectively.
(a) 1 minutes (b) 3 minutes Both are kept open for 2 minutes and the first is turned off.
2 2
3 1 In how many minutes more will the tank be filled ?
(c) 3 minutes (d) 4 minutes (a) 15 min. (b) 20 min.
5 4
31. A man, a woman or a boy can do a job in 20 days, 30 days or (c) 11 min. (d) 13 min.
60 days respectively. How many boys must assist 2 men 41. One fill pipe A is 3 times faster than second fill pipe B and
and 8 women to do the work in 2 days? takes 10 minutes less time to fill a cistern than B takes. Find
(a) 15 boys (b) 8 boys when the cistern will be full if fill pipe B is only opened.
(c) 10 boys (d) None of these (a) 20 min (b) 18 min
32. If 15 women or 10 men can complete a project in 55 days, in (c) 15 min (d) 10 min
how many days will 5 women and 4 men working together 42. Three fill pipes A, B and C can fill separately a cistern in 3, 4
complete the same project ? and 6 minutes respectively. A was opened first. After 1
(a) 75 (b) 8 minute, B was opened and after 2 minutes from the start of
(c) 9 (d) 85 A, C was also opened. Find the time when the cistern will be
33. A can do a piece of work in 10 days, while B alone can do it full ?
in 15 days. They work together for 5 days and the rest of the
1 1
work is done by C in 2 days. If they get ` 450 for the whole (a) 2 min (b) 4 min
work, how should they divide the money ? 9 2
(a) ` 225, ` 150, ` 75 (b) ` 250, ` 100, ` 100 3
(c) 3 min (d) None of these
(c) ` 200, ` 150, ` 100 (d) ` 175, ` 175, ` 100 4
43. Water flows at 3 metres per sec through a pipe of radius 4
1
34. After working for 8 days, Anil finds that only of the work cm. How many hours will it take to fill a tank 40 metres long,
3 30 metres broad and 8 metres deep, if the pipe remains full?
has been done. He employs Rakesh who is 60% efficient as
Anil. How many more days will Anil take to complete the (a) 176.6 hours (b) 120 hour
job? (c) 135.5 hours (d) None of these
(a) 15 days (b) 12 days 44. 40 men can cut 60 trees is 8 hrs. If 8 men leaves the job how
(c) 10 days (d) 8 days many trees will be cut in 12 hours ?
35. X can do a piece of work in 15 days. If he is joined by Y who (a) 72 (b) 60
is 50% more efficient, in what time will X and Y together (c) 48 (d) 36
finish the work? 45. 10 horses and 15 cows eat grass of 5 acres in a certain time.
(a) 10 days (b) 6 days How many acres will feed 15 horses and 10 cows for the
(c) 18 days (d) Data insufficient same time, supposing a horse eats as much as 2 cows ?
36. If 12 men or 15 women or 18 boys can do a piece of work in (a) 40/7 acres (b) 39/8 acres
15 days of 8 hours each, find how many men assisted by 5 (c) 40/11 acres (d) 25/9 acres
women and 6 boys will finish the same work in 16 days of 9
46. 4 pipes can fill a reservoir in 15, 20, 30 and 60 hours
hours each.
respectively. The first was opened at 6 am, second at 7 am
(a) 6 men (b) 2 men
third at 8 am and fourth at 9 am. When will the reservoir be
(c) 8 men (d) 4 men
full ?
37. 2 men and 3 boys can do a piece of work in 10 days while (a) 11 am (b) 12 pm
3 men and 2 boys can do the same work in 8 days. In how
(c) 12.30 pm (d) 1.00 pm
many days can 2 men and 1 boy to the work ?
47. Two pipes can fill a cistern in 14 and 16 hours respectively.
1 1 The pipes are opened simultaneously and it is found that
(a) 12 days (b) 11 days
2 2 due to leakage in the bottom, 32 minutes extra are taken for
1 1 the cistern to be filled up. If the cistern is full, in what time
(c) 15 days (d) 13 days would the leak empty it ?
2 2
38. A man can do a piece of work in 5 days but with the help of (a) 110 hr (b) 112 hr
his son he can do it in 3 days. In what time can the son do it (c) 115 hr (d) 100 hr
alone? 48. A tank is filled in 5 hours by three pipes A, B and C. The
1 pipe C is twice as fast as B and B is twice as fast as A. How
(a) 6 days (b) 7 days much time will pipe A alone take to fill the tank ?
2
(a) 20 hrs (b) 25 hrs
1
(c) 7 (d) 8 days (c) 35 hrs (d) Cannot be determind
2
B- 40 Time & Work
49. 12 buckets of water fill a tank when the capacity of each 54. A alone can complete a work in 12 days and B alone in 48
tank is 13.5 litres. How many buckets will be needed to fill days. Starting with B, they work on alternate days. The
the same tank, if the capacity of each bucket is 9 litres ? total work will be completed in
(a) 8 (b) 15 (a) 18 days (b) 19 days
(c) 16 (d) 18 1
50. A cistern has a leak which would empty it in 8 hours. A tap (c) 19 days (d) Data insufficient
2
is turned on which admits 6 litres a minute into the cistern 55. 4 men can do a piece of work in 10 days, 2 women can do it
and it is now emptied in 12 hours. The cistern can hold in 15 days and 5 children can do it in 12 days. In how many
(a) 7860 litres (b) 6840 litres days can 8 men, 5 women and 15 children together complete
(c) 8640 litres (d) 8840 litres the piece of work?
51. Rekha can do a piece of work in 40 days. Surekha is 25% (a) 2 days (b) 3 days
more efficient than Rekha. The number of days taken by (c) 4 days (d) None of these
Surekha to do the same piece of work is 56. 48 workers can reap a field in 9 days. If the work is to be
(a) 24 days (b) 28 days completed in 6 days, the extra workers required are
(c) 32 days (d) 35 days (a) 36 (b) 32
52. A can do a work in 12 days and B in 15 days. If they work on (c) 24 (d) 22
it together for 6 days, then the fractioh of the work that is 57. 4 men and 6 boys can do a piece of work in 8 days and 6 men
left is and 4 boys can do it in 7 days. If the daily wages of a boy be
` 20, what will be the weekly wages of a man?
1 1 (a) ` 280 (b) ` 275
(a) (b)
4 5 (c) ` 270 (d) ` 265
58. A is thrice as good a workman as B and is therefore able to
1 1
(c) (d) finish a piece of work in 30 days less than B. Find the time in
10 12 which they can do it working together.
53. A alone can complete work in 15 days and B alone in 20 (a) 45 days (b) 11¼ days
days. Starting with A, the work on alternate days. The total (c) 15 days (d) 22½ days
work will be completed in 59. A takes twice as much time as B to do a work. Working
(a) 17 days together the work is completed in 8 days. A can do the work
(b) 16 days alone in
(c) 14 days (a) 24 days (b) 12 days
(d) 13 days (c) 16 days (d) 28 days
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 13 (c) 25 (a) 37 (a) 49 (d)
2 (a) 14 (c) 26 (b) 38 (c) 50 (c)
3 (a) 15 (a) 27 (d) 39 (c) 51 (c)
4 (c) 16 (c) 28 (b) 40 (d) 52 (c)
5 (b) 17 (b) 29 (b) 41 (c) 53 (a)
6 (b) 18 (c) 30 (c) 42 (a) 54 (c)
7 (a) 19 (b) 31 (b) 43 (a) 55 (d)
8 (a) 20 (a) 32 (a) 44 (a) 56 (c)
9 (a) 21 (c) 33 (a) 45 (a) 57 (a)
10 (c) 22 (a) 34 (c) 46 (d) 58 (b)
11 (b) 23 (a) 35 (b) 47 (b) 59 (a)
12 (c) 24 (c) 36 (b) 48 (c)
4. (c) Let C completes the work in x days. 7. (a) Sunil takes 5 days and Pradeep takes 15 days to do the
work.
1
Work done by (A + B) in 1 day = 1 1 4 th
10 In a day they would complete + i.e., work.
5 15 15
1 11
Work done by (B +C) in 1 day = The remaining th work would be completed by
18 15
A’s 5 days’ work + B’s 10 days’ work 11
+ C’s 15 days’ work = 1 Pradeep in ´ 15 i.e. 11 days.
15
or (A + B)’s 5 days’ work + (B + C)’s 5 days’ work
8. (a) Let 1 man’s 1 day’s work = x and
+ C’s 10 days’ work = 1 1 boy’s 1 day’s work = y.
5 5 10 1 1
or + + =1 Then, 6x + 8y = and 26x + 48y = .
10 18 x 10 2
\ x = 45 days Solving these two equations, we get :
5. (b) In one min, (A + B) fill the cistern 1 1
x= and y = .
1 1 1 100 200
= + = th
10 15 6 \ (15 men + 20 boys)’s 1 day’s work
In 3 mins, (A + B) fill the cistern æ 15 20 ö 1
=ç + ÷= .
= 3 = 1 th è 100 200 ø 4
6 2 \ 15 men and 20 boys can do the work in 4 days.
1 1 1
Remaining part = 1 - = 9. (a) 1 man’s 1 day’s work = .
2 2 108
1 æ1 ö 2
12 men’s 6 day’s work = ç ´ 6 ÷ = .
Q th part is filled by A in one min. è9 ø 3
10
1 1 æ 2ö 1
\ nd part is filled by A in 10 ´ = 5 min . Remaining work = ç 1 - ÷ = .
2 2 è 3ø 3
\ Total time = 3 + 5 = 8 min. æ 1 ö 1
18 men’s 1 day’s work = ç ´18 ÷ = .
1 è 108 ø 6
6. (b) A's one day's work =
32 1
work is done by them in 1 day..
1 6
B's one day's work =
20 1
\ work is done by them in 6 ´ 1 = 2 days
1 3 3
(B + C)'s one day's work =
12
æ 1 1ö 9 3
10. (c) (A + B)'s 1 hour's work = ç + ÷ = =
1 1 1 è 12 15 ø 60 20
\ C's one day's work = - =
12 20 30
æ 1 1 ö 8 2
1 (A + C)'s 1 hour's work = ç + ÷ = =
D's one day's work = è 12 20 ø 60 15
24
\ (A + B + C + D)'s one day's work æ 3 2 ö 17
Part filled in 2 hrs = ç + ÷ =
1 1 1 1 15 + 24 + 16 + 20 è 20 15 ø 60
= + + + =
32 20 30 24 480 æ 17 ö 17
Part filled in 6 hrs = ç 3 ´ ÷ =
5 è 60 ø 20
==
32
5 æ 17 ö 3
\ Out of of work done, Remaining part = ç 1 - ÷ =
32 è 20 ø 20
1 3
of the work is done by C. Now, it is the turn of A and B and part is filled by
30 20
Þ Out of Rs. 25 paid for the work, C will receive A and B in 1 hour.
1/ 30 1 32 \ Total time taken to fill the tank
` ´ 25, i.e. ´ ´ 25 i.e. ` 16
5 / 32 30 5 3 = (6 + 1) hrs = 7 hrs.
B- 42 Time & Work
11. (b) Days Men 18. (c) Let C completes the work in x days.
17 26 1
Work done by (A + B) in 1 day =
13 x 10
where x is the number of men required to complete the 1
work in 13 days Work done by (B +C) in 1 day =
18
Þ 13 : 17 = 26 : x
Þ 13 x = 17 × 26 A’s 5 days’ work + B’s 10 days’ work
+ C’s 15 days’ work = 1
17 ´ 26 or (A + B)’s 5 days’ work + (B + C)’s 5 days’ work
Þ x= = 34 Men
13 + C’s 10 days’ work = 1
\ Number of additional men = 34 – 26 = 8
5 5 10
12. (c) Ratio of work efficiency of A, B and C or + + =1
=1:2:4 10 18 x
Ratio of time taken to finish the work \ x = 45 days
=8:4:2=4:2:1 19. (b) Ratio of times taken by A and B
Time taken to finish the work by B alone = 100 : 130 = 10 : 13.
= 7 × 2 = 14 days Suppose B takes x days to do the work.
Time taken to finish the work by A alone Then, 10 : 13 : : 23 : x
= 7 × 4 = 28 days
\ work done in 1 day by A, B and C æ 23 ´ 13 ö 299
Þx =ç ÷ Þx= .
è 10 ø 10
1 1 1
= + + = 1+ 2 + 4 A’s 1 day’s work
28 14 7 28
1 10
7 1 = ; B’s 1 day's work = .
= = 23 299
28 4
æ 1 10 ö 23 1
So time taken to complete the work by A, B and C (A + B)’s 1 day’s work = ç + ÷ = 299 = 13 .
è 23 299 ø
together = 4 days.
13. (c) Q 16 men can complete the work in 8 days. \ A and B together can complete the job in 13 days.
\ 1 man can complete the work in 8 × 16 20. (a) Sunil takes 5 days and Pradeep takes 15 days to do the
\ 12 men can complete the same work in work.
1 1 4 th
16 ´ 8 32 2 In a day they would complete + i.e., work.
= = 10 days. 5 15 15
12 3 3 11
The remaining th work would be completed by
12 ´ 8 15
14. (c) Number of days = = 24 days 11
12 - 8 Pradeep in ´ 15 i.e. 11 days.
15
15. (a) 12 men can complete the whole work in
21. (c) Let the required time to fill the tank be x hours
8 × 3 = 24 days
According to question
12 ´ 24
\ Required no. of days = = 18 1 æ3 ö 1 æ 3 ö 1 æ 3 ö
16 ç x÷ + ç x - x÷ø + çè x - x÷ø = 1
12 è 4 ø 15 è 4 12 4
1
16. (c) Part processed by computer A in 1 minute = x x x
3 Þ + + =1
16 60 48
1 \ x = 10 hours.
Part processed by computer B in 1 minute = 22. (a) Let 1 man’s 1 day’s work = x and
5
Part processed by computer C in 1 minute 1 boy’s 1 day’s work = y.
1 1
42 1 1 Then, 6x + 8y = and 26x + 48y = .
= - - 10 2
60 3 5
Solving these two equations, we get :
42 - 20 - 12 10 1 1 1
= = = x= and y = .
60 60 6 100 200
Hence, computer C will process 1 input in 6 minutes. \ (15 men + 20 boys)’s 1 day’s work
800 ´ 21 ´ 15 æ 15 20 ö 1
17. (b) Required no. of binders = =9 =ç + ÷= .
1400 ´ 20 è 100 200 ø 4
\ 15 men and 20 boys can do the work in 4 days.
Time & Work B- 43
æ 1 ö 1 æ1 ö
18 men’s 1 day’s work = ç ´18 ÷ = . Time taken by B = 14 ç + 1÷ = 21 days
è 108 ø 6 è2 ø
3
1 27. (d) Q A can do of the work in 12 days
work is done by them in 1 day.. 4
6 1 4 1
\ A can do of the work in 12 ´ ´ days = 2 days
1 1 8 3 8
\ work is done by them in 6 ´ = 2 days
3 3 28. (b) Let the man alone do the work in x days.
Then, the woman alone do the work in 2x days.
OR 1
12 men complete the remaining work in = 3 days Their one day’s work = th part of whole work
8
1 man in = 12 ´ 3 days 1 1 1
i.e. + =
12 ´ 3 x 2x 8
(12 + 6) men in = = 2 days Þ x = 12 days
18
\ man takes 12 days and woman 2x = 24 days.
æ 1 1ö 9 3 29. (b) m1 ´ d1 ´ t1 ´ w 2 = m 2 ´ d 2 ´ t 2 ´ w1
24. (c) (A + B)'s 1 hour's work = ç + ÷ = =
è 12 15 ø 60 20 24 × 10 × 8 × 1 = m2 × 6 × 10 × 1
æ 1 1 ö 8 2 24 ´ 10 ´ 8
(A + C)'s 1 hour's work = ç + ÷ = = Þ m2 = = 32 men
è 12 20 ø 60 15 6 ´ 10
æ 3 2 ö 17 æ1 1ö 5
Part filled in 2 hrs = ç + ÷ = 30. (c) 1 minute’s work of both the punctures = ç + ÷ = .
è 20 15 ø 60 è 9 6 ø 18
So, both the punctures will make the tyre flat in
æ 17 ö 17 18 3
Part filled in 6 hrs = ç 3 ´ ÷ = = 3 min.
è 60 ø 20 5 5
æ 17 ö 3 1 1
Remaining part = ç 1 - ÷ = 31. (b) Man’s two day’s work = 2 ´ th work = th work
20 10
è 20 ø 20 Woman’s two days’s work
3 1 1
Now, it is the turn of A and B and part is filled by = 2 ´ th work = th work
20 30 15
A and B in 1 hour. 1 1
Boy’s two day’s work = 2 ´ th work = th work
\ Total time taken to fill the tank 60 30
= (6 + 1) hrs = 7 hrs. Now, let 2 men, 8 women and x boys can complete
work in 2 days. Then ,
æ 1 1 ö 7
25. (a) Part filled in 7 min. = 7 × ç + ÷ = 2 men’s work +8 women’s work + x boy’s work =1
è 36 45 ø 20
æ 1ö æ1ö æ 1 ö
2ç ÷ + 8ç ÷ + x ç ÷ =1
æ 7 ö 13 è 10 ø è 15 ø è 30 ø
Remaining part = ç1 - ÷ =
è 20 ø 20 æ 1 8ö
Þ x = ç1 - - ÷ ´ 30 Þ x = 8 boys
Part filled by (A + B + C) in 1 min. è 5 15 ø
32. (a) 15 W = 10 M
æ 1 1 1 ö 1
=ç + - ÷= . 4 ´ 15
è 36 45 30 ø 60 Now, 5W + 4M = 5W + W = 5W + 6W = 11 W
10
1 part fill in 60 min. If 15 women can complete the project in 55 days,
11 women can complete the same project in
13 13
part fill in = 60 ´ = 39 min. 55 ´15
20 20 = 75 days
11
B- 44 Time & Work
æ 1 1ö 5 So, 2 men and 1 boy together can finish the work in
33. (a) Work done by A and B in 5 days = ç + ÷ ´ 5 =
è 10 15 ø 6 1
12 days.
5 1 2
Work remaining = 1 - =
6 6 æ1 1ö 2
\ C alone can do the work in 6 × 2 = 12 days 38. (c) Son’s 1 day’s work = ç - ÷ =
è 3 5 ø 15
5 5 2 \ Son alone complete the work in
Ratio of their share work = : : = 3 : 2 :1
10 15 12 15 1
Share of wages = ` 225, ` 150, ` 75. = = 7 days
2 2
1 æ1 1 1 ö 1
34. (c) In 8 days, Anil does = rd work . 39. (c) Part filled by (A + B + C) in 1 hour = ç + + ÷ = .
3 è 5 10 30 ø 3
1 \ All the three pipes together will fill the tank in
\ in 1 day, he does = th work. 3 hours.
24
1
1 1 40. (d) Part filled by first tap in one min = th
\ Rakesh’s one day’s work = 60% of = th work . 12
24 40
1
Part filled by second tap in one min = th
1 2 18
Remaining work = 1 - =
3 3
Now, 2 éê + ùú + unfilled part = 1
1 1
(Anil and Rakesh)’s one day’s work ë12 18 û
1 1 1 13
= + = th work Þ unfilled part = th
24 40 15 18
Now,
1
th work is done by them in one day.. Q 1 th part of tank is filled by second tap in 1min.
15 18
\
2 2
rd work is done by them in 15 ´ = 10 days \ 13 th part of tank is filled by second tap in 1 min.
3 3 18
1 13
35. (b) X’s one day’s work = th work . = 18 ´ min = 13 min.
15 18
1 1 1 41. (c) Let B can fill the cistern in x min. Then,
Y’s one day’s work = + 50% of = th work
15 15 10 x
then A can fill the cistern in min
1 1 1 3
\ (X + Y)’s one day’s work = + = th work
15 10 6
Given x - x = 10 Þ x = 15 min
Hence, they together finish the work in 6 days. 3
36. (b) Given 12 men º 15 women º 18 boys 42. (a) Let cistern will be full in x min. Then,
\ 1 Man º 1.5 boys, 1 woman = 6/5 boys. part filled by A in x min + part filled by B in (x – 1) min
Now, 5W + 6B = 12B. + part filled by C in (x – 2)min = 1
Required answer is calculated as follows :
Total no. of boys reqd. = 18 × [(15/16) × (8/9)] x x -1 x - 2
Þ + + =1
= 15 boys 3 4 6
The number of boys already present = 12. 19 1
Hence, 3 boys more required. Þ 9x = 19 Þ x = = 2 min
9 9
But 3 boys = 2 men.
43. (a) Radius of the pipe (r) = 4 cm = 0.04 meter
So, 2 men are required.
Volume of water flowing out per sec
37. (a) Let 1 man’s 1 days’ work= x & 1 boy’s 1 day’s work = y
= pr2 × rate of flow
1 1
Then, 2x + 3y = and 3x + 2y = 22
10 8 = ´ 0.042 ´ 3 cu meters = 0.0151 cubic m
7
7 1
Solving, we get : x = and y =
200 100 8
Time taken to fill the tank = 40 × 30 × sec
\ (2 men + 1 boy)’s 1 day’s work 0.0151
æ 7 1 ö 16 2 40 ´ 30 ´ 8 1
= çè 2 ´ + 1´ ÷= = = ´ hours = 176.6 hours
200 100 ø 200 25 0.01 3600
Time & Work B- 45
44. (a) M1 = 40, D1 = 8 (As days and hrs both denote time) 1
W1 = 60 (cutting of trees is taken as work) 50. (c) In 1 hour, empty part = th.
8
M2 = 40 – 8 = 32, D2 = 12, W2 = ? When tap is turned on, then
Putting the values in the formula 1
M1 D1 W2 = M2 D2 W1 empty part in 1 hour = th .
12
We have , 40 × 8 × W2 = 32 × 12 × 60 \ Part of cistern emptied, due to leakage in
32 ´ 12 ´ 60 1 1 3- 2 1
or, W2 = = 72 trees. 1 hour = - = = th
40 ´ 8 8 12 24 24
45. (a) 1 horse = 2 cows, 10 horses = 20 cows. Now, In 1 min, cistern fill = 6 lit
Þ 10 horses + 15 cows = 20 + 15 = 35 cows. 1
\ In hr, cistern fill = 6 lit.
15 horses + 10 cows = 40 cows. Now 35 cows eat 5 60
acres. \ Cistern can hold = 6 × 60 × 24 litre = 8640 litre.
51. (c) Ratio of efficiency of Rekha and Surekha
40 40 = 100 : 125 = 4 : 5
Þ 40 cows eat 5 × = acres.
35 7 Hence, ratio of time taken to do a work by Rekha and
Here we have converted everything in terms of cows, Surekha = 5 : 4
you can work in terms of horses also. So, if Rekha can do a work in 40 days, Surekha will do
the same work in 32 days.
46. (d) Let the time be t hours after 6 am.
1 1
1 (t - 1) (t - 2) (t - 3) 52. (c) A’s 1 day’s work = , B’s 1 day’s work =
\ ´t+ + + =1 12 15
15 20 30 60 æ 1 1 ö 3 9
\ 4t + 3 (t – 1) + 2 (t – 2) + (t – 3) = 60 (A + B)’s 6 day’s work = 6 ç + ÷ = 6 ´ =
è 12 15 ø 20 10
\ t = 7 hours \ It is filled at 1 pm æ 9 ö 1
47. (b) Cistern filled by both pipes in one hour Work left = ç1 – ÷ =
è 10 ø 10
1 1 15 1 1 7
= + = th 53. (a) (A + B)’s 2 day’s work = + =
14 16 112 15 20 60
æ 7 ö 14
112 Work done in 8 pairs of days = ç ´ 8 ÷ =
\ Both pipes filled the cistern in hrs . è 60 ø 15
15
Now, due to leakage both pipes filled the cistern in æ 14 ö 1
Remaining work = ç 1 – ÷ =
è 15 ø 15
112 32
+ = 8 hrs. 1
15 60 \ Work done by A on 17th day =
15
1 \ Total time taken = 17 days
\ Due to leakage, filled part in one hour =
8 æ1 1 ö 5
54. (c) (A + B)’s 2 day’s work = ç + ÷ =
\ part of cistern emptied, due to leakage in one hour è 12 48 ø 48
15 1 1 æ 5 ö 15
= - = th Work done in 9 pairs of days = ç ´ 9 ÷ =
112 8 112 è 48 ø 16
\ In 112hr, the leakage would empty the cistern. æ 15 ö 1
Remaining work = ç 1 – ÷ =
48. (c) Suppose pipe A alone takes x hours to fill the tank. è 16 ø 16
x x æ1 1 ö 1
Then, pipes B and C will take and hours Remaining work = ç – ÷ =
è 16 48 ø 24
2 4
respectively to fill the tank. 1
Work done by B on 19th day =
48
1 2 4 1 7 1
\ + + = Þ = Þ x = 35 hrs. 1
x x x 5 x 5 Now, work is done by A in 1 day..
12
49. (d) Capacity of the tank = (12 × 13.5) litres = 162 litres.
1 æ 1 ö 1
Capacity of each bucket = 9 litres. work is doen by A in ç 12 ´ ÷ day = day
24 è 24 ø 2
æ 162 ö 1
Number of buckets needed = ç ÷ = 18. \ Total time taken = 19 days
è 9 ø 2
B- 46 Time & Work
1 Wages of a man = 2 × 20 = ` 40
55. (d) 4 men’s 1 day’s work = or ` 40 × 7 ie, ` 280 per week.
10
58. (b) Ratio of work done by A and B in the same time = 3 : 1
1
1 man’s 1 day’s work = Ratio of time taken by A and B = 1 : 3
40
Suppose B takes x days to finish a work. Then, A takes
1 (x – 30) days to finsh it.
2 women’s 1 day’s work =
15
x – 30 1
1 \ =
1 woman’s 1 day’s work = x 3
30
Þ 3x – 90 = x
1 Þ x = 45 days
5 children’s 1 day’s work =
12 Thus, A and B can finish the work in 15 days and 45
days respectively.
1
1 child’s 1 day’s work =
60 1 1 4
Now, (A + B)’s 1 day’s work = + =
Now, (8 men + 5 women + 15 children)’s 1 day’s work 15 45 45
8 5 15 1 1 1 37 So, both together can finish the work in
= + + = + + =
40 30 60 5 6 4 60 45 1
days = 11 days
60 4 4
So, they can finish the work in days.
37 59. (a) Ratio of times of A and B = 2 : 1
56. (c) In 9 days work complete by = 48 workers Þ Ratio of work done by A and B = 1 :2
In 1 day work complete by = 48 ´ 9 1
(A + B)’s 1 day’s work =
48 ´ 9 8
In 6 days work complete by = =72 workers
6
1
\ The extra workers required = 72 – 48 = 24 workers. Divide in the ratio 1 : 2
8
57. (a) 4 M + 6 B = 8 days Þ 32 M + 48 B = 1 day
Also, 6M + 4B = 7 days æ1 1ö 1
\ A’s 1 day’s work = ç ´ ÷ =
Þ 42 M + 28 B = 1 day è 8 3 ø 24
Þ 32 M + 48 B = 42 M + 28 B Hence, A alone can finish the work in 24 days.
Þ 10 M = 20 B
Þ 1M=2B
CHAPTER
9 Interest
S.I. éæ R ö æ R öù
2
æ tp ö
(ii) C.I. – S.I. = 3 ç 100 ÷ + 3 ç 100 ÷ ú
ê
r
æ r ö ç q ÷
A = P ç1 + ÷ ç1 + êëè ø è ø úû
è 100 ø ç 100 ÷÷
è ø
EXERCISE
1. On what sum of money lent out at 9% per annum simple 3. On retirement, a person gets 1.53 lakhs of his provident
interest for 6 years does the simple interest amount to fund which he invests in a scheme at 20% p.a. His monthly
` 810? income from this scheme will be
(a) ` 900 (b) ` 1000 (a) ` 2, 450 (b) ` 2,500
(c) ` 1200 (d) ` 1500 (c) ` 2, 550 (d) ` 2, 600
1 1 4. A father left a will of ` 68,000 to be divided between his two
2. Out of a certain sum, rd is invested at 3%, th at 6% and sons aged 10 years and 12 years such that they may get
3 6
equal amount when each attains the age of 18 years If the
the rest at 8%. If the simple interest for 2 years from all these money is reckoned at 10% p.a., find how much each gets at
investments amounts to ` 600, find the original sum. the time of the will.
(a) ` 4000 (b) ` 5000 (a) ` 30,000, ` 38,000 (b) ` 28,000, ` 40,000
(c) ` 6000 (d) ` 7000 (c) ` 32,000, ` 36,000 (d) Cannot be determined.
B- 48 Interest
5. The price of a T.V. set worth ` 20,000 is to paid in 20 16. If the difference between S.I and C.I for 2 years on a sum of
instalments of ` 1000 each. If the rate of interest be 6% per money lent at 5% is ` 6, then the sum B.
annum, and the first instalment be paid at the time of (a) ` 2200 (b) ` 2400
purchase, then the value of the last instalment covering the (c) ` 2600 (d) ` 2000
interest as well will be : 17. What will ` 1000 be worth after three years if it earns interest
(a) ` 1050 (b) ` 2050 at the rate of 5% compounded annually ?
(c) ` 3000 (d) None of these (a) ` 1075 (b) ` 1257
6. What sum of money lent out at compound interest will (c) ` 1157 (d) ` 1300
amount to ` 968 in 2 years at 10% p.a., interest being charged 18. A sum of money placed at compound interest doubles itself
annually? in 5 years Find in how many years it will become 8 times.
(a) ` 600 (b) ` 700 (a) 15 years (b) 20 years
(c) ` 800 (d) ` 900
(c) 25 years (d) 30 years
7. If the difference between S.I and C.I for 2 years on a sum of
19. The C.I. on a certain sum of money for the 4th year at 8%
money lent at 5% is ` 6, then the sum B.
p.a. is ` 486. What was the compound interest for the third
(a) ` 2200 (b) ` 2400
year on the same sum at the same rate?
(c) ` 2600 (d) ` 2000
(a) ` 450 (b) ` 475
8. A sum of money placed at compound interest doubles itself
in 5 years Find in how many years it will become 8 times. (c) ` 456 (d) None of these
(a) 15 years (b) 20 years 20. The difference between compound interest and simple
(c) 25 years (d) 30 years interest on a certain sum of money in 3 years at the rate of
9. What annual instalment will discharge a debt of ` 4,200 due 7% per annum is ` 225.645. What is the principal?
in 5 years at 10% simple interest? (a) ` 10]000 (b) ` 15]000
(a) ` 500 per year (b) ` 600 per year (c) ` 17]000 (d) ` 20]000
(c) ` 700 per year (d) ` 800 per year 21. The simple interest accrued on an amount of ` 19,800 at the
10. A lent ` 5000 to B for 2 years and ` 3000 to C for 4 years on end of three years is ` 7,128. What would be the compound
simple interest at the same rate of interest and received interest accrued on the same amount at the same rate in the
` 2200 in all from both of them as interest. The rate of interest same period?
per annum is: (a) ` 8934.6784 (b) ` 8017.5744
(a) 5% (b) 7%
(c) ` 7861.8754 (d) Cannot be determined
1
(c) 7 % (d) 10% 22. What is the interest received on a principal of ` 450 for 2
8 yea if the interest received on ` 1 after four year at the same
11. The difference between the simple interest received from rate of simple interest is ` 0.40?
two different sources on ` 1500 for 3 years is ` 13.50. The
(a) ` 90 (b) ` 180
difference between their rates of interest is:
(a) 0.1% (b) 0.2% (c) ` 36 (d) Cannot be determined
(c) 0.3% (d) 0.4% 23. Mr. Deepak invested an amount of ` 21,250 for 6 years. At
12. An amount of ` 1,00,000 is invested in two types of shares. what rate of simple interest will he obtain the total amount
The first yields an interest of 9% p.a. and the second, 11% of ` 26,350 at the end of 6 years?
3 (a) 4 % p.a (b) 5 % p.a
p.a. If the total interest at the end of one year is 9 % , then
4 (c) 8 % p.a (d) 12 % p.a
the amount invested in each share was: 24. Sudhanshu invested ` 15,000 at interest @ 10% p.a for one
(a) ` 52,500; ` 47,500 (b) ` 62, 500; ` 37,500 year. If the interest is compounded every six months what
(c) ` 72,500: ` 27,500 (d) ` 82, 500; ` 17,500 amount will Sudhanshu get at the end of the year?
13. A person invested in all ` 2600 at 4%, 6% and 8% per annum
(a) ` 16,537.50 (b) ` 16,5000
simple interest. At the end of the year, he got the same
interest in all the three cases. The money invested at 4% is: (c) ` 16,525.50 (d) ` 18,150
(a) ` 200 (b) ` 600 25- The simple interest accrued on an amount of ` 84,000 at the
(c) ` 800 (d) ` 1200 end of three year is ` 30,240. What would be the compound
14. If Re. 1 produces ` 9 in 60 years at simple interest, the rate interest accrued on the same amount at the same rate in the
% p.a. is same period?
1 (a) ` 30]013-95 (b) ` 31]013-95
(a) 13 % (b) 14%
3 (c) ` 34]013-95 (d) ` 33]013-95
1
(c) 15% (d) 12 % 26. The simple interest accrued on a sum of certain principal is
2
15. What sum of money lent out at compound interest will ` 1,200 in four year at the rate of 8% p.a. What would be the
simple interest accrued on thrice of that principal at the rate
amount to ` 968 in 2 years at 10% p.a., interest being charged
of 6% p.a in 3 year ?
annually?
(a) ` 600 (b) ` 700 (a) ` 2,025 (b) ` 3,025
(c) ` 800 (d) ` 900 (c) ` 2,250 (d) ` 2,150
Interest B- 49
AN SWER KEY
1 (d) 7 (b) 13 (d) 19 (a ) 25 (c )
2 (b) 8 (a ) 14 (a ) 20 (b) 26 (a )
3 (b) 9 (c) 15 (c) 21 (b)
4 (c) 10 (d) 16 (b) 22 (a )
5 (d) 11 (c) 17 (c) 23 (a )
6 (c) 12 (b) 18 (a ) 24 (a )
10 Mensuration
a c
h 1
Triangle a + b + c = 2s 1. .b.h b = base, h = height
2
C A
b
p h
1
Right angled b+ h +p bh p = b2 + h2
2
triangle
b
a a
1
Equilateral 3a 1. ah a = side
2
triangle
a
3 2 3
2. a h = altitude = a
4 2
b
Rectangle 2(a + b) ab a = Length
a
b = Breadth
a
Square 4a a2 a = side
a
B- 52 Mensuration
a h a
Parallelogram 2(a + b) bh a, b = sides
b h = height
d1
a 1
Rhombus d2 4a d1d 2 a = side
2
d1, d2 are diagonals
p q
h1
d
1
Quadrilateral h2 sum of four sides (AC) (h1 + h2) AC = diagonal
s r 2
h1, h2 are altitude on AC
d = diameter
1 2
Semicircle pr + 2r pr r = radius
2
r
O
q r
pr 2 1
Sector of a circle l + 2r or lr l = length of arc
360 2
A B
l Segment
prd
or + 2r q = angle of the sector
180
R2
Ring R1 ...................... p (R22 – R12) R2 = Outer radius
R1 = Inner radius
Mensuration B- 53
a
Cube 4a2 6a2 a3 a = Edge
a
a
h
Cuboid 2(l + b) h 2(lb + bh + hl) lbh l = Length
l b
b = Breadth
h = Height
1
Pyramid (Perimeter of base) × (Area of base) + (Area of base)
3
(slant height) Lateral surface × height
area
h
Right circular 2prh 2pr(h + r) pr 2 h r = Radius
cylinder r
h = Height
l
h 1 2
Cone prl pr(l + r) pr h h = Height
3
r
R = Radius
B- 54 Mensuration
Name Figure Lateral Curved Total surface Volume Nomenclature
Surface Area Area
4 3
Sphere — 4pr2 pr r = Radius
3
r
æ 2ö 3
Hemisphere r 2pr2 3pr2 ç ÷ pr r = Radius
è 3ø
r1
h
1
l = h 2 + ( r1 - r2 )
2
Frustum pl (r 1 + r2) pl (r 1 + r2) + ph (r12 + r22
3
r2 pr12 + pr22 + r1r2)
EXERCISE
1. The length and breadth of a rectangle are in the ratio 9 : 5. If (c) 150 m2 (d) None of these
its area is 720 m2, find its perimeter. 6. From a square piece of a paper having each side equal to 10
(a) 112 metre (b) 115 metre cm, the largest possible circle is being cut out. The ratio of
(c) 110 metre (d) 118 metre the area of the circle to the area of the original square is
2. How many squares are there in a 5 inch by 5 inch square nearly :
grid, if the grid is made up one inch by one inch squares ? 4 3
(a) (b)
(a) 50 (b) 150 5 5
(c) 55 (d) 25 5 6
(c) (d)
3. A circle and a rectangle have the same perimeter. The sides 6 7
of the rectangle are 18 cm and 26 cm. What is the area of the 7. If the area of a circle decreases by 36%, then the radius of a
circle ? circle decreases by
(a) 88 cm2 (b) 154 cm2 (a) 20% (b) 18%
(c) 1250 cm 2 (d) 616 cm2 (c) 36% (d) 64%
4. When the circumference and area of a circle are numerically 8. A typist uses a paper 12" by 5" length wise and leaves a
equal, then the diameter is numerically equal to margin of 1" at the top and the bottom and a margin of ½"on
(a) area (b) circumference either side. What fractional part of the paper is available to
(c) 4 (d) 2 p him for typing ?
5. A horse is tethered to one corner of a rectangular grassy 2 1
field 40 m by 24 m with a rope 14 m long. Over how much (a) (b)
3 2
area of the field can it graze?
1 5
(a) 154 cm2 (b) 308 m2 (c) (d)
3 7
Mensuration B- 55
9. A rectangular lawn 70 m × 30 m has two roads each 5 metres 18. A wire can be bent in the form of a circle of radius 56 cm. If
wide, running in the middle of it, one parallel to the length it is bent in the form of a square, then its area will be:
and the other parallel to the breadth. Find the cost of (a) 3520 cm2 (b) 6400 cm2
gravelling the road at the rate of ` 4 per square metre.
(c) 7744 cm2 (d) 8800 cm2
(a) ` 2,000 (b) ` 1,800
(c) ` 1,900 (d) ` 1,700 19. A metal cube of edge 12 cm is melted and formed into three
smaller cubes. If the edges of two smaller cubes are 6 cm
10. A cylindrical bucket of height 36 cm and radius 21 cm is
and 8 cm, then find the edge of the third smaller cube.
filled with sand. The bucket is emptied on the ground and a
conical heap of sand is formed, the height of the heap being (a) 10 cm (b) 14 cm
12 cm. The radius of the heap at the base is : (c) 12 cm (d) 16 cm
(a) 63 cm (b) 53 cm 20. A copper sphere of radius 3 cm is beaten and drawn into a
(c) 56 cm (d) 66 cm wire of diametre 0.2 cm. The length of the wire is
11. The area of a square field is 576 km2. How long will it take (a) 9 m (b) 12 m
for a horse to run around at the speed of 12 km/h ?
(c) 18 m (d) 36 m
(a) 12 h (b) 10 h
21. The length, breadth and height of a cuboid are in the ratio
(c) 8 h (d) 6 h
1 : 2 : 3. The length, breadth and height of the cuboid are
12. A rectangular parking space is marked out by painting three increased by 100%, 200% and 200%, respectively. Then,
of its sides. If the length of the unpainted side is 9 feet, and the increase in the volume of the cuboid will be :
the sum of the lengths of the painted sides is 37 feet, then
(a) 5 times (b) 6 times
what is the area of the parking space in square feet?
(c) 12 times (d) 17 times
(a) 46 (b) 81
22. The surface area of a cube is 150 m2. The length of its
(c) 126 (d) 252
diagonal is
13. A farmer wishes to start a 100 square metres rectangular
vegetable garden. Since he has only 30 m barbed wire, he (a) 5 3m (b) 5 m
fences three sides of the garden letting his house compound
10
wall act as the fourth side fencing. The dimension of the (c) m (d) 15 m
garden is: 3
(a) 15 m × 6.67 m (b) 20 m × 5 m 23. The length of the longest rod that can be placed in a room
(c) 30 m × 3.33 m (d) 40 m × 2.5 m which is 12 m long, 9 m broad and 8 m high is :
14. A rectangular tank measuring 5m × 4.5 m × 2.1 m is dug in (a) 27 m (b) 19 m
the centre of the field measuring 13.5 m × 2.5. The earth dug (c) 17 m (d) 13 m
out is spread evenly over the remaining portion of a field. 24. If the volume of a sphere is divided by its surface area, the
How much is the level of the field raised ? result is 27 cms. The radius of the sphere is
(a) 4.0 m (b) 4.1 m (a) 9 cms (b) 27 cms
(c) 4.2 m (d) 4.3 m (c) 81 cms (d) 243 cms
15. Four equal circles are described about the four corners of a 25. The volume of water measured on a rectangular field 500 m
square so that each touches two of the others. If a side of × 300 m is 3000 m3. Find the depth (amount) of rain that has
the square is 14 cm, then the area enclosed between the fallen.
circumferences of the circles is : (a) 2 cms (b) 3 cms
(a) 24 cm2 (b) 42 cm2 (c) 4 cms (d) 3.5 cms
(c) 154 cm 2 (d) 196 cm2 26. How many spherical bullets can be made out of a lead
16. The ratio between the length and the breadth of a cylinder 28 cm high and with base radius 6 cm, each bullet
rectangular park is 3 : 2. If a man cycling along the boundary being 1.5 cm in diameter?
of the park at the speed of 12km / hr completes one round (a) 1845 (b) 1824
in 8 minutes, then the area of the park (in sq. m) is: (c) 1792 (d) 1752
(a) 15360 (b) 153600 27. Water flows out through a circular pipe whose internal
(c) 30720 (d) 307200 diameter is 2 cm, at the rate of 6 metres per second into a
17. The water in a rectangular reservoir having a base 80 metres cylindrical tank, the radius of whose base is 60 cm. By how
by 60 metres is 6.5 metres deep. In what time can the water much will the level of water rise in 30 minutes?
be emptied by a pipe whose cross section is a square of (a) 2 m (b) 4 m
side 20 cm, if the water runs through the pipe at the rate of (c) 3 m (d) 5 m
15 km per hour? 28. The capacity of a cylindrical tank is 246.4 litres. If the height
(a) 52 hrs (b) 26 hrs is 4 metres, what is the diameter of the base?
(c) 65 hrs (d) 42 hrs (a) 1.4 m (b) 2.8 m
(c) 14 m (d) None of these
B- 56 Mensuration
29. A reservoir is supplied from a pipe 6 cm in diameter. How 30. If the radius of a sphere is increased by 2 cm, then its surface
many pipes of 3 cms diameter would discharge the same area increases by 352 cm2. The radius of the sphere before
quantity, supposing the velocity of water is same ? the increase was:
(a) 4 (b) 5 (a) 3 cm (b) 4 cm
(c) 6 (d) 7 (c) 5 cm (d) 6 cm
ANSW ER KEY
1 (a) 7 (a) 13 (b) 19 (a) 25 (a)
2 (d) 8 (a) 14 (c) 20 (d) 26 (c)
3 (d) 9 (c) 15 (b) 21 (d) 27 (c)
4 (c) 10 (a) 16 (b) 22 (a) 28 (d)
5 (a) 11 (c) 17 (a) 23 (c) 29 (a)
6 (a) 12 (c) 18 (c) 24 (c) 30 (d)
Total area of road Area of the shaded region = Area of the square – area
= Area of road which parallel to length + Area of road of four quadrants of the circles
which parallel to breadth – overlapped road 1
= 70 × 5 + 30 × 5 – 5 × 5 = (14)2 – 4´ p (7)2
4
= 350 + 150 – 25
22
= 500 – 25 = 475 m2 = 196 –´ 49 = 196 – 154 = 42 cm 2
7
\ Cost of gravelling the road
16. (b) Perimeter = Distance covered in 8 min.
= 475 × 4 = ` 1900
10. (a) Volume of the bucket = volume of the sand emptied æ 12000 ö
=ç ´ 8 ÷ m = 1600 m.
Volume of sand = p (21)2 × 36 è 60 ø
Let r be the radius of the conical heap. Let length = 3x metres and breadth = 2x metres.
Then, 2 (3x + 2x) = 1600 or x = 160.
1 2
Then, pr ´ 12 = p(21)2 ´ 36 \ Length = 480 m and Breadth = 320 m.
3
\ Area = (480 × 320) m2 = 153600 m2.
or r2 = (21)2 × 9 or r = 21 × 3 = 63 17. (a) Volume of the water running through pipe per hour
11. (c) Area of field = 576 km2. Then, 20 20
= ´ ´ 15000 = 600 cubic metre
100 100
each side of field = 576 = 24 km
60 ´ 6.5 ´ 80
Distance covered by the horse Required time = = 52 hours
600
= Perimeter of square field
= 24 × 4 = 96 km æ 22 ö
18. (c) Length of wire = 2p´ R = ç 2 ´ ´ 56 ÷ cm = 352 cm.
distance 96 è 7 ø
\ Time taken by horse = = =8h
speed 12 352
Side of the square = cm = 88 cm.
12. (c) Clearly, we have : l = 9 and l + 2b = 37 or b = 14. 4
\ Area = (l × b) = (9 × 14) sq. ft. = 126 sq. ft. Area of the square = (88 × 88) cm2 = 7744 cm2.
19. (a) Let the edge of the third cube be x cm.
13. (b) We have : 2b + l = 30 Þ l = 30 – 2b.
Then, x3 + 63 + 83 = 123
Area = 100 m2 Þ l × b = 100 Þ b(30 – 2b) = 100 Þ x3 + 216 + 512 = 1728
Þ b2 – 15b + 50 = 0 Þ (b – 10) (b – 5) = 0 Þ x3 = 1000 Þ x = 10.
Þ b = 10 or b = 5. Thus the edge of third cube = 10 cm.
20. (d) Let the length of the wire be h cm.
When b = 10, l = 10 and when b = 5, l = 20.
and radius of sphere and wire are R and r respectively.
Since the garden is rectangular, Then, volume of sphere = volume of wire (cylinder)
so its dimension is 20 m × 5 m. 4
14. (c) Area of the field = 13.5 × 2.5 = 33.75 m2 or p R 3 = p r 2h
3
Area covered by the rectangular tank
4 3 2
= 5 × 4.5 = 22.50 m2 or R =r h
3
Area of the field on which the earth dug out is to be
4 3
spread = 33.75 – 22.50 = 11.25 m2 or (3) = (0.1)2 h
3
Let the required height be h.
Then, 11.25 × h = 5 × 4.5 × 2.1 4 ´ (3)3 108
\ h= 2
= = 3600 cm = 36 m
or h = 4.2 m 3 ´ (0.1) 0.03
15. (b)
21. (d) Let the length, breadth and height of the cuboid be
7 7 x, 2x and 3x, respectively.
7 Therefore, volume = x × 2x × 3x = 6x3
7
New length, breadth and height = 2x, 6x and 9x,
7 respectively.
7
New volume = 108x3
Thus, increase in volume = (108 – 6)x3 = 102 x3
11 Data Interpretation
Data Interpretation questions are based on the information given in which the magnitudes are represented by the length or
in the tables and graphs. height of rectangle, whereas width of rectangles are
Classification of Data Interpretation : immaterial. Thus, a bar is just one dimensional as only the
length of the bar is to be considered and not the width. All
the bars drawn in a diagram are generally of uniform width
DI which depends on the number of bars to be constructed
and the availability of the space.
Tables Graphs Types of Bar Graphs are–
(i) Simple Bar Graph : It is used to represent only one
dependent variable.
Bar Graph Line Graph Pie Graph Combined (ii) Sub-divided Bar Graphs : These are used to represent
Graph
the break down of a total into its component bars. A
bar is divided into different segments, each segment
1. BG+ LG
Simple Bar Subdivided 2. BG + PG respresents a given component. Different shades,
Multiple
Graph Bar Bar 3. LG + PG colours, designs etc. are used to distinguish the
Graph Graph etc. various components. An index is given to represent
the various components. To compare, the order of
various components in the different bars is same.
TABLES (iii) Multiple Bar Graph (MBG) : When a combination
A table is one of the easiest way for summarising data. of inter-related variables are to be represented
A statistical table is the logical listing of related quantitative data graphically, multiple bar diagrams are used. These
in vertical columns and horizontal rows of numbers with sufficient are extended form of simple bar diagrams. In M.B.G.
explanatory and qualifying words, phrases and statements in the many aspects of the data are presented
form of titles, heading and notes to make clear the meaning of simultaneously with separated bars or various shades
data. of colours. An index is given to explain the shades or
colours used.
2. Line Graph(LG) : LG are used to show how a quantity
changes, very often the quantity is measured as time
changes. If the line goes up, the quantity is increasing
Sum of all items
Average = and the line goes down, the quantity is decreasing. If the
Total number of items
line is horizontal, the quantity is not changing.
l = The bars are drawn proportional in length to the total
3. Pie Graph(PG) : is a pictorial representation of numerical
and then divided in the ratios of their components.
data by non-intersecting adjacent sectors of a circle sector’s
% change (increase or decrease)
area of each sector is proportional to the magnitude of the
Final value _ Initial value data represented by the sector.
= ´ 100
Initial value
360
1% of total value = = 3.6°
GRAPHS 100
Graphs are a convenient way to represent information. The graphs The % of components parts can be converted to degrees
should be labelled properly to show what part of the graphs by multiplying 3.6°.
shows what a value. Degree of any component part
1. Bar Graph - Bar diagram consists of a number of component value
equidistant rectangles. One for each category of the data = ×360 .
total value
B- 60 Data Interpretation
EXERCISE
Directions (Qs.1-5): Study the following table to answer the 7. If the income of Company A in 2002 was ` 600 crores, what
given questions: was its expenditure?
Percentage of marks obtained by seven (a) ` 360 crores (b) ` 480 crores
students in six subjects (c) ` 375 crores (d) Cannot be determined
Subject Eng His Com MathsScience Econ 8. If the income of Company B in 1998 was ` 200 crores, what
(Max, Marks was its profit in 1999?
¯ Students (100) (100) (100) (100) (100) (100) (a) ` 21.5 crores (b) ` 153 crores
Meera 100 80 50 90 90 60 (c) ` 46.15 crores (d) Cannot be determined
Subodh 80 70 80 100 80 40 9. If the incomes of the two companies in 1998 were equal,
Kunal 90 70 60 90 70 70 what was the ratio of their expenditure?
Soni 60 60 65 80 80 80 (a) 1 : 2 (b) 26 : 27
Richu 50 90 62 80 85 95 (c) 100 : 67 (d) Cannot be determined
Irene 40 60 64 70 65 85 10. What is the per cent increase in per cent profit for CompanyB
Vgay 80 80 35 65 50 75 from years 2000 to 2001?
(a) 75 (b) 175
1. What is the total marks obtained by Meera in all the subject? (c) 42.86 (d) Cannot be determined
(a) 448 (b) 580
(c) 470 (d) 74.67 Directions (Qs. 11-15): Study the following graph carefully and
2. What is the average marks obtained by these seven students answer the questions given below:
in History? (rounded off to two digits) The following graph shows the percentage growth of
(a) 72.86 (b) 27.32 Branded and Assembled PCs
(c) 24.86 (d) 29.14
3. How many students have got 60% or more marks in all the 60
subjects?
(a) One (b) Two 50
(c) Three (d) Four Branded Assembled
4. What is the overall percentage of Kunal ?
40
(a) 64 (b) 65
(c) 75 (d) 64.24
5. In which subject is the overall percentage the best ? 30
(a) Maths (b) Economics
(c) History (d) Science 20
Directions (Qs.6-10): Study the following graph to answer the
given questions. 10
Percent profit earned by two companies over
the given years. 0
Income - Expenditure 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999
%profit = ´100
Expenditure
11. What is the average percentage growth of sales of
Company A Company B Assembled PCs for the given years?
70 (a) 30 (b) 20
60 (c) 40 (d) 35
50 12. If the Branded PCs sold in1996 were 100000, how many
Per cent profit
15. For Assembled PCs sale, which year is the per cent growth 21. If the income of Company X in 1998-99 was equal to the
the highest compared to previous year’? expenditure of Company Y in 2001-2002, what was the ratio
(a) 1999 (b) 1996 of their respective profits?
(c) 1998 (d) Cannot be determined (a) 13 : 15 (b) 6 : 13
Directions (Qs. 16-20): Read the following table and answer the (c) 13 : 26 (d) Cannot be determined
questions. 22. For Company X, its income in 2001-2002 was equal to its
Internet owners in our country (Approximate) expenditure in 2002-2003. What was the ratio of its respective
Year Government Private incomes in these two years?
1995-96 3900 – (a) 4 : 5 (b) 3 : 4
1996-97 29400 – (c) 2 : 3 (d) Cannot be determined
1997-98 90000 – 23. For Company Y, in which year is the per cent of increase in
per cent profit over that of previous year, the highest?
1998-99 230000 12000
(a) 2002-03 (b) 1999-2000
1999-2000 520000 120000
(c) 2001-02 (d) Cannot be determined
2000-2001 1060000 450000
24. In 1997-98, the expenditure of Company X was ` 40 crores.
2001-2002 1550000 950000
What was its income in that year?
16. In which period the percentage increase in the total internet (a) ` 50 crores (b) ` 48 crores
owners is least to that over the earlier period? (c) ` 46 crores (d) Cannot be determined
(a) 1997-98 (b) 1998-99 25. What was the difference in the expenditures of the two
(c) 1999-2000 (d) 2001-02 companies in 1999-2000?
17. What is the total number of fresh internet owners in the (a) 10 (b) 100
period 2001-02?
(c) 1000 (d) Cannot be determined
(a) 54900 (b) 549000
26. In 2002-03 the income of Company Y was ` 128 crores. What
(c) 990000 (d) 99000
was its expenditure in that year?
18. What is the proportion of Government internet owners to
the Private internet owners in the period 1999-2000? (a) ` 80 crores (b) ` 64 crores
(a) 13 : 4 (b) 13 : 3 (c) ` 48 crores (d) Cannot be determined
(c) 3 : 13 (d) 4 : 13 Directions (Qs.27-32): Study the following table to answer the
19. What is the approximate percentage increase in the Private given questions:
internet owners in the period 2001-02 over that in the period Production (in crore units) of six
1998-99? companies over the year
(a) 5000 (b) 6000 Company Years Total
(c) 8000 (d) 4000 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002
20. What is the approximate percentage of Private internet TP 103 150 105 107 110 132 707
owners in the total internet owners in 1998-99? ZIR 75 80 83 86 90 91 505
(a) 20 (b) 5 AVC 300 300 300 360 370 340 1970
(c) 10 (d) 15 CTU 275 280 281 280 285 287 1688
Directions (Qs.21-26): Study the following graph to answer the PEN 25 30 35 40 42 45 217
given questions.
SIO 85 87 89 91 92 96 540
Percent profit earned by two companies
Total 863 927 893 964 989 991 5627
over the given years
27. The production of Company AVC in 2000 is approximately
Income - Expenditure what per cent of its average production over the given years?
% Profit = ´ 100
Expenditure (a) 300 (b) 110 (c) 136 (d) 18.25
28. For SIO, which year was the per cent increase or decrease
Company X Company Y in production from the previous year, the highest?
(a) 2001 (b) 1998
(c) 2002 (d) 2000
29. Which company has less average production in the last
three years compared to that of first three years?
Per cent Profit
Directions (Qs. 47-51): Study the following table carefully and 52. For Company A, what is the per cent decrease in production
answer the questions given below: from 1994 to 1995?
Number of students studying in different faculties in seven (a) 75 (b) 50
institutions
(c) 25 (d) 10
Faculty 53. In 2001, the production of Company B is approximately
Instit- Arts C om- Science Engine- Mana-
what per cent of that in 2000?
ution merce ering gement
(a) 60 (b) 157
A 125 187 216 98 74
B 96 152 198 157 147
(c) 192 (d) 50
C 144 235 110 164 127 54. For Company A, in which year is the percentage increase/
D 165 138 245 66 36 decrease in the production from the previous year the
E 215 196 287 86 66 highest?
F 184 212 195 112 97 (a) 2001 (b) 1995
G 255 206 182 138 89 (c) 1999 (d) 1996
55. What is the difference in the total production of the two
47. What is the percentage of students studying science in the companies for the given years?
institue G with respect to the total number of students (a) 2700000 (b) 3100000
studying in the institute G?
(c) 270000 (d) 310000
(a) 17.20 (b) 12.70
56. Which of the following is the closest average production
1 2 (in lakh units) of Company B for the given years?
(c) 21(d) 21
3 3 (a) 4.1 (b) 3.9
48. Out of the total students of the institute ‘D’, approximately (c) 4.3 (d) 3.75
what percentage of students study Management?
(a) 6 (b) 8 Directions (Qs. 57-61): Study the following table to answer the
(c) 12 (d) 10 given questions.
49. The total number of students studying Arts in institutes A, Centrewise and Postwise number of candidates
B and C together is approximately what per cent of the total
number of students studying commerce in institutes D, E, F Post?
and G together? Field Specialist
Specialist Officer Clerk Supervis or
(a) 50 (b) 45 Officer officer
Centre ?
(c) 42 (d) 55 Bangalore 2000 5000 50 2050 750
50. What is the percentage of students studying Engineering
Delhi 15000 17000 160 11000 750
in institute C with respect to the total students of all
institutions studying Engineering? (rounded to the nearest Mumbai 17000 19500 70 7000 900
integer) Hyderabad 3500 20000 300 9000 1150
(a) 19 (b) 20 Kolkata 14900 17650 70 1300 1200
(c) 18 (d) 21 Lucknow 11360 15300 30 1500 650
51. In which institution, the percentage of students studying Chennai 9000 11000 95 1650 500
Commerce with respect to the total students of the institution
is maximum?
(a) F (b) E 57. In Kolkata, number of Specialist Officers is approximately
(c) C (d) A what per cent of Officers?
Directions (Qs. 52-56) : Study the following graph to answer the (a) 8.7 (b) 9
given questions. (c) 6.5 (d) 8
Production of two companies A & B over the years 58. What is the difference between total number of Officers
(Production in lakh units)
and Clerks?
14
13 (a) 29680 (b) 34180
Production in lakh units
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
76. What is the ratio between the number of boys who have 84. What is the angle of the pie chart showing the expenditure
opted for only Hindi and the number of girls who have incurred on royalty ?
opted for the composite subject respectively? (a) 15° (b) 24°
(a) 15 : 16 (b) 10 : 7 (c) 48° (d) 54°
(c) 10 : 9 (d) 11 : 12 85. The marked price of the book is 20% more than the CP. If the
77. How many boys have opted for the composite subject? marked price of the book is `30, then what is the cost of the
(a) 30 (b) 15 paper used in a single copy of the book ?
(c) 21 (d) 32 (a) `6 (b) `5
78. How many girls have opted for only Sanskrit? (c) `4.5 (d) `6.50
(a) 72 (b) 47 86. Which two expenditures together will form an angle of 108°
(c) 51 (d) 77 at the centre of the diagram ?
Directions (Qs. 79 - 83) : These questions are to be answered on (a) A and E (b) B and E
the basis of the pie chart given below showing how a person’s (c) A and D (d) D and E
monthly salary is distributed over different expense heads. 87. If the difference between the two expenditures are represented
by 18 degrees in the diagram, then these expenditures must
be :
Food (a) B and E (b) A and C
15%
House Rent (c) A and D (d) D and E
Petrol 30% Directions (Qs. 88 - 91) : Study the following pie-charts carefully
10%
to answer the questions that follow :
Entertainment Percentage of Students in a College, studying in various
15% Clothes
7% subjects and the percentage of girls out of these
Savings
23%
Total students: 1800 (1200 girls + 600 boys)
Percentage of students in various subjects
79. For a person, whose monthly salary is Rs 6,000 p.m., how
many items are there on which he has to spend more than
` 1,000 p.m ? Biology Law
(a) 1 (b) 2 13% 20%
(c) 3 (d) 4 Arts
80. The annual saving for such a person will be approximately: 12%
(a) ` 5,000 (b) ` 10, 000 Computers
(c) ` 15, 000 (d) ` 16, 560 Political 15%
Science
Ma %
81. The monthly salary for a person who follows the same
35% 5
ths
expense pattern, but has a petrol expense of Rs 500 p.m., is
(a) ` 2,500 (b) ` 3, 000
(c) ` 5, 000 (d) ` 6,500 Total Girls : 1200
82. The percentage of money spent on clothes and savings is Percentage of girls in various subjects
equal to which other single item of expense ?
Maths
(a) Petrol (b) House rent 2%
(c) Food (d) Entertainment
83. The angle made at the centre of the pie chart by the sector
representing the expense on petrol is :
ts
(a) 30° (b) 45° Ar
%
30
(a) 312.4 (b) 341.4 30
25 25 25 25 25
(c) 241.4 (d) 212.4 25
20 20 20 20
93. What is the ratio of military expenditure to veterans 20
15 15
expenditure approximately? 15
(a) 59 : 6 (b) 1 : 10 10
10 7
(c) 54 : 10 (d) None of these
94. If India had a total expenditure of Rs. 120 billion, 5
approximately how many billions did it spend on interest 0
on debt? 1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993
(a) ` 8.10 billion (b) `12.9 billion Year
(c) `10.8 billion (d) `11.12 billion 101. In which year was the sale of ‘Pep-up’ the maximum?
95. If `9 billion were spent for veterans, what would have been (a) 1990 (b) 1991
the total expenditure for that year? (c) 1992 (d) 1989
(a) ` 150 billion (b) ` 56. 25 billion 102. In the case of which soft drink was the average annual sale
(c) ` 140 billion (d) ` 145 billion maximum in the given period?
Directions (Qs. 96-99) : Study the chart and give the answer of (a) Pep-up only (b) Cool-sip only
following questions. (c) Dew-drop only (d) Cool-sip and Dew-drop
103. In the case of Cool-sip drink, what was the approximate per
Selling of the car in UK according to the colours cent increase in sale in 1992 over its sale in 1991?
Blue Yellow (a) Less than 20 (b) 20-25
13% 10% Red (c) 25 (d) 31-35
19%
Green 104. In the year 1990, what was the difference between the number
9% of ‘Pep-up’ and ‘Cool-sip’ bottles sold?
Silver (a) 50,00,000 (b) 5,00,000
10% (c) 50,000 (d) 10,00,000
105. What was the approximate per cent drop in sale of Pep-up
Brown White in 1990 over its sale in 1989?
2% Golden 26% (a) 5 (b) 12
Black 6%
5% (c) 14 (d) 20
Data Interpretation B- 67
Directions (Qs. 106-110): Study the following graphs carefully 106. What is the average production of all the units (in lakh
to answer these questions. tons) for the year 2002?
Production (in lakh tons) of six units of a company in 2001 (a) 89 (b) 92 (c) 87 (d) 95
and 2002 107. Average production of three units A, B & C in 2001 is what
2001 2002 per cent of the average production of units D , E & F in
120
2002? (rounded off to two digits after decimal)
110 (a) 109.43 (b) 90.37 (c) 91.38 (d) 106.43
100 108. What is the ratio of total production for two years to-gether
Production (in lakh tons)
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 16 (d) 31 (b) 46 (a) 61 (d) 76 (a) 91 (d) 106 (d)
2 (a) 17 (c) 32 (c) 47 (d) 62 (b) 77 (b) 92 (d) 107 (c)
3 (b) 18 (b) 33 (a) 48 (a) 63 (d) 78 (b) 93 (d) 108 (b)
4 (c) 19 (c) 34 (a) 49 (a) 64 (c) 79 (b) 94 (c) 109 (a)
5 (a) 20 (b) 35 (d) 50 (b) 65 (c) 80 (d) 95 (c) 110 (b)
6 (a) 21 (b) 36 (b) 51 (c) 66 (b) 81 (c) 96 (b)
7 (c) 22 (c) 37 (b) 52 (c) 67 (a) 82 (b) 97 (b)
8 (d) 23 (c) 38 (a) 53 (b) 68 (a) 83 (c) 98 (a)
9 (b) 24 (b) 39 (c) 54 (d) 69 (c) 84 (d) 99 (d)
10 (a) 25 (d) 40 (d) 55 (a) 70 (d) 85 (b) 100 (d)
11 (d) 26 (a) 41 (d) 56 (b) 71 (c) 86 (c) 101 (d)
12 (d) 27 (b) 42 (c) 57 (d) 72 (c) 87 (d) 102 (a)
13 (d) 28 (c) 43 (d) 58 (c) 73 (a) 88 (b) 103 (c)
14 (d) 29 (d) 44 (b) 59 (b) 74 (c) 89 (a) 104 (d)
15 (c) 30 (c) 45 (c) 60 (c) 75 (b) 90 (b) 105 (c)
B- 68 Data Interpretation
24. (b) Required income 30. (c) Total production of the six companies in first two given
= 120% of ` 40 crore= ` 48 crores years = 863 + 927 = 1790
25. (d) The given graph depicts only the per cent profit earned Again, total production of the six companies in last
by the two companies over the given years. Hence, two given years = 989 + 991 =1980
these informations are insufficient to answer the 1790 ´ 100
Therefore, required per cent = = 90.40%
question. 1980
26. (a) In 2002-03 profit earned by company Y was 60%. 31. (b) The required difference
Therefore, 160% of expenditure = (91 – 90) crore units =1×10000000= 10000000 units
= ` 128 crores 32. (c) Those companies are:
ZIR PEN and SIO
128
Thus, required expenditure = ´ 100 33. (a) Production in 1996 = 5 lakh units
160
Production in 2002 = 32.5 lakh units
= ` 80 crores
32.5
27. (b) Production of company AVC in 2000 =360 crore units \ The required percentage= ´ 100 = 650
5
Average production of AVC over the given years
34. (a) Average production
300 + 300 + 300 + 360 + 370 + 340 1970
= = (5 + 7.5 + 10 + 17.5 + 25 + 27.5 + 32.5)lakhs
6 6 =
7
360 ´ 6
Hence, required per cent = ´ 100 125
1970 =17.8 » 18 lakh units
7
= 109.64% » 110% 35. (d) It is obvious from the graph.
28. (c) Approximate per cent increase or decrease in
production from the previous year for SIO are as 17.5 - 10
36. (b) Per cent increase in 1999 = ´ 100 = 75
follows: 10
2 25 - 17.5
1998 = ×100 = 2.35% Per cent increase in 2000 = ´ 100
85 17.5
2 ´ 100
1999 = = 2.29% 7.5 ´ 100
87 = = 42.86
17.5
2 ´ 100 37. (b) Marks obtained by R in B, D and E
2000 = = 2.24% = 54% of 40 + 84% of 50 + 62% of 120
89
= 21.60 + 42 + 74.40 = 138.00
1 ´ 100 38. (a) Average % marks by all the students in C
2001 = =1.09%
91
58 + 67 + 72 + 82 + 64 + 75 418
= = = 69.66%
4 ´ 100 6 6
2002 = =4.35%
92 Average marks = 69.66% of 80 » 56
You can solve it with simple rough work. See the 39. (c) Average percentage of marks obtained by all the
difference of produced units between two consecutive students in ‘A’
years. The difference is maximum for 2001 to 2002, and 80 + 55 + 74 + 68 + 75 + 82 434 1
production during all these years is almost same. = = = 72 %
6 6 3
Hence, in the year 2002 SIO registered maximum
40. (d) Total marks obtained by Q in all subjects
increase in production over the previous year.
= 55% of 60 + 70% of 40 + 67% of 80 + 74% of 50 + 88%
29. (d) Sum of the productions of the companies in first three
of 120 + 78% of 75 = 33 + 28 + 53.60 + 37 + 105.6 + 58.50
years and the last three years in ` crore is as follows:
= 315.7
316
Company First three years Last three years percentage of marks = ´ 100 » 74%
TP 358 349 425
ZIR 238 267 41. (d) Total marks obtained by student E in all the subjects
AV C 900 1070 = (75 + 88 + 62 + 72 + 80 + 68)% of 120 = 534
CTU 836 852 42. (c) Expenditure of Company C in 2000
PEN 90 127 100
SIO 261 279 = 35 ´ = ` 25 lakhs
140
B- 70 Data Interpretation
43. (d) Here, the percentage profits of Companies B and C in 58. (c) Total no. of Officers = 2000 + 15000 + 17000 + 3500 +
2001 were not the same. Therefore, can’t be determined 14900 + 11360 + 9000 = 72760
is the correct choice. Total no. of Clerks = 5000 + 17000 + 19500 + 20000 +
44. (b) Income of Company C in 2000 17650 + 15300 + 11000 = 105450
Reqd difference = 105450 – 72760 = 32690
140
= 32 ´ = ` 44.80 lakhs
100 59. (b) Reqd more % = 11000 - 9000 ´ 100 » 22%
9000
45. (c) Reqd ratio = 145:155 = 29 : 31
60. (c) 300% more means four times the number of Clerks in
46. (a) Expenditure of Company D in 2000
Bangalore, which is in Hyderabad.
100 61. (d) No. of candidates in different centres: Bangalore
= 31 ´ = ` 20 lakhs = 3550; Mumbai = 44470; Delhi = 43910; Hyderabad
155
= 33950, Kolkata = 35120; Lucknow = 28840; Chennai
Profit = Income – Expenditure = 31 – 20 = ` 11 lakhs
= 22245
47. (d) Total no. of students studying in institute G
62. (b) Let the investment of company B in 1996 be ` x lakhs.
= 225 + 206 + 182 + 138 + 89 = 840
7
182 2 \ Investment of company B in 1997 = ` x
Reqd % = ´100 = 21 % 5
840 3
9 7 63
48. (a) Total students in institute D Income of company B in 1997 = ´ x= x
5 5 25
= 165 + 138 + 245 + 66 + 36 = 650
63
36 \ Reqd. % = × 100 = 252%
Reqd % = ´ 100 » 6% 25
650 63. (d) Investment for each year is not given.
125 + 96 + 144 100
49. (a) Reqd % = ´100 = 48.50% 64. (c) Investment of company A in 1995 = 21.7 ×
138 + 196 + 212 + 206 155
= ` 14 lakhs
164 65. (c) Let i95(A) = e96(B) = ` x lakhs
50. (b) Reqd % = ´ 100 » 20%
821
100
x´
187 \ Regd. ratio = 155 = 20 : 31
51. (c) percentage of institute A = ´ 100 = 26.71% x
700
66. (b) Income of company B in 1993
152 145
% of institute B = ´ 100 = 20.26% = ` 22.33lakhs
750 = 1540000 ×
100
% of institute C = 30.12 % 67. (a) Strength of B in 1998 = 132 + 9 – 2 + 0 + 3 = 142
% of institute D = 21.23 % 68. (a) Strength of workers in 1999
% of institute E = 23.05 % A B C D E
% of institute F = 26.5 % and G = 23.67 % 192 146 149 135 125
Hence, maximum % is in institute C. 69. (c) Strength of C in 1996 = 98 + 24 + 11 = 133
4-3 Strength of E in 1997 = 125 + 2 + 4 – 3 = 128
52. (c) Reqd % decrease = ´100 = 25%
4 133
\ Reqd. % = ´ 100 » 104%
128
11
53. (b) Reqd % = ´ 100 »157% 70. (d) Total strength of workers in all the five units in 1996
7
= 160 + 139 + 133 + 107 + 131= 670.
54. (d) From the graph’s slope, it is obvious that the maximum 71. (c) Increase in the strength of workers in D in 1998
% increase is in the year 1996, i.e., 166.67%. = 20 + 11+ 7 + 11= 49
55. (a) Reqd difference = 58 – 31 = 2700000 \ % increase = 49/76 × 100 » 64.47%
72. (c) Marks obtained by B = 69% of 150 + 72% of 75
31
56. (b) Average production for Company B = = 3.9 + 71% of 200 + 78% of 100 + 69% of 50 + 66% of 75
8 = 103.50 + 54 + 142 + 78 + 34.5 + 49.50 = 461.5
57. (d) Reqd. % = 1200 ´ 100 » 8% 73. (a) Average marks <
420 75
´ < 52.5
14900 6 100
Data Interpretation B- 71
100% 10 + 15 + 25 + 15 + 30 + 25
Þ 108° = o
´ 108° = 30% =
6
= 20 lakhs
360
Avg. annual sale of Cool-sip
From the given pie chart. (A + D) = 30%
25 + 7 + 20 + 20 + 25 + 30
18o =
6
= 21.16 lakhs
87. (d) 18° = ´ 100% = 5%
360o Avg. annual sale of Pep-up
So, the difference in percentages of expenditures be
30 + 35 + 30 + 25 + 20 + 20
5% = 26.66 lakhs
6
Thus, required expenditures are C and B or D and E.
or A and B or A and E.
B- 72 Data Interpretation
108. (b) Total production by unit B in 2001 and 2002 together
25 - 20
103. (c) Reqd % = × 100 = 25% = (75 + 60 =) 135 lakh tons
20
Total production by unit C in 2001 and 2002 together
104. (d) Reqd no. = 30 – 20 = 1000000
= (100 + 110 =) 210 lakh tons
35 - 30 \ Required ratio = (135 : 210 =) 9 : 14
105. (c) Reqd % drop = ´ 100 » 14%
35 109. (a) Total production by unit F in year 2001and 2002
(110 + 60 + 110 + 100 + 105 + 85 = )570 together = (70 + 85 =) 155 lakh tons
106. (d) = 95 lakh tons
6 Total production by unit D in year 2001 and 2002
107. (c) Average production of units A, B and C in 2001 together = (95 + 100 = ) 195 lakh tons
[use white bars]
æ 155 ö
(90 + 75 + 100 =) 265 \ Required percentage çè ´ 100÷ = 79.487 » 79.49
195 ø
3
\ Average production of units D, E & F in 2002 110. (b) Required total production = (100 + 110 + 95 + 100
+ 85 + 105 =) 595 lakh tons
(100 + 105 + 85 =) 290
=
3
265 ´ 3
Required answer = ´ 100 = 91.38
3 ´ 290
SECTION C : GENERAL AWARENESS
CHAPTER
1 History
ANCIENT INDIA
Pre History
Palaeolithic Age or Mesolithic Age or Neolithic Age or
Old stone age Late Stone age New Stone age
(500,000-10,000 BC) (10,000-4,000 BC) (6,000-1,000 BC)
Pre Historic Phases
Stone Age Primary Culture Major Site Importance
Lower Palaeolithic Flakes,Chopper Kashmir, Punjab, Whole India except Sind - Head axe and pebble tools, Fossil of
Chopping Culture and Kerala. Main :- Sohan(Punjab), Homo Erectus from Hathnaura (Narmada
Singrauli basin (U.P.), Chhotanagpur basin)
(Jharkhand), Assam, Narmada, Andhra - Represented by Sohan Culture (now in
Pradesh, Karnataka. Pakistan.)
Middle Scraper/Booer Culture Navasa (Maharashtra), Didwana - Varieties of Blades, Points, Borer and
Palaeolithic (Rajasthan), Bhimbetka (MP), Bankura Scraper made of Flakes.
and Purulia (West Bengal), Narmada - 200 rock shelters and caves are located
Valley etc. on Bhimbetka hills having thousands of
paintings.
Upper Palaeolithic Blade and Burin Culture A.P. (Kurnool, Chittor) Karnataka, Central - The age of Neanderthal Man
MP, Jharkhan Plateau, U.P., Rajasthan, - Earlier "Homo Sapiens"
Gujrat - Harpoon, blade tools from Renugunta
(A.P.)
- Bone tools from Kurnool.
Meslithic Age Microliths Culture or Karnataka, Rajasthan (Bagor, Tilwara), - Microlith (a great technological
Fluting & Gometrical Gujrat (Langhanj), M.P., Tamil Nadu,West development, introduction of compound
tools Benal (Birbhanpur), U.P. (Sarai Nahar Rai) tools)
- Man still a savage but pottery maing
(Tilwara) and permanent habitation
found, still a hunder, fisher.
- Earlies Farming community
- Kinship became the basis of social
organisation
- Pit dwelling houses
Kashmir (Burzahom, Gufkral), Assam
- Food begain to be cooked by fire
(Daojili Hading), Garohill Meghalaya,
Neolithic Age Polished tool culture -Evidence of dogs, circular huts made of
Bihar (Chirand), Peninsular India, Amri,
bamboo, bone-tools, hand made pottery
Kotdiji, Mehargarh etc
etc
- Also called "Neolithic Revolution"
-Boat making, spinning cotton and wool.
C-2 History
IMPORTANT HARAPPAN SITES
Year of
Name of Sites Excavators Region/River Features
Excavation
Montgomery 1. City followed grid planning
district of Punjab 2. Row of six granaries
Harappa 1921 Daya Ram Sahni 3. Only place having evidences of coffin burial
(Now in Pak) on the
4. Evidence of fractional burial and coffin burial
left bank of Ravi
5. Cemetery-H of alien people.
1. City followed grid planning
2. A large granary and Great Bath, a college
Larkana district in
3. Human skeletons showing invasiona and massacre.
Sind on the right
Mohenjodaro 1922 R.D.Banarjee 4. Evidence of Horse come from superficial level.
bank of Indus(Now
5. A piece of woven cotton alongwith spindle whorls and
in Pak)
needles
6. Town was flooded more then seven times.
1. The city has no citadal
2. Famous for bead makers shop
N. Gopal
Situtated in Sind on 3. A small pot, possibly an inkpot
Chanhu-daro 1931 Majumdar,
the bank of Indus 4. Foot prints of a dog chasing a cat
Mackey
5. Three different cultural layers, Indus,Jhukar and
Jhangar
1. Shows both Pre Harappan and Harappan phase
Situated in 2. Evidence of furrowed land
Kalibangan 1953 A. Ghosh Rajasthan on the 3. Evidence of seven fire altars and camel bones
Bank of Ghaggar 4. Many houses had their own well
5. Kalibangan stand for black bangles
6. Evidence of wooden furrow
1. A titled floor which bears intersecting design of circles
Situated in Gujarat 2. Remains of rice husk
on Bhogava river 3. Evidence of horse from a terracotta figurine
Lothal 1953 S.R. Rao
near Gulf of 4. A ship designed on a seal
Cambay 5. Beads & trade ports
6. An instrument for measuring angles,pointing to modern
day compass
Situated in Hissar 1. Shows both Pre-Harappan and Harppan phase
Banwali 1974 R.S. Bisht
district of Haryana 2. Good quantity of barley found here
Situated in Sind on
Amri 1935 N.G. Majumdar 1. Evidence of antelope
the bank of Indus
1. Seven cultural stages
Situated in Gujarat 2. Largest site
Dholavira 1985-90 R.S. Bisht
in Rann of Kutch 3. Three party of city
4. Unique water management
Situated on the
M.S. Vats, B.B.
Rangpur 1953 bank of Mahar in 1. Rice was cultivated
Lal & S.R. Rao
Gujarat
1. Evidence of burying a dog below the human bural
Situated in Punjab 2. One example of rectangular mudbrick chamber was
Ropar 1953 Y.D. Sharma of the banks of noticed
Sutlej 3. Five fold cultures - Harappan, PGW, NBP, Kushana -
Gupta and Medieval
1. The impression of cloth on a trough is discovered
Situated on Hindon
Alamgirpur 1958 Y.D. Sharma 2. Usually considered to be the eastern boundary of the
in Ghaziabad
Indus culture
History C-3
EXERCISE
1. Where is Harappa situated, according to the present map? 16. After the Kalinga war, Ashoka :
(a) India (b) Pakistan (a) restored all the kingdoms he had conquered
(c) Afghanistan (d) China (b) abandoned the policy of physical conquests in favour of
2. Copper and bronze were used to make cultural conquests.
(a) tools (b) weapons (c) renounced his kingdom and became a sadhu
(c) ornaments (d) All of them (d) followed the policy of physical occupation more rigorously
3. The first metal to be used by man was 17. How are empires different from kingdoms?
(a) bronze (b) iron (a) Empires are larger than kingdoms
(c) copper (d) stone (b) Empires need more resources than kingdoms
4. The people of Indus Valley civilisation worshipped the female (c) Empires need more officials who collect more taxes than
form of Kingdoms
(a) Mother goddess (b) Laxmi (d) All of them
(c) Saraswati (d) Durga
18. Where did Ashoka send his messengers to spread ideas about
5. The biggest building at Mohnejodaro was the
‘Dhamma’. Choose the correct answer from the code given below :
(a) great granary (b) rectangular building
(i) Syria (ii) Egypt
(c) great bath (d) assembly hall
(iii) Greece (iv) Sri Lanka
6. The polity of the Indus Valley people was
(a) Only (i) (b) Only (ii) and (iii)
(a) Oligarchy (Merchants) (b) Secular federalism
(c) Theocratic federalism (d) Theocratic unitary (c) Only (iv) (d) All of them
7. Iron was brought to many civilisation by the 19. Who wrote the biography of Harshavardhana?
(a) Turks (b) Greeks (a) Aryabhatta (b) Kalidasa
(c) Hittites (d) Huns (c) Shaka (d) Banabhatta
8. The first home of the Aryans was the 20. What was the name of Harshavardhana’s biography?
(a) Punjab (b) Gujarat (a) Harshacharita (b) Harshamanglam
(c) Rajasthan (d) Madhya Pradesh (c) Harshamanas (d) None of them
9. Agriculture was the main occupation of the 21. Allora was built by
(a) Aryans (b) Kushans (a) Pallavas (b) Chankyas
(c) Guptas (d) Kushanas (c) Rastrakutas (d) None of these
10. Which one of the following gives the correct chronological order 22. Who built town of Thanjavur?
of the vedas? (a) Vijayalaya (b) Rajput
(a) Rigveda, Samaveda, Atharvaveda, Yajurveda (c) Rajendra Chola (d) None of these
(b) Rigveda, Samaveda, Yajurveda, Atharvaveda 23. Which changes did take place in early medieval period?
(c) Atharvaveda, Yajurveda, Samaveda, Rigveda (a) Extension of agriculture
(d) Rigveda, Yajurveda, Samaveda, Atharvaveda (b) Migration of forest dwellers
11. Which of the following contains the Gayatri Mantra? (c) Emergence of peasants
(a) Yajurveda (b) Rigveda (d) All of the above
(c) Samaveda (d) Upanishad 24. When did Delhi first become capital of a kingdom?
12. What is name of the form of government which ruled Magadha? (a) At the time of Tomar dynasty
(a) Dictatorship (b) Democratic (b) Tuglaq dynasty
(c) Monarchical (d) Both ‘b’ and ‘c’ (c) Lodhi dynasty
13. The modern location of some old states are given below. Which (d) None of these
is/are correctly matched?
25. What was Iqta in sultanate period?
A. Anga - Bhagalpur and Monghyr
(a) Territories of land (b) A tax
B. Magadha - Patna and Gaya
(c) A form of military (d) None of these
C. Kasala - Avadh
26. Muhammad Tuglaq Transferred his capital from Delhi to
D. Panchala - Badawn, Bareilly
(a) Daulatabad (b) Sahibabad
E. Matsya - Allahabad
(a) All, A, B, C, D and E (b) A, B, C and D (c) Firozabad (d) None of these
(c) B, C, D and E (d) A, C and D 27. Which sultan first did campaign in South India?
14. What is meant by Janapadas? (a) Alauddin Khalji (b) Raziyya
(a) The land where the jana set its foot and settled down. (c) Qutabdin Aibak (d) None of these
(b) The land of shudras 28. Under whose rule, was Ajmer the capital?
(c) The land of historical monuments (a) Mauryas (b) Chauhans
(d) Museums (c) Guptas (d) Pallavas
15. Ashoka was inspired by the teachings of ____________. 29. Which was the most important festival celebrated at Hampi?
(a) Mahavira (b) Satyakama (a) Shivratri (b) Diwali
(c) Buddha (d) Pannini (c) Mahanavami (d) Holi
C-8 History
30. What was the capital of Maratha kingdom? 47. Match column I with column II and select the correct answer
(a) Poona (b) Nagpur using the code given below the columns.
(c) Bombay (d) Nasik Column I Column II
31. Dual Administration was established in Bengal by I. Raja Ram Mohan A. Used the ancient texts to
Roy suggest that widows could
(a) Clive (b) Warren Hastings
remarry
(c) Wellesley (d) Dulhousie II. Ishwarchandra B. Founded the reform
32. Which of the following statements was not a feature of the Vidyasagar association called Arya
Permanent Settlement Act? Samaj
(a) Zamindars were made the legal proprietor of the land III. Jyotirao Phule C. Protested against the
(b) Most of the landlords did not take interest in the practice of Sati and was able
improvement of land to finally ban it
(c) State was assured of a fixed income IV. Swami Dayanand D. Founded the association
Saraswati Satyashodhak Samaj to
(d) One-sixth of the produce was given to the Govt
propagate caste equality
33. Who introduced ‘Permanent Settlement’ in Bengal?
(a) I - C; II - A; III - B; IV - D
(a) Lord Bentinck (b) Lord Cornwallis (b) I -A; II -B; III - C; IV - D
(c) Lord Wellesley (d) Lord Hastings (c) I - C; II - A; III - D; IV - B
34. The English East India Company’s first presidency in India was at (d) I - D; II - C; III - B; IV - A
(a) Hooghly (b) Surat 48. The War of Independence of 1857 failed because
(c) Madras (d) Masulipatnam (a) The revolution was not well organised
35. The battle of Plassey(1757) was fought between (b) It was not supported by public
(a) Tipu Sultan and East India Company (c) There were differences of opinions
(d) All of these
(b) Haider Ali and East India Company
49. The revolt of 1857 broke out for an immediate cause
(c) Siraj-ud-Daulah and East India Company (a) a British interfered by introducing new social reforms like
(d) Mir Qasim, Shiraj-ud-Daulah and East India Company widow remarriage act 1856
36. Which of the following was twice made the Nawab of Bengal by (b) banning sati and child marriage
the East India Company? (c) greasing of the cartridges in the new enfield rifle with the fats
(a) Siraj-ud-Daula (b) Sah Alam II of cows and pigs.
(c) Mir Qasim (d) Mir Jafar (d) banning polygamy
37. The Supreme Court in British India was established under: 50. Who was the Governor General when the 1857 revolt broke out?
(a) The Charter Act of 1813 (b) The Charter Act of 1833 (a) Canning (b) Hastings
(c) Dalhousie (d) Curzon
(c) Regulating Act of 1773 (d) Pitt’s India Act of 1784
51. Which of the following was one of the major political causes of
38. The founder of the kingdom of Awadh was the revolt of 1857?
(a) Safdarjang (b) Saddat Khan (a) The withdrawl of the pension of Nana Sahib
(c) Shuja-ud-daula (d) Asaf-ud-daula (b) Lord Dalhousie’s policy of discriminate annexation and
39. The real founder of the British Empire in India was Doctrine of Lapse
(a) Clive (b) Warren Hastings (c) The absence of sovereignship of British rule in India
(c) Wellesley (d) Dalhousie (d) After the defeat of the Sikhs and annexation of the Punjab,
40. With whom was the Ryotwari Settlement made? the properties of the Lahore, Durbar were auctioned and the
Kohinoor was sent to England
(a) The Zamindars (b) The Cultivaters
52. Bengal was divided during the Govenrner-Generalship of
(c) The Village communities (d) The Muqaddars
(a) Lord Warren Hastings (b) Lord Canning
41. Raja Ram Mohan Roy favoured the banning of (c) Lord Curzon (d) Lord Hardings
(a) Child marriages (b) Caste system 53. The Government of India Act, 1919 was based on
(c) Sati (d) Widow exploitation (a) Simon Commission
42. The Home Rule League was organised by (b) Nehru’s report
(a) Mahatma Gandhi (b) Dr. Annie Besant (c) Montagu Chelmsford Report
(c) Lala Lajpat Rai (d) Sir Syed Ahmed Khan (d) Minto-Morley Reforms
43. William Jones founded the following society in 1789 54. The Indian National Congress was founded by
(a) Sir A.O. Hume (b) Lokmanya Tilak
(a) The Asiatic Society (b) The Bombay Society
(c) Gopal Krishna Gokhale (d) Mahatma Gandhi
(c) The Indian Society (d) Calcutta Society 55. The Conference in which the congress was divided into two camps-
44. The first Indian newspaper to be printed was Extremist and Liberal was held in
(a) The Times of India (b) Kesari (a) Mumbai (b) Surat
(c) Bengal Gazette (d) None of these (c) Kolkata (d) Lahore
45. The founder of Ramakrishna mission was 56. The way which Gandhi adopted for non-cooperation movement
(a) Vivekanand was
(b) Ramakrishna Paramhansa (a) to inspire army to revolt against British Government
(c) Raja Ram Mohan Roy (b) to provoke public for violence
(c) to make people agree to surrender their titles and resign from
(d) Bankim Chandra Chatterjee
Government jobs with peaceful means
46. The founder of the Ahmediya movement was (d) to instruct the leaders to oppose the Government in
(a) Sir Syed Ahmed Khan (b) Malviya Chirag Ali Parliament
(c) Mirza Ghulam Ahmed (d) Shaukat Ali
History C-9
57. The Sati Pratha was declared illegal during the Governer 71. The Lahore session of the Congress in 1929 decided to
Generalship of (a) launch civil disobedience movement
(a) William Bentinck (b) Dalhousie (b) struggle for freedom
(c) Canning (d) Cornwallis (c) attainment of complete independence
58. The Civil Disobedience Movement was started with the action (d) None of these
that 72. The Quit India Movement was organised on
(a) The people offered themselves to be sent to jail (a) June, 1941 (b) 8 August, 1942
(b) The Government was compelled to call Round Table (c) July, 1943 (d) July 1946
Conference 73. The first split in Congress took place in 1907 in
(c) The meeting was held against the Government (a) Calcutta (b) Allahabad
(d) Gandhiji acted against Salt Act (c) Madras (d) Surat
59. The Forward Block was formed by 74. The Muslim League demanded partition in
(a) Subhash Chandra Bose (a) 1906 (b) 1936
(b) C.R. Dass (c) 1940 (d) 1942
(c) Bal Ganga Dhar Tilak 75. Who among the following belonged to the moderate group of the
(d) Gopal Krishan Gokhale Indian National Congress?
60. The Revolutionary who threw a bomb in the Assembly was (a) Lala Lajpat Rai (b) Bipan Chandra Pal
(a) Chandra Shekhar Azad (c) Bal Gangadhar Tilak (d) Gopal Krishna Gokhale
(b) Bhagat Singh 76. Jallianwala Bagh massacre took place in the city of?
(c) Ram Prasad Bismil (a) Agra (b) Meerut
(d) Sukh Dev (c) Amritsar (d) Lahore
61. The Swaraja Party was organised by 77. The slogan ‘Inquilab Zindabad’ was raised by
(a) Lala Lajpat Rai and Feroz Shah Mehta (a) Subhash Chandra Bose
(b) Sarojini Naidu and Annie Besant (b) Bhatgat Singh
(c) C. R. Das and Motilal Nehru (c) Mahatma Gandhi
(d) C. Rajagopalachari and C.Y. Chintamani (d) Jawaharlal Nehru
62. The Khilafat Movement was organised to protest against the 78. What amongst the following were the main problems of India just
injustice done to after independence?
(a) Egypt (b) Arabia (I) Refugees (II) Education
(c) Persia (d) Turkey (III) Princely states (IV) Poverty
63. Which one of the following is incorrectly matched? (a) I and III are correct (b) II, III and I are correct
(a) Bhagat Singh : Merrut Conspiracy Case (c) Only II is correct (d) All are correct
(b) Ram Prasad Bismil : Kakori Conspiracy Case 79. Which of the following statements regarding the Nehru Report are
(c) Chandra Shekhar Azad : New Delhi Conspiracy Case correct?
(d) Surya Sen : Chittagong Armoury Raid 1. It favoured Dominion Status.
64. Who among the following did not attend the First Round Table 2. It favoured a federal system.
Conference? 3. It rejected the system of Communal Electorate.
(a) M.K. Gandhi (b) Sir Tej Bahadur Sapru 4. It was against the setting up of a Supreme Court.
(c) Dr. Ambedkar (d) C.Y. Chintamani Choose the correct answer from the codes given below:
65. Who led the Bardoli Satyagraha in 1928? Codes:
(a) Morarji Desai (b) M.K. Gandhi (a) I and IV (b) I and III
(c) Mahadev Desai (d) Vallabhbhai Patel (c) I, III and IV (d) I, II and III
66. Railway and telegraph systems were introduced in India by 80. Which one of the following is considered the Magna Carta of the
Indian people?
(a) Lord Cornwallis (b) Lord Dalhousie
(a) The Government of India Act, 1858
(c) Lord Wellesley (d) Lord Bentinck
(b) The Ilibert Bill
67. The interim Government formed in India in 1946 was headed by
(c) Indian Councils Act of a 1892
(a) C. Rajagopalachari (b) Mahatma Gandhi
(d) Queen Victoria’s Proclamation
(c) Jawaharlal Nehru (d) Dr. Rajendra Prasad
81. During indian freedom struggle, which one of the following
68. “Do or Die” was the slogan which Mahatma Gandhi gave during
happened earlist?
the
(a) Simon Commission
(a) Quit India Movement
(b) Gaya Session of Congress
(b) Non-Cooperation Movement
(c) Tripuri Session of congress
(c) Khilafat agitation
(d) Gandhi-Irwin Pact
(d) Civil Disobedience Movement
82. The Mansabdari System introduced by Akbar was borrowed from
69. Hunter Commission was appointed by the British Government
the system followed in:
to probe into
(a) Afghanistan (b) Turkey
(a) Chauri Chaura incident
(c) Mongolia (d) Persia
(b) Demolition of Kanpur Mosque
83. Gulf war was fought between
(c) Jalianwalla Bagh massacre
(a) Iran and Iraq (b) Iraq and Israel
(d) Kakori train dacoity incident
(c) Iraq and America
70. The moderate congress leaders demanded (d) Iraq, America & Allied forces
(a) no separation but representation 84. Mention the most important social issue taken up by Ghandhiji
(b) immediate end of British rule in India for reforms -
(c) end of racial discrimination (a) Religion (b) Cast
(d) introduction of English education (c) Women's status (d) Orthodoxy in Hinduism
C- 10 History
85. From which one of the following did Kosovo declare its 2. The Government of India Act of 1935 provided for the
independence ? establishment of an All India Federation to be based on a
(a) Bulgaria (b) Croatia Union of the provinces of British India and the Princely
(c) Macedonia (d) Serbia States.
86. With which of the following is ‘Boston tea party’ associated? Which of the statements given above is/are correct ?
(a) Glorious revolution (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(b) French revolution (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
(c) Russian revolution 95. The Sun Temple of Konark was built by Narasimhadeva I. To
(d) American war of Independence which dynasty did he belong to?
(a) Somavamsi dynasty
87. In 305 BC, which Maurya ruler defeated Alexander's general
(b) Imperial Ganga dynasty
Seleucus Nicator and received the territories of Kabul and
(c) Suryavamsi Gajapati dynasty
Balochistan ? (d) Bhoi dynasty
(a) Bindusara (b) Ashok the Great 96. What was the main difference between the Indus Valley Civilization
(c) Chandragupta Maurya (d) Dasharatha Maurya and Vedic Civilization?
88. In the context of the Indian freedom struggle, 16 October 1905 is (a) Indus Valley Civilization was urban, while the Vedic
well known for which one of the following reasons? Civilization was rural.
(a) The formal proclamation of Swadeshi Movement was made (b) "Pipal" tree was worshiped in Indus Valley Civilization,
in Calcutta town hall while "Burgad" tree was worshiped in Vedic Civilization.
(b) Partition of Bengal took effect (c) The main emphasis in Indus Valley Civilization was on trade
(c) Dadabhai Naoroji declared that the goal of Indian National while in the Vedic Age was on religion.
Congress was Swaraj (d) Indus Valley Civilization believed in non-violence while Vedic
(d) Lokmanya Tilak started Swadeshi Movement in Poona Civilization had no hard and fast rules about violence.
89. When was the first atom bomb dropped on Hiroshima? 97. Which one of the following is correctly matched?
(a) August 6, 1945 (b) August 8, 1942 (a) Second Battle of Panipat - Akbar and Ibrahim Lodi
(c) August 9, 1945 (d) August 9, 1944 (b) Battle of Khanwa - Akbar and Rana Sanga
90. Sultan Muhammad Quli Qutub Shah was the contemporary of - (c) Battle of Chausa - Humayun and Sher Shah
(a) Akbar (b) Aurangzeb (d) First battle of Tarian - Mahmud Ghaznavi and Prithviraj
(c) Shahjahan (d) Muhammad Shah Chauhan
91. The Indus Valley Civilization was famous for 98. Who had demarcated the border-line between India and Pakistan?
(a) McMohan (b) Lord Durand
(a) Well-planned cities
(c) Redcliffe (d) None of these
(b) Efficient civil organization
99. In Indian history, who was Abdul Hamid Lahori?
(c) Development of Art and Architecture (a) An important military commander during Akbar's reign
(d) All of these (b) An official historian of the reign of Shah Jahan
92. Which one of the following began with the Dandi March ? (c) An important noble and confident of Aurangzeb
(a) Home Rule Movement (d) A chronicler and poet during the reign of Muhammad Shah
(b) Non-Cooperation Movement 100. The parleys between the Prime Ministers Zulfikar Ali Bhutto and
(c) Civil Disobedience Movement Indira Gandhi, so much referred to in world politics, were held at
(d) Quit India Movement (a) Manali (b) Rawalpindi
93. Which one of the following settlements comprised Zamindar as (c) Shimla (d) Islamabad
middleman to collect the land revenue ? 101. Which one of the following is not related to the continuing turmoil
(a) Mahalwari Settlement (b) Ryotwari Settlement in Bosnia?
(c) Permanent Settlement (d) None of these (a) Serbs (b) Muslims
94. Consider the following statements : (c) Jews (d) Croats
1. The discussions in the Third Round Table Conference 102. The Gulf war of 1991 was precipitated by the Iraqi annexation of
eventually led to the passing of the Government of India Act (a) Bahrain (b) Kuwait
of 1935. (c) Saudi Arabia (d) South Yemen
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b) 14 (a) 27 (a) 40 (b ) 53 (c) 66 (b ) 79 (d ) 92 (c)
2 (d) 15 (c) 28 (b) 41 (c) 54 (a) 67 (c) 80 (d ) 93 (c)
3 (c) 16 (b) 29 (c) 42 (b ) 55 (b ) 68 (a) 81 (a) 94 (c)
4 (a) 17 (d) 30 (a) 43 (a) 56 (c) 69 (c) 82 (c) 95 (c)
5 (c) 18 (d) 31 (a) 44 (c) 57 (a) 70 (a) 83 (d ) 96 (a)
6 (a) 19 (a) 32 (d) 45 (a) 58 (d ) 71 (c) 84 (b ) 97 (c)
7 (c) 20 (d) 33 (b) 46 (b ) 59 (a) 72 (b ) 85 (d ) 98 (c)
8 (a) 21 (c) 34 (b) 47 (c) 60 (b ) 73 (d ) 86 (d ) 99 (d )
9 (a) 22 (a) 35 (c) 48 (d ) 61 (c) 74 (c) 87 (c) 1 00 (c)
10 (d) 23 (d) 36 (d) 49 (c) 62 (d ) 75 (d ) 88 (b ) 1 01 (c)
11 (b) 24 (a) 37 (c) 50 (a) 63 (c) 76 (b ) 89 (a) 1 02 (b )
12 (c) 25 (a) 38 (b) 51 (b ) 64 (a) 77 (b ) 90 (d )
13 (b) 26 (a) 39 (a) 52 (c) 65 (d ) 78 (a) 91 (d )
CHAPTER
2 Geography
Solar System and approximately the same period of time it takes to revolve
• Our galaxy is milky way Galaxy (or the Akash Ganga). It is around the earth. The moon’s period of revolution with
spiral in shape. reference to the sun is about 29.53 days (29 days, 12 hours,
• The Sun is at the centre of the solar system and one of the 44 minutes and 2.8 seconds). This period is called a synodic
month.
stars in the milky way galaxy.
• The light from the moon takes 1.3 seconds to reach the
• Hydrogen and helium are the main gases present in the Sun earth.
and Weighs 2 × 1027 tons. • The size of the Moon is one-fourth (1/4 th) the size of the
• It has a surface temperature of about 6000°C. Earth.
• Light (at the speed of 300,000 km per second) takes about • Gravitational pull of Moon is one-sixth (1/6 th) that of the
8.5 minutes to reach the Earth from the Sun. Earth.
• There are eight planets in the Solar system. • Jupiter is the largest planet of the solar system.
• Saturn has bright concentric rings which are made up of ice
• A ninth planet has been recently discovered by NASA
and ice-covered dust particles which revolve around it.
named as Carla.
• Neptune is very similar to Uranus and can be considered
• The sequence of planets according to their distance from its twin. Neptune is surrounded by methane rings at sub
the Sun is Mercury, Venus, Earth, Mars, Jupiter, Saturn, zero temperature.
Uranus, Neptune. The sequence of planets according to
their size (in discending order i.e., from big to small) is Jupiter, Geography of India
Saturn, Uranus, Neptune , Earth, Venus, Mars, Mercury. Location
Facts About Planets • India lies in the northern and eastern hemispheres of the
• Mercury is the closest planet to the Sun. globe between 8° 4’ N and 37°6’ N latitudes and 68°7’ E and
• Venus is like the Earth in size and mass and hence also 97°25’E longitudes.
known as the “Earth’s twin”. • The southern most point extent upto 6°45’ N latitude to
• The Earth is 23½° tilted on its axis and thus makes 66½º cover the last island of the Nicobar group of islands. The
angle with the plane of its orbit southern extreme is called Pygmalion Point or Indira Point.
• It takes 365 days and 5 hours 45 minutes to revolve around • The tropic of cancer passes through the middle part of
the Sun. India and crosses the states of Gujarat, Rajasthan, Madhya
• Earth is known as the “watery planet” or the “blue planet” Pradesh, Chhattisgarh, Jharkhand, West Bengal, Tripura
due to presence of a huge amount of water. and Mizoram.
• The earth has a protective blanket of ozone layer high up in Size and Shape
its atmosphere to save life from harmful ultraviolet radiations • India commands a total geographical area of 32,87,263 sq.
coming from the sun. km which is- roughly 0.57% of the area of the earth and
Facts About our Planet — the Earth 2.4% of the total area of the land hemisphere.
Ø Estimated age of the Earth : 4600 million years. • The Indian states on international boundaries (other
Ø Mean distance from the Sun : 149,407,000 kms. country/ countries within brackets) are: Gujarat (Pakistan),
Ø Equatorial diameter : 12753 kms. Rajasthan (Pakistan), Punjab (Pakistan), Jammu and Kashmir
Ø Polar diameter : 12710 kms (China and Pakistan), Himachal Pradesh (China), Bihar
Ø Equatorial circumference : 40,066 kms. (Nepal), Uttarakhand (China and Nepal), Uttar Pradesh
Ø Period of rotation : 23hrs. 56mts. 4.09sec. (24hrs.) (Nepal), West Bengal (Bhutan and Bangladesh), Sikkim
(China, Bhutan and Nepal), Arunachal Pradesh (Bhutan,
Ø Period of revolution : 365 days 5 hours 48 mts and
China and Myanmar), Nagaland (Myanmar), Manipur
45.51 seconds. (365¼ days)
(Myanmar), Mizoram (Bangladesh and Myanmar),
Ø Total area : 510,100,500 sq. kms.
Meghalaya (Bangladesh), Tripura (Bangladesh) and Assam
The Moon (Bhutan, Bangladesh and Myanmar).
• The Moon is the only satellite of the earth. • The states of Haryana, Madhya Pradesh, Chhattishgarh
• It takes 27 days, 7 hours and 43 minutes to rotate on its axis and Jharkhand are the only land-locked states which are
(this period of about 27½ days is called the sideral month) neither on the coast or on an international border.
C- 12 Geography
Physical Features • Its north-west limit is marked by Aravalli range and its
• Out of the total area of the country, about 10.6% is occupied northern extreme has the raised Bundel khand. At its eastern
by mountains, 18.5% by hills, 27.7% by plateaus and 43.2% and western ends are Eastern Ghats and Western Ghats
by the plains. respectively. It has the shape of an inverted triangle.
• India may be divided into four major physiographic regions, The Indian Coasts and Islands
viz, 1. The Northern Mountains, 2. The Great Plains, 3. The Islands India has a number of islands (247) both in the Bay of
Peninsular Uplands, and 4. The Indian Coasts and Islands. Bengal, (204 islands) and the Arabian Sea (43 islands). The
Physical Features Andaman and Nicobar Islands in the Bay of Bengal represent the
India may be divided into four major physiographic regions, viz, 1. elevated portions of submarine mountains. Mount Harriet (460 m)
The Northern Mountains, 2. The Great Plains, 3. The Peninsular in the South Andaman Island is the highest point.
Uplands, and 4. The Indian Coasts and Islands.
The Northern Mountains States with the Longest Coastline
Himalayas represent the youngest and the highest folded State/UT
Length of coastline (km)
mountains of the earth, rising to over 8000 m above sea level and
1. Andaman & Nicobar Islands 1,962
consisting of three parallel ranges : (a) Himadri (Greater Himalaya),
2. Gujarat 1,215
(b) Himachal (Lesser Himalaya), and (c) the Siwaliks (Outer
3. Andhra Pradesh 974
Himalayas).
4. Tamil Nadu 907
Principal Peaks of India 5. Maharashtra 653
Peak Height (Mtrs) Location
The Ganga Drainage System
1. Mt. Everest 8848 Nepal-Tibet
2. Mt. K2 8611 India Name of Source Length (in Area
3. Kanchenjunga 8597 Nepal-India the river km) drained
4. Dhaulagiri 8172 Nepal (sq km)
5. Nanga Parbat 8126 India Ganga Gangotri Glacier 2,525 861,404
6. Annapurna 8078 Nepal at 7,010 m
7. Gasherbrum 8068 India Yamuna Yamnotri Glacier 1,376 366,223
8. Nanda Devi 7817 India at 6,330
9. Mt. Kamet 7756 India Chambal Near Mhow 1,050 139,468
10. Gurla Mandhata 7728 Tibet Ramganga Garhwal district 596 32,493
Valleys and its locations at 3,110 m
• Araku Valley : Andhra Pradesh Ghaghra Near Gurla 1,080 127,950
• Damodar Valley : Jharkhand and West Bengal Mandhota peak
• Darma Valley : Uttarakhand Gandak South of 425 in India 46,300
• Dzukou Valley : North-eastern part Manasarovar (7,620 in
• Johar Valley : Uttarakhand India)
• Markha Valley : Ladakh Kosi Tibet-Nepal 730 in India 86,900
• Nubra Valley : Ladakh border at 7,620 (21,500 in
• Sangla Valley : Himachal pradesh Sikkim Nepal- India)
• Saur Valley : Uttarakhand
Tibet Himalaya
• Suru Valley : Ladakh
• Tons Valley : Uttarakhand Lakes of India
• Yumthang Valley : Sikkim Wular Lake Jammu & Kashmir
Trans Himalayas Lonar Maharashtra
• The Trans-Himalayan Zone with a width of 40 km in its Kolleru Andhra Pradesh
eastern and western ends and a width of 222 km in its central
part, it has important ranges such as the Zaskar Range and Loktak Manipur
the Great Karakoram range. The karakoram extends towards Dal Lake Jammu & Kashmir
the south-east to form the Kailash Range (Tibet). The Naini Tal Uttarakhand
highest peak in the Karakoram range is K2 (8,611 m). The Salt Lake Kolkata
longest glacier is Siachen in the Nubra Valley which is more
than 72 km long. Chilka Orissa
The Peninsular Uplands Pulicut Andhra Pradesh
• Covering an area of 16 lakh sq km, the Peninsular Uplands Vembanad Kayal Kerala
form the largest and oldest physiographic division of India. Ashtamudi Kerala
Geography C- 13
Political Divisions of India • Plantation crops–Tea, Coffee, spices, coconut, rubber, etc.
India is divided into 28 States and 7 Union Territories. • Horticulture crops–Apple, mango, banana, citrus, etc.
EXERCISE
1. Which one of the following layers of the atmosphere is 11. In order of their distances from the Sun, which of the
responsible for the deflection of radio waves? following planets lie between Mars and Uranus?
(a) Troposphere (b) Stratosphere (a) Earth and Jupiter (b) Jupiter and Saturn
(c) Mesosphere (d) Ionosphere (c) Saturn and Earth (d) Saturn and Neptune
2. Which one of the following stars is nearest to the Earth? 12. In the structure of planet Earth, below the mantle, the core
(a) Polaris (b) Alpha Centauri is mainly made up of which one of the following?
(c) Sun (d) Sirius (a) Aluminium (b) Chromium
3. Which one of the following conditions is most relevant for (c) Iron (d) Silicon
the presence of life on Mars? 13. The earth’s rotation does not cause
(a) Atmospheric composition (a) deflection of ocean currents
(b) Thermal conditions (b) phases of the moon
(c) Occurrence of ice caps and frozen water (c) tides
(d) Occurrence of ozone (d) difference in time between two meridians
4. The correct sequence of different layers of the atmosphere 14. The difference in the duration of day and night increases as
from the surface of the Earth upwards is : one moves from
(a) Troposphere, Stratosphere, Ionosphere, Mesosphere (a) west to east
(b) Stratosphere, Troposphere, Ionosphere, Mesosphere (b) east and west of the prime meridian
(c) Troposphere, Stratosphere, Mesosphere, Ionosphere (c) poles to equator
(d) Stratosphere, Troposphere, Mesosphere, Ionosphere (d) equator to poles
5. Which one of the following types of coal contains a higher
15. On the day the sun is nearest to the earth, the earth is said to
percentage of carbon than the rest?
be in
(a) Bituminous coal (b) Lignite
(a) aphelion (b) perihelion
(c) Peat (d) Anthracite
(c) apogee (d) perigee
6. Which one of the following weather conditions is indicated
16. In aeroplanes, the atmospheric pressure is measured with
by a sudden fall in barometer reading?
(a) Aneroid barometer (b) Barometer
(a) Stormy
(c) Barogram (d) Altimeter
(b) Calm weather
17. All of the following types of climates occur in the southern
(c) Cold and dry weather
hemisphere expect
(d) Hot and sunny weather
(a) hot desert (b) savannah
7. Who amongst the following was the first to state that the
earth was spherical ? (c) equatorial (d) tundra
(a) Aristotle (b) Copernicus 18. The density of air is normally _________ at higher attitude.
(c) Ptolemy (d) Strabo (a) increases (b) decreases
8. Volcanic eruptions do not occur in : (c) remains constant (d) varies from place to place
(a) Baltic Sea (b) Black Sea 19. Farrel’s Law is concerned with the
(c) Caribbean Sea (d) Caspian Sea (a) direction of winds (b) velocity of winds
9. For short-term climatic predictions, which one of the (c) intensity of waves (d) None of these
following events, detected in the last decade, is associated 20. Which compound is the most abundant in sea water?
with occasional weak monsoon rains in the Indian sub- (a) Calcium carbonate (b) Potassium chloride
continent? (c) Sodium chloride (d) Magnesium sulphate
(a) La Nina 21. Our solar system is located in which Galaxy?
(b) Movement of Jet Stream (a) Proxima Centauri (b) Alfa Centauri
(c) El Nino. and Southern Oscillations (c) Milky Way (d) Andromeda
(d) Greenhouse effect at global level 22. The layer of the atmosphere which contains dust particles
10. Which one of the following is not a lagoon? and water vapour is called
(a) Ashtamudi lake (b) Chilka lake (a) Stratosphere (b) Troposphere
(c) Periyar lake (d) Pulicat lake (c) Ionosphere (d) Mesophere
C- 18 Geography
23. Granite and Basalt are the examples of which of the 38. Duncan passage is between
following? (a) South Andaman and Little Andaman
(a) Sedimentary rock (b) Metamorphic rock (b) Little Andaman and Car Nicobar
(c) Igneous rock (d) Calcareous rock (c) Lacadives and Minicoy Islands
24. Which of the following cities is nearest to the equator? (d) Kanyakumari and Trincomalee
(a) Colombo (b) Jakarta 39. The Palk Bay lies between
(c) Manila (d) Singapore
(a) Gulf of Kutch and Gulf of Khambhat
25. The waterfall ‘Victoria’ is associated with the river
(b) Gulf of Mannar and Bay of Bengal
(a) Amazon (b) Missouri
(c) Lakshadweep and Maldive Islands
(c) St. Lawrence (d) Zambezi
(d) Andaman and Nicobar Islands
26. The biggest hot desert of the world is
40. Which one of the following rivers originates in Amarkantak?
(a) Kalahari (b) Gobi
(c) Sahara (d) Thar (a) Damodar (b) Mahanadi
27. Which one of the following pairs is not correctly matched? (c) Narmada (d) Tapi
City River 41. Which of the following is the main difference between the
(a) Berlin Rhine Western and Eastern Ghats?
(b) London : Thames (a) Height (b) Continuity
(c) New York : Hudson (c) Proximity to the coast (d) Vegetation
(d) Vienna : Danube 42. Lakshadweep islands are the product of
28. Which one of the following is a land-locked country? (a) Volcanic activity (b) Wave action
(a) Angola (b) Mozambique (c) Sea floor expansion (d) Reef formation
(c) Namibia (d) Zimbabwe 43. One of the states through which the Tropic of Cancer passes
29. Which one of the following is a tropical grassland? is
(a) Lianos (b) Prairie (a) Jammu and Kashmir (b) Himachal Pradesh
(c) Steppe (d) Veld (c) Bihar (d) Jharkhand
30. In which one of the following is Malta located? 44. Which of the following has the oldest rocks in the country?
(a) Baltic Sea (b) Mediterranean Sea (a) The Himalayas
(c) Black Sea (d) North Sea (b) The Aravallis
31. In which one of the following areas is monsoon climate found? (c) The Indo-Gangetic plain
(a) Pacific Coast of Columbia (d) The Shiwaliks
(b) South-Eastern United States 45. In India, how many States share the coastline?
(c) Southern Part of South Africa (a) 7 (b) 8
(d) Central California (c) 9 (d) 10
32. The equator passes through 46. Which one of the following is the largest canal ?
(a) Cameroon (b) Costa Rica (a) Sharda Canal
(c) Kenya (d) Venezuela (b) Lower Ganga Canal
33. The Death valley in South California, USA is an example of
(c) Upper Ganga Canal
(a) Anticlinal valley (b) Synclinal valley
(d) Yamuna Canal (West)
(c) Antecedent valley (d) Rift valley
47. Which one of the following pairs is not correctly matched?
34. The Black Mountains are located in
Dam/Lake River
(a) Canada (b) Norway
(a) Govind Sagar : Sutlej
(c) Switzerland (d) U.S.A.
(b) Kolleru Lake : Krishna
35. The driest area of the Earth is
(a) Arabian desert (b) Atancama desert (c) Ukai Reservoir : Tapi
(c) Gobi desert (d) Thar desert (d) Wular Lake : Jhelum
36. Which one of the following is the most populous Islamic 48. Which one among the following major Indian cities is most
country of the world? eastward located?
(a) Bangladesh (b) Egypt (a) Hyderabad (b) Bhopal
(c) Indonesia (d) Pakistan (c) Lucknow (d) Bengaluru (Bangalore)
37. Which country has the highest percentage of its 49. Which one of the following mountain peaks of Himalayas
geographical area under forests? is not in India ?
(a) China (b) India (a) Annapurna (b) Nanda Devi
(c) Indonesia (d) Japan (c) Mt. Kamet (d) Kanchenjunga
Geography C- 19
50. The ‘Chilka lake region’ lies in between the deltas of: 63. Which of the following states is the largest producer of
(a) Ganga and Mahanadi silver in India?
(b) Godavari and Krishna (a) Karnataka (b) Andhra Pradesh
(c) Mahanadi and Godavari (c) Jharkhand (d) Goa
(d) Krishna and Cauvery 64. The chief petroleum state in India are
51. On which of the following rivers is the Jog Waterfall located? (a) Rajasthan and Gujarat
(a) Ganga (b) Cauvery (b) Asom and Gujarat
(c) Sharawati (d) Chambal (c) Gujarat and Maharashtra
52. Where is the Nanda Devi peak located ? (d) Andhra Pradesh and Tamil Nadu
(a) Himachal Pradesh (b) Uttarakhand 65. The greatest potential for the generation of tidal power in
(c) Sikkim (d) Nepal India is available in the
53. ‘Yellow Revolution’ is associated with the production of (a) Coromandel coast (b) Gujarat Coast
(a) poultry (b) oil seeds (c) Konarat Coast (d) Malabar coast
(c) sunflower (d) gold 66. Which one of the following is the longest National Highway
54. Jhumming is a shifting agriculture practiced in in India?
(a) North-Eastern India (a) NH 2 (b) NH 7
(b) South-Western India (c) NH 8 (d) NH 31
(c) South-Eastern India 67. Which is the artificial port of India?
(d) Northern India (a) Kandla (b) Mangalore
55. Match List I (Crops) with List II (Producing State) and select (c) Chennai or Madras (d) Haldia
the correct answer using the codes given below 68. The National highways system is the responsibility of
List I List II (a) State Governments
(Crops) (Producing State) (b) Central Government
A. Tea 1. Himachal Pradesh (c) A Special Roads Authority
B. Sugarcane 2. Assam (d) State and Central Governments
C. Groundnut 3. UttarPradesh 69. Monoculture is a distinct characteristic of
D. Apple 4. Gujarat
(a) Commercial grain farming
Codes
(b) Shifting cultivation
A B C D A B C D
(c) Subsistence farming
(a) 2 4 1 3 (b) 2 3 4 1
(d) Organic farming
(b) 3 2 1 4 (d) 4 3 1 2
70. Geothermal energy is basically
56. Which of the following is a bio-diesel plant?
(a) Non renewable (b) Renewable
(a) Jatropha (b) Rose
(c) Biotic (d) None cyclic
(c) Pepper (d) Noni
71. Largest industrial gas reserves are found in
57. Golden revolution refers to the development of
(a) Iran (b) Iraq
(a) oilseeds (b) pulses
(c) Qatar (d) Russia
(c) horticulture (d) cereals
58. Which one of the following states is the largest producer of 72. Which of the following crops are grown mostly under
black pepper in India? subsistence forming?
(a) Tamil Nadu (b) Kerala (a) Millets and Rice (b) Cotton and Tobacco
(c) Karnataka (d) Andhra Pradesh (c) Tea and Coffee (d) Vegetables and Fruits
59. Silk is mostly obtained from 73. According to area India is __ largest country in the World.
(a) Ujjain (b) Koshambi (a) 6th (b) 3rd
(c) Taxila (d) Varanasi (c) 2nd (d) 7th
60. The Kishenganga Power Project is in 74. Located in India it is largest residential university in Asia.
(a) Odisha (b) Maharashtra Name it.
(c) Gujarat (d) Jammu & Kashmir (a) Banaras Hindu University
61. Tehri dam is built on which of the following rivers? (b) Anna University
(a) Ganga (b) Brahmaputra (c) The Utkal University
(c) Bhagirathi (d) Yamuna (d) Jawaharlal Nehru University
62. Tummalapalli in Andhra Pradesh has recently come on the 75. Which is the India's largest and the oldest museum?
world map for its largest (a) Indian Museum, Kolkata
(a) uranium deposits (b) tungsten deposits (b) Salar Jung Museum, Hyderabad
(c) coal deposits (d) bauxite ore deposits (c) National Museum, New Delhi
(d) Allahabad Museum
C- 20 Geography
76. The largest revenue in India is obtained from 86. Which of the following is the highest Aravalli Peak ?
(a) Direct Taxes (b) None of these (a) None of these (b) Guru Shikhar
(c) Excise Duties (d) Sales Tax (c) Mt. K2 (d) Taragarh
77. The largest Public Sector Bank in India is 87. The largest southernmost single island in India is
(a) Indian Overseas Bank(b) State Bank of India (a) Rameswaram island
(c) Central Bank (d) Punjab National Bank (b) Great Nicobar island
78. Name the Indian Bank which is having the largest number (c) Car Nicobar island
of branches abroad : (d) Minicoy island
(a) Bank of India (b) Central Bank of India 88. The largest Zoo in India is at
(c) Indian Overseas Bank(d) State Bank of India (a) Bombay (b) Madras
79. Which of the following ports was the biggest port during (c) Kolkata (d) Delhi
the Mughal Period ? 89. Which Indian state is the largest producer of pepper ?
(a) Chittagong (b) Balasore (a) Tamil Naidu (b) Karnataka
(c) Surart (d) Hooghly (c) Andhra Pradesh (d) Kerela
80. Which of the following states has the largest representation 90. The largest coffee growing state in India is
in the Lok Sabha ? (a) Tamil Naidu (b) Maharashtra
(a) Uttar Pradesh (b) Madhya Pradesh (c) Kerela (d) Karnataka
(c) Bihar (d) Maharashtra 91. The largest food crop of India is
81. Next to Hindi, language spoken by the largest number of
(a) Gram (b) Rice
people in the Indian subcontinent is
(c) Wheat (d) Maize
(a) Tamil (b) Marathi
92. The largest coal producing state in India is
(c) Telugu (d) Bengali
(a) Bihar (b) Madhya Pradesh
82. Which of the following groups of states has the largest
(c) West Bengal (d) Orissa
deposits of iron ore ?
(a) Bihar and Orissa 93. Which state in India is the largest producer of maganese ?
(b) West Bengal and Assam (a) Madhya Pradesh (b) West Bengal
(c) Andhra Pradesh and Karnataka (c) Orissa (d) Bihar
(d) Madhya Pradesh and Maharashtra 94. Which of the following sea ports is the largest exporter of
83. Which of the following foodgrain crops occupies the largest iron ore from India ?
part of the cropped area in India ? (a) Calcutta (b) Kandla
(a) Rice (b) Wheat (c) Bombay (d) Vishakhapatnam
(c) Barley and maize (d) Jowar and bajra 95. Which of the following states in India is the largest in area ?
84. Which of the following agricultural products is the largest (a) Maharashtra (b) West Bengal
earner of foreign exchange for India ? (c) Uttar Pradesh (d) Madhya Pradesh
(a) Tea (b) Tobacco 96. The largest coconut producing state in India is
(c) Sugarcan (d) Jute (a) Karnataka
85. The largest river delta of India is of (b) Tamil Nadu
(a) Kaveri (b) Ganga (c) Andhra Pradesh
(c) Mahanadi (d) Godavari (d) Kerela
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 11 (b) 21 (c) 31 (a) 41 (b) 51 (c) 61 (c) 71 (d) 81 (d) 91 (b)
2 (c) 12 (c) 22 (b) 32 (c) 42 (d) 52 (b) 62 (a) 72 (a) 82 (a) 92 (a)
3 (c) 13 (d) 23 (c) 33 (d) 43 (d) 53 (b) 63 (b) 73 (d) 83 (a) 93 (c)
4 (c) 14 (d) 24 (d) 34 (d) 44 (b) 54 (a) 64 (c) 74 (a) 84 (a) 94 (d)
5 (d) 15 (b) 25 (d) 35 (b) 45 (c) 55 (b) 65 (b) 75 (a) 85 (b) 95 (d)
6 (a) 16 (d) 26 (c) 36 (c) 46 (d) 56 (a) 66 (b) 76 (c) 86 (b) 96 (d)
7 (a) 17 (d) 27 (a) 37 (d) 47 (b) 57 (c) 67 (c) 77 (b) 87 (d)
3 Indian Polity
President is the Supreme Commander of the Armed Forces of the Calling Attention Motion • Moved to call the attention of a
country. minister to matters of public
importance
Emergency Powers
Adjournment Motion • To draw attention of Parliament
Article 352 to 360 provides for Emergency Powers of the President. to a matter of urgent public
Emergencies envisaged under the Constitution are of 3 types: importance
• National Emergency (Art 352) which arise out of war, external • Motion needs the support of 50
aggression or armed rebellion. members for admission.
• President's Rule (Art 356 & 365) which is due to failure of • Rajya Sabha cannot move this
Constitutional Machinery in the State. motion.
• Financial Emergency (Art 360), If the President is satisfied No Confidence Motion • Moved to prove the confidence
that there is an economic situation in which the financial of Lok Sabha in the Council of
stability or credit of India is threatened. Ministers
• No Confidence Motion needs the
Election of Lok Sabha
support of 50 members to be
• Members of Lok Sabha are directly elected by the People. admitted
• Total membership is fixed at 552 by the Constitution. • Can be moved only in Lok Sabha.
Indian Polity C- 23
Privileges of Parliament
ORDINARY BILL MONEY BILL FINANCIAL BILL CONSTITUTIONAL
AMENDMENT BILL
Can be introduced in either Only in Lok Sabha Only in Lok Sabha in either house of Parliament
house of Parliament
Does not need President Need President Need President Does not need President
recommendation for recommendation for recommendation for recommendation for
introduction (except u/A 3) introduction introduction introduction
Joint Session of the House • He can be removed by an order of President only on the
grounds of proved misbehavior or incapacity.
• At a joint sitting of two Houses, the Speaker of the Lok
• The Judges are 'Public Servants' and can be prosecuted for
Sabha and in his absence, the Deputy Speaker of the House,
criminal misconduct.
or if he is also absent, Deputy Chairman of the Council and
• Seat of the SC is in New Delhi. However it can be shifted
if he is also absent, such person as may be determined by
elsewhere in India or more benches of SC can be established
the members present in the sitting presides. Lok Sabha by
in India by CJI in consultation with the President.
its numerical majority prevails over the joint sitting.
• This provision does not apply to Money Bill. There cannot Legislative Assembly (Vidhan Sabha)
be a joint sitting for Constitution Amendment Bills. Nor do • It is the popular House of the State. Members are chosen
such Bills require previous sanction of President. by direct election on the basis of adult suffrage from
• President cannot summon a joint sitting if the bill has lapsed territorial constituencies (Article 170).
by reason of a dissolution of Lok Sabha. • Their no. of members varies between 60 and 500. However
certain States like Sikkim, Goa, Mizoram and Arunachal
Attorney General of India (Article 76) Pradesh have less than 60 members.
• Appointed by the President and hold office during the
Centre-State Relations
pleasure of President.
• He is the first Law officer of the Government of India. • The distribution of powers is an essential feature of
federalism. A federal constitution establishes the dual polity
• He is the only person who is not a member of Parliament, with the union at the centre and the states at the periphery,
yet can take part in its proceedings (without a right to vote). each endowed with the sovereign powers to be exercised in
Appointment and Removal of Judges the field assigned to them respectively by the constitution.
The one is not subordinate to the other in its own field; the
• The CJI is appointed by the President. In this matter, the authority of one is co-ordinate with the other.
President shall consult such judges of the SC and the High • In the Indian federal set-up the constitution divides powers
Courts as he may deem necessary. A 9 judge bench of the between centre and states as:-
SC has laid down that the senior most judge of Supreme • Legislative
Court should be appointed as CJI. • Administrative
• In the appointment of other judges, the President shall • Financial
always consult the CJI. He 'may' consult other judges of SC
and High Courts as he may deem necessary [Article 124(2)] Legislative Relations
• Power of appointment is exercised by the President on the • Article 245(1) of the constitution of India provides that the
advice of council of ministers. Parliament has power to make laws for the whole or any part
• There is no fixed period of office for SC judges. Once of territory of India. This includes not only the states but
appointed, they hold office till the age of 65 years. He can also the UTs or any other area, for the time being included
quit office earlier by submitting his resignation to the in the territory of India. It also possesses the power of
President. 'Extra-Territorial Legislation' which no State Legislature
possesses.
C- 24 Indian Polity
• In distributing the subject matters between centre and Important Subjects in Various Lists
states, our constitution makers followed Canadian scheme. Union List (List I)
However they added one more list to it, Concurrent List. 1. Atomic energy and mineral resources.
(GoI Act 1935 had 3 fold enumeration - Federal, Provincial 2. Extradition.
and Concurrent) 3. Banking.
1. Union List - 97 subjects 2. State List - 66 subjects 4. Insurance.
5. Stock exchanges and futures markets.
3. Concurrent List -52 subjects
6. Patents, inventions and designs; copyright; trade-marks
• Subjects mentioned in the Union List are of national and merchandise marks.
importance and only Parliament is competent to make laws 7. Census.
on these subjects. 8. Corporation tax.
• Under Article 256, Parliament is empowered to make laws 9. Any other matter not enumerated in List II or List III
w.r.t. all matters in the State list when there is failure of including any tax no mentioned in either of those Lists.
constitutional machinery of the State under Article 356. State List (List II)
• In normal times, there are constitutional provisions which 1. Public order.
ensure the control of the union over the states. 2. Local Government.
3. Public health and sanitation.
• Under Article 258 (1), Parliament with the consent of the 4. Libraries, museums and other similar institutions.
State government can entrust to it any matter falling with in 5. Agriculture.
the executive powers of the Union. 6. Fisheries.
• State government has also the power to delegate its 7. Gas and gas-works.
functions to the Union and its officers. Article 258 (A) 8. Markets and fairs.
provides that Governor of the State with the consent of 9. Captivation taxes.
GoI, entrust to the Government, such functions to which Concurrent List (List III)
the executive power of State extends. 1. Criminal law.
2. Criminal procedure.
• These relations are related to the distribution of taxes as
3. Preventive detention.
well as non-tax revenue and the Power of borrowing. Grant- 4. Marriage and divorce.
in-aid forms an important part of centre-state relations. 5. Transfer of property other than agricultural land.
Distribution of Taxes 6. Contracts.
7. Civil procedure.
Taxes Belongin g to Taxes Belonging to States
8. Contempt of court, but not including contempt of the
Union Exclusively Exclusively
Supreme Court.
1. Customs 1. Land Revenue. 9. Prevention of cruelty to animals.
2. Corporation 2. Stamp duty except in 10. Economic and social planning.
documents included in 11. Legal, medical and other professions.
the Union List. 12. Electricity.
13. Archaeological sites.
3. Taxes on Capital 3. Succession duty, estate
Values of assets of duty and income tax on Election Commission
Individuals and Cos. agricultural land. • It is a permanent and an independent body established by
the constitution of India directly to ensure free and fair
4. Surcharge on 4. Taxes on Passengers and
elections in the country.
Income Tax. goods carried on inland
• Elections to Parliament, State legislatures, President and
waterways.
Vice-President are vested in it.
5. Fees in respect of 5. Taxes on lands and • Qualifications of Voters, preparation of electoral rolls,
matters in U nion buildings, mineral rights. delimitation of constituencies, allocation of seats in
List. parliament and state legislatures.
6. Taxes on animals and • Not concerned with the elections to Panchayats and
boats, road vehicles, on Municipalities in the states. For this, the constitution of
advertisements, India (Art 243K and 243 AZ) provides for a separate State
electricity, luxuries and Election Commission.
amusements, etc. • Election commission shall consist of Chief Election
7. Taxes on the entry of Commissioner and such number of other Election
goods. Commissioners, as the President from time to time fix.
8. Sales tax. • Chief Election Commissioner and other Election
Commissioners have equal powers and receive equal salary,
9. Tolls. allowances and other perquisites.
10. On matters in the State • Term six years or until they attain the age of 65 years,
List. whichever is earlier.
11. On profession, trade etc • Powers and functions can be classified into three categories
as Administrative, Advisory and Quasi-Judicial.
(not exceeding ` 2,500
• Register political parties for the purpose of elections grant
per annum (Li st II). them the status of National or State Parties on the basis of
their poll performance.
Indian Polity C- 25
EXERCISE
1. Nationalist demand for a Constituent Assembly was 10. The name of the Union given in the Constitution is:
conceded by the British through: (a) Hindustan or Bharatavarsha
(a) Cripps Proposals (b) India or Hindustan
(b) August Offer (c) India or Bharat
(c) Cabinet Mission Plan (d) Bharatadesh or India
(d) Act of 1935 11. ‘Union of India’ includes :
2. Constituent Assembly which framed India’s Constitution I. States
was set up by:
II. Union Territories
(a) Indian Independence Act
III. Acquired Territories
(b) Government of India Act, 1935
(a) I only (b) II only
(c) Cabinet Mission Plan - 1946
(c) I and II (d) I, II and III
(d) Queen’s Proclamation
12. Old name of which state/ Union Territory is wrong?
3. Members of the Constituent Assembly were:
(a) Directly elected by the people (a) Karnataka - Mysore
(b) Nominated by Indian (b) Tamil Nadu - Madras
National Congress and the Muslim League (c) Lakshadweep - Laccadive,
(c) Indirectly elected by Minicoy and Amindivi Islands
Provincial Assemblies (d) Meghalaya - Eastern Hill Province
(d) Nominated by the British Government 13. Citizenship Act, 1955 was amended to confer citizenship by
4. Constituent Assembly made decisions by: birth on those who were born on or after January 26, 1950
(a) majority vote (b) 2/3 majority but before June 30, 1987. The cut-off date was included as:
(c) Consensus (d) Unanimously (a) there were refugees from Sri Lanka and Bangladesh
5. Constitutional Adviser to Constituent Assembly was: (b) African nations were expelling Indian settlers
(a) Sachchidanand Sinha (c) fake applications were being received
(b) B. N. Rao (d) Indians were migrating from Burma
(c) Gopalaswamy Ayyangar 14. What does not explain the reason for the rights included in
(d) R. N. Kunzru Part III of the Constitution being called ‘fundamental’?
6. Which features and source are WRONGLY matched? I. They are available to both citizens and aliens.
(a) Judicial review - British practice II. They are above ordinary law.
(b) Concurrent List - Australian Constitution III. They are fundamental to governance.
(c) Directive Principles - Irish Constitution IV. They are not absolute.
(d) Fundamental Rights - US Constitution (a) II and IV (b) I, II and III
7. Constitution was adopted and enacted by the: (c) I, III and IV (d) III and IV
(a) Constituent Assembly 15. Fundamental Right to ... has been deleted by the ...
(b) People of India Amendment Act.
(c) Indian Parliament (a) form associations; 44th
(d) British Parliament (b) property; 44th
8. What facts emerges from the Preamble?
(c) against exploitation; 42nd
I. When the Constitution was enacted
(d) private property; 42nd
II. Ideals that were to be achieved .
16. Right to Constitutional Remedies are available to:
III. System of government
(a) only citizens of India
IV. Source of authority
(a) II, III and IV (b) I and II (b) all persons in case of infringement of a fundamental
right
(c) I, II and III (d) I, II, III and IV
9. Which statements about the Preamble are correct? (c) any person for enforcing a fundamental rights
conferred on all
(a) It is unenforceable by law
(b) Supreme Court has ruled that the Preamble is not a (d) an aggrieved individual alone
part of the Constitution 17. Which writ is called the bulwark of personal freedom?
(c) Preamble has been amended twice (a) Mandamus (b) Habeas corpus
(d) All of the above (c) Quo warranto (d) Prohibition
C- 26 Indian Polity
18. Regarding equality before law, the Indian Constitution (a) I only (b) II only
makes exceptions in the case of : (c) I and II (d) I, II and III
(a) President or a Governor 26. Proclamation of national emergency automatically suspends
(b) Foreign sovereigns only (a) all fundamental rights
(c) President only (b) right to freedom
(d) None of the above
(c) right to constitutional remedies
19. Censorship of the press is :
(d) no fundamental right
(a) prohibited by the Constitution
27. Enforcement of Directive Principles depends on :
(b) judged by test of reasonableness
(a) Courts
(c) restriction on freedom of the press mentioned in
Article 19 (b) Effective opposition in the Parliament
(d) specified in Article 31 of the Constitution (c) Resources available to the Government
20. Freedom of speech and expression are restricted by the (d) Public cooperation
Constitution on grounds of: 28. If the State implements a Directive Principle calling for
I. defamation equitable distribution of material resources it:
II. contempt of court (a) is put in the Ninth Schedule
III. protecting scheduled tribes (b) is not void even if it violates the rights in Articles 14
IV. friendly relations with foreign states and 19
(a) I, II and III (b) II, III and IV (c) can be struck down by the Supreme Court on grounds
(c) I and IV (d) I, II and IV of violating Fundamental Rights
21. Constitution permits preventive detention but stipulates (d) is not void if it violates a fundamental right
that: 29. Fundamental Duties were included in the Constitution to:
(a) no one should be detained beyond three months (a) Give more importance to the Fundamental Rights
unless an Advisory Board auth orises further
(b) Stop subversive and un-constitutional activities
detention.
(c) Prevent abuse of Fundamental Rights
(b) grounds for detention should be conveyed to the
person before arresting him (d) Give more power to the executive
(c) the person must be produced before a magistrate within 30. Fundamental Duties:
24 hours of the arrest I. were introduced by the 44th Amendment
(d) All of the above II. are incorporated in Part III- A
22. Right against exploitation prohibits children below: III. are not justiciable
(a) 14 years from working in family businesses (a) I and II (b) I and III
(b) 14 years of age from working in hazardous occupations (c) II and III (d) III only
(c) 14 years from working on family farms 31. Fundamental Duties of a citizen EXCLUDE:
(d) All of the above (a) Promoting communal harmony
23. ______ can impose reasonable restrictions on Fundamental (b) Developing a scientific temper
Rights of Indians?
(c) safeguarding public property
(a) Supreme Court
(d) protecting children from hazardous work
(b) Parliament
32. Which are among the Fundamental Duties in the
(c) President on the advice of the Council of Ministers
Constitution?
(d) None of these as restrictions are provided in the
Constitution I. To preserve the heritage of our composite culture.
24. In case of proclamation of Emergency due to war or external II. To abide by the Constitution.
aggression: III. To strive for excellence in scientific research.
(a) Fundamental rights are automatically suspended IV. To render national service.
(b) Right to move a court for enforcement of funda-mental (a) I, II and III (b) I and II
right is suspended (c) I, II and IV (d) II, III and IV
(c) President may order the suspension of any 33. The President takes an oath before taking office in the
fundamental right except Article 20-21 presence of Chief Justice of India. If the Chief Justice is not
(d) Parliament may authorise suspension of all fundamental available, he takes the oath in the presence of the:
rights (a) Vice-President
25. Fundamental Rights in Indian Constitution places limitations (b) senior-most judge of the Supreme Court
on the powers of the:
(c) Attorney-General
I. Executive II. Legislature
(d) Election Commissioner
III. Individuals
Indian Polity C- 27
34. Disputes about election of the President and Vice-President 43. Position of the Vice-president of India matches that of the
are settled by the: Vice-president of:
(a) Supreme Court (a) USA (b) Russia
(b) Election Commission (c) Italy (d) New Zealand
(c) Parliamentary Committee 44. If the Chairman of Rajya Sabha becomes acting President,
(d) Combined bench of Supreme Court and High Courts his duties as a Chairman are performed by:
35. Where can impeachment proceedings against the President (a) Continues as Chairman
are initiated? (b) A newly elected Chairman
(a) In Lok Sabha (c) Deputy Chairman
(b) Joint sitting of the two Houses called for this purpose (d) Member of Rajya Sabha deputed by the Chairman
(c) In either House of Parliament 45. President may the following except the:
(d) In the Supreme Court (a) Prime Minister (b) Governor
36. Vice-President’s letter of resignation is addressed to: (c) High Court judges (d) Chairman of Rajya Sabha
(a) Deputy Chairman of Rajya Sabha 46. Post of the Prime Minister of India:
(b) Chief Justice of India (a) is based on conventions
(c) President of India (b) has been created by the Parliament
(d) Speaker of the Lok Sabha (c) has been created by the Constitution
37. The President sends his resignation letter to: (d) is less powerful than that of the President
(a) Chief Justice of India 47. Council of Ministers has to resign if it loses the confidence
(b) Speaker of:
(c) Vice-President (a) Parliament (b) either House or Parliament
(d) Prime Minister (c) Rajya Sabha (d) Lok Sabha
38. An election to fill a vacancy in the office of Vice-President 48. Ministers are individually responsible to the:
occurring due to death, resignation or removal, has to be (a) President (b) Lok Sabha
held : (c) Prime Minister
(a) within six months of the vacancy (d) House of which they are members
(b) within a year of the vacancy 49. Ministers can be chosen from:
(c) as soon as possible I. Lok Sabha
(d) after expiration of the term if the remaining period is II. Rajya Sabha
less than three months III. Outside the Parliament
39. Legislative powers of the President EXCLUDES the power (a) I only (b) II only
to: (c) I and II (d) I, II and III
(a) summon or prorogue the Houses of Parliament 50. In case of resignation or death of the Prime Minister:
(b) call a joint sitting of the Houses to resolve deadlocks (a) Council of Ministers is dissolved
(c) nominate 12 members to the Lok Sabha (b) General elections are held
(d) address either House at any time (c) Cabinet elects another leader
40. If there vacancy in the offices of both President and Vice- (d) Lok Sabha is dissolved
President, who function as President? 51. Salary and perks of the Prime Minister are decided by the:
(a) Chief Justice of India (a) Constitution (b) Cabinet
(b) Chief Justice of the Delhi High Court. (c) Parliament (d) President
(c) Any person appointed by Parliament 52. Policy of the Government is shaped by:
(d) All of the Above (a) Ministers
41. An ordinance promulgated by the President : (b) Prime Minister
(a) has an indefinite life (c) Cabinet
(b) effective only if the Lok Sabha is dissolved (d) Special Committees
(c) must be laid before the Parliament when it meets. 53. Prime Minister is a channel of communication between the
(d) is a parallel power of legislation available to the President and the Council of Ministers from:
President even when Parliament is in session (a) Convention (b) Statute
42. In the matter of State legislation, the President may: (c) Article - 78 (d) Article - 75
(a) exercise only suspensive veto power 54. The Prime Minister:
(b) withhold assent to any bill sent for his consideration (a) is head of the government
except money bills (b) is the leader of Lok Sabha
(c) withhold his assent to any bill sent to him (c) can change the portfolios of Ministers
(d) disallow any bill which is anti-national (d) all of the above
C- 28 Indian Polity
55. Which is/are correct about the office of Attorney-General 63. Chief executive head of a State is:
of India? (a) Governor (b) President
I. He is a member of the Cabinet. (c) Chief Minister (d) Prime Minister
II. He can address either House of Parliament and vote. 64. A Governor must be:
III. He must have qualification of a judge of the Supreme I. a citizen of India II. of 30 years
Court.
III. not be a Member of Parliament or State Legislature
IV. Salary of Attorney General is fixed by Parliament.
(a) I and II (b) I, II and III
(a) II and IV (b) I, II and IV
(c) I only (d) I and III
(c) III only (d) III and IV
65. A Governor holds office:
56. A joint sitting of the Parliament is called:
(a) for five years
I. During national emergency.
(b) for a period specified by the Parliament
II. To pass a Constitutional Amendment.
III. When financial matters/bill is rejected by the other house. (c) during the pleasure of the President
(a) I and III (b) II and III (d) till he has the confidence of the Parliament
(c) I, II and III (d) None of these 66. In appointing a Governor, the President consults the Chief
57. Charged expenditure is: Minister of the State as this is:
(a) expenditure from the Consolidated Fund of India which (a) Constitutionally imperative
is non-votable (b) A convention
(b) expenditure incurred for making payment (c) As Parliament has legislated to the effect
(c) expenditure that the President incurs independently. (d) A duty of the President
(d) money required to meet expenditure from the 67. Ordinances issued by a Governor are subject to:
Consolidated Fund of India (a) Parliamentary approval
58. Privileges of the members of Parliament include: (b) State Legislature approval.
(a) Freedom from arrest in all cases (c) President
(b) Freedom of attendance as witness if Parliament is in (d) None of the above
session 68. Which of the following is a discretionary powers of the
(c) Total freedom of speech Governor?
(d) All of the above I. Selecting a chief minister if no single party has a clear
59. All income received by the Government are deposited in: majority.
(a) Consolidated Funds of India II. Dismissing the ministry at any time.
(b) Public Accounts of India III. Reserving a bill for the President.
(c) Contingency Fund of India (a) I and III (b) I and II
(d) Either (a) or (b)
(c) III only (d) I, II and III
60. Members of Rajya Sabha are:
69. Contingency Fund of a State is operated by the:
(a) Elected indirectly
(a) President (b) Chief Minister
(b) All are nominated
(c) Governor (d) Council of Ministers
(c) Elected both directly and indirectly
70. Council of Ministers in a State is to
(d) Elected by members of State Legislative assemblies
and Legislative Councils (a) The Houses 01, the State Legislature
61. A dissolution does not affect: (b) Parliament
(a) a bill that originated in the Rajya Sabha and is with Lok (c) Governor
Sabha the President calls upon it to do so (d) Legislative Assembly
(b) Rajya Sabha passes a resolution by simple majority 71. Vidhan Sabha is:
that it is necessary in national interest (a) the upper house of State Legislature
(c) Speaker certifies the need (b) indirectly elected
(d) there is a national emergency (c) subject to dissolution
62. Parliament controls the financial system NOT BY? (d) unimportant at State level
(a) Authorizing collection of taxes 72. Members of Legislative Council are appointed through:
(b) Money can be withdrawn from the Consolidated Fund I. Direct elections
of India only if the Parliament sanctions it.
II. Indirect elections
(c) Through financial com-mittees that scrutinize
III. Nomination
Government expenditure
(a) I and II (b) II and III
(d) It causes the Budget to be laid before itself
(c) I, II and III (d) I and III
Indian Polity C- 29
73. For enactment of a law, the State Legislative Council: 82. Which statement about the State Finance Commission is
(a) has to pass the bill incorrect?
(b) may delay it for a maximum of four months (a) It reviews financial status of Municipalities
(c) may disagree to, its provisions, if a joint sitting is called (b) It recommends measures to augment Consolidated
(d) has nothing to do with the bill Fund of a State to add to resources of the Municipalities
74. Membership of the Legislative Assembly varies between (c) It makes recommendations about distribution between
60 and 500, but the exception is in: the State and Panchayats of net proceeds of taxes
I. Pondicherry (d) It recommends taxes, duties and tolls that may be
II. Mizoram assigned to the Municipalities
III. Goa 83. There should be Ward Committees for municipalities with a
(a) I and II (b) II and III population of:
(c) II only (d) I, II and III (a) One lakh (b) Three lakh
75. Limitations on authority of the State Legislature EXCLUDES: (c) Ten lakh (d) Twenty lakh
(a) Parliament’s authority to make laws on subjects in the 84. Regarding reservation of seats on Panchayats and
State List during an Emergency Municipalities, it would INCORRECT to say:
(b) Parliament’s authority to make laws on state subjects (a) Seats are reserved for SC/ST in proportion to their
if Rajya Sabha passes a resolution number
(c) Governor’s discretionary power to dissolve the (b) At least 1/3 of total number of seats are filled by direct
legislature elections and are reserved for women
(d) Governors power to reserve bills for consideration of (c) Reservations for SC/ST are effective till 2010
the President (d) Unreserved seats cannot be contested by women
76. J&K Constitution was framed by: 85. Self-governing institutions for ar-eas designated as urban
(a) Constituent Assembly which framed India’s area are:
Constitution (a) Nagar Palika (b) Nagar Panchayat
(b) Constituent Assembly set up by the Parliament (c) Ward Committee (d) Municipal Council
(c) Constituent Assembly set up by the State 86. Direct elections to all tiers of the Panchayat were held first
(d) The State Legislature after the 73rd Amendment came into force in ____?
77. Proclamation of emergency by the President: (a) Andhra Pradesh (b) Rajasthan
(a) Cannot apply to J&K (c) Karnataka (d) Madhya Pradesh
(b) Is effective in J&K only with concurrence of the State 87. 73rd and 74th Amendment Acts:
Legislature (a) Came into force on being passed by the Parlia-ment
(c) Apply to J&K after endorse-ment by the Governor (b) Both came into force in June, 1993
(d) Has to be separately issued (c) Had to be ratified by more than half the states
78. List of items reserved for the Panchayats are given in the: (d) Have not been ratified by the required number of states
(a) Eleventh Schedule (b) Twelfth Schedule 88. Union Territories are administered by the:
(c) Seventh Schedule (d) State List (a) Parliament
79. A person should be ___ years to stand in a panchayat (b) Union Council of Ministers
election. (c) President through administrators
(a) 21 years (b) 18 years (d) Prime Minister
(c) 25 years (d) 30 years 89. If the Governor of a State is appointed administrator of a
80. State Election Commissioner can be removed from office: Union Territory, he exercises his functions
(a) only by the Governor (a) on advice of his Council of Ministers
(b) in the same manner and grounds as a Judge of the (b) independently of Council of Ministers
Supreme Court
(c) according to Parliament’s directions
(c) only the President on the advice of the Chief Justice of
(d) on the directions of the State Legislature
the state
90. District Council in autonomous tribal areas:
(d) in the same manner as the Vice President of India
I. may collect land revenue
81. Electorate for a Panchayat is at:
II. are independent of State Governments
(a) Taluka board
III. must get their laws endorsed by the President
(b) all adults of 21 years and above in a village
IV. have no law making power
(c) village and selected Members of Parliament and State
Legislature (a) I and II (b) I and III
(d) Gram Sabha (c) I only (d) III only
C- 30 Indian Polity
91. Provisions about administration of SC/ST : 96. One-third of the members of Rajya Sabha retire every
(a) may be altered by the Governor (a) year (b) two years
(b) may be altered by Parliament with 2/3 majority (c) three years (d) six years
(c) can not be altered 97. Term of Rajya Sabha was fixed by the:
(d) altered by the Parliament by ordinary legislation (a) President (b) Constitution
92. Union Territory with a High Court is/are: (c) Parliament (d) Cabinet
(a) Delhi (b) Pondicherry and Delhi 98. Deputy Chairman of the Rajya Sabha is:
(c) Pondicherry (d) Chandigarh (a) nominated by the Chairman
93. Judges of the Supreme Court take an oath or affirmation (b) elected by the Parliament
before entering upon office conducted by (c) nominated by the President
(a) Chief Justice of India (d) elected by the Rajya Sabha from its members
(b) President or Vice-President 99. If an unqualified or disqualified person attends and votes
(c) President or some person appointed by him in either house of the Parliament:
(d) None of the above (a) he is prosecuted and jailed
94. To whom does a judge of the Supreme Court address his (b) he is fined ` 500 per day of his sitting
resignation? (c) he may be imprisoned
(a) Chief Justice of India (d) Nothing can be done
(b) Prime Minister 100. When a resolution for removal of Speaker is under
(c) President consideration, he:
(d) Union Law Minister I. does not participate in the proceedings.
95. Power of judicial review ensures: II. has no right to vote.
(a) Supremacy of the Supreme Court III. has the right to reply.
(b) That Supreme Court can review its own judgments (a) I only (b) I and II
(c) Constitutionality of laws (c) II only (d) III only
(d) Justice by subordinate courts
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 11 (a) 21 (a) 31 (d) 41 (c) 51 (c) 61 (b) 71 (c) 81 (d) 91 (d)
2 (c) 12 (d) 22 (b) 32 (c) 42 (b) 52 (d) 62 (d) 72 (b) 82 (b) 92 (a)
3 (c) 13 (a) 23 (b) 33 (b) 43 (a) 53 (d) 63 (a) 73 (b) 83 (b) 93 (c)
4 (c) 14 (c) 24 (c) 34 (a) 44 (c) 54 (d) 64 (d) 74 (d) 84 (d) 94 (a)
5 (b) 15 (b) 25 (a) 35 (b) 45 (d) 55 (c) 65 (c) 75 (c) 85 (b) 95 (c)
6 (a) 16 (c) 26 (b) 36 (c) 46 (c) 56 (d) 66 (b) 76 (c) 86 (d) 96 (b)
7 (c) 17 (b) 27 (c) 37 (c) 47 (d) 57 (a) 67 (b) 77 (b) 87 (c) 97 (c)
8 (d) 18 (a) 28 (b) 38 (c) 48 (a) 58 (b) 68 (a) 78 (a) 88 (c) 98 (d)
9 (a) 19 (b) 29 (b) 39 (c) 49 (d) 59 (d) 69 (b) 79 (a) 89 (b) 99 (b)
10 (c) 20 (d) 30 (d) 40 (a) 50 (a) 60 (a) 70 (d) 80 (b) 90 (a) 100 (d)
CHAPTER
4 Miscellaneous
IMPORTANT DATE OF THE YEAR 26 September : CSIR Foundation Day, Day of the Deaf
9 January : NRI Day 1 October : International Day for the Elderly (UN)
15 January : Army Day 2 October : Gandhi Jayanti, International Non-violence Day
26 January : Indian Republic Day Human Rights Protection Day
Jammu & Kashmir Day Prisoner's Day
International Customs Day World Ostony Day
28 January : Birth Anniversary of Lala Lajpat Rai World Wide Life Week (2-8)
30 January : Martyr's Day, Mahatma Gandhi's 3 October : World Nature Day, World Habitat Day
8 March : International Women's Day 6 October : World Wildlife Day
Mothers Day 8 October : Indian Air force Day
13 March : No Smoking Day Rapid Action Force Raising Day
15 March : World Consumer Rights Day, 9 October : National Postal Week (9-14)
22 March : World Water Day 12 October : World Sight Day
23 March : World Meteorological Day 16 October : World Anaesthesiologists Day
24 March : World TB Day World Food Day
31 March : Financial Year Ending 9 November : Legal Services Day
1 April : Fools Day Pravasiya Bharatiya Divas/Legal Services Day
13 April : Jallianwallah Bagh Massacre Day (1919) Uttaranchal State Formation Day
14 April : B.R. Ambedkar Remembrance Day; 10 November : Forest Martyrs Day
18 April : World Heritage Day Transport Day
22 April : World Earth Day 11 November : Armistice Day
24 April : World Lab Animals Day Education Day
25 April : National Administrative Professionals Day Countries; their Capitals and Currencies
29 April : World Intellectual Property Day
9 May : World Thalassaemia Day Country Capital Currency
11 May : National Resurgence Day Afghanistan Kabul Afgani
National Technology Day Argentina Buenos Aires Peso
12 May : International Nurses Day, Australia Canaberra Australian Dollar
World Hypertension Day Bangladesh Dhaka Taka
1 June : International Children's Day, Belgium Brussels Euro
World Milk Day Bhutan Thimpu Ngultrum
3 June : World Naturist Day Brazil Brasilia Real
5 June : World Environment Day Brunei Bandar Seri Brunei Dollar
14 June : World Blood Donere Day Begawan
23 June : International Olympic Day Cambodia Phnom Penh Riel
2 July : World Sports Journalists Day Canada Ottawa Canadian Dollar
11 July : World Population Day Chile Santiago Peso
26 July : Kargil Victory Day China Beijing Renmminbi Yuan
6 August : Hiroshima Day Cuba Havana Cuban Peso
8 August : World Senior Citizen's Day East Timor Dili US Dollar
12 August : International Youth Day Egypt Cairo Egyptian Pound
Librarians Day Iceland Reykjavik Krona
15 August : India's Independence Day India New Delhi Rupee
West Bengal Day Indonesia Jakarta Rupiah
26 August : Women's Equality Day Iran Tehran Rial
29 August : National Sports Day Iraq Baghdad Iraqi Dinar
5 September : Teacher's Day Ireland Dublin Euro
7 September : Forgiveness Day Israel Jerusalem Shekel
8 September : International Literacy Day (UNESCO) Japan Tokyo Yen
World Literacy Day Kenya Nairobi Shiling
14 September : Hindi Day, World First Aid Day North Korea Pyongyang Won
C- 32 Miscellaneous
South Korea Seoul Won Chandrakanta Devki Nandan Khatri
Kuwait Kuwait city Kuwaiti Dinar Devadasa, Charitrahin Sharatchandra Chattopadhyay
Kyrgyzstan Bishkek Som Mother Maxim Gorki
Laos Vientiane Kip Mein Kemph Adolf Hitler
Malaysia Kuala Lumpur Ringgit A Pasage to India E M Foster
Maldives Male Rufiyaa War and Peace Leo Tolstoy
Mauritius Port Louis Mauritius Rupee The Insider P V Narsimha Rao
Mexico Mexico City Mexican Peso Ignited Minds A P J Abdul Kalam
Morocco Rabat Dirham The God of Small things Arundhati Roy
Myanmar Yangon (Rangoon) Kyat A Suitable Boy, Golden Gate Vikram Seth
Nepal Kathmandu Nepalese Rupee Long Walk to Freedom Nelson Mandela
Portugal Lisbon Euro Half a life V S Naipaul
Qatar Doha Riyal Lajja Taslima Nasrin
Russia Moscow Rouble Satanik Verses Salman Rushdie
Soudi Arabia Riyadh Rial
South Africa Pretoria Rand UN and its Specialized Agencies
Spain Madrid Euro
Sri Lanka Colombo Sri Lankan Rupee Organization Year of Headquarters
Sweden Stockholm Krona Establishment
Switzerland Berne Swiss Franc United Nations (UN) Oct 24, 1945 New York
Syria Damascus Syrian Pound International Atomic July 29, 1957 Vienna (Austria)
Tajikistan Dushanbe Somoni Energy Agency (IAEA)
Thailand Bangkok Baht Food and Agriculture Oct 16, 1945 Rome (Italy)
Tanzania Dodoma Shilling Organization (FAO)
Turkey Ankara Lira United Nations Nov 4, 1946 Paris (France)
Turkmenistan Askhabad Manat Educational, Scientific
United Arab Abu Dhabi Dirham and Cultural Organization
Emirates (UAE) (UNESCO)
United Kingdom London Pound Sterling World Health July 22, 1946 Geneva
(UK) Organization (WHO) (Switzerland)
United States of Washington DC Dollar International Labour April 11, 1919 Geneva
America (USA) Organization (ILO) (Switzerland)
Uzbekistan Tashkent Som International Finance July, 1956 Washington DC
Vietnam Hanoi Dong Corporation (IFC)
Yemen Sana’s Riyal International Civil Dec, 1944 Montreal (Canada)
Aviation Organization
Important Books and Authors (ICAO)
Book Author Universal Postal Union July 1, 1875 Berne
(UPU) (Switzerland)
Panchatantra Vishnu Sharma World Meteorological 1951 Geneva
Buddhacharita Ashvaghosha Organization (WMO) (Switzerland)
Kadambari Banabhatta International Maritime March, 1948 London (Britain)
Shahnama Firdausi Organization (IMO)
Sursagar Surdas World Intellectual 1967 Geneva
Mudrarakshasha Vishakhadatta Property Organization (Switzerland)
Bhagawat Gita, Mahabharat Vedvyas (WIPO)
Rajtarangini Kalhana
Arthashashtra Chankaya (Kautilya) Other International Organizations
Abhijnan Shakuntalam, Kalidasa
Raghuvansham Organization Year of Headquarters No. of
Gitagovinda Jayadev Establish- Member
Uttarramcharitta Bhavbhuti ment States
Padmavat Mallik Mohammad Jayasi Arab League 1945 Cairo (Egypt) 22
Geetanjali, Gora Ravindranath Tagore African Union 1963 Addis Ababa 53
Indian Philosophy Dr S Radhakrishnan (Ethiopia)
Kamayani Jaishankar Prasad Asia-Pacific Economic 1989 Singapore 21
Bharat-Bharti Maithilisharan Gupta Cooperation (APEC)
Yama Mahadevi Verma Asian Development 1966 Manila 59
Anamika, Parimal Suryakant Tripathi Nirala Bank (ADB) (Philippines)
Godan, Gaban, Rangbhoomi, Premchand Association of 1967 Jakarta 10
Karmabhoomi South-East Asian (Indonesia)
Chidambara Sumitranandan Pant Nations (ASEAN)
Kurukshetra, Urvashi Ramdhari Singh ‘Dinkar’ Commonwealth 1931 London (Britain) 53
Malgudi Days, Guide R K Narayan European Union (EU) 1991 Brussels (Belgium) 27
Miscellaneous C- 33
Commonwealth 1991 Kirava (Belarus) 12 • Booker Prize has been renamed as Man Booker Prize.
of Independent States Oscar Awards
(CIS)
G-8 (Group of Eight) 1975 – 8 • These awards were instituted in 1929 and conferred annually
INTERPOL 1923 Lyon (France) 184 by the Academy of Motion Pictures in USA.
North Atlantic Treaty 1949 Brussels (Belgium) 28 • These are considered the most prestigious awards in the
Organization (NATO) cinema world.
Organization of 1960 Vienna (Austria) 12 • The first Indian to get an Oscar was Bhanu Athaiya for the
Petroleum Exporting movie ‘Gandhi’.
Countries (OPEC) • Satyajit Ray was awarded Oscar for lifetime achievements in
Non-Aligned 1961 (First Conference 118 cinema in 1992.
Movement (NAM) at Belgrade)
Secretariat at Bharat Ratna
Kathmandu (Nepal) • It is the highest civilian award of India. It is presented by the
South Asian 1985 Kathmandu (Nepal) 8 Government of India.
Association for • It is presented for exceptional public service and rarest
Regional Cooperation achievements in the field of art, literature and science.
(SAARC)
• It was instituted in 1954 and the first recepient were
Awards, Honours and Prizes C Rajagopalachari, Dr Radhakrishnan and CV Raman.
• Padma Vibhushan is the second highest civilian award for
Nobel Prize
distinguished services in any field including Government
• It was instituted by the inventor of dynamite, Alfred Bernard service.
Nobel (1833-96). • Padma Bhushan and Padma Shree are the other important
• The award is given on December 10, which is the death
civilian awards.
anniversary of its founder.
• Nobel Prize is given every year to those eminent persons who Sahitya Akademy Awards
have made pioneering achievements in the field Physics, • It was instituted in 1955 and is given for any exclusive writing
Chemistry, Medicine, Peace, Literature and Economics.
in any of the 22 languages including English literature during
• Apart from Economics, all other categories have been given
since 1901. Economics Nobel Prize was instituted in 1967 and last 5 years.
was first given in 1969. Shanti Swaroop Bhatnagar Awards
Indian Nobel Prize Winners • These awards are given to the Indian scientists for their
exceptional performance.
Name Field Year
Arjuna Awards
Rabindra Nath Tagore Literature 1913
• These were instituted in 1961 and given by Sports Ministry,
Dr. C V Raman Physics 1930
Dr. Hargovind Khurana Medicine 1968 Government of India.
Mother Teresa Peace 1979 • These are given for the special achievements in different types
Dr. S Chandrashekhar Physics 1983 of sports.
Dr. Amartya Sen Economics 1999 Dronacharya Awards
V S Naipaul Literature 2001
Venkataraman Ramakrishnan Chemistry 2009 • These are given to sports coaches.
• These were instituted in 1985 and given by Sports Ministry,
Pulitzer Prize Government of India.
• It was instituted in 1917 and named after the US Publisher Rajiv Gandhi Khel Ratna
Joseph Pulitzer.
• It is conferred annually in the USA for accomplilshments in • It was instituted in 1962 and is presented for commendable
journalism, literature and music. display by the players.
* First Deputy Prime Minister - Vallabh Bhai Patel * First Prime Minister to resign without full term -
* First Doctor to receive Nobel Prize in Medicine - Morar Ji Desai
Dr.Hargovind Khurana * First Speaker of Loksabha - Ganesh Vasudeva Mavalankar
* First Education Minister - Abul Kalam Azad * First Vice President of India - Dr. S. Radhakrishnan
* First Ethnic Indian Prime Minister of Fiji -
First in India - Female
Mahendra Chaudhury
* First Field Marshal of India General - S.P.F.J. Manekshaw * First Indian Woman to Receive Lenin Peace Award
* First Foreigner to receive Bharat Ratna - Aruna Asaf Ali
Khan Abdul Gaffar Khan * First Woman Vice-Chairperson of Rajyasabha
* First Governor General of free India - Lord Mountbatten Violet Alva In 1962
* First Home Minister of India - Sardar Vallabh Bhai Patel * First Woman Session Judge in India - Anna Chandi
* First Indian Air chief Marshal - S. Mukherjee * First Woman President of Students Union
* First Indian Chess Grandmaster - S Vishwnathan Anju Sachdeva of Delhi University
* First Indian Chief Justice Justice - Hiralal J Kania * First Indian Woman to Receive Norman Borlaug Award
* First Indian Commander-in-chief General - K. M. Kariappa Dr. Amrita Patel
* First Indian Cricketer to score three centuries in three matches * First Indian Woman to Get International Grandmaster Award
successive on debut - Mohd. Azaharuddin in Chess - Bhagyasri Thipse
* First Indian Cricketer to score Triple Century in Test - * First Indian Woman IAS Officer - Anna George
Virendra Sehwag * First Indian Woman to Reach in Olympic Games -
* First Indian Judge of International Court of Justice - Shaini Abraham
Dr. Nagendra Singh * First Woman President of India - Pratibha Devisingh Patil
* First Indian Member of the viceroy's executive council - * First Woman Governor of State in India -
S.P.Sinha Mrs. Sarojini Naidu
* First Indian Naval Chief Vice Admiral - R. D. Katari * First Woman Prime Minister of India - Mrs. Indira Gandhi
* First Indian Pilot - JRD Tata * First Indian Woman to Swim Across English Channel -
* First Indian to Cross English Channel - Mihir Sen Mrs. Aarti Saha
* First Indian to get an Oscar - Bhanu Athaiya * First Indian Woman to Swim Across Strait of Gibraltar -
* First Indian to get Anderson Award - Ruskin Bond Aarti Pradhan
* First Indian to go in space Squadron Ldr. - Rakesh Sharma * First Muslim Woman to Sit on Throne of Delhi -
* First Indian to Join the ICS - Satyendra Nath Banerjee Razia Sultan
* First Indian to reach Antarctica - Lt. Ran Charan * First Woman President of Indian National Congress -
* First Indian to reach in British Parliament - Dada Bhai Naoroji Annie Besant
* First Indian to reach the deep sea floor in the Mid Atlantic - * The First Woman Chief Minister of An Indian State -
P.S. Rao Mrs. Sucheta Kriplani ( Uttar Pradesh)
* First Indian to reach the south pole - Col. I K Bajaj * First Woman Central Minister of India -
* First Indian to Receive Bharat Ratna - Dr. Radha Krishnan Rajkumari Amrit Kaur
* First Indian to receive Gyan Peeth award - * First Indian Woman to Climb The Mount Everest -
Sri Shankar Kurup Bachhendri Pal
* First Indian to receive Magsaysay Award - Vinoba Bhave * First Woman Ambassador - Mrs. Vijay Lakshmi Pandit
* First Indian to receive Nobel Prize in Economics - * First Woman to Climb Mount Everest Twice -
Dr. Amartya Sen Santosh Yadav
* First Indian to receive Stalin Prize - Saifuddin Kichlu * First Woman Judge of Supreme Court -
* First Indian to win Nobel Prize - Rabindra Nath Tagore Meera Sahib Fatima Biwi
* First Judge to face Impeachment proceedings in Loksabha - * First Woman Chief Justice of High Court - Mrs. Leela Seth
Justice V. Ramaswami * First Indian Woman Pilot in Indian Air Force -
* First Muslim President of India - Dr. Jakir Hussein Haritakaur Dayal
* First Muslim President of Indian National congress - * First Woman Air Vice Marshal - P. Bandhopadhyaya
Badruddin Tayyabji * First Woman Lieutenant General - Puneeta Arora
* First person to reach Mount Everest without Oxygen - Sherpa * First Woman Chairman of UPSC - Rose Millian Mathew
Arga Dorji * First Woman Chairperson of Indian Airlines -
* First person to receive Paramvir Chakra Sushma Chawla
- Major Somnath Sharma * First Woman to Receive Gyan peeth Award -
* First Person to resign from Central Cabinet Asha Purna Devi
- Shyama Prasad Mukharjee * First Woman to Receive Bharat Ratna - Mrs. Indira Gandhi
* First President of Indian National Congress - W.C. Banerjee * First Indian Woman to Receive Nobel Prize -
* First President of Indian Republic - Dr. Rajendra Prasad Mother Teresa
* First president to die in Office - Dr. Jakir Hussain * First Woman to Receive Ashok Chakra - Niraja Bhanot
* First Prime Minister of Free India - Pt. Jawahar Lal Nehru
* First Woman IPS Officer - Mrs. Kiran Bedi
C- 36 Miscellaneous
* First Woman Doordarshan News Reader - Pratima Puri Khantumm Mizoram
* First Woman Finger Print Experts in India - Karma Madhya Pradesh
Sita Varthambal and Bhrangathambal ( Both Were Sisters) Laho Meghalaya
* First Indian Woman to Go in Space - Kalpana Chawla Mohiniattam Kerala
* First Actress in the Indian Cinema Devika Rani Mando Goa
* First Indian Woman to Become Miss World - Reita Faria Mani puri Manipur
* First Woman Speaker of the State Assembly - Nati Himachal Pradesh
Mrs. Shano Devi Nat-Natin Bihar
Odissi Orissa
* First Indian Woman to Receive An Asiad Gold Medal -
Rauf Jammu & Kashmir
Kamalji Sandhu
Yakshagan Karnataka
* First Indian Test Tube Baby - Harsha (1986)
* First Woman Chairperson of National Woman Commission - SPORTS AND GAMES
Mrs. Jayanti Patnayak Cups & Trophies Associated with Sports
* First Woman Chairman of Exim Bank - Tarzani Vakil
International
* First Woman to Get Arjun Award - N. Lumsden (1961) * Colombo Cup : Football
* First Woman to Win Miss Universe Title - Sushmita Sen * Davis Cup : Lawn Tennis
* First Indian Woman President of UNO General Assembly * Grand National : Horse Streple Chase Race
Vijay Lakshmi Pandit * Merdeka Cup : Football
* First Woman Surgeon - Dr. Prema Mukherjee * Thomas Cup : Badminton
* First Indian Woman Barrister - Cornotia Sorabji * Uber Cup : Badminton (Women)
* First Indian Woman Advocate - Regina Guha * Rothman's Trophy : Cricket
* First Chief Justice of Mumbai High Court - * European Champions Cup : Football
Justice Sujaata B Manohar * Grand Prix : Table Tennis
* First Woman President of Indian Science Congress - * Grand Prix : Lawn Tennis
Dr. Ashima Chatterjee National
* First Deputy Governor of Reserve Bank of India - * Agha Khan Cup : Hockey
K. J. Udesi * Beighton Cup : Hockey
* First Woman Sahitya Award Winner - Amrita Pritam * Bombay Gold Cup : Hockey
* First Woman Commercial Pilot - * Deodhar Trophy : Cricket
Prem Mathur of Deccan Airways * Durand Cup : Football
* First Woman Foreign Minister - Lakshmi N Menon * Dhyan Chand Trophy : Hockey
* First Indian Woman At Antarctica - Meher Moos In 1976 * lrani Trophy : Cricket
* First Woman Chief Engineer - P. K. Tresia Nanguli * Jaswant Singh Trophy : Best Services Sportsman
* First Indian Woman to Complete Her MBBS - * MCC Trophy : Hockey
Kadambini Ganguli Bose In 1888 * Moinuddaula Gold Cup : Cricket
* First Indian Paratrooper of Indian Air Force - Nita Ghose * Murugappa Gold Cup : Hockey
* First Woman Indian Railway Driver -Surekha Shankar Yadav * Modi Gold Cup : Hockey
* The First Indian Woman Cricketer to Get 100 Wickets - * Nehru Trophy : Hockey
Diana Eduljee * Ranjit Trophy : Cricket
* First Indian Woman to Get Magsaysay Award -Kiran Bedi * Rangaswami Cup : Hockey
* First Woman Secretary General of Rajya Sabha - * Sheesh Mahal Trophy : Cricket
V. S. Rama Devi Number of Players in Sports
Cultural Panorama Sports Number of Players
Classical Folk and Tribal Dances in India Baseball 9
Polo 4
Classical Dance of India Water Polo 7
Dance State Kho Kho 9
Bharat Natyam Tamil Nadu Kabaddi 7
Bihu Assam Hockey 11
Bhangra Punjab
Football (Soccer) 11
Chhau Bihar, Orissa, W. Bengal and Jharkhand
Cricket 11
Garhwali Uttaranchal Netball 7
Garba Gujarat Volleyball 6
Hattari Karnataka Basketball 5
Kathak North India
Kathakali Kerala
Kutchipudi Andhra Pradesh
Miscellaneous C- 37
EXERCISE
1. Rosetta is a robotic spacecraft launched by the European 12. The ‘Mahajan Commission’ was constituted to look into
Space Agency to perform a detailed study of a / an _____. the border dispute between which two states?
(a) Asteroid (a) Karnataka and Andhra Pradesh
(b) Comet (b) Andhra Pradesh and Maharashtra
(c) Galaxy (c) Maharashtra and Karnataka
(d) Neutron Star (d) Karnataka and Kerala
2. ‘Aotearoa’ is an alternative name for which one of the 13. The ‘Tsukheniye’, ‘Bishu’, ‘Moatsu’ and ‘Tuluni’ are the
following entities? important festivals celebrated by the Tribal people of ?
(a) Pitcairn Island (b) Fiji (a) Tripura (b) Nagaland
(c) Assam (d) Mizoram
(c) Vanuatu (d) New Zealand
14. As per the latest Census data, which one of the following
3. According to World Health Organisation (WHO), which is states has the highest proportion of homeless population
the most polluted city in the world? in the country?
(a) Lucknow, India (a) Haryana (b) Rajasthan
(b) Beijing, China (c) Madhya Pradesh (d) Karnataka
(c) Mexico City, Mexico 15. The International Day of Persons with Disabilities observed
(d) Tokyo, Japan on _______.
4. In context to India's defence structure ‘Agni missile’ is (a) November 29 (b) December 2
_____. (c) December 3 (d) December 4
(a) Surface-to-air (b) Air-to-air 16. The ‘Panch Prayag’ which connotes the five sacred river
(c) Air-to-surface (d) Surface-to-surface confluences is in the state of ___________.
5. Tirupur in Tamil Nadu is well known for export of which of (a) Himachal Pradesh (b) Madhya Pradesh
the following items? (c) Uttarakhand (d) Andhra Pradesh
(a) Handicrafts (b) Knitted Garments 17. As per the RBI guidelines Public Sector Banks has to give
(c) Leather Products (d) Horticulture Products loans to women SHGs at the interest rate of _________.
6. Which court has become the first high court in the country (a) 5 percent (b) 6 percent
to provide court case details and other key judicial (c) 7 percent (d) 8 percent
information in public domain? 18. Who among the following is the new Chairman of the 20th
(a) Himachal Pradesh High court Law Commission of India?
(b) Bombay High court (a) Justice D K Jain
(c) Madras High court (b) Justice A P Shah
(d) Karnataka High court (c) Justice Vikram Sen
(d) Justice Gopal Gowda
7. Which among the following personalities birthday is 19. The ‘Yashsvini Health Insurance’ scheme is associated with
observed as Kisan Diwas in India? which of the following states?
(a) Chaudary Charan Singh (a) Punjab (b) Karnataka
(b) Norman Borlaug (c) Tamil Nadu (d) Andhra Pradesh
(c) M S Swamynathan 20. Which of the following has emerged as India's most
(d) Atal Bihari Vajapeyi attractive brand in banking and financial services industry
8. The ‘Sagar Thermal Power Plant’ is a proposed power plant (BFSI) category?
coming up in which state? (a) SBI (b) UCO
(a) Bihar (b) Andhra Pradesh (c) LIC (d) ICICI
(c) West Bengal (d) Odisha 21. The BASIC countries are a bloc of four larger developing
9. Which among the following is not a minority community in countries. Which one of the following is not a BASIC
India? country?
(a) Muslim (b) Christians (a) Brazil (b) Switzerland
(c) Jainism (d) Buddhists (c) India (d) China
10. Who among the following has been appointed new 22. National Education Day is observed on November 11 every
chairman of NABARD? year. Who among the following leaders is remembered on
(a) Harsh Kumar Bhanwala this occasion?
(b) Chandra Shekar (a) Dr. Sarvepalli Radhakrishnan
(c) Hemanth Banswal (b) Maulana Abdul Kalam Azad
(d) Amith Mishra (c) Swami Vivekanand
(d) Dr. Rajendra Prasad
11. Which among the following has become the first country
23. Who among the following has been appointed as first
to grant non-human personhood status to dolphin & Chairman and Managing Director of Bharatiya Mahila Bank?
whales to recognise their unique intelligence and self- (a) Arundhati Bhattacharya
awareness? (b) Usha Ananthasubramanian
(a) India (b) Mauritius (c) Geetha Kumari
(c) Sri Lanka (d) New Zealand (d) Chandrakala Subramanian
C- 38 Miscellaneous
24. Which one of the following countries is not a member of 40. On which riverbank is Goa located?
Organisation of the Petroleum Exporting Countries (OPEC)? (a) Mandovi (b) Ganga
(a) Angola (b) Indonesia (c) Gomati (d) Sabarmati
(c) Ecuador (d) Kuwait 41. The largest freshwater lake in India is ?
25. High powered money is (a) Dal Lake (b) Powai Lake
(a) Banks reserves at Central Bank (c) Wular Lake (d) Chilka Lake
(b) All loans and advances of banks 42. Dilli Chalo and Jai Hind were coined by ?
(c) Money held by banks (a) Bhagat Singh (b) Subhash Chandra Bose
(d) Currency held by public and reserves with the Central Bank (c) Gandhiji (d) Balagangadhar Tilak
26. Which amongst the following Abbreviations stands for 43. First Cyber Police Station established in India at
organization related to Indian space programme? (a) Hyderabad (b) Bangalore
(a) NASA (b) ISO (c) Kolkatta (d) Madhya
(c) ISRO (d) NSAT 44. State Bank of India was formed in
27. When is the World Population Day observed? (a) 1955 (b) 1949
(a) May 31 (b) October 4 (c) 1959 (d) 1935
(c) December 10 (d) July 11 45. The first railway line in India was opened in __ year ?
28. Which of the following statements defines the density of (a) 1854 (b) 1856
population? (c) 1857 (d) 1853
(a) Number of persons living per unit area 46. The persons who became the Chief Minister for the longest
(b) Number of persons living in a country period in India ?
(c) Change in the number of inhabitants of a country (a) E.K. Nayanar (b) Vasantha Sate
during a specific period of time (c) Jyothi Basu (d) K. Karunakaran
(d) Absolute numbers added every year. 47. India’ space Rocket Launching centre is in -
29. What does NPR stand for? (a) Wheeler Island (b) Hassan
(a) National Population Programme (c) Sri Harikota (d) Port Blair
(b) National Population Project 48. The first nuclear reactor in India is
(c) National Population Register (a) Dhruva (b) Harsha
(d) National Population Production (c) Apsara (d) Vipula
30. As per Census 2011 which of the two states have been 49. Atomic Minerals Directorate is located at
ranked first and second most populous states? (a) Mumbai (b) Bhopal
(a) Bihar and U.P. (b) Maharastra and Bihar (c) Chennai (d) Hyderabad
(c) U.P. and Bihar (d) U.P. & Maharastra 50. India’s first heavy water plant was set up in 1962 at
31. Which state in India shows the lowest population as per (a) Talcher (b) Tuticorin
Census 2011? (c) Baroda (d) Hazira
(a) Manipur (b) Sikkim 51. Which is NOT the name of the missile developed by the
(c) Pandicherry (d) Arunachal Pradesh Defense Research and Development Organisation (DRDO)?
32. Which one among the following states has the highest (a) Shaurya (b) Pinaka
gender disparity? (c) Brahmos (d) Agni
(a) Odisha (b) Uttar Pradesh 52. The National Mesosphere, Stratosphere, Troposphere
(c) Haryana (d) Maharashtra Radar Facility is located at
33. How many years the South African president Nelson (a) Bangalore (b) Thiruvananthapuram
Mandela was in prison? (c) Ahmedabad (d) Tirupathi
(a) 20 (b) 18 53. Who among the following bowlers have taken more than
(c) 19 (d) 17 500 wickets in Test Cricket?
34. The nutrient that not stored in human body is 1. Wasim Akram 2. Richard Hadlee
(a) Protein (b) Fat 3. Glen McGrath 4. Courtney Walsh
(c) Vitamin (d) None of these Select the correct answer using the code given below:
35. JEEVIKA, is the Rural Livelihoods project of which of the (a) 1 and 2 only (b) 3 and 4 only
following State Governments? (c) 1, 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
(a) West Bengal (b) Bihar 54. SERB stands for –
(c) Punjab (d) Uttar Pradesh (a) Social Enlightenment and Research Board
36. Who was the first person to address the United Nations in (b) Scientific and Engineering Research Board
Hindi?
(c) Scientists’ and Engineers’ Research Board
(a) A.P.J. Abdul Kalam (b) Narendra Modi
(c) Atal Behari Vajpayee (d) Manmohan Singh (d) Science and Engineering Research Board
37. Which of the following is NOT a missile developed by the 55. Who among the following is considered as the inventor of
Defence Research and Development. Organisation (DRDO)? the WWW ?
(a) Shaurya (b) Agni (a) Edward Kasner (b) Bill Gates
(c) Pinaka (d) Brahmos (c) Tim Berners-Lee (d) Vinod Dham
38. Pranab Mukherjee is the _______the President of India. 56. Who was the first Indian to win the World Amateur Billiards
(a) 14th President of India (b) 13th President of India title?
(c) 12th President of India (d) 11th President of India (a) Geet Sethi (b) Wilson Jones
39. What is the second largest desert in the world after the (c) Michael Ferreira (d) Manoj Kothari
Sahara desert ? 57. In which Olympics Games did India first win a Gold Medal?
(a) Arabian Desert (b) Gobi Desert (a) Montreal (1976) (b) Moscow (1980)
(c) Kalahari Desert (d) Libyan Desert (c) Low Angeles (1984) (d) Atlanta (1996)
Miscellaneous C- 39
58. The 1988 World Olympics Game were held at 76. The design of the National Flag was adopted by the
(a) Montreal (b) Los Angeles Constituent Assembly of India on
(c) Tokyo (d) Seoul (a) 15 August, 1947 (b) 22 July, 1947
59. The first Asian Games were held at – (c) 26 November, 1949 (d) 26 January, 1950
(a) Manila (b) Tokyo 77. The National Anthem was composed by
(c) Jakarta (d) New Delhi (a) Rabindranath Tagore (b) Bankim Chandra Chatterji
60. The number of players on each side in the case rugby (c) Sri Aurobindo Ghosh (d) Ramdhari Singh Dinkar
football is 78. The National Song was composed by
(a) 12 (b) 15 (c) 11 (d) 9 (a) Rabindranath Tagore
61. In which sports is it illegal to play left-handed? (b) Maithilisharan Gupta
(a) Discus Throw (b) Polo (c) Bankim Chandra Chatterji
(c) Lacrosse (d) Chess (d) Ramdhari Singh Dinkar
62. Who is the first Indian batsman to score a triple century in 79. The first man to land on the Moon was
Test Cricket? (a) Neil Armstrong (b) Yuri Gagarian
(a) V. V. S. Laxman (b) Rahul Dravid (c) Valentina Tereshkova (d) None of the above
(c) Sachin Tendulkar (d) Virendra Sehwag 80. First man of the world in space
63. Which of the following Countries is the host for the 2016 (a) Yuri Gagarian (b) Edwin Aldrin
Olympic Games? (c) Edward H White (d) Danish Tito
(a) South Africa (b) Netherlands 81. First woman of the world in space
(c) Brazil (d) Italy (a) Dr Sally K Ride (b) Anonsheh Ansari
64. Which of the following will host the 20th FIFA World Cup (c) Marie Collins (d) Valentina Tereshkova
in 2014? 82. First Asian woman to swim across the English Channel was
(a) Spain (b) Brazil (a) Bula Choudhary (b) Arati Saha
(c) Germany (d) Argentina (c) Santosh Yadav (d) None of these
65. Which among the following sports is NOT a part of the 83. Who was the first woman to summit Everest?
London Olympics? (a) Bachhendri Pal (b) Santosh Yadav
(a) Triathlon (b) Taekwondo (c) Junko Tabei (d) None of these
(c) Table Tennis (d) Baseball 84. First Indian woman to swim across seven seas of the world
66. In which Indian state did the game of Polo originate? was
(a) Meghalaya (b) Rajasthan (a) Bula Choudhary (b) Arati Saha
(c) Manipur (d) West Bengal (c) Bachhendri Pal (d) None of these
67. Which of the following is a pair names of the same game? 85. Who became the first woman Lok Sabha speaker in India?
(a) Soccer - Football (b) Golf - Polo (a) Annie Beasant (b) Sucheta Kriplani
(c) Billiards - Carrom (d) Volleyball – Squash (c) Meira Kumar (d) Vijayalakshmi Pandit
68. Who was the first Indian to win the World Amateur Billiards 86. The first post-office in India was established at
title? (a) Kolkata (b) Delhi
(a) Geet Sethi (b) Wilson Jones (c) Mumbai (d) Allahabad
(c) Michael Ferreira (d) Manoj Kothari 87. The first postal stamp in India was issued in
69. How many players are there on each side in a baseball (a) 1855 (b) 1853
match? (c) 1857 (d) 1852
(a) 5 (b) 7 88. The first Television Centre of India was established in 1959
(c) 9 (d) 11 at
70. Name the Indian Chess player who has broken the World (a) Kolkata (b) Bangaluru
Record by finishing the game in first twelve moves? (c) New Delhi (d) Chennai
(a) Vishwanathan Anand (b) Champa Bose 89. The first hydel plant in India was established at
(c) Sakunthala Devi (d) Praveen Thipsey (a) Darjeeling (b) Arunachal Pradesh
71. India won its first Olympic hockey gold in...? (c) Asom (d) Uttar Pradesh
(a) 1928 (b) 1932 90. ‘Moon and Stars’ is the National Symbol of
(c) 1936 (d) 1948 (a) Turkey (b) Pakistan
72. The 'Dronacharya Award' is given to – (c) Iran (d) All of these
(a) Sportsmen (b) Coaches 91. The National Symbol of Russia is
(c) Umpires (d) Sports Editors (a) Eagle (b) Double headed eagle
73. The Asian Games were held in Delhi for the first time in... (c) Mapple Bird (d) None of the above
(a) 1951 (b) 1963 92. The international boundary between India and China is
(c) 1971 (d) 1982 (a) Red Cliff Line (b) Durand Line
74. The state emblem of India has been adopted from (c) Mac Mohan Line (d) Maginot Line
(a) Palace of Chandragupta Maurya at Patna 93. Who of the following is popularly known as ‘Tiger of
(b) Ashokan Pillar at Allahabad Snow’?
(c) Ashokan Pillar at Delhi (a) Sir Walter Scott (b) Richard Golden
(d) Lion Capital of Ashoka at Sarnath (c) Tenzing Norge (d) None of these
75. How many spokes are in Indian National Flag? 94. ‘Yellow Book’ is the official document of
(a) 24 (b) 23 (a) UK (b) Germany
(c) 26 (d) 22 (c) France (d) Italy
C- 40 Miscellaneous
95. ‘Antara’ is the news agency of 106. The deepest lake of the world is
(a) Saudi Arab (b) Indonesia (a) Aral (b) Victoria
(c) Japan (d) Russia (c) Dead sea (d) Baikal
96. ‘Reuters’ is the news agency of 107. ‘Kathakali’ is the prominent classical dance of
(a) Britain (b) Canada (a) Kerala (b) Maharashtra
(c) France (d) None of these (c) Karnataka (d) Andhra Pradesh
97. The organization ‘World Wide Fund for Nature’ (WWF) 108. Which of the following dance forms was earlier practised
was established in 1961 at as a temple dance?
(a) France (b) UK (a) Odissi (b) Bharatnatyam
(c) Switzerland (d) Spain (c) Manipuri (d) Kathakali
98. ‘World Watch Institute’ is located in 109. Hari Prasad Chaurasiya is related to
(a) Rome (b) Paris (a) Santoor (b) Flute
(c) Geneva (d) Washington (c) Sarod (d) Lute
99. ‘World Health Day’ is observed on 110. The first Indian who received the famous Oscar Award, was
(a) 22 March (b) 7 April (a) Satyajit Ray (b) Mrinal Sen
(c) 21 March (d) 22 April (c) Bhanu Athaiya (d) Smita Patil
100. Which of the following is observed as ‘International 111. Who was the first Indian to receive the Nobel Prize
Women’s Day’? (a) Rabindranath Tagore (b) C V Raman
(a) 8 March (b) 22 March (c) Hargobind Khurana (d) Amartya Sen
(c) 22 April (d) 8 April 112. Who was the first recipient of Magsaysay Award?
101. ‘Dirham’ is the currency of (a) Vinoba Bhave (b) Chintaman Deshmukh
(a) Saudi Arabia (b) Kuwait (c) Mother Teresa (d) Verghese Kurien
(c) UAE (d) Iraq 113. Pulitzer prize is given for
102. Muscat is the capital of (a) literature (b) science and technology
(a) Yemen (b) Oman (c) journalism (d) spots
(c) Sierra Leone (d) Mozambique 114. Who was the first recipient of Dada Saheb Phalke Award?
103. The currency of Indonesia is (a) Devika Rani Roerich (b) B N Sircar
(a) Krona (b) Riel (c) Prithvi Raj Kapoor (d) Kanan Devi
(c) Rupiah (d) Peso 115. Which of the following Indian scientists is known as
104. Which is known as the ‘Land of the Midnight Sun’? ‘Missile Man’ of India?
(a) Japan (b) Norway (a) H J Bhabha (b) Vikram Sarabhai
(c) Newzealand (d) Finland (c) APJ Abdul Kalam (d) K Kastoori Rangan
105. Which of the following continents has the largest 116. ISRO (Indian Space Research Organization) was established
population? in
(a) Asia (b) Europe (a) 1970 (b) 1972
(c) Africa (d) South America (c) 1969 (d) 1974
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b ) 21 (b) 41 (c) 61 (b ) 81 (b) 10 1 (d)
2 (d ) 22 (b) 42 (b) 62 (d ) 82 (c) 10 2 (c)
3 (c) 23 (b ) 43 (b) 63 (c) 83 (b) 10 3 (a)
4 (d ) 24 (b) 44 (a) 64 (b ) 84 (a) 10 4 (c)
5 (b ) 25 (a) 45 (d) 65 (d ) 85 (c) 10 5 (c)
6 (a) 26 (c) 46 (c) 66 (c) 86 (d) 10 6 (c)
7 (a) 27 (d) 47 (c) 67 (a) 87 (a) 10 7 (a)
8 (c) 28 (a) 48 (c) 68 (b ) 88 (c) 10 8 (c)
9 (c) 29 (c) 49 (d) 69 (a) 89 (c) 10 9 (c)
10 (a) 30 (d) 50 (c) 70 (a) 90 (c) 11 0 (a)
11 (a) 31 (b) 51 (d) 71 (a) 91 (a) 11 1 (a)
12 (c) 32 (c) 52 (d) 72 (b ) 92 (a) 11 2 (c)
13 (b ) 33 (b) 53 (b) 73 (a) 93 (b) 11 3 (b)
14 (b ) 34 (a) 54 (d) 74 (d ) 94 (d) 11 4 (a)
15 (c) 35 (b) 55 (c) 75 (a) 95 (a) 11 5 (b)
16 (c) 36 (c) 56 (b) 76 (b ) 96 (c) 11 6 (a)
17 (c) 37 (a) 57 (b) 77 (a) 97 (b)
18 (b ) 38 (b) 58 (d) 78 (c) 98 (c)
19 (b ) 39 (a) 59 (d) 79 (a) 99 (a)
20 (c) 40 (a) 60 (b) 80 (d ) 1 00 (b)
Railways C- 41
CHAPTER
5 Railways
EXERCISE
1. The trial run of e-catering service by railways is undertaken 11. Railway budget 2014 has an plan outlay for 2014-15 of
at which among the following routes ________.
(a) Delhi- Amritsar (b) Delhi- Patna (a) ` 65455 cr (b) ` 75500 cr
(c) Delhi- Mumbai (d) Delhi- Chennai (c) 85400 cr (d) 45300 cr
2. What is CRIS? 12. In Railway Budget expenditure in 2014-15 is pegged at
(a) Centre for Railways intelligent system ________.
(b) Central Railways investigative system (a) 159178 cr (b) 149176 cr
(c) Centre for Railways Information System (c) 169400 cr (d) 123000 cr
(d) Central railways Information section 13. The loss per passenger per kilometer is up from 10% in
3. Which among the following is the e- system developed by 2000-01 to what % in 2012-13________.
IRCTC which provides information such as current position, (a) 43% (b) 23%
expected time of arrival and departure of train (c) 33% (d) 24%
(a) Train Locator (b) Spot your train 14. Railway Budget 2014 proposes to start Jansadharan Trains
(c) Train Schedule (d) Vyavastha for which among the following stations
4. Which among the following is the smart card would cut (a) Ahmedabad-Darbhanga Jansadharan Express
down the transaction time at booking counters as there will (b) Jaynagar-Mumbai Jansadharan Express
not be cash dealing during issuance of tickets? (c) Mumbai-Gorakhpur Jansadharan Express
(a) India smart card (d) All of the above
(b) Go-India smart card 15. Railway Budget 2014 proposes to start Premium Trains for
(c) Smart India smart card which among the following stations.
(d) India on card smart card (a) Mumbai Central-New Delhi
5. The Indian Railways has registered an increase of whaich (b) Shalimar-Chennai
among the following percentage in its total earning during (c) Jaipur-Madurai Premium Express
April- June 2014. (d) All the above
(a) 10.1 (b) 9.48 16. The recently inaugurated 25 Km long railway line in Jammu
(c) 9.58 (d) 10.58 connects Katra to which among the following:
6. In the Railway budget bullet train is proposed in which (a) Jammu (b) Udhampur
among the following sector? (c) Lhasa (d) Katnipur
(a) Mumbai-Ahmedabad sector 17. The trial run of India's fastest train was performed at which
(b) Mumbai- Pune Sector among the following routes
(c) Chennai-Banglore sector (a) New Delhi- Amritsar (b) New Delhi- Kanpur
(d) None of the above (c) New Delhi- Agra (d) New Delhi- Jaipur
7. Railway Budget 2014 Proposes to enhance speed of trains 18. The first trial run of the India's fastest train on the New
to 160-200 km/hr in ________. Delhi-Agra route covering 200 kms was done in ________.
(a) 8 sectors (b) 9 sectors (a) 100 minutes (b) 90 minutes
(c) 10 sectors (d) 5 sectors (c) 110 minutes (d) 80 minutes
8. In Railway Budget 2014 the cleanliness budget is increased 19. Railways has effected a hike in passenger fare in all classed
by ________. by________.
(a) 10 % (b) 20% (a) 18% (b) 20.5%
(c) 30% (d) 40% (c) 14,2% (d) 15.5%
9. Railway Budget 2014 pushes cleanliness by having which 20. Railways has effected a hike in freight rates by________.
among the following: (a) 8% (b) 6.5%
(a) Cleanliness budget increased by 40% over last year (c) 4.5% (d) 10.5%
(b) CCTVs to be used at stations for monitoring 21. Which among the following is the High speed rail project?
cleanliness (a) Golden Triangle (b) Golden Quadrilateral
(c) Forming a corpus fund for stations' maintenance (c) Diamond Triangle (d) Diamond quadrilateral
(d) All of the above 22. Indian Railways' approach to High Speed consist of which
10. Railway Budget proposes FDI in railway projects except among the following?
which among the following: (a) Dedicate tracks to passenger trains
(a) Operations (b) Infrastructure (b) Track-Upgrade for 250-300 km/h
(c) Manufacturing (d) none of the above (c) Upgrade locomotives and coaches
(d) All of the above
C- 44 Railways
23. Which among the following recently released books tells 33. The Railway Budget 2014 proposes how many new trains
the story of the long an eventful journey of Indian Railways (a) 58 (b) 60
starting from 1853 to the present day? (c) 62 (d) 70
(a) India at Junction 34. The railway Budget 2014 proposes extension of how many
(b) India Junction - A Window to the Nation new trains________.
(c) Rail journey- A Growth Story (a) 10 (b) 20
(d) Yatra (c) 11 (d) 9
24. Who among the following has edited the book India 35. Which among the following are proposals in the railway
Junction - A Window to the Nation? budget 2014?
(a) Seema Sharma (b) Ratan Bahl (a) Railways university for technical and non-technical
(c) Ravi Bansal (d) Kunal Kelkar subjects
25. Who among the following said 'No Railways, no India.' (b) Some stations to be built to international standards
(a) Mark tullu (b) Sandipan Deb through PPP model
(c) Ian J. Kerr (d) Sharmila Kantha (c) Parcel traffic to be segregated to separate terminals to
26. Indian Railways launched a web based Electrical Energy make passenger traffic unhampered
Management System called ________. (d) All of the above
(a) Railsaver (b) Raileem 36. The new e ticketing system launched by IRCTC would
(c) Railfuture (d) Railoorja enable booking of how many tickets per minute________.
27. RAILSAVER is a part of which among the following projects (a) 3000 (b) 4500
(a) Improving Energy Efficiency in Indian Railway System (c) 6300 (d) 7200
(b) Improving safety in Indian Railway system 37. CRIS has launched mobile app and desktop app for which
(c) Improving services in Indian Railway system among the following platform:
(d) Improving railway (a) windows8 (b) windows7
28. Which among the following state capital has become second (c) windows10 (d) linux
state capital in North East to be put on rail map of India 38. Which among the following online system is introduced
(a) Dispur (b) Itanagar for online booking of wagons and making payment without
(c) Shillong (d) Aizawl going to counters
29. The rail route connecting Dekargaon to itanagar covers a (a) e demand and e diversion
distance of (kms)________. (b) e wagon and e diversion
(a) 181 (b) 251 (c) e payment and e demand
(c) 301 (d) 161 (d) None of the above
30. Which among the following is 24 x 7 security helpline 39. Which among the following are the features of Indian
No.launched by Northern Railways to provide speedy railways during the april- june 2014 quarter
assistance to passengers in the event of thefts, harassment (a) The total approximate earnings from goods were
and other criminal incidents on rail premises? augmented by 7.05%
(a) 1332 (b) 1332 (b) An increase of 16.38% was registered in the total
(c) 3321 (d) 2231 approximate revenue earnings from passengers
31. Which among the following is the fastest train of India with (c) The total approximate numbers of passengers booked
the top speed of 150 km? registered an increase of 7.33%
(a) Bhopal- Delhi Shatabdi Express (d) All of the above
(b) Delhi- Lucknow Shatabdi 40. Who among the following is the Union Railway minister?
(c) Delhi- Amritsar Rajdhani (a) Pawan Bansal
(d) Delhi- Mumbai Rajdhani (b) D.V. Sadananda Gowda
32. FDI allowed in Indian Railways is ________. (c) Ram Bilas Paswan
(a) 26% (b) 51% (d) Ravi Shankar Prasad
(c) 100% (d) 76%
ANSWER KEY
1 (a) 11 (a) 21 (d) 31 (a)
2 (c) 12 (b) 22 (d) 32 (c)
3 (b) 13 (b) 23 (b) 33 (a)
4 (b) 14 (d) 24 (a) 34 (c)
5 (b) 15 (d) 25 (c) 35 (d)
6 (a) 16 (b) 26 (a) 36 (d)
7 (b) 17 (c) 27 (a) 37 (a)
8 (d) 18 (a) 28 (b) 38 (a)
9 (d) 19 (c) 29 (a) 39 (d)
10 (a) 20 (b) 30 (b) 40 (b)
Current Affairs C- 45
CHAPTER
6 Current Affairs
EXERCISE
1. The winners of US Open women doubles title 2014 are (a) INS Saryu (b) INS Shivalik
(a) Sania Mirza and Cara Black (c) INS Sunayna (d) INS Sumedha
(b) Martina Hingis and Flavia Pennetta 8. Kuno Palpur wildlife sanctuary is located in
(c) Ekaterina Makarova and Elena Vesnina (a) West Bengal (b) Jharkhand
(d) Sania Mirza and Abigail Spears (c) Madhya Pradesh (d) Maharashtra
2. Which of the following is not involved in the protool for 9. Subhash Chandra Garg has been appointed as the
ceasefire agreement between Ukraine government and the (a) Executive Director in World Bank
rebels signed recently? (b) Executive Director in IMF
(a) Russia (c) Executive Director in UNDP
(b) the Organisation for Security and Cooperation in (d) Executive Director in WTO
Europe 10. Recent outbreak of Ebola virus in Africa started in
(c) Ukrainian rebels (a) Nigeria (b) Guinea
(d) NATO (c) Somalia (d) Sudan
3. AIIMS has joined hand with Alfred Hospital for research in 11. Neel Mukherjee has been shortlisted for Man Booker Prize
health field. Alfred Hospital is located in for which of the following book?
(a) USA (b) Australia (a) Past Continuous (b) A Life Apart
(c) Canada (d) Germany (c) The Lives of Others (d) None of these
4. NATO Summit-2014 was held at 12. KIRAN (Knowledge and Involvement in Research
(a) Geneva (b) London Achievement through Nurturing) scheme is related to
(c) Lisbon (d) Wales (a) Women Engineers (b) Women Doctors
5. Who among the following retired Judges of the Supreme (c) Women Scientists (d) Women teachers
Court is/was the first to be appointed as the Governor of a 13. Which of the following pairs are correctly matched:
state in India?
Grand Slam Title Winner
(a) Justice Fathima Beevi
(1) US Open women's title 2014 Serena Williams
(b) Justice Mohammed Hidayatullah
(2) US Open men's title 2014 Roger Federer
(c) Justice Lalit Mohan Sharma
(3) French Open women's title 2014 Maria Sharapova
(d) Justice P. Sathasivam
(4) French Open men's title 2014 Rafael Nadal
6. The name of the committee appointed to search for a suitable
Codes:
location for capital of Andhra Pradesh is
(a) 1, 2 and 4 only (b) 1, 3 and 4 only
(a) N.C Saxena Committee
(c) 2 and 3 only (d) All of these
(b) I.S Israni Committe
14. Graphene is a
(c) Sivaramakrishnan Committee
(a) two-dimensional material comprising of sheets of
(d) Justice Shah Committee
carbon atoms
7. INS Sumitra has been recently commissioned in the Indian
(b) three-dimensional material comprising of sheets of
Navy. Which of the following does not belong to the same
carbon atoms
class as INS Sumitra?
C- 46 Current Affairs
(c) two-dimensional material comprising of sheets of (a) Kohre Mein Kaid Rang
Silicon atoms (b) Paanch Aangano Wala Ghar
(d) three-dimensional material comprising of sheets of (c) Biyanba Mein Bahar
Silicon atoms (d) Dhool Paudhon Par
15. Swachh Vidyalaya campaign will be anchored by which of 24. State Bank of India has recently signed a $500 Line of Credit
the following ministeries? (LoC) with the Exim Bank of
(a) Ministry of Rural Development (a) Japan (b) China
(b) Ministry of Women and Child Development (c) South Korea (d) Indonesia
(c) Ministry of Human Resource Development 25. "5/20 rule" is associated with which industry?
(d) Ministry of Social Justice and Empowerment (a) Steel (b) Aviation
16. US Senate has declared which of the following date as the (c) Telecom (d) Coal
US-India Partnership Day? 26. Which of the following statements are correct about "Make
(a) 25th September, 2014 (b) 30th September, 2014 in India" campaign?
(c) 2nd October, 2014 (d) 5th October, 2014 (1) All Central government services to be integrated with
17. Yazidi tribes lives in which of the following countries? an e-Biz single window online portal
(a) Afghanistan (b) Uzbekistan (2) Expert group from DIPP and FICCI to be set up to
(c) Azerbaijan (d) Iraq propose reforms to the Centre and states.
18. Alok Shetty, who has been named as the 'leader of tomorrow' (3) States are recommended to initiate the self-certification
is a/an (4) Home Ministry to provide all security clearances to
(a) Doctor (b) Environmentalist investment proposals within 3 months.
(c) Educationist (d) Architect Codes
19. Which of the following pairs regarding to Indian Navy's (a) 1, 2 and 3 only (b) 3 and 4 only
ship/weapon system is/ are correct? (c) 2 and 4 only (d) All of these
(1) Varunastra : Torpedo 27. Which one of the following has been appointed as the
(2) Mareecha : Decoy Governor of Kerala, the former Chief Justice of India?
(3) INS Arihant : Submarine (a) Justice Altamas Kabir
(4) INS Kolkata : Aircraft carrier (b) Justice P. Sathasivam
Codes (c) Justice K.G.Balakrishnan
(a) 1, 2 and 3 only (b) 3 and 4 only (d) Justice S.H. Kapadia
(c) 2 and 4 only (d) 2, 3 and 4 only 28. Identify the name Indian American who invented E-mail 32
20. Which of the following players are correctly matched years back?
according to the game they are associated with? (a) A.V. Ramaswami (b) V.V. Annadurai
(1) Rajat Chauhan : Archery (c) V.A. Shiva Ayyadurai (d) R.V. Ramalingam
(2) Gurpreet Singh : Shooting 29. Consider the following statements given below regarding
(3) Saurav Ghoshal : Swimming Dronacharya Awards 2014 and select which is/are correct?
Codes : 1. Mahabir Prasad, has been awarded Dronacharya Award
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 only for Wrestling
(c) 1 and 3 only (d) 2 and 3 only 2. Gurcharan Singh Gogi, has been awarded Dronacharya
21. Which of the following has been selected to be the SAARC Award for Boxing.
cultural capital for the year 2016-17? Choose the appropriate option from those given below:
(a) Bamiyan (b) Dhaka (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
(c) Ajanta (d) Lahore (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
22. Which of the following statement(s) is/are correct about 30. Who has been appointed as the Civil Aviation secretary in
Mars Orbitor Mission (MOM)? the last week of August 2014?
(1) India became the first Asian nation to successfully (a) Chandraji Banerjee (b) V. Somasundaram
send a satellite to Mars' orbit (c) Ajit Seth (d) S.A. Suryanarayan Verma
(2) MOM is the India's first inter-planetry mission 31. Who among the following is the author of the Book Titled
(3) The mission used Geostatinary Satellite Launch "Assassination of Rajiv Gandhi: An Inside Job"?
Vehicle (GSLV) for the launch (a) Faraz Ahmed (b) DP Yadav
Codes (c) Daman Singh (d) None of these
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 only 32. Who among the following has been appointed as the new
(c) 1 and 3 only (d) 2 and 3 only chief of Joint Intelligence Committee?
23. Govind Misra has been awarded with Saraswati Samman- (a) Ramesh chand Tayal (b) RN Ravi
2013 for his novel titled as (c) K V Thomas (d) None of these
Current Affairs C- 47
33. Which one of the following has been recently appointed as 43. Which of the following pact is on track between India and
the 12th President of Turkey? Japan?
(a) Ekmeleddin Ihsanoglu (a) Automobile SEZ Pact (b) Nuclear Pact
(b) Selahattin Demirtas (c) Aviation SEZ Pact (d) GM crop Pact
(c) Recep Tayyip Erdogan 44. Which city was chosen as the ad hoc capital of Andhra
(d) None of these Pradesh by the state government recently?
34. Who has been recently appointed as the Governor of (a) Vijayawada (b) Guntur
Rajasthan? (c) Visakhapatanam (d) Nellore
(a) Kalyan Singh (b) Kamla Beniwal 45. Who was elected as the Deputy Speaker of the Lok Sabha
recently?
(c) Vidya Sagar Rao (d) Mridula sinha
(a) M. Thambidurai (b) M. Venkateshwar
35. India on 29th August 2014 signed loan agreement with
________ for Mizoram State Roads Project (MSRP II). (c) V. Rameshwar (d) D. Subramaniam
46. Name the state that on 19 September 2014 made the decision
(a) Asian Development Bank
of opening the Nirbhaya Centers in all districts of the state
(b) International Monetary Fund
to provide prompt help to victims of crime against women?
(c) UNDP
(a) Bihar (b) West Bengal
(d) World Bank (c) Uttar Pradesh (d) Karnataka
36. Which of the following community in Iraq is warned by 47. Delhi's Narula brothers became the first ever contestants to
ISIS to convert to Islam or be ready to face the win 7 crore rupees in Season 8 of the show, Kaun Banega
consequences? Crorepati, hosted by Amitabh Bachchan. What was the
(a) Zoroastrians (b) Christians tagline of the Season 8 of the KBC?
(c) Yazidis (d) Jews (a) Koi Bhi Sawaal Chota Nahi Hota
37. Who has been recently appointed as head of National (b) Sirf Gyaan Hi Aapka Haq Dilata Hai
Biodiversity Authority? (c) Seekhna Bandh Toh Jeetna Bandh
(a) V Rajagopalan (b) Venkatesh Naik (d) Yahan Sirf Paise Nahi, Dil Bhi Jeete Jate Hain
(c) Rama Krishunudua (d) Ajit Seth 48. Point 30R Post of Chumar area was in news in September
38. Which of the following received the outstan ding 2014 for which of the following reasons?
Parliamentarian Award for the year 2010? (a) The area was opened for Kailash Mansarovar Yatra
(a) Sharad Yadav (b) Karan singh during the India visit of Chinese President Xi Jingping
(c) Arun Jaitley (d) Jaswant Singh (b) The area witnessed infiltration of terrorists from
39. Which among the following is India's largest indigenously Pakistani side during the Jammu and Kashmir floods
built warship, recently inducted in Indian Navy? (c) The area witnessed incursion by Chinese Army several
(a) INS Kolkata (b) INS Goa times in the month where they even pitched their tents
(c) INS Kochi (d) INS Mumbai (d) The area witnessed a heavy earthquake several times
in the month leading to landslides
40. Which of the following received the Field's medal (Nobel
49. Name the rescue operation undertaken by Indian Army
Prize of Mathematics) 2014?
during Jammu and Kashmir floods that affected the State in
(a) Mukul Pathak (b) Sanjay Barua September 2014?
(c) Manjul Bhargava (d) Srikant Kheda (a) Operation Madad
41. What is the name of new commission, announced by Modi (b) Operation Megh Rahat
in his maiden speech on 15th August 2014, which will replace
(c) Operation Surya Hope
the Planning Commission?
(d) Operation Imdad
(a) National Development commission
50. Name the Shiite rebel front that in September 2014 forced
(b) National Development and Reform commission the government of Yemen to sign a peace deal leading to
(c) National Development Council removal of the Prime Minister?
(d) National Planning and Development commission (a) Moro Islamic Liberation
42. Who has been awarded the highest peace time gallantry (b) Houthi
award "Ashoka Chakra" on 15th August 2014? (c) Al-Shabaab
(a) Major Mukund Varadarajan (d) United Wa State Army
(b) Sepoy Vikram 51. Union Cabinet chaired by the Prime Minister Narendra Modi
(c) Lt. Manoran kumar recently approved an agreement on grid connectivity with
(d) Lt. Kapish singh which country?
C- 48 Current Affairs
(a) Myanmar (b) Sri Lanka (a) To promote maximum use of public transport
(c) Nepal (d) Tibet (b) To aware about the metro
52. Parliament of which country recently backed the resolution (c) To promote the construction of environment friendly
for its participation in the US-led air strikes against militants buildings
of Islamic State of Iraq and Syria (ISIS) in Iraq? (d) To promote the travel
(a) United Kingdom (b) Germany 62. Which of the following countries are allies of the USA in
(c) Slovenia (d) India the air strikes against ISIS militant group?
53. Name the bank of a country with which State Bank of India (a) Saudi Arabia, Bahrain, Qatar, Jordan, UAE ,France and
(SBI) signed a Line of Credit (LoC) of 500 million dollar? Australia
(a) Export-Import Bank of Singapore (b) France, Russia, Australia and Germany
(b) Export-Import Bank of Germany (c) France, Saudi Arabia, Qatar, Russia and Switzerland
(c) Export-Import Bank of Brazil (d) France, United Kingdom, Russia, Qatar, Saudi Arabia
(d) Export-Import Bank of Korea 63. Union Ministry of Sports on 22 September 2014 inaugurated
54. Name the person who was selected for the Shanti Swarup National Academy for Athletics and National Golf Academy.
Bhatnagar Awards 2014 in the field of Mathematical Sciences Where the academy was inaugurated?
in September 2014? (a) Bhiwani, Haryana
(a) Dr. Soumen Chakrabarti (b) Mandi, Himachal Pradesh
(b) Dr. Kaushal Kumar Verma (c) Thiruvananthapuram, Kerala
(c) Dr. Roop Mallik (d) Pune, Maharashtra
(d) Dr. Kavirayani Ramakrishna Prasad 64. Which country is the current chair of G20 group of
countries?
55. Deen Dayal Upadhyaya Antyodaya Yojana launched on 25
September 2014 is related to (a) USA (b) France
(a) Rural sanitation program (c) Germany (d) Australia
(b) Urban Sanitation program 65. The successful launch of Mars Orbital Mission into Mars
orbit was done by the critical test-fire of LAM of
(c) Rural and Urban skill development program
Mangalyaan. What does LAM stand for?
(d) Rural and Urban infrastructure development Program
(a) Land Apogee Motor (b) Liquid Aerial Motor
56. Who was selected as Prime Minister Narendra Modi's
(c) Land Aerial Motor (d) Liquid Apogee Motor
Sherpa for G20 Annual Summit of major economies on 23
67. Who among the following served as first Chairman of the
September 2014?
National Human Rights Commission?
(a) Suresh Prabhu (b) Kumar Jha
(a) Justice Sabyasachi Mukharji
(c) Gaurav Agarwal (d) Prabhu dev
(b) Justice P N Bhagwati
57. Andhra Pradesh government on 23 September 2014
(c) Justice Ranganath Misra
enhanced the upper age limit for direct recruitment into
(d) Justice YV Chandrachud
government services. What is the upper age limit?
67. Which nationalized Indian Bank has recently completed
(a) 33 years (b) 35 years
150 years of its operations in Sri Lanka?
(c) 38 years (d) 40 years
(a) Allahabad Bank
58. Who was recently appointed as Secretary General of
(b) Punjab and Sind Bank
Independent Commission on Multilateralism (ICM)?
(c) Bank of Maharashtra
(a) Dag Hammarskjold (b) Ban Ki-moon
(d) State Bank of India
(c) Hardeep Singh Puri (d) None of the above
68. Which Indian shuttler has recently won the Indonesian
59. Who was elected as the Prime Minister of New Zealand on
Masters Grand Prix in Indonesia?
21 September 2014?
(a) H.S. Prannoy (b) Parupalli Kashyap
(a) David Kunloff (b) Kim Ductom
(c) Danny Chrisnanta (d) Pranaav Chopra
(c) Michael Kerry (d) John Key
69. As per the sixth Economic Census, 2013, which state in
60. Who on 22 September 2014 was elected as the Inter-Services India has the highest number of hired workers?
Intelligence (ISI) chief?
(a) Andhra Pradesh (b) Punjab
(a) Rizwan Akhtar (b) Zaheerul Islam
(c) Arunachal Pradesh (d) Odisha
(c) Mohammad Khan (d) Mahmud-ul-ashfaq
70. What is the upper age limit set by RBI for MDs and CEOs of
61. Recently, Delhi Metro Rail Corporation observed World the private sector banks recently?
Green Building Week from 22 September to 27 September
(a) 68 years (b) 70 years
2014. What was the agenda of observing this week?
(c) 62 years (d) 65 years
Current Affairs C- 49
71. Who was India's flag bearer at the 17th Asian Games opening 80. Which State government recently launched a Unicode based
ceremony? mobile app for android phones to promote the language
(a) PC Thulasi (b) Sardar Singh spoken in the State?
(c) Jitu Rai (d) Samaresh Jung (a) Andhra Pradesh (b) Tamil Nadu
72. Which of the following is not a part of the new office of (c) Karnataka (d) Telangana
Intellectual Property Office of India, launched by the Union 81. Who was appointed as Chairperson of National Commission
Ministry of Commerce? for Women?
(a) International Searching Authority (ISA) (a) Sonia Gandhi (b) Lalitha Kumarmangalam
(b) International Preliminary Examining Authority (IPEA) (c) Nancy Kumari (d) Reema Malhotra
(c) Patent Cooperation Treaty (PCT) 82. Where was the G-20 Labour and Employment Ministerial
(d) International Property Examining Authority(IPA) Level Meet held?
73. India observed National Hindi Divas on? (a) Geneva (b) Melbourne
(a) 16 September (b) 14 September (c) Perth (d) India
(c) 12 September (d) 10 September 83. Who recently became the Miss America 2014?
74. AIBA Executive Committee Bureau on 15 September 2014 (a) Miss Virginia Courtney(b) Miss Kira Kazantsev
formally recognised Boxing India as the provisional AIBA (c) Miss North Dakota (d) Miss North Dakota
National Federation to represent the sport of boxing in India. 84. Where Cu Chi tunnels are located which was in news
Name the President of Boxing India? recently?
(a) Praful Patel (b) Sandeep Jajodia (a) Malaysia (b) China
(c) Bhupindra Singh (d) Narayana Ramachandran (c) Vietnam (d) Sikkim
75. Cabinet Committee on Economic Affairs (CCEA) recently 85. And then One Day: A Memoir is the autobiography of which
approved 4754.42 crore rupees Comprehensive Scheme for of the following personality?
Strengthening of Transmission & Distribution (T&D) (a) Sachin Tendulkar (b) Atal Bihari Vajpayee
Systems (CSST&DS) in two north-eastern states of India. (c) Naseeruddin Shah (d) Amitabh Bachhan
Name them? 86. Police of which state recently launched its first e-police
(a) Assam and Arunachal Pradesh station to deal with vehicle thefts?
(b) Meghalaya and Manipur (a) Haryana (b) Uttrakhand
(c) Arunachal Pradesh and Sikkim (c) Gujarat (d) New Delhi
(d) Mizoram and Tripura 87. Which Prime Minister of India had started the Pradhan
76. Union Information and Broadcasting Ministry recently Mantri Gram Sadak Yojana?
signed a Memorandum of Understanding (MoU) with which (a) PV Narsimha Rao (b) Manmohan Singh
State to make the State a permanent venue for International (c) Atal Bihari Vajpayee (d) Narendra Modi
Film Festival of India (IFFI)? 88. With how many permanent members of United Nations
(a) Kerala (b) Maharashtra Security Council India has civil nuclear pact signed?
(c) Goa (d) Kolkata (a) Two (b) Three
77. Recently International Basketball Federation (FIBA) allowed (c) Four (d) Five
players to wear religious head coverings such as hijabs or 89. According to the Global Competitiveness Report 2014,
turbans on trial basis. In this context name the two Indian which is the most competitive economy?
Sikh players who were asked to remove their turbans during
(a) USA (b) Singapore
Asia Basketball Cup in July 2014?
(c) Switzerland (d) Japan
(a) Amanpreet Singh and Manpreet Singh
90. What is the name given to military exercises conducted
(b) Amjyot Singh and Amritpal Singh
between India and Nepal?
(c) Anmol Singh and Amjyot Singh
(a) Surya Kiran (b) Malabar
(d) Anmol Singh and Amritpal Singh
(c) Indra (d) Varuna Exercise
78. Recently Union government launched FASTag. What is
91. Who among the following is the youngest sailor to
FASTag?
represent India at the Asian Games, 2014?
(a) ETC programme to be launched by Government
(a) Chitresh Tatha (b) Upamanyu Dutta
(b) A programme to enhance athleticism in youth
(c) Arosh Chaudhari (d) Diya Correa
(c) SBI women run for breast cancer
92. Union Home Ministry has inaugurated the integration of
(d) None of the above Border Security Force with which of the following projects
79. India and China agreed to open a new route for Kailash of the Gujarat Government at Bhuj, Gujarat?
Mansarovar Yatra during the visit of Chinese President Xi (a) BISAG (b) TRISAG
Jingping to India. As per the agreement, the new route will
(c) VISAG (d) MISAG
be through?
(a) Nathula Pass (b) Lipulekh Pass
(c) Spanggur Gap (d) Shipkila Pass
C- 50 Current Affairs
ANSWER KEY
1 (c) 16 (b) 31 (a) 46 (c) 61 (c) 76 (c) 91 (a)
2 (d) 17 (d) 32 (b) 47 (d) 62 (a) 77 (b) 92 (a)
3 (b) 18 (d) 33 (c) 48 (c) 63 (c) 78 (a)
4 (d) 19 (a) 34 (a) 49 (b) 64 (d) 79 (b)
5 (a) 20 (b) 35 (d) 50 (b) 65 (d) 80 (c)
6 (c) 21 (b) 36 (c) 51 (c) 66 (c) 81 (b)
7 (b) 22 (b) 37 (a) 52 (a) 67 (d) 82 (b)
8 (c) 23 (d) 38 (c) 53 (d) 68 (a) 83 (b)
9 (a) 24 (c) 39 (a) 54 (b) 69 (c) 84 (c)
10 (b) 25 (b) 40 (c) 55 (c) 70 (b) 85 (c)
11 (c) 26 (d) 41 (b) 56 (a) 71 (b) 86 (d)
12 (c) 27 (b) 42 (a) 57 (d) 72 (d) 87 (c)
13 (b) 28 (c) 43 (b) 58 (c) 73 (b) 88 (c)
14 (a) 29 (a) 44 (a) 59 (d) 74 (b) 89 (c)
15 (c) 30 (b) 45 (a) 60 (a) 75 (c) 90 (a)
SECTION D : GENERAL SCIENCE
Physics
CHAPTER
1 Mechanics
Physical Quantities
Those quantities which can describe the laws of physics and possible to measure are called physical quantities.
The physical quantities which do not depend upon other physical quantities are called fundamental quantities.
In Standard International (S.I.) system the fundamental quantities are mass, length, time, temperature, luminous intensity, electric
current and amount of substance.
The physical quantities which depend on fundamental quantities are called derived quantities e.g. speed, acceleration, force, etc.
Units
The unit of a physical quantity is the reference standard used to measure it.
Types of Units
1. Fundamental Units
The units defined for the fundamental quantities are called fundamental or base units.
Fundamental Length Time Temperature Electric Luminous Amount of
Mass (M)
Physical quantity (L) (T) (q or K) current (I) intensity substance
kilogram metre second kelvin ampere Candela mole
Fundamental unit
(kg) (m) (s) (K) (A) (Cd) (mol)
2. Derived Units
The units defined for the derived quantities are called derived units. e.g. unit of speed or velocity (metre per second),
acceleration (metre per second2) etc.
Dimensions
The limit of a derived quantity in terms of necessary basic units is called dimensional formula and the raised powers on the basic
units are dimensions.
Angular velocity M 0 L0 T -1
25. Angular acceleration = M0 L0 T -2 rad/s2
Time T
26. Angular momentum Moment of inertia × ML2T–1 kg m2/s
angular velocity
27. Torque Moment of inertia × angular ML2T–2 N-m
acceleration
28. Wavelength Length M0LT 0 m
1
29. Frequency No. of vibrations/s = M 0 L0 T -1 s –1
T
LT -1
30. Velocity gradient Velocity/distance = M 0 L0 T -1 s –1
L
Centre of Mass r r r r r
t = r ´ p where r = position relative to origin p
It is an imaginary point at which the whole mass of a body is = linear momentum at position.
supposed to be concentrated. r r
Characteristics of centre of mass: Angular momentum = L = r ´ p : S.I unit kg m2/s
(i) It need not hold mass physically, e.g. for a hollow sphere, Relation between torque and angular momentum,
uur
centre of mass is at the geometrical centre of the sphere ur d L
although there is no mass present physically at the centre. t =
dt
(ii) Location of centre of mass depends on the distribution of Moment of Inertia
masses and their individual location. For regular geometrical It is equivalent to mass in rotational motion. It is defined as the
shaped bodies, having uniform distribution of mass, the sum of the product of the constituent masses and the square of
centre of mass is located at their centres. their perpendicular distances from the axis of rotation.
(iii) When no external force acts on a body, centre of mass has For an n-particle system having mass points m1, m2, m3, ...............,
constant velocity and constant angular momentum. mn at perpendicular distances
Acceleration is zero. r1, r2, ............, rn, moment of inertia,
n
n
r
If C.M. is the origin, then å M i ri = 0. I = m1r12 + m2r22 + ............ + mnrn 2=
å mi r i2
i =1 i =1
Torque and Angular Momentum S.I. unit is kgm2 and it is a scalar quantity.
Torque is the moment of force. It is the cross product of the force
Radius of Gyration
It is the root mean square of the perpendicular distances of the
with the perpendicular distance between the axis of rotation and
constituent masses. It is the perpendicular distance of the point
the point of application of force with the force.
v uuv uuv where the whole mass is concentrated form the axis of rotation.
Torque = t = r ´ F ; S.I. unit is N – m
r12 + r22 + .................. + rn2
Angular momentum is the moment of linear momentum. It is also Radius of gyration = k =
the product of the linear momentum and the perpendicular n
distance of the mass from the axis of rotation. Moment of inertia I = Mk2
Moment of inertia of various objects:
Name of the object Axis Moment of inertia
(a) Rod (i) about an axis passing through Ml2/12
its C.M. and ^ to its length
(ii) about an axis passing through Ml2/3
one edge of the rod
(b) Ring (i) about an axis passing through MR2
C.M & ^ to its plane
(ii) about any diameter MR2/2
3
(iii) about a tangent in the plane of the ring MR2
2
(iv) about a tangent ^ to the plane 2MR2
of the ring
(c) Disc (i) about an axis passing through C.M. and MR2/2
^ to its plane
(ii) about its diameter MR2/4
(d) Solid cylinder about its axis MR2/2
(e) Hollow cylinder about its axis MR2
2
(f) Hollow sphere about its diameter MR2
3
2
(g) Solid sphere about its diameter MR2
5
Gravitation m1m2
It is the force of attraction between any two bodies. \ F=G
Newton's Universal Law of Gravitation: Every body in this r2
universe attracts every other body with a force which is directly G = Universal gravitational constant
proportional to the product of their masses and inversely = 6.67 × 10–11 Nm2/kg2
proportional to the square of the distance between them. Acceleration due to gravity: The acceleration produced in a body
due to gravitational force of the earth is called acceleration due to
1 mm gravity (g).
F µ m1m2 and F µ 2 Þ F µ 1 2
r r2
D- 6 Mechanics
Satellite
GM e
g= (on the surface of the earth); Me = mass on the earth It is a heavenly body or an artificial object which revolves round
Re2 a planet in a particular orbit. The required centripetal force is
and Re = radius of the earth. provided by the gravitational force. Kepler’s laws of planetary
Mass and density of the earth: motion are applicable to them.
(a) Orbital velocity of a satellite: Velocity with which the
g Re2 satellite orbits around the planet.
Me = = 6 × 1024 kg, Re = 6400 km;
G
GM
vo =
3g R+h
Density = r = = 5.5 × 103 kg/m3
4pRe G h ® height of the orbit from the surface of the planet;
Variation of 'g': R ® Radius of the planet.
æ 2h ö GM
(a) With height: g' = g ç1 - ÷ when h << R; If h < < R vo = = gR
è Rø R
(b) Time period of a satellite: Time taken by it to complete one
2
g' = g æç
R ö revolution around the planet.
when h » R
è R + h ÷ø
3p( R + h)3 2p ( R + h)3
\ g decreases with height. T= =
GrR 3 R g
With depth: g' = g æç1 - ö÷ \ g decreases with depth.
d
(b) where r ® mean density of the planet;
è Rø
At the centre of the earth d = R, g' = 0 3p
For h << R; T =
(c) Effect of latitude: Gr
g' = g – Rw2 cos2 q (c) Height of a satellite above the surface of the planet:
where q ® latitude of the point
1/ 3
w ® angular velocity of the earth. æ T 2 R2 g ö
(d) Effect of the shape of the earth: H= ç ÷ –R
è 4p 2 ø
The equatorial radius is 21 km (approx) greater than the
(d) “Total energy of a satellite orbiting on a circular path is
polar radius.
negative” with potential energy being negative but twice
1 as the magnitude of positive kinetic energy.
Q gµ \ g increases from equator to poles. (e) Binding energy of a satellite is the energy required to
R2
remove it from its orbit to infinity.
i.e., g is maximum at poles and least (zero) at equator.
Gravitational Potential GMm
B.E. = No energy is required to keep the satellite in
Gravitational Potential : Gravitational potential at a point in a 2r
gravitational field is defined as the work done in taking a unit its orbit.
mass from infinity to the point. Geostationary satellites : The satellites in a circular orbit around
the earth in the equatorial plane with a time period of 24 hours,
- GM appears to be fixed from any point on earth are called geostationary
Gravitational potential = V =
r satellite.
Gravitational P.E. = Gravitational potential For geostationary satellite, height above the earth’s surface
GMm = 35800 km and orbital velocity = 3.1 km/s.
× mass of the object = – Polar Satellites : A satellite that revolves in a polar orbit along
r
north-south direction while the earth rotates around its axis in
Escape Speed east west direction.
Minimum speed required to escape the earth’s gravitational pull. Weightlessness
ve = 2gR = 2 × vo (For earth ve = 11.2 km/s) A situation where the effective weight of the object becomes
zero. An astronaut experiences weightlessness in space satellite
where v0 = oribital speed
because the astronaut as well as the satellite are in a free fall state
towards the earth.
Mechanics D- 7
EXERCISE
1. Light year is 13. Which of the following are examples of uniform velocity?
(a) light emitted by the sun in one year. (a) Motion of moon around earth
(b) time taken by light to travel from sun to earth. (b) Motion of planet around sun
(c) the distance travelled by light in free space in one year. (c) Motion of car on crowded road
(d) time taken by earth to go once around the sun. (d) Motion of a moving fan
2. A passenger in a moving train tosses a coin. If the coin falls 14. A person swims in a river aiming to reach exactly on the
behind him, the train must be moving with opposite point on the bank of a river. His speed of swimming
(a) an acceleration (b) a deceleration is 0.5 m/s at an angle of 120º with the direction of flow of
(c) a uniform speed (d) any of the above water. The speed of water is
3. Watt–hour meter measures (a) 1.0 m/s (b) 0.5 m/s
(a) current (b) voltage (c) 0.25 m/s (d) 0.43 m/s
(c) power (d) electric energy 15. When a body is stationary
4. Which of the following time-displacement graph is not (a) there is no force acting on it
possible in nature? (b) the force acting on it not in contact with it
t (c) the combination of forces acting on it balances each
t other
(d) the body is in vacuum
(a) (b) 16. Four cars A, B, C and D are moving on a levelled road. Their
s
s distance versus time graphs are shown in figure. Choose
t t the correct statement.
C
(c) (d) D
s s Distance (m)
5. A car is moving on a road and rain is falling vertically. Select A
the correct answer.
(a) The rain will strike the wind screen only B
(b) The rain will strike the front screen only
(c) The rain will strike both the screens
O
Time (s)
(d) The rain will not strike any of the screens
6. SI unit of pressure is (a) Car A is faster than car D
(a) atmosphere (b) bar (b) Car B is the slowest.
(c) pascal (d) mm of Hg (c) Car C is faster than car D.
7. Dimensions of impulse are (d) Car C is the lowest.
(a) [MLT–1] (b) [MLT2] 17. A man getting down a running bus, falls forward because
(c) [MT ]–2 (d) [ML–1T–3] (a) due to inertia of rest, road is left behind and man reaches
2 –2
8. ML T are dimensions of forward
(a) force (b) moment of force (b) due to inertia of motion upper part of body continues
(c) momentum (d) power to be in motion in forward direction while feet come to
9. The number of significant figures in 0.00060 m is rest as soon as they touch the road
(a) 1 (b) 2 (c) he leans forward as a matter of habit
(c) 3 (d) 4 (d) of the combined effect of all the three factors stated in
10. A particle is moving in a circular path of radius r. The (a), (b) and (c)
displacement after half a circle would be 18. The relative velocity vAB or vBA of two bodies A and B may be
(a) zero (b) pr (1) greater than velocity of body A
(c) 2 r (d) 2pr (2) greater than velocity of body B
11. The numerical ratio of average velocity to average speed is (3) less than the velocity of body A
(a) always less than one (b) always equal to one (4) less than the velocity of body B
(c) always more than one (d) equal to or less than one (a) (1) and (2) only
12. A vector quantity is a physical quantity which needs (b) (3) and (4) only
(a) magnitude (b) direction (c) (1), (2) and (3) only
(c) both (a) and (b) (d) time (d) (1), (2), (3) and (4).
D- 8 Mechanics
19. A parrot is sitting on the floor of a closed glass cage which 27. Which of the following is NOT an illustration of Newton's
is in a boy’s hand. If the parrot starts flying with a constant third law ?
speed, the boy will feel the weight of the cage as (a) Flight of a jet plane
(a) unchanged (b) reduced (b) A cricket player lowering his hands while catching a
(c) increased (d) nothing can be said cricket ball
20. A cannon after firing recoils due to (c) Walking on floor
(a) conservation of energy (d) Rebounding of a rubber ball
(b) backward thrust of gases produced 28. Swimming is possible on account of
(c) Newton’s third law of motion (a) first law of motion
(d) Newton’s first law of motion (b) second law of motion
21. The force exerted by the floor of an elevator on the foot of a (c) third law of motion
person standing there, is more than his weight, if the elevator (d) Newton’s law of gravitation
is 29. 1 kilowatt hour is equal to
(a) going down and slowing down (a) 1 joule (b) 100 joule
(b) going up and speeding up (c) 36 joule (d) 3.6 × 103 kilo joule
(c) going up and slowing down 30. The centre of mass of triangle shown in figure has
coordinates
(d) either (a) or (b)
22. Consider an elevator moving downwards with an acceleration
y
a, the force exerted by a passenger of mass m on the floor of
the elevator is
(a) ma (b) ma – mg
(c) mg – ma (d) mg + ma
h
23. A large truck and a car, both moving with a velocity of same
magnitude have a head-on-collision. Car suffers more
damage than the truck. This is because
(a) the material used in car is inferior than the material used x
b
in truck.
(b) car experience the greater force of impact than the truck.
(c) momentum transferred to the truck is greater than the h b b h
(a) x= ,y= (b) x= ,y=
momentum transferred to the car. 2 2 2 2
(d) momentum transferred to the car is greater than the b h h b
momentum transferred to the truck. (c) x= ,y= (d) x = , y =
3 3 3 3
24. Frictional force
31. For a body falling freely under gravity from a height
(a) always acts opposite to the direction of motion
(a) only the potential energy goes on increasing
(b) always acts in the direction of motion
(b) only the kinetic energy goes on increasing
(c) may act in the direction of motion
(c) both kinetic energy as well as potential energy go on
(d) always acts perpendicular to the direction of motion
increasing
25. A coin is placed on a rotating disc and is stationary w.r.t. the
(d) the kinetic energy goes on increasing while potential
disc, then the direction of friction is
energy goes on decreasing
(a) along the direction of motion of the coin w.r.t. ground
32. A jet plane moves up in air because
(b) opposite to the direction of motion of the coin w.r.t.
(a) the gravity does not act on bodies moving with high
ground
speeds
(c) towards the centre of the disc
(b) the thrust of the jet compensates for the force of gravity
(d) away from the centre of the disc
(c) the flow of air around the wings causes an upward
26. A monkey is climbing up a rope, then the tension in the rope
force, which compensates for the force of gravity
(a) must be equal to the force applied by the monkey on (d) the weight of air whose volume is equal to the volume
the rope. of the plane is more than the weight of the plane
(b) must be less than the force applied by the monkey on 33. In an explosion, a body breaks up into two pieces of unequal
the rope. masses. In this
(c) must be greater than the force applied by the monkey (a) both parts will have numerically equal momentum
on the rope. (b) lighter part will have more momentum
(d) may be equal to, less than or greater the force applied (c) heavier part will have more momentum
by the monkey on the rope. (d) both parts will have equal kinetic energy
Mechanics D- 9
34. For inelastic collision between two spherical rigid bodies 44. The escape velocity of a body depends upon mass as
(a) the total kinetic energy is conserved (a) m0 (b) m1
(c) m 2 (d) m3
(b) the total mechanical energy is not conserved
(c) the linear momentum is not conserved 45. There is no atmosphere on the moon because
(d) the linear momentum is conserved (a) it is closer to the earth and also it has the inactive inert
35. If a running boy jumps on a rotating table, which of the gases in it.
following is conserved? (b) it is too for from the sun and has very low pressure in
(a) Linear momentum (b) K.E its outer surface.
(c) Angular momentum (d) None of these (c) escape velocity of gas molecules is greater than their
36. A gymnast takes turns with her arms and legs stretched. root mean square velocity.
When she pulls her arms and legs (d) escape velocity of gas molecules is less than their root
(a) the angular velocity decreases mean square velocity.
(b) the moment of inertia decreases 46. A missile is launched with a velocity less than escape
(c) the angular velocity stays constant velocity. The sum of its kinetic and potential energies is
(d) the angular momentum increases (a) zero
37. Two bodies A and B have masses M and m respectively (b) negative
where M > m and they are at a distance d apart. Equal force (c) positive
is applied to them so that they approach each other. The (d) may be positive, negative or zero
position where they hit each other is 47. If the earth rotates faster than its present speed, the weight
(a) nearer to B of an object will
(b) nearer to A (a) increase at the equator but remain unchaged at the
(c) at equal distance from A and B poles
(d) cannot be determined (b) decrease at the equator but remain unchanged at the
38. When a steady torque is acting on a body, the body poles
(a) continues in its state of rest or uniform motion along a (c) remain unchaged at the equator but decrease at the
straight line poles
(b) gets linear acceleration (d) remain unchanged at the equator but increase at the
(c) gets angular acceleration poles
(d) rotates at a constant speed 48. The maximum kinetic energy of a planet moving around the
39. A couple produces a sun is at a position B
(a) pure linear motion (a) A
(b) pure rotational motion (b) B A Sun C
(c) no motion.
(c) C
(d) both linear and rotational motion
(d) D D
40. A balloon filled with CO2 released on earth would (neglect
viscosity of air) 49. A man waves his arms while walking. This is to
(a) climb with an acceleration 9.8 m/s2 (a) keep constant velocity
(b) fall with an acceleration 9.8 m/s2 (b) ease the tension
(c) fall with a constant acceleration 3.4 m/s2 (c) increase the velocity
(d) fall with acceleration and then would attain a constant (d) balance the effect of earth’s gravity
velocity 50. A ball is dropped from a satellite revolving round the earth
41. When a satellite is in the synchronous orbit above the at a height of 120 km. The ball will
equator, it stays in one place with reference to the earth by (a) continue to move with same speed along a straight line
making each revolution in just the same time as it takes the tangentially to the satellite at that time.
earth to rotate once. What is the altitude of the synchronous (b) continue to move with the same speed along the original
orbit? orbit of satellite.
(a) 20000 km (b) 30000 km (c) fall down to earth gradually
(c) 32500 km (d) 36000 km (d) go far away in space
42. If the earth stops rotating about its axis, the acceleration 51. Two satellites of earth, S1 and S2 are moving in the same
due to gravity will remain unchanged at orbit. The mass of S1 is four times the mass of S2. Which one
(a) equator (b) latitude 45° of the following statements is true?
(c) latitutde 60° (d) poles (a) The potential energies of earth satellites in the two
43. Time period of a simple pendulum inside a satellite orbiting cases are equal.
earth is (b) S1 and S2 are moving with the same speed.
(a) zero (b) ¥ (c) The kinetic energy of the two satellites are equal.
(c) T (d) 2 T (d) The time period of S1 is four times that of S2.
D- 10 Mechanics
52. If suddenly the gravitational force of attraction between the 54. Kepler’s second law (law of area) is nothing but a statement
earth and a satellite revolving around it becomes zero, then of
the satellite will (a) work energy theorem
(a) continue to move in its orbit with same speed (b) conservation of linear momentum
(b) move tangentially to the original orbit with same speed (c) conservation of angular momentum
(c) become stationary in its orbit (d) conservation of energy
(d) move towards the earth 55. A person sitting on a chair in a satellite feels weightless
53. Which one of the following statements regarding artificial because
satellite of the earth is incorrect ? (a) the earth does not attract the objects in a satellite
(a) The orbital velocity depends on the mass of the (b) the normal force by the chair on the person balances
satelllite the earth’s attraction
(c) the normal force is zero
(b) A minimum velocity of 8 km/sec is required by a satellite
(d) the person in satellite is not accelerated
to orbit quite close to the earth
56. A hole is drilled through the earth along the diameter and a
(c) The period of revolution is large if the radius of its stone is dropped into it. When the stone is at the centre of
orbit is large earth, it possesses
(d) The height of a geostationary satellite is about (a) weight (b) mass
36000 km from earth (c) acceleration (d) potential energy
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 11 (d) 21 (b) 31 (d ) 41 (d) 51 (b)
2 (a) 12 (a, b ) 22 (c) 32 (b ) 42 (d) 52 (b)
3 (d ) 13 (a, b ) 23 (b, d ) 33 (a) 43 (b) 53 (a)
4 (b ) 14 (c) 24 (c) 34 (d ) 44 (a) 54 (c)
5 (b ) 15 (c) 25 (c) 35 (c) 45 (d) 55 (c)
6 (c) 16 (b, c) 26 (a) 36 (b ) 46 (b) 56 (b)
7 (a) 17 (b) 27 (b) 37 (b ) 47 (b)
8 (b ) 18 (d) 28 (c) 38 (c) 48 (a)
9 (b ) 19 (a) 29 (d) 39 (b ) 49 (d)
10 (c) 20 (c) 30 (c) 40 (c) 50 (b)
30. (c) We can assume that three particles of equal mass m are 41. (d) The period of revolution of the satellite must be exactly
placed at the corners of triangle one day, or 86400s. The centripetal acceleration of the
r r r satellite must be 4p2r/T2, the gravitational field must be
r1 = 0iˆ + 0 ˆj , r2 = biˆ + 0 ˆj and r3 = 0iˆ + hjˆ
g = g0 (r0/r)2. In free fall, a = g, so
r r r
uuur m1r1 + m2 r2 + m3r3 b h
\ rcm = = iˆ + ˆj (9.8m / s 2 ) (6.4 ´10 -6 m)2 (86400s) 2
m1 + m2 + m3 3 3 r =3
4p 2
æ b hö = 4.23 × 107m
i.e. coordinates of centre of mass is çè , ÷ø To get the altitude, subtract the radius of the earth. The
3 3
y satellite must be at an altitude of 36000 km.
(0,h) l
43. (b) Since, T = 2p
g
but inside the satellite g = 0
So, T = ¥
44. (a) n esc = 2gR , where R is radius of the planet.
x
(0,0) (b,0) Hence escape velocity is independent of m.
32. (b) When jet plane flies, it ejects gases in backward direction 47. (b) g ' = g - w2 R cos 2 l .
at very high velocity. From Newton’s third law, these
50. (b) The orbital speed of satellite is independent of mass of
gases provides the momentum to jet plane in forward
satellite, so the ball will behave as a satellite and will
direction plus compensates the force of gravity.
continue to move with the same speed in the original
33. (a) Both part will have numerically equal momentum and
orbit.
lighter part will have more velocity.
51. (b) Since orbital velocity of satellite is
34. (d) For inelastic collision between two spherical rigid
bodies K.E. is not conserved as it is converted into GM
other forms like heat, light sound etc. but total linear v0 = , it does not depend upon the mass of the
r
momentum is conserved.
satellite.
35. (c) The boy does not exert a torque to rotating table by
Therefore, both satellites will move with same speed.
jumping, so angular momentum is conserved i.e.,
52. (b) Due to inertia of motion it will move tangentially to the
r
dL r original orbit with same velocity.
= 0 Þ L = constant.
dt 53. (a) v0 = gR i.e., v0 independent of mass of the satellite.
36. (b) Since no external torque act on gymnast, so angular 54. (c) From Kepler's 2nd law – The straight line joining the
momentum (L = Iw) is conserved. After pulling her arms sun and the planet sweeps out equal areas in equal
& legs, the angular velocity increases but moment of
inertia of gymnast, decreases in, such a way that angular dA
time intervals ( = const; area swept)
momentum remains constant. dt
37. (b) As net external force on the system is zero therefore Areal velocity of the satellite is given by
position of their centre of mass remains unaffected i.e.
dA 1 2 L
they will hit each other at the point of centre of mass. = wr = const. =
The centre of mass of the system lies nearer to A because dt 2 2m
MA > MB. where w = angular velocity of the satellite
38. (c) t = Ia L = mvr = mwr2 = const, showing that Kepler's 2nd law
39. (b) Two forces equal in magnitude but opposite in direction is a consequence of the conservation of angular
form a couple which tends to rotate the body. momentum.
40. (c) If B is upthrust of air on balloon, and a is downward 55. (c) The weightlessness inside a satellite is due to the fact
acceleration, then that the surface does not exert any force on the body
and hence its apparent weight is zero.
Mg – B = Ma
56. (b) At the centre of earth, weight is zero as g = 0 at
Mg - B V rair g center of earth.
Þ a= =g-
M V rCO2 weight = mg = 0 and Potential energy = mgh
But mass ¹ 0 as mass is the quantity of matter.
æ Vrair ö æ 28.8 ö 2
= ç1 - ÷÷ g = ç1 - ÷ ´ 9.8 m / s
ç VrCO è 44 ø
è 2 ø
= 3.4 m/s2
D- 12 Properties of Matter
CHAPTER
2 Properties of Matter
Elasticity and Plasticity (ii) Brittle materials : The materials which have very small
The property of the body to regain its original configuration range of plastic extension are called brittle materials. These
(length, or shape) when the deforming forces are removed is materials break as soon as the stress is increased beyond
called elasticity. On the other hand, if the body does not have the elastic limit. e.g., glass, ceramics, cast iron, etc.
any tendency to regain its original configuration on removal of (iii) Elastomers : The materials which can be stretched to large
deforming force the body is called plastic body and this property values of strain are called elastomers. e.g., rubber, elastic
is called plasticity. tissue of aorta, etc.
Perfectly elastic body : A body which regains its original Young’s modulus of elasticity (Y) : It is defined as the ratio of
configuration immediately and completely after the removal of normal stress to the longitudinal strain within the elastic limit.
deforming force from it, is called perfectly elastic body. Quartz Normal stress
and phosphor bronze, are closed to perfectly plastic body. Thus, Y =
Longitudinal strain
Perfectly plastic body : A body which does not regain its original
F / p r 2 MgL0
configuration at all on the removal of deforming force, however or, Y= =
small the deforming force may be is called perfectly plastic body. Dl / L0 pr 2 Dl
Putty and mud are closed to perfectly plastic body. Thermal Stress
Stress When a rod is rigidly fixed at its two ends and its temperature is
The internal restoring force acting per unit area of a body is changed, then a thermal stress is set up in the rod. And the
called stress. corresponding strain developed is called thermal strain.
i.e., Stress = Restoring force/ Area Force F
Thermal stress = = = Y a Dq.
Strain Area of cross section A
The ratio of change in configuration to the original where a = coefficient of linear expansion of the rod
configuration is called strain.
Dq = change in temperature.
Change in configuration Fluids
i.e., Strain =
Original configuration Fluids are the substances that can flow. Therefore liquids and
Strain being the ratio of two like quantities has no units and gases both are fluids. The study of fluids at rest is called fluid
dimensions. statics or hydrostatics and the study of fluids in motion is called
Elastic Limit fluid dynamics or hydrodynamics. Both combined are called fluid
Elastic limit is the upper limit of deforming force up to which, if mechanics.
deforming force is removed, the body regains its original form Density (r)
completely and beyond which, if deforming force is increased, Mass per unit volume is defined as density. So density at a point
the body loses its property of elasticity and gets permanently of a fluid is represented as
deformed.
Dm dm
Hooke’s law r = lim =
D
D V ®0 V dV
It states that within the elastic limit stress is directly proportional
where m is the mass and v is the volume of the fluid.
to strain.
Relative Density
i.e., Stress µ strain
It is defined as the ratio of the density of the given fluid to the
or Stress = E × strain
density of pure water at 4°C.
Stress Density of given liquid
or = E = constant
Strain Relative density (R.D). =
Density of pure water at 4°C
Here E is the coefficient of proportionality and is called modulus
The density of water is maximum at 4°C and is equal to
of elasticity or coefficient of elasticity of a body.
1.0 × 103 kgm–3
Materials-Ductile, Brittle and Pressure
Elastomers If a uniform force is exerted normal to an area (A), then average
(i) Ductile materials : The materials which have large range pressure (pav) is defined as the normal force (F) per unit area.
of plastic extension are called ductile materials. They can
be drawn into thin wires, e.g., copper, silver, aluminium, F
i.e., pav =
iron, etc. A
Properties of Matter D- 13
DF
In limiting sense, pressure p = lim . Pressure is a scalar Factors Affecting Viscosity
quantity. DA ® 0 DA (1) Effect of temperature : On increasing temperature viscosity
SI unit : pascal (Pa), 1 Pa = 1 N/m2 of a liquid decreases. While it increases in the case of gases.
Practical units: atmospheric pressure (atm), bar and torr (2) Effect of pressure : On increasing pressure viscosity of a
1 atm = 1.01325 × 105Pa = 1.01325 bar = 760 torr = 760mm of Hg liquid increases but viscosity of water decreases. Viscosity
column pressure. of gases is independent of pressure.
Pascal's Law of Transmission of Fluid Pressure Stoke’s Law
Pascal's law is stated in following ways : According to stoke’s law, the viscous drag force F on a spherical
• The pressure in a fluid at rest is same at all the points if body of radius r moving through a fluid of viscosity h with a
gravity is ignored. velocity called terminal velocity v is given by
• A liquid exerts equal pressures in all directions. F=6 phrv
• If the pressure in an enclosed fluid is changed at a particular Terminal Velocity
point, the change is transmitted to every point of the fluid
It is maximum constant velocity acquired by the body while
and to the walls of the container without being diminished
falling freely in a viscous medium.
in magnitude.
Applications of Pascal's law : Hydraulic machines, lifts, 2r 2 (r - s) g
presses and brakes, are based on the Pascal's law. VT =
9h
Atmospheric Pressure
Surface Tension
Force exerted by air column on unit cross-section area of sea
level is called atmospheric pressure (P0) Surface tension is basically a property of liquid. The liquid surface
behaves like a stretched elastic membrane which has a natural
F tendency to contract and tends to have a minimum possible surface
P0 = = 101.3 kN / m2
A area. This property of liquid is called surface tension.
Barometer is used to measure atmospheric pressure which was
Force F
discovered by Torricelli. Surface tension T =
Atmospheric pressure varies from place to place and at a particular Length L
place from time to time. Examples of surface tension
Buoyancy and Archimed Principle (i) Raindrops are spherical in shape.
If a body is partially or wholly immersed in a fluid, it experiences (ii) The hair of a shaving brush cling together when taken out
an upward force due to the fluid surrounding it. This phenomenon of water.
of force exerted by fluid on the body is called buoyancy and force (iii) Oil spread on cold water but remains as a drop on hot water
is called buoyant force or upthrust. etc.
Archimedes’ Principle : It states that the buoyant force on a
Angle of Contact (q)
body that is partially or totally immersed in a fluid equal to the
weight of the fluid displaced by it. The angle enclosed between the tangent plane at the liquid
Bernoulli’s Principle surface and the tangent plane at the solid surface at the point of
contact inside the liquid is termed as the angle of contact.
When incompressible, non-viscous, irrotational liquid i.e., ideal
liquid flow from one position to other in streamline path then in Angle of contact of various solid-liquid pairs
its path at every point, the sum of pressure energy, kinetic energy Solid - liquid pair qC
and potential energy per unit volume remains constant. Glass -normal water 8°
Glass -distilled water 0° Acute angle
1 2 1 2
i.e., P1 + rgh1 + r v1 = P2 + rgh2 + rv2 Glass - alcohol 0°
2 2
2 Glass - mercury 135°
rv Obtuse angle
\ P + rgh + = constant Paraffin wax - water 108°
2
Viscosity Silver - water 90° Right angle
The property of a fluid due to which it opposes the relative Capillarity
motion between its different layers is called viscosity (or fluid A glass tube with fine bore and open at both ends is known as
friction or internal friction) and the force between the layers capillary tube. The property by virtue of which a liquid rise or
opposing the relative motion is called viscous force. fall in a capillary tube is known as capillarity. Rise or fall of
According to Newton, the frictional force or viscous force between liquid in tubes of narrow bore (capillary tube) is called capillary
two layers depends upon the following factors : action. Rise of kerosene in lanterns, rise of ink in fountain pen
dv etc. are due to capillary action.
FµA
dy
dv
or F = -h A
dy
where, h is a constant called coefficient of viscosity or simply
viscosity of fluid.
D- 14 Properties of Matter
EXERCISE
1. Kerosene oil rises up in a wick of a lantern because of 11. A body floats in a liquid containing in a beaker. The whole
(a) diffusion of the oil through the wick system as shown in Fig. is falling under gravity. The upthrust
(b) surface tension on the body due to liquid is
(c) buoyant force of air
(d) the gravitational pull of the wick (a) zero
(b) equal to weight of body in air
2. Two pieces of metal when immersed in a liquid have equal
(c) equal to weight of liquid displaced
upthrust on them; then
(a) both pieces must have equal weights (d) equal to weight of immersed part of the body
12. A water tank of height 10 m, completely filled with water is
(b) both pieces must have equal densities
placed on a level ground. It has two holes one at 3 m and the
(c) both pieces must have equal volumes
other at 7 m from its base. The water ejecting from
(d) both are floating to the same depth (a) both the holes will fall at the same spot
3. If the force on the surface is doubled and area is reduced to (b) upper hole will fall farther than that from the lower hole
half, pressure will (c) upper hole will fall closer than that from the lower hole
(a) become 2 times (b) become 3 times (d) more information is required
(c) become 4 times (d) remain unchanged 13. The lift of an air plane is based on
4. Pressure at a point inside a liquid does not depend on (a) Torricelli’s theorem
(a) the depth of the point below the surface of the liquid (b) bernoulli’s theorem
(b) the nature of the liquid (c) law of gravitation
(c) the acceleration due to gravity at that point (d) conservation of linear momentum
(d) the shape of the containing vessel 14. The rain drops falling from the sky neither injure us nor
5. The bulk modulus for an incompressible liquid is make holes on the ground because they move with
(a) zero (b) unity (a) constant acceleration (b) variable acceleration
(c) infinity (d) between 0 and 1 (c) variable speed (d) constant terminal velocity
15. Two soap bubbles are held by a tube. What will happen ?
6. An egg when placed in ordinary water sinks but floats when
(a) Air will travel from bigger to smaller bubble
placed in brine. This is because (b) Air will not travel
(a) density of brine is less than that of ordinary water (c) Air will travel through tube
(b) density of brine is equal to that of ordinary water (d) Nothing can be said
(c) density of brine is greater than that of ordinary water 16. With the increase of temperature, the surface tension of the
(d) None of these liquid
7. Water is flowing through a horizontal pipe in streamline (a) may increase or decrease depending on the density of
flow. At the narrowest part of the pipe liquid
(a) Velocity is maximum and pressure is minimum (b) remains the same
(b) Pressure is maximum and velocity is minimum (c) always increases
(c) Both the pressure and velocity are maximum (d) always decreases
(d) Both the velocity and pressure are minimum 17. According to Hooke’s law of elasticity, if stress is
8. The following four wires are made of the same material. increased, then the ratio of stress to strain
Which of these will have the largest extension when the (a) becomes zero (b) remains constant
(c) decreases (d) increases
same tension is applied ?
18. Liquid pressure at a point in a liquid does not depend on the
(a) Length = 50 cm , diameter = 0.5 mm (a) density of liquid
(b) Length = 100 cm, diameter = 1 mm (b) shape of the vessel in which the liquid is kept
(c) Length = 200 cm, diameter = 2 mm (c) depth of the point from the surface
(d) Length = 300 cm, diameter = 3 mm (d) acceleration due to gravity
9. A man is sitting in a boat which is floating in pond. If the 19. A container partly filled in a liquid is suspended from a spring
man drinks some water from the pond, the level of water in balance. A small body is gently dropped in the container.
the pond will The pointer of spring balance will
(a) rise a little (b) fall a little (a) read less (b) oscillate
(c) remain stationary (d) None of these (c) read the same (d) read more
10. In solids, interatomic forces are 20. Small droplets of a liquid are usually more spherical in shape
(a) totally repulsive than larger drops of the same liquid because
(b) totally attractive (a) force of surface tension is equal and opposite to the
(c) combination of (a) and (b) force of gravity
(b) force of surface tension predominates the force of
(d) None of these
gravity
Properties of Matter D- 15
(c) force of gravity predominates the force of surface 30. Water is flowing through a horizontal pipe line having a
tension restriction. Then
(d) force of gravity and force of surface tension act in the (a) pressure will be the same throughout the length of the
same direction and are equal pipe.
21. Which of the following materials is most elastic ? (b) pressure will be greater at the restriction.
(a) Rubber (b) Lead (c) pressure will be greater in the wider portion.
(c) Wood (d) Steel (d) None of these
22. A stretched rubber has 31 Paint-gun is based on
(a) increased kinetic energy (a) Bernoulli’s theorem (b) Archemedes’ principle
(b) increased potential energy (c) Boyle’s law (d) Newton’s laws of motion
(c) decreased kinetic energy 32. A tank filled with water has a hole at a certain height from its
(d) decreased potential energy bottom. The volume of water emerging out per second from
23. The load verses elongation graph for four wires is shown. the hole does not depend on
The thinnest wire is (a) the height of the level of liquid above the hole.
(b) the area of a hole.
Load a (c) the density of a liquid.
b (d) the acceleration due to gravity.
c 33. A boy carries a fish in one hand and a bucket of water in the
other hand. If he places the fish in the bucket, the weight
now carried by him.
d (a) is less than before (b) is more than before
(c) is the same as before (d) depends upon his speed
34. A drop of oil is placed on the surface of water. Which of the
Elongation following statements is correct?
(a) It will remain on it as a sphere
(a) a (b) b (b) It will spread as a thin layer
(c) c (d) d (c) It will partly be a spherical droplet and partly a thin film
24. Elastomers are the materials which (d) It will float as a distorted drop on the water surface
(a) are not elastic at all 35. For a fluid which is flowing steadily, the level in the vertical
(b) have very small elastic range tubes is best represented by
(c) do not obey Hooke’s law
(d) None of these
25. The lift in an aeroplane is based on
(a) Law of gravitation (b) Theorem of continuity (a)
(c) Pascal’s low (d) Bernoulli’s theorem
26. In the figure below is shown the flow of the liquid through a
horizontal pipe. Three tubes A, B and C are connected to the
pipe. The radii of the tubes A, B and C at the junction are
respectively 2 cm, 1 cm and 2 cms. It can be said that (b)
A B C
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b ) 8 (a) 15 (a) 22 (b ) 29 (b) 36 (d)
2 (c) 9 (c) 16 (d) 23 (b ) 30 (c) 37 (c)
3 (c) 10 (c) 17 (b) 24 (c) 31 (a) 38 (a)
4 (d ) 11 (a) 18 (b) 25 (d ) 32 (c) 39 (c)
5 (c) 12 (a) 19 (d) 26 (d ) 33 (c) 40 (c)
6 (c) 13 (b) 20 (b) 27 (c) 34 (b) 41 (a)
7 (a) 14 (b) 21 (d) 28 (b ) 35 (a) 42 (b)
3 Heat
Change of State AM
radio
FM T.V. x-rays
Infrared Ultraviolet
Any state of a substance (solid/ liquid/ gas) can be changed into 109 106 103 10° 10
–3
10
–6
10
–9
10
–12
10
–15
EXERCISE
1. Woollen clothes are used in winter season because woollen 12. By the first law of thermodynamics, for solids
clothes (a) dQ = dU + dW (b) dQ = dU
(a) are good sources for producing heat (c) dQ = dW + dU (d) dQ = dU / dW
(b) absorb heat form surroundings 13. There are four objects A, B, C and D. It is observed that A
(c) are bad conductors of heat and B are in thermal equilibrium and C and D are also in
(d) provide heat to body continuously thermal equilibrium. However, A and C are not in thermal
2. Water has maximum density at equilibrium. We can conclude that –
(a) 0°C (b) 32°F (a) B and D are in thermal equilibrium
(c) –4°C (d) 4°C (b) B and D could be in thermal equilibrium but might not
3. Expansion during heating be A and D
(a) occurs only in solids (c) B and D cannot be in thermal equilibrium
(b) increases the weight of a material (d) the zeroth law of thermodynamics does not apply here
(c) decreases the density of a material because there are more than three objects
(d) occurs at the same rate for all liquids and solids 14. According to the kinetic theory of gases
4. When a copper ball is heated, the largest percentage increase (a) all the atoms move horizontally with equal speeds
will occur in its (b) an atom moves faster during its downward motion than
(a) diameter (b) area its upward motion
(c) volume (d) density (c) at any instant one-third of the total atoms are moving
5. If a liquid is heated in condition of weightlessness, the heat along x-axis
is transmitted through (d) None of these
(a) conduction 15. The fastest mode of transfer of heat is
(b) convection (a) conduction (b) convection
(c) radiation (c) radiation (d) None of these
(d) None, because the liquid cannot be heated in 16. The wavelength of radiation emitted by a body depends
weightlessness upon
6. Heat travels through vacuum by (a) the nature of its surface
(a) conduction (b) convection (b) the area of its surface
(c) radiation (d) both (a) and (b) (c) the temperature of its surface
7. A bimetallic strip consists of brass and iron. When it is heated (d) All of the above
it bends into an arc with brass on the convex and iron on the 17. The sprinkling of water slightly reduces the temperature of a
concave side of the arc. This happens because closed room because
(a) brass has a higher specific heat capacity than iron (a) temperature of water is less than that of the room
(b) density of brass is more than that of iron (b) specific heat of water is high
(c) it is easier to bend an iron strip than a brass strip of the (c) water has large latent heat of vaporisation
same size (d) water is a bad conductor of heat
(d) brass has a higher coefficient of linear expansion than 18. Which of the following is not close to a black body?
iron (a) Black board paint (b) Green leaves
8. The earth radiates in the infra-red region of the spectrum. (c) Black holes (d) Red roses
The spectrum is correctly given by 19. A solid cube and a solid sphere of the same material have
(a) Wien’s law equal surface area. Both are at the same temperture 120°C ,
(b) Rayleigh's law then
(c) Planck’s law of radiation (a) both the cube and the sphere cool down at the same
(d) Stefan’s law of radiation rate
9. Good absorbers of heat are (b) the cube cools down faster than the sphere
(a) poor emitters (b) non-emitters (c) the sphere cools down faster than the cube
(c) good emitters (d) highly polished (d) whichever is having more mass will cool down faster
10. Which of the following qualities suit for a cooking utensil? 20. At a given temperature the internal energy of a substance
(a) High specific heat and low thermal conductivity (a) in liquid state is equal to that in gaseous state
(b) High specific heat and high thermal conductivity (b) in liquid state is less than that in gaseous state
(c) in liquid state is more than that in gaseous state
(c) Low specific heat and low thermal conductivity
(d) is equal for the three states of matter
(d) Low specific heat and high thermal conductivity
21. Consider two identical iron spheres , one which lie on a
11. 5g ice at 0ºC is mixed with 5g of steam at 100ºC . What is the
thermally insulating plate, while the other hangs from an
final temperature?
insulatory thread. Equal amount of heat is supplied to the
(a) 50ºC (b) 100ºC
two spheres
(c) 80ºC (d) 150ºC
Heat D- 21
31. Heat is transmitted from higher to lower temperature through
actual mass motion of the molecules in
(a) conduction (b) convection
(c) radiation (d) none of these
32. The temperature of a room is 77°F. What would it be on the
(a) Temperature of A will be greater than B Celsius scale?
(b) Temperature of B will be greater than A (a) 25°C (b) 45°C
(c) Their temperature will be equal
(c) 60°C (d) 350°C
(d) Can’t be predicted 33. Ventilators are provided at the top of room
22. Air conditioner is based on the principle of (a) to bring oxygen for breathing
(a) Carnot cycle (b) so that sunlight may enter the room
(b) refrigerator
(c) to maintain conventional currents to keep the air fresh
(c) first low of thermodynamics
in the room
(d) None of these
23. Gases exert pressure on the walls of the container because (d) to provide an outlet for carbon dioxide
the gas molecules 34. What temperature is the same on celsius scale as well as on
(a) possess momentum Fahrenheit scale?
(b) collide with each other (a) – 212°C (b) – 40°C
(c) have finite volume (c) – 32°C (d) 32°C
(d) obey gas laws 35. Two holes of unequal diameters d1 and d2 (d1 > d2) are cut in
24. Food in the pressure cooker is cooked faster, as a metal sheet. If the sheet is heated,
(a) the boiling point increases due to an increase in pressure
(b) the boiling point decreases due to an increase in
pressure
(c) more steam is available at 100°C
(d) more pressure is available at 100°C
25. A metal sheet with a circular hole is heated. The hole
(a) both d1 and d2 will decrease
(a) gets larger
(b) gets smaller (b) both d1 and d2 will increase
(c) remains of the same size (c) d1 will increase, d2 will decrease
(d) gets deformed (d) d1 will decrease, d2 will increase
26. When water is heated from 0ºC to 10ºC, its volume 36. At 0°C a body emits
(a) increases (a) no radiation
(b) decreases (b) only visible light
(c) does not change (c) only microwave radiation
(d) first decreases and then increases (d) all wavelengths.
27. A : At high altitude regions the cooking of food becomes 37. Triple point is the temperature at which
difficult. (a) matter may simultaneously exist in liquid and gaseous
B : Water boils at lower temperature when the pressure is state.
low. (b) matter may simultaneously exist in liquid and solid state.
(a) Both A and B are wrong. (c) matter may simultaneously exist in solid and gaseous
(b) A and B are correct and B is not the correct explanation state.
of A. (d) matter may simultaneously exist in all the three forms.
(c) A and B are correct and B is the correct explanation of
38. In order that the heat flows from one part of a solid to another
A.
part, what is required?
(d) A is correct but B is wrong.
28. When vapour condenses into liquid (a) Uniform density (b) Temperature gradient
(a) it absorbs heat (b) it liberates heat (c) Density gradient (d) Uniform temperature
(c) its temperature rises (d) its temperature decreases 39. At a common temperature, a block of wood and a block of
29. The temperature of the sun is measured with metal feel equally cold or hot. The temperatures of block and
(a) Platinum thermometer wood are
(b) Gas theromometer (a) equal to the temperature of the body
(c) Pyrometer (b) less than the temperature of the body
(d) Vapour pressure thermometer (c) greater than temperature of the body
30. Two spheres of same size are made of the same metal but (d) either (b) or (c)
one is hollow and the other is solid. They are heated to same 40. The bulb of one thermometer is spherical, while that of other
temperature, then is cylindrical. If both of them have equal amount of mercury,
(a) both spheres will expand equally which thermometer will respond quickly to the temperature?
(b) hollow sphere will expand more than the solid one (a) spherical bulb (b) cylindrical bulb
(c) solid sphere will expand more than the hollow one (c) elliptical bulb (d) both (a) and (c)
(d) None of the above
D- 22 Heat
41. Consider the following statements. (b) length of the rod.
(A) Some bodies may contract on heating (c) temperature difference across the rod.
(B) Water shows anamolous expansion. (d) All of these
(a) (A) is true and (B) is false 43. Which of the following represents convection ?
(b) (A) is false and (B) is true. (a) Land breeze
(c) Both (A) and (B) are true. (b) Exhaust fan
(d) Both (A) and (B) are false. (c) Heating water by keeping the vessel on a flame
42. The rate of flow of heat through a rod depends on: (d) All of these
(a) thermal conductivity of the rod.
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 9 (c) 17 (c) 25 (a) 33 (c) 41 (c)
2 (d ) 10 (d) 18 (a) 26 (d ) 34 (b ) 42 (d)
3 (c) 11 (b) 19 (b) 27 (c) 35 (b) 43 (d)
4 (c) 12 (c) 20 (b) 28 (b ) 36 (d)
5 (a) 13 (c) 21 (b) 29 (c) 37 (d)
6 (c) 14 (c) 22 (b) 30 (a) 38 (b)
7 (d ) 15 (c) 23 (a) 31 (b ) 39 (a)
8 (c) 16 (d) 24 (a) 32 (a) 40 (b)
4 Sound
Periodic Motion (a) Transverse wave : When the particles of the medium vibrate
Any motion that repeats itself in equal intervals of time is called in a direction perpendicular to the direction of
periodic motion. A periodic motion can be represented in terms propagation of the wave, the wave is known as the
of sines and cosines, so it is called a harmonic motion. The transverse wave. For example, waves produced in a
uniformly rotating earth represents a periodic motion that repeats stretched string, waves on the surface. These waves travel
itself at every 24 hours. in form of crests and troughs. These waves can travel in
solids and liquids only.
Simple Harmonic Motion (S.H.M.)
(b) Longitudinal wave : When the particles of the medium
Oscillatory motion in which the acceleration of the particle is vibrate along the direction of propagation of the wave
directly proportional to the displacement and directs towards then the wave is known as the longitudinal wave. For
a fixed point in a direction opposite to displacement is called example sound wave in air, waves in a solid rod produced
simple harmonic motion abbreviated as S.H.M. by scrabbing etc.
If a particle performs oscillatory motion such that its acceleration These waves travel in the form of compressions and rarefactions.
(a) and displacement (x) are related as below These waves can travel in solids, liquids and gases.
a µ – x, Electromagnetic Waves
then the motion of particle is simple harmonic. The waves which do not require medium for propagation are
An oscillatory motion is always periodic but a periodic motion called electromagnetic waves. This means that these waves can
may not be oscillatory. travel through vacuum also. For example, light waves, X-rays, g-
Examples of S.H.M. (i) clock pendulum, (ii) oscillating liquid in a rays, Infrared waves, radio waves, microwaves, etc. These waves
U-tube, (iii) oscillating block in a liquid, (iv) oscillating frictionless of transverse type.
piston fitted in a cylinder filled with ideal gas, etc. Difference between sound waves and electromagnetic waves
Sound (i) Sound waves are longitudinal and electromagnetic waves
Sound is a form of energy which produces a sensation of hearing are transverse.
in our ears. (ii) Sound waves travel at a speed of 340 m/s whereas
electromagnetic waves travel at a speed of 3 × 108 m/s
Source of Sound and its Propagation
(iii) Sound waves do not pass through a vacuum but
A source of vibration (vibration means a kind of rapid to and fro
electromagnetic waves (light) do.
motion of an object) is normally a source of sound. When we
Characteristics of Sound Waves
pluck a string of guitar or sitar or veena it produces sound. Similarly
Sound is characterised by three parameters :
vibrations of wings of bee or mosquito.
(i) Pitch (ii) Loudness (iii) Quality
Sound is emitted by vibrating source and is transmitted through
(i) Pitch : Pitch is the sensation (brain interpretation) of the
a material medium producing sensation of hearing in our ears.
frequency of an emitted sound and is the characteristic
The motion of a vibrating source sets up waves in the surrounding
which distinguishes a shrill (or sharp) sound from a grave
medium. (or flat) sound.
Sound Needs a Material Medium for its (ii) Loudness : Loudness or softness of a sound wave is the
Propagation sensation that depends upon its amplitude. The loudness
In the absence of medium (air) around the source, sound is not of sound is a measure of the sound energy reaching the ear
being propagated and light (electromagnetic) waves travel through per second.
the vacuum. The loudness of sound is measured in ‘decibel dB’. The
Mechanical Waves loudness of sound of people talking quietly is about 65 dB,
A mechanical wave is a periodic disturbance which requires a the loudness of sound in a very noisy factory is about
material medium for its propagation. The properties of these waves 100 dB.
depend on the medium so they are known as elastic waves, such (iii) Quality (Timber) : Quality or timber of a sound wave is
as sound-waves, water waves, waves in stretched string. On the that characteristic which helps us in distinguishing one
basis of motion of particles the mechanical waves are classified sound from another having same pitch and loudness. We
into two parts. recognise a person (without seeing) by listening to his
sound as it has a definite quality.
D- 24 Sound
A pure sound of single frequency is called a tone. Reverberation
An impure sound produced by mixture of many frequencies Persistence of sound after its production stopped, is called
is called a note. It is pleasant to listen. reverberation.
Reflection of Sound When a sound is produced in a big hall, its wave reflect from the
When sound waves strike a surface, they return back into the walls and travel back and forth. Due to this energy does not
same medium. This phenomenon is called reflection. reduce and the sound persist.
Laws of reflection of sound waves A short reverberation is desirable in a concert hall (where music
(i) Angle of incidence is equal to the angle of reflection. is being played) because it gives ‘life’ to sound.
(ii) The incident wave, the reflected wave and the normal all lie Speed of sound
in the same plane. Speed of sound through any medium depends upon elasticity
Echo and density of medium.
Phenomenon of hearing back our own sound is called an echo.
It is due to successive reflection from the surface of obstacles of (i) In solids, v = Y
d
large size.
Conditions for the formation of Echoes
(i) The minimum distance between the source of sound and (ii) In liquids, v = B
r
the reflecting body should be 17.2 metres.
(ii) The wavelength of sound should be less than the height of
gP gRT g = CP
the reflecting body. (iii) In gases, v = , v= ;
r M Cv
(iii) The intensity of sound should be sufficient so that it can
be heard after reflection.
EXERCISE
1. Ultrasonic waves have frequency (c) the sound is reflected from the head
(a) below 20 Hz (d) the wavelength of the sound is much smaller than the
(b) between 20 and 20,000 Hz head
(c) only above 20,000 Hz 7. A thunder clap is heard 5.5 second after the lightening flash.
The distance of the flash is
(d) only above 20,000 MHz
(velocity of sound in air = 330 m/s)
2. Voice of your friend can be recognized by its (a) 1780 m (b) 1815 m
(a) pitch (b) quality (c) 300 m (d) 3560 m
(c) intensity (d) velocity 8. Which of the following is carried by the waves from one
3. The ratio of the speed of a body to the speed of sound is place to another ?
called (a) Mass (b) Velocity
(a) Sonic index (b) Doppler ratio (c) Wavelength (d) Energy
(c) Mach number (d) Refractive index 9. Human ears can sense sound waves travelling in air having
4. The velocity of sound is largest in wavelength of
(a) water (b) air (a) 10–3 m (b) 10–2 m
(c) 1m (d) 102 m
(c) metal (d) vacuum
10. The frequency of a wave travelling at a speed of 500 ms–1 is
5. An underwater explosion is caused near the sea-shore. There 25Hz. Its time period is
are two observers, X under water and Y on land, each at a (a) 20 s (b) 0.05 s
distance of 1 km from the point of explosion then (c) 25 s (d) 0.04 s
(a) X will hear the sound earlier 11. The velocity of sound in any gas depends upon
(b) Y will hear the sound earlier (a) wavelength of sound only
(c) Both will hear the sound at the same time (b) density and elasticity of gas
(d) Y will not hear the sound at all (c) intensity of sound waves only
6. If you are at open-air concert and someone’s head gets (d) amplitude and frequency of sound
between you and the orchestra, you can still hear the 12. What is the effect of humidity on sound waves when humidity
increases?
orchestra because
(a) Speed of sound waves is more
(a) sound waves pass easily through a head (b) Speed of sound waves is less
(b) a head is not very large compared with the wavelength (c) Speed of sound waves remains same
of the sound (d) Speed of sound waves becomes zero
Sound D- 25
13. Which of the following is used to find the depth of sea? 21. Resonance is an example of
(a) RADAR (b) SONAR (a) tuning fork (b) forced vibration
(c) ECHO (d) None of these (c) free vibration (d) damped vibration
14. Echo is a type of 22. A hollow sphere is filled with water. It is hung by a long
(a) reflected sound thread. As the water flows out of a hole at the bottom, the
(b) refracted sound period of oscillation will
(c) neither reflected sound nor refracted sound (a) first increase and then decrease
(d) None of these (b) first decrease and then increase
15. A shrill sound has a ______ pitch and a dull sound has a (c) go on increasing
_____ pitch. (d) go on decreasing
(a) high, low (b) low, high 23. If a tunnel is dug along the diameter of earth and a piece of
(c) low, low (d) high, high stone is dropped into it, then the stone will
16. _____ is the characteristic of a musical sound by which a (a) come out of the another end of the earth and will escape
loud sound can be distinguished from a faint sound even out in space
though both have the same pitch. (b) come to rest at the centre of the earth
(a) Loundness (b) Pitch (c) start oscillating about the centre of the earth
(c) Quality (d) None of these (d) stop at another end of the earth
17. If you go on increasing the stretching force on a wire in a 24. Which of the following statements is incorrect regarding
guitar, its frequency. the time period of a simple pendulum oscillating with small
(a) increases (b) decreases amplitude? The time period of the pendulum
(c) remains unchanged (d) None of these
(a) is inversely proportional to g
18. A vibrating body
(a) will always produce sound (b) is directly proportional to l
(b) may or may not produce sound if the amplitude of (c) does not depend upon the amplitude
vibration is low (d) depends upon its mass, material and shape
(c) will produce sound which depends upon frequency 25. Range of audio-frequencies is
(d) None of these (a) 1 – 15 Hz (b) 20 – 20, 000 Hz
19. The wavelength of infrasonics in air is of the order of (c) 103 – 105 Hz (d) 106 – 108 Hz
(a) 100 m (b) 101 m 26. The marching soldiers break steps while crossing a bridge
(c) 10 m–1 (d) 10–2 m because of
20. When a sound wave goes from one medium to another, the (a) damped oscillations (b) resonance
quantity that remains unchanged is (c) echo (d) reverberation
(a) frequency (b) amplitude
(c) wavelength (d) speed
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 6 (b) 11 (b) 16 (a) 21 (b) 26 (b)
2 (b ) 7 (b) 12 (a) 17 (a) 22 (a)
3 (c) 8 (d) 13 (b) 18 (c) 23 (c)
4 (c) 9 (c) 14 (a) 19 (b ) 24 (d)
5 (a) 10 (d) 15 (a) 20 (a) 25 (b)
5 Optics
Magnification 1
The power of a lens is defined as P = . The unit of power
f (in m)
If a thin object linear size O situated vertically on the axis of a is diopter.
mirror at a distance u from the pole and its image of size I is Focal length of a lens (lens maker’s formula)
formed at a distance v (from the pole), magnification (transverse)
is defined as 1 é1 1 ù
= ( m –1) ê - ú
m l
f ë R1 R2 û
(+ve means erect image) where mml refractive index of lens with respect to medium.
(–ve means inverted image) R1 = radius of curvature of first surface of lens, R2 = radius of
é I ù évù curvature of second surface of lens.
m= ê ú = ê ú (|m| >1 means large image)
ëO û ëu û Total Internal Reflection
(|m| < 1 means small image) When the object is placed in an optically denser medium and if
the incident angle is greater than the critical angle then the ray of
Refraction of Light light gets reflected back to the originating medium. This
When a ray of light passes from one medium to another medium phenomenon is called total internal reflection.
it bends – towards the normal when goes from rarer to denser Critical angle (ic) : When a ray passes from an optically denser
and away from the normal when goes from denser to rarer medium to an optically rarer medium, the angle of refraction r is
medium. This phenomenon is called refraction of light. greater than the corresponding angle of incidence i. From Snell’s
Twinkling of stars, sun is visible to us about 2 minutes before the law.
actual sunrise, and about 2 minutes after actual sunset etc. due to Let m1 = m and m 2 = 1 and let for i = ic, r = 90º then sin i c = 1/ m
atmospheric refraction. 1
\ i c = sin -1; i is called the critical angle.
Refractive index m c
Refractive index of medium II with respect to medium I This phenomenon takes place in shining of air bubble, sparkling
of diamond, mirage, looming, in optical communication,
Speed of light in medium I endoscopy using optical fibre.
m 21 =
Speed of light in medium II
Dispersion of Light
Laws of Refraction When a white ray of light or sunlight passes through a prism it
breakes into its seven constituents colours violet, indigo, blue,
(i) Snell’s law : For any two media and for light of a given green, yellow, orange and red (VIBGYOR). This phenomenon
wavelength, the ratio of the sine of the angle of incidence to is called dispersion of light. The band of seven constituents
the sine of the angle of refraction is a constant. colours is called spectrum. The deviation is maximum for violet
colour and least for red colour.
D- 28 Optics
The Rainbow Astigmatism : Astigmatism is the most common refractive
A rainbow is a spectrum of white light from the sun. This is a problem responsible for blurry vision. Most of the eyeball’s
phenomenon due to combined effect of dispersion, refraction focusing power occurs along the front surface of the eye, involving
and reflection of sunlight by spherical water droplets of rain. the tear film and cornea (the clear ‘window’ along the front of the
(i) Primary rainbow: It is formed due to two refractions and eyeball).
one total internal reflection of the light incident on the
The ideal cornea has a perfectly round surface. Anything other
droplet. Sunlight is first refracted as it enters a raindrop
which cause different colours of light to separate. The than perfectly round contributes to abnormal corneal curvature–
observer sees a rainbow with red colour on the top and this is astigmatism. Cylindrical lens is use to correct astigmatism.
violet on the bottom. Microscope
(ii) Secondary rainbow: It is formed due to two refractions and
two total internal reflection of light incident on the water It is an optical instrument used to see magnified image of a tiny
droplet. It is due to four - step process. The intensity of objects.
light is reduced at the second reflection and hence the
secondary rainbow is fainter than the primary rainbow. Resolving power (R.P.) of a microscope
Resolving power of a microscope is defined as the reciprocal of
Scattering of Light
the least separation between two close objects, so that they
As sunlight travels through the earth’s atmosphere it gets appear just separated, when seen through the microscope.
scattered by the small particles present in the atmosphere.
According to Rayleigh law, the amount of scattering is inversely 1 2m sin q
Resolving power of a microscope = =
d l
æ 1 ö
proportional to the fourth power of the wavelength ç ÷. q = half angle of the cone of light from the point object
è l4 ø
m sin q = numerical aperture
Phenomenon based on scattering of light
(i) Blue colour of sky: Blue colour has a shorter wavelength Telescope (Astronomical)
than red colour therefore blue colour is scattered strongly. It is an optical instrument used to increase the visual angle of
Hence the bluish colour predominates in a clear sky. distant large objects.
(ii) White colour of clouds: Clouds contain large dust particles,
water droplets or ice particles. These large sized Particles It is used to see far off objects clearly.
do not obey Rayleigh law of scattering. All wavelengths Resolving power (R.P.) of a telescope
are scattered nearly equally. Hence clouds are generally Resolving power of telescope is defined as the reciprocal of the
white.
smallest angular separation between two distant objects, so
(iii) Sun looks reddish at the Sunset or Sunrise: At sunset or that they appear just separated, when seen through the telescope.
sunrise, the sun’s rays have to pass through a larger
distance in the atmosphere. Most of the blue and other D
Resolving power of telescope =
shorter wavelengths are scattered. The least scattered light 1.22l
reaching our eyes, therefore the sun looks reddish.
Interference of Light Waves
Power of Accomodation of Eye
The phenomenon of redistribution of light energy in a medium
The ability of the lens to change its shape to focus near and due to superposition of light waves from two coherent sources is
distant objects is called accommodation. called interference of light.
A normal human eye can see objects clearly that are between Conditions for sustained interference:
25 cm and infinity. (i) Two sources must be coherent.
Defects of Vision and Their Correction (ii) Amplitudes of waves should be either equal or
Nearsightedness: If the eyeball is too long or the lens too approximately equal.
spherical, the image of distant objects is brought to a focus in (iii) Light should be monochromatic.
front of the retina and is out of focus again before the light strikes Polarisation
the retina. Nearby objects can be seen more easily. Eyeglasses
with concave lenses correct this problem by diverging the light It is the phenomenon of restricting the vibration of light in a
rays before they enter the eye. Nearsightedness is called myopia. particular plane.
Light waves are transverse in nature i.e., the electric field vector
Farsightedness: If the eyeball is too short or the lens too flat or
inflexible, the light rays entering the eye — particularly those associated with light wave is always at right angles to the direction
from nearby objects— will not be brought to a focus by the time of propagation of the wave. When unpolarised light is incident
they strike the retina. Eyeglasses with convex lenses can correct on a polaroid (Nicol Prism), the light wave gets linearly polarised
the problem. Farsightedness is called hypermetropia. i.e., the vibration of electric field vector are along a single direction.
Optics D- 29
EXERCISE
1. When the distance between the object and the plane mirror (b) the sun is cooler at sunrise or at sunset
increases (c) refraction causes this phenomenon
(a) the image remains same (d) diffraction sends red rays to the earth at these times
(b) the size of the image will become less than the size of
12. A person cannot see objects clearly which are nearer than
the object
75 cm from his eyes, the disease he is suffering from is
(c) the distance between the image and the plane mirror
increases (a) astigmatism (b) myopia
(d) the distance between the image and the plane mirror (c) hypermetropia (d) presbyopia
decreases 13. For seeing a cricket match, we prefer binoculars to the
2. In lateral inversion terrestrial telescope, because
(a) right side of the object will be right side of the image. (a) binoculars give three-dimensional view
(b) left side of the object will be left side of the image. (b) terrestrial telescope gives inverted image
(c) upside of the object will be down side of the object.
(c) to avoid chromatic aberration
(d) right side of the object will be left side of the image.
3. The sun is seen before the actual sunrise because of (d) to have larger magnification
(a) reflection 14. Dispersion is the term used to describe
(b) refraction (a) the propagation of light in straight lines
(c) scattering of light (b) the splitting of a beam of light into component colours
(d) rectilinear propagation of light (c) the bending of a beam of light when it strikes a mirror
4. Butter paper is an example for ............. object. (d) the change that takes place in white light after passage
(a) a transparent (b) a translucent through red glass
(c) an opaque (d) a luminous 15. Consider telecommunication through optical fibres.
5. Power of accommodation of eye implies
Which of the following statement is not true?
(a) control intensity
(a) Optical fibres can be of graded refractive index
(b) prevent internal reflection of light
(b) Optical fibres have extremely low transmission loss
(c) change of focal length of eye lens
(c) Optical fibres are subject to electromagnetic
(d) All of the above
6. Which of the following parts of eye protects the eye and interference from outside
gives it shape? (d) Optical fibres may have homogeneous core with a
(a) Choroid (b) Sclera suitable cladding
(c) Yellow spot (d) Ciliary muscles 16. An optician while testing the eyes finds the vision of a
7. The human eye forms the image of an object at its patient to be 6/12. By this he means that
(a) cornea (b) iris (a) the person can read the letters of 6 inches from a
(c) pupil (d) retina distance of 12 m
(b) the person can read the letters of 12 inches from 6 m
8. Rainbow is caused due to
(c) the person can read the letters of 6 m which the normal
(a) reflection of sun light from air particles
eye can read from 12 m
(b) dispersion of sun light from water drops
(d) the focal length of eye lens had become half that of the
(c) interference of light normal eye
(d) diffraction of sun rays from water drops 17. A mirage occurs because
9. In the visible spectrum the colour having the shortest
(a) the refractive index of atmosphere increases with
wavelength is
height
(a) green (b) red
(b) the refractive index of atmosphere decreases with
(c) violet (d) blue
height
10. The splitting of white light into seven colours on
(c) the hot ground acts like a mirror
passing through a glass prism is due to
(a) refraction (b) reflection (d) refractive index remains constant with height
(c) interference (d) diffraction 18. A well cut diamond appears bright because
11. At sunrise or at sunset the sun appears to be reddish while (a) of reflection of light
at mid-day it looks white. This is because (b) of dispersion of light
(a) scattering due to dust particles and air molecules causes (c) of the total internal reflection
this phenomenon (d) of refraction of light
D- 30 Optics
19. Twinkling of stars is on account of
(a) large distance of stars and storms in air
(b) small size of stars
(c) large size of stars
(d) large distance of stars and fluctuations in the density
of air
20. A coin in a beaker filled with water appears raised. This
phenomenon occurs because of the property of
(a) reflection of light
(a) region I will be slightly brighter than the hill and region
(b) refraction of light
II will be slightly brighter than the sky
(c) total internal reflection of light (b) region I will be slightly darker than the hill and region
(d) interference of light II will be slightly brighter than the sky
21. A spherical air bubble is embedded in a piece of glass. For (c) region I will be slightly brighter than the hill and region
II will be slightly darker than the sky
a ray of light passing through the bubble, it behaves like a
(d) region I will be slightly darker than the hill and region
(a) converging lens (b) diverging lens II will be slightly darker than the sky
(c) plano-converging lens (d) plano-diverging lens 30. The ability of an optical instrument to show the images of
22. ‘The stars seem to be higher on the sky than they actually two adjacent point objects as separate is called
are’. This can be explained by (a) dispersive power (b) magnifying power
(c) resolving power (d) None of these
(a) atmospheric refraction (b) dispersion of light
31. Total internal reflection can take place only if
(c) total internal reflection (d) diffraction of light (a) light goes from optically rarer medium to optically
23. Yellow colour light is used as fog light because yellow colour denser medium
(a) light is most scattered by fog (b) light goes from optically denser medium to rarer medium
(c) the refractive indices of the two media are close to
(b) has the longest wavelength among all colours
different
(c) has the longest wavelength among all colours except (d) the refractive indices of the two media are widely
red and orange but the red colour is already used for different
brake light and stop light whereas orange colour is 32. The least distance of distinct vision of a normal eye of an
avoided due to its similarity with red adult is
(d) has the shortest wavelength among all colours (a) 25 m (b) 25 cm
(c) 25 mm (d) None of these
24. The mirror used for the head light of a car is
33. Rear-view mirror used in a vehicle is a
(a) spherical concave (b) plane (a) concave mirror (b) convex mirror
(c) cylindrical (d) parabolic concave (c) plane mirror (d) None of these
25. Soap bubble looks coloured due to 34. Magnification produced by a rear view mirror fitted in
(a) dispersion (b) reflection vehicles
(c) interference (d) Any one of these (a) is less than one
26. A star is emitting yellow light. If it is accelerated towards (b) is more than one
earth then to an observer on earth, it will appear (c) is equal to one
(a) shinning yellow (d) can be more than or less than one depending upon the
position of the object in front of it
(b) gradually changing to violet
35. A child is standing in front of a magic mirror. She finds the
(c) gradually changing to red
image of her head bigger, the middle portion of her body of
(d) unchanged the same size and that of the legs smaller. The following is
27. What should be refractive index of a transparent medium to the order of combinations for the magic mirror from the top.
be invisible in vacuum? (a) Plane, convex and concave
(a) 1 (b) < 1 (b) Convex, concave and plane
(c) > 1 (d) None of these (c) Concave, plane and convex
28. When a drop of oil is spread on a water surface, it displays (d) Convex, plane and concave
beautiful colours in daylight because of 36. When a CD (compact disc used in audio and video systems)
(a) dispersion of light (b) reflection of light is seen in sunlight, rainbow like colours are seen. This can
(c) polarization of light (d) interference of light be explained on the basis of the phenomenon of
29. Smoke emerging from a campfire at the bottom of a hill is (a) reflection and diffraction
being observed by a person at some distance, as shown in (b) reflection and transmission
the figure. It is evening and the sun has just set behind the (c) diffraction and transmission
hill. Consider regions I and II of the smoke going up the sky (d) refraction, diffraction and transmission
Optics D- 31
37. A watch shows times as 3 : 25 when seen through a mirror, 39. For which wavelength of light is our eye most sensitives
time appeared will be (a) 3.00 nm (b) 555 nm
(a) 8 : 35 (b) 9 : 35 (c) 200 nm (d) 800 nm
(c) 7 : 35 (d) 8 : 25 40. The acronym for LASER is
38. The fine powder of a coloured glass is seen as (a) Light Amplification by Stimulated Emission of
(a) coloured (b) white Radiation
(c) black (d) that of the glass colour (b) Low Amplitude Stimulated Emission of Radiation
(c) Low Amplitude Short Energy Radiation
(d) Light Amplification by Short Energy Radiation
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 8 (b) 15 (c) 22 (a) 29 (c) 36 (d )
2 (d ) 9 (c) 16 (c) 23 (c) 30 (c) 37 (a)
3 (b ) 10 (a) 17 (a) 24 (d ) 31 (b) 38 (b)
4 (b ) 11 (a) 18 (c) 25 (c) 32 (b) 39 (b)
5 (c) 12 (c) 19 (d) 26 (b ) 33 (b) 40 (a)
6 (b ) 13 (a) 20 (b) 27 (a) 34 (a)
7 (d ) 14 (b) 21 (b) 28 (d ) 35 (c)
6 Electricity
Electric Charges The S.I. unit of electric field intensity is N/coul or volt/metre.
Charge is something associated with matter due to which it Electric Lines of Force
produces and experiences electric and magnetic effects.
An electric line of force is that imaginary smooth curve drawn
The study of charges at rest is called static electricity or in an electric field along which a free isolated unit positive
electrostatics while the study of charges in motion is called charge moves.
current electricity. There are two types of electric charge : Two lines of force never intersect. If they are assumed to intersect,
(i) Positive charge and (ii) Negative charge there will be two directions of electric field at the point of
The magnitude of elementary positive or negative charge is same intersection, which is impossible.
and is equal to 1.6 × 10–19 C.
Electric Flux ( f )
Charge is a scalar quantity and its SI unit is ampere second or
coulomb (C). The total number of electric lines of force through a given area
Basic Properties of Electric Charge is called the electric flux.
z z
(a) For open surface, f0 = df = E . ds
r r
z
(1) Similar charges repel and opposite charges attract. r r
(2) A charged body attracts light uncharged bodies. (b) For closed surface, fc = E . ds
(3) Accelerated charge radiates energy.
Gauss’s Law
Conductors and Insulators
æ 1 ö
The materials which allow electric charge (or electricity) to The total electric flux linked with a closed surface is ç e ÷
flow freely through them are called conductors. Metals are very è 0ø
good conductors of electric charge. Silver, copper and aluminium times the charge enclosed by the closed surface (Gaussian
are some of the good conductors of electricity. r r q
surface). i.e. Ñ
ò E.ds = e0
The materials which do not allow electric charge to flow through
them are called nonconductors or insulators.
For example, most plastics, rubber, non-metals (except graphite),
Electrostatic Potential
dry wood, wax, mica, porcelain, dry air etc., are insulators. Potential at a point can be physically interpreted as the work
done by the field in displacing a unit + ve charge from some
Coulomb's Law
reference point to the given point.
It states that, the electrostatic force of interaction (repulsion or P
attraction) between two electric charges q1 and q2 separated w
i.e., V =
by a distance r, is directly proportional to the product of the q0 r
charges and inversely proportional to the square of distance rr r dv
between them. V = – ò E.ds i.e. E = – O q
dr
qq ¥
i.e., F µ q1 q2 and F µ 1/r2 or F = k 1 22 It is a scalar quantity.
r Its dimensions : [M L2 T–3 A–1]
1 Nm 2 coul2 Its SI unit is volt or joule coulomb–1.
K= = 9 × 109 Þ e 0 = 8.85× 10 –12
4 pe 0 coul2 Nm 2 Equipotential Surfaces
For a given charge distribution, locus of all points having same
Electric Field potential is called equipotential surfaces.
The region surrounding an electric charge or a group of charges
in which another charge experiences a force of attraction or Capacitors and Capacitance
repulsion is called 'electric field'. A capacitor or condenser is a device that stores electrical energy.
r r It consists of conductors of any shape and size carrying charges
r F r F
E = , E = qlim of equal magnitude and opposite signs and separated by an
q0 0 ®0 q insulating medium
0
Electricity D- 33
EXERCISE
1. The charge given to any conductor resides on its outer 3. Potential at any point inside a charged hollow sphere
surface, because (a) increases with distance
(a) the free charge tends to be in its minimum potential (b) is a constant
energy state (c) decreases with distance from centre
(b) the free charge tends to be in its minimum kinetic energy (d) is zero
state 4. Three bulbs of 40 W, 60 W and 100 W are connected in
(c) the free charge tends to be in its maximum potential series to a current source of 200 V. Which of the following
energy state. statements is true ?
(a) 40 W bulb glows brightest
(d) the free charge tends to be in its maximum kinetic energy
(b) 60 W bulb glows brightest
state
(c) 100 W bulb glows brightest
2. Two identical conducting balls having positive charges q1 (d) All bulbs glow with same brightness
and q2 are separated by a distance r.If they are made to 5. A voltmeter essentially consists of
touch each other and then separated to the same distance, (a) a high resistance, in series with a galvanometer
the force between them will be (b) a low resistance, in series with a galvanometer
(a) less than before (b) same as before (c) a high resistance in parallel with a galvanometer
(c) more than before (d) zero (d) a low resistance in parallel with a galvanometer
D- 36 Electricity
6. Eddy currents are produced when 17. On charging by conduction, mass of a body may
(a) a metal is kept in varying magnetic field (a) increase (b) decreases
(b) a metal is kept in steady magnetic field (c) increase or decrease (d) none of these
(c) a circular coil is placed in a magnetic field 18. Coulomb’s law is true for
(d) through a circular coil, current is passed (a) atomic distances (= 10–11 m)
7. An AC generator of 220 V having internal resistance r = 10W (b) nuclear distances (= 10–15 m)
and external resistance R = 100W. What is the power (c) charged as well as uncharged particles
developed in the external circuit? (d) all the distances
(a) 484 W (b) 400 W 19. Which of the following is the best insulator of electricity?
(c) 441 W (d) 369 W (a) Carbon (b) Paper
8. Choke coil works on the principle of (c) Graphite (d) Ebonite
(a) transient current (b) self induction 20. Two spheres A and B of exactly same mass are given equal
(c) mutual induction (d) wattless current positive and negative charges respectively. Their masses
9. In an a.c. circuit, the r.m.s. value of current, Irms is related to after charging
the peak current, I0 by the relation (a) remains unaffected (b) mass of A > mass of B
(a) I rms = 2 I 0 (b) I rms = p I 0 (c) mass of A < mass of B (d) nothing can be said
21. What happens when some charge is placed on a soap
1 1 bubble?
(c) I rms =
I0 (d) I rms = I0
p 2 (a) Its radius decreases (b) Its radius increases
10. The frequency of A.C. mains in India is (c) The bubble collapses (d) None of these
(a) 30 c/s (b) 50 c/s 22. If a body is charged by rubbing it, its weight
(c) 60 c/s (d) 120 c/s (a) remains precisely constant
11. A bulb and a capacitor are connected in series to a source of (b) increases slightly
alternating current. If its frequency is increased, while keeping (c) decreases slightly
the voltage of the source constant, then bulb will (d) may increase slightly or may decrease slightly
(a) give more intense light 23. Electric flux at a point in an electric field is
(b) give less intense light (a) positive (b) negative
(c) give light of same intensity before (c) zero (d) none of these
(d) stop radiating light 24. The length of a wire is doubled and the radius is doubled.
12. In an A.C. circuit with voltage V and current I the power By what factor does the resistance change?
dissipated is (a) 4 times as large (b) Twice as large
(c) Unchanged (d) Half as large
1 1 25. According to international convention of colour coding in a wire
(a) VI (b) VI
2 2 (a) live is red, neutral is black and earth is green
(c) V I (b) live is red, neutral is green and earth is black
(d) dependent on the phase between V and I (c) live is brown, neutral is blue and earth is black
13. Alternating current cannot be measured by D.C. ammeter (d) live is red, neutral is black and earth is green
because 26. The resistivity of a wire depends on
(a) average value of current for complete cycle is zero (a) length
(b) A.C. changes direction (b) area of cross-section
(c) A.C. cannot pass through D.C. ammeter (c) material
(d) D.C. ammeter will get damaged (d) all of these
14. The core of a transformer is laminated because 27. In the circuits shown below the ammeter A reads 4 amp. and the
(a) the weight of the transformer may be reduced voltmeter V reads 20 volts. The value of the resistance R is
(b) rusting of the core may be prevented R
(c) ratio of voltage in primary and secondary may be A
increased
(d) energy losses due to eddy currents may be minimised
15. When a body is charged by induction, then the body
(a) becomes neutral V
(b) does not lose any charge
(c) loses whole of the charge on it (a) slightly more than 5 ohms
(d) loses part of the charge on it (b) slightly less than 5 ohms
16. If a body is positively charged, then it has (c) exactly 5 ohms
(a) excess of electrons (d) None of these
(b) excess of protons 28. Gases are good conductors of electricity at
(c) deficiency of electrons (a) high pressure (b) low pressure
(d) deficiency of neutrons (c) low temperature (d) high temperature
Electricity D- 37
29. The resistance of a thin wire in comparison of a thick wire of 42. The heating element of an electric heater should be made
the same material with a material, which should have
(a) is low (a) high specific resistance and high melting point
(b) is equal (b) high specific resistance and low melting point
(c) depends upon the metal of the wire (c) low specific resistance and low melting point
(d) is high (d) low specific resistance and high melting point
30. Conductivity increases in the order of 43. In charging a battery of motor car, the following effect of
(a) Al, Ag, Cu (b) Al, Cu, Ag electric current is used
(c) Cu, Al, Ag (d) Ag, Cu, Al (a) magnetic (b) heating
31. Kilowatt-hour is the unit of (c) chemical (d) induction
(a) potential difference (b) electric power 44. For electroplating a spoon, it is placed in the voltameter at
(c) electrical energy (d) charge (a) the position of anode
32. An electric bulb is filled with (b) the position of cathode
(a) hydrogen (b) oxygen and hydrogen (c) exactly in the middle of anode and cathode
(c) ammonia (d) nitrogen and argon (d) anywhere in the electrolyte
33. When current is passed through an electric bulb, its filament 45. Electroplating does not help in
glows, but the wire leading current to the bulb does not (a) fine finish to the surface
glow because (b) shining appearance
(a) less current flows in the leading wire as compared to (c) metals to become hard
that in the filament (d) protect metals against corrosion
(b) the leading wire has more resistance than the filament 46. Faraday’s laws are consequence of conservation of
(c) the leading wire has less resistance than the filament (a) energy
(d) filament has coating of fluorescent material over it (b) energy and magnetic field
34. From a power station, the power is transmitted at a very high (c) charge
voltage because – (d) magnetic field
(a) it is generated only at high voltage 47. Lenz’s law is a consequence of the law of conservation of
(b) it is cheaper to produce electricity at high voltage (a) charge (b) mass
(c) electricity at high voltage is less dangerous (c) energy (d) momentum
(d) there is less loss of energy in transmission at high 48. The laws of electromagnetic induction have been used in
voltage the construction of a
35. When a fuse is rated 8A, it means (a) galvanometer (b) voltmeter
(a) it will not work if current is less than 8A (c) electric motor (d) generator
(b) it has a resistance of 8 ohm 49. Whenever, current is changed in a coil, an induced e.m.f. is
(c) it will work only if current is 8A produced in the same coil. This property of the coil is due to
(d) it will burn if current exceeds 8A (a) mutual induction (b) self induction
36. Fuse wire is made of (c) eddy currents (d) hysteresis
(a) platinum (b) copper 50. Alternating current is converted to direct current by
(c) aluminium (d) alloy of tin and lead (a) rectifier (b) dynamo
37. Which is not a device based on the heating effect of (c) transformer (d) motor
electricity? 51. To convert mechanical energy into electrical energy, one
(a) Heater (b) Toaster can use
(c) Refrigerator (d) Press (a) DC dynamo (b) AC dynamo
38. The primary cell which is used in daily life is (c) motor (d) (a) & (b)
(a) Leclanche cell (b) Dry cell 52. Transformers are used
(c) Daniel cell (d) Simple voltaic cell (a) in DC circuits only
39. The filament of an electric bulb is of tungsten because (b) in AC circuits only
(a) its resistance is negligible (c) in both DC and AC circuits
(b) it is cheaper (d) neither in DC nor in AC circuits
(c) its melting point is high 53. The essential difference between an AC generator and a DC
(d) filament is easily made generator is that
40. Which one of the following heater element is used in electric (a) AC generator has an electromagnet while a DC
press? generator has permanent magnet
(a) Copper wire (b) Nichrome wire (b) DC generator will generate a higher voltage
(c) Lead wire (d) Iron wire (c) AC generator will generate a higher voltage
41. What should be the characteristic of fuse wire? (d) AC generator has slip rings while the DC generator
(a) High melting point, high specific resistance has a commutator
(b) Low melting point, low specific resistance 54. At the time of short circuit, the current in the circuit
(c) High melting point, low specific resistance (a) reduces substantially (b) does not change
(d) Low melting point, high specific resistance (c) increases heavily (d) vary continuously
D- 38 Electricity
55. In an electric motor, conversion takes place of 57. The current in the armature of a motor is reversed at every
(a) chemical energy into electrical energy half cycle due to the action of a(n)
(b) electrical energy into mechanical energy (a) armature (b) field coil
(c) electrical energy into light energy
(c) brush (d) commutator
(d) electrical energy into chemical energy
56. The current in a generator armature is AC because 58. For dynamo which one of the following statements is correct?
(a) the magnetic field reverses at intervals (a) It converts the electrical energy into light energy
(b) the current in the field coils is AC (b) It converts the kinetic energy into heat energy
(c) the rotation of the armature causes the field through it (c) It converts the mechanical energy into electrical energy
to reverse
(d) the commutator feeds current into it in opposite (d) It converts the electrical energy into mechanical energy
directions at every half cycle
AN SW ER KEY
1 (a) 6 (a) 11 (a) 16 (c) 21 (b ) 26 (c) 31 (c) 36 (c) 41 (d) 46 (a) 51 (d) 56 (c)
2 (c) 7 (b ) 12 (d ) 17 (c) 22 (d ) 27 (a) 32 (d) 37 (b) 42 (a) 47 (c) 52 (b) 57 (d)
3 (b ) 8 (b ) 13 (a) 18 (d ) 23 (c) 28 (b ) 33 (c) 38 (c) 43 (c) 48 (d) 53 (d) 58 (c)
4 (a) 9 (d ) 14 (d ) 19 (d ) 24 (d ) 29 (d ) 34 (b) 39 (c) 44 (b) 49 (b) 54 (c)
5 (a) 10 (b ) 15 (b ) 20 (c) 25 (d ) 30 (b ) 35 (a) 40 (a) 45 (c) 50 (a) 55 (b)
7 Magnetism
EXERCISE
1. The magnetism of magnet is due to 12. Electromagnets are made of soft iron because soft iron has
(a) the spin motion of electron (a) low retentivity and high coercive force
(b) earth (b) high retentivity and high coercive force
(c) pressure of big magnet inside the earth (c) low retentivity and low coercive force
(d) cosmic rays (d) high retentivity and low coercive force
2. Which of the following is the most suitable material for 13. To shield an instrument from external magnetic field, it is
making permanent magnet ? placed inside a cabin made from
(a) Steel (b) Soft iron (a) wood (b) ebonite
(c) Copper (d) Nickel (c) iron (d) diamagnetic substance
3. The permanent magnet is made from which one of the 14. The force which makes maglev move
following substances? (a) gravitational field (b) magnetic field
(a) Diamagnetic (b) Paramagnetic (c) nuclear forces (d) air drag
(c) Ferromagnetic (d) Electromagnetic 15. A conducting wire can give magnetic poles when it
4. Demagnetisation of magnets can be done by (a) bent into the form of a circular ring
(a) rough handling (b) placed in an external magnetic field
(b) heating (c) suspended freely in air
(c) magnetising in the opposite direction (d) All of the above
(d) All of the above 16. Which of the following is an artificial magnet?
5. Which of the following is most suitable for the core of (a) Bar magnet
electromagnets? (b) Horse-shoe magnet
(a) Soft iron (b) Steel (c) Magnetic needle
(c) Copper-nickel alloy (d) Air (d) All of the above
6. A magnetic needle is kept in a non-uniform magnetic field. It 17. The distance between two magnetic poles is doubled and
experiences their pole-strength is also doubled. The force between them
(a) neither a force nor a torque (a) increases to four times
(b) a torque but not a force (b) decreases by half
(c) a force but not a torque (c) remains unchanged
(d) a force and a torque (d) increases to two times
7. Out of the following, diamagnetic substance is 18. Earth’s magnetic field always has a horizontal component
(a) iron (b) copper except at
(c) lead (d) silver (a) magnetic equator
8. The magnetic compass is not useful for navigation near the (b) magnetic pole
magnetic poles. Since (c) geographical north pole
(a) R = 0 (b) V = 0 (d) at an altitude of 45°
(c) H = 0 (d) q = 0º 19. When an iron bar is moved over a bar magnet along its
9. Metals getting magnetised by orientation of atomic magnetic length the attractive force
moments in external magnetic field are called (a) increases first and then decreases
(a) diamagnetics (b) paramagnetics (b) decreases first and then increases
(c) ferromagnetics (d) antimagnetics (c) remains same
10. At magnetic poles, the angle of dip is (d) cannot say
(a) 45º (b) 30º 20. When the S–pole of a magnet is placed near an unknown
(c) zero (d) 90º pole of another magnet, the two magnets
11. Curie temperature is the temperature above which (a) repel each other because the unknown pole is N–pole
(a) a ferromagnetic material becomes paramagenetic (b) repel each other because the unknown pole is S–pole
(b) a paramagnetic material becomes diamagnetic (c) attract each other because the unknown pole is
(c) a ferromagnetic material becomes diamagnetic S–pole
(d) a paramagnetic m aterial becomes ferromagnetic (d) can either attract or repel
D- 42 Magnetism
21 Two magnets A and B are placed with like poles having one (b) will stay in east-west direction only
above another. What will happen? (c) will stay in any position
(d) None of these
23. Magnetic meridian is a
(a) point (b) horizontal plane
N S A (c) vertical plane (d) line along N-S
24. Due to the earth's magnetic field, charged cosmic ray particles
(a) require greater kinetic energy to reach the equator than
the poles
(b) require less kinetic energy to reach the equator than
N S B the poles
(c) can never reach the equator
(d) can never reach the poles
(a) A will stuck to B 25. Which one of the following is a non-magnetic substance?
(b) A will remain as in figure (a) Iron (b) Cobalt
(c) A will move side ways (c) Nickel (d) Brass
(d) Can't say 26. The universal properties of all substances is
22. A compass which is allowed to move in a horizontal plane is (a) diamagnetism (b) ferromagnetism
taken to a geomagnetic pole. It (c) paramagnetism (d) All of these
(a) will stay in north-south direction only
ANSW ER KEY
1 (a) 6 (d) 11 (a) 16 (d ) 21 (b ) 26 (a)
2 (a) 7 (b) 12 (d) 17 (b ) 22 (c)
3 (c) 8 (c) 13 (c) 18 (b ) 23 (c)
4 (d ) 9 (b) 14 (b) 19 (b ) 24 (c)
5 (a) 10 (d) 15 (a) 20 (b ) 25 (d)
8 Semiconductor
Electronics
Metals, Semiconductors and Insulators side (p ® n) and electrons move from (n ® p) creating a layer of
positive and negative charges on n and p side respectively called
On the basis of electrical conductivity (s) or resistivity (r = 1/s) depletion layer. External bias is applied to cause charges to flow.
the solids are classified as
(i) Metals – have low resistivity W
r ~ 10–2 to 10–8 Wm – – + +
p – – + + n
s ~ 102 to 108 Sm–1 – – + +
– – + +
(ii) Semiconductors – have intermediate resistivity
r ~ 105 to 100 Wm metallic metallic
contact depletion contact
s ~ 10–5 to 100 Sm–1
layer
(iii) Insulators – have high resistivity
Symbol of p-n junction diode
r ~ 108 Wm
s ~ 10–8 Sm–1
i.e. the Semiconductors are the materials whose conductivity is
more than insulators but less than conductors. p n
Types of Semiconductors p – n junction under forward bias: When p – side is connected to
Intrinsic semiconductors or Pure semiconductors positive terminal and n – side to negative terminal of external
In semiconductors forbidden energy gap Eg is more than metals voltage, it is said to be forward biased.
or conductors and less than insulators. V
Silicon (Si) and Germanium (Ge) are the examples of pure semi-
conductors. W
– +
In pure or intrinsic semiconductor, – +
p n
ne = nh = ni where, ne = no. of electrons; nh = no. of holes – +
– +
and ni = no. of intrinsic carrier concentration.
Impurity like pentavalent (As, Sb, P) or trivalent (In, B, Al) are The applied voltage V is opposite to built in potential V0, hence
added to increase conductivity. Depending on doping type we depletion layer width decreases and barrier height is reduced to
have (V0 – V). There is minority carrier injection, hence charges begin to
(a) n – type semiconductor and flow. Current is in the order of mA.
(b) p – type semiconductor (c) p – n junction under reverse bias: When p-side of p-n
(a) n – type semiconductor: Si or Ge with pentavalent doping. junction is connected to –ve terminal and n-side to +ve
An atom of valency +5 occupies the position of parent terminal of the battery, the diode is said to be reverse biased.
atom in crystal lattice. Four valence electrons form 4 covalent The direction of applied voltage is same as direction of
bonds but 5th electron is free and weakly bound to parent barrier potential, so barrier height increases to (V0 + V).
atom. The ionisation energy (~ 0.01V for Ge and 0.05V for Si) This suppresses flow of electrons from n ® p and holes
is small and even at room temperature the electron jumps to from p ® n. Diffusion current decreases but drift of electrons
conduction band. The dopant is called donor impurity and holes under the electric field affect remains. This drift
(positively charged). current is few mA. The current under reverse bias is
(b) p - type semiconductor: Si or Ge with trivalent doping means independent of applied voltage upto a critical value known
one less electron in the 4 covalent bonds, so the 4 th as breakdown voltage (Vbr) when V = Vbr diode reverse
neighbour has a vacancy or hole that can be occupied by current increases sharply. If the reverse current is not limited
an electron from another site. Thus a hole is available for below this, the diode gets destroyed due to overheating.
conduction. The trivalent atom is negatively charged as it
acquires an electron and is called acceptor atom or impurity.
– – – + + +
Formation of p – n junction: Part of p-type can be converted into p – – – + + + n
– – – + + +
n – type by adding pentavalent impurity. There is concentration – – – + + +
gradient between p and n sides, holes diffuse from p side to n W
D- 44 Semiconductor Electronics
Special purpose p – n junction diode: Junction Transistor:
Zener diode: It is fabricated by heavy doping of p and n sides of Types: (i) n-p-n type, (ii) p-n-p type.
p – n junction. Depletion region is thin < 10–6 m. Electric field of Structure: (i) Emitter (E), (ii) Base (B), (iii) Collector (C)
junction is high ~ 5 × 106 V/m. Reverse bias ~ 5V. Symbol:
It is used as voltage regulator.
p-n junction diode is used as a rectifier. E E
Rectifier is a device which converts A.C. into D.C. C C
Inverter converts D.C. into A.C.
Optoelectronic junction devices:
(a) Photodiode: It is a p – n junction fabricated with a B B
transparent window to allow light photons to fall on it. These npn type pnp type
photons generate electron hole pairs upon absorption. The n-p-n type p-n-p type
generation of electron hole pair is near the junction and due AC parameters:
to junction field they remain separated till external load is
Change in base-emitter voltage
connected. The electron are collected on n–side and holes (i) Input resistance =
on p–side near junction and give rise to an emf. Base current
When external load is connected, current flows. The ΧVBE
magnitude of current depends on intensity of incident Þ ri = ® dynamic resistance
ΧI B
radiation.
(b) Light emitting diode (LED) : It consists of heavily doped æ ΧVCE ö÷
p – n junction in forward bias. Electrons move from n ® p Output resistance, r0 = ççç ÷
çè ΧIC ø÷÷
(ii)
and holes from p ® n (minority carriers). Thus, near I B
junction, minority carrier concentration increases (under (iii) Current amplification factor (b)
no bias it is less) and they combine with majority carriers
near the junction to release energy in form of photons with æ ΧI ö
α ac < ççç C ÷÷÷
IC
energy equal to or less than band gap energy. As forward çè ΧI B ø÷ ; αdc < Þ αac ; αdc
V IB
bias increases, current increases till light intensity reaches CE
EXERCISE
1. In a p-n junction 5. When n-p-n transistor is used as an amplifier
(a) the potential of p & n sides becomes higher alternately (a) electrons move from collector to base
(b) the p side is at higher electrical potential than n side (b) holes move from emitter to base
(c) the n side is at higher electric potential than p side (c) electrons move from base to collector
(d) both p & n sides are at same potential
(d) holes move from base to emitter
2. Barrier potential of a p-n junction diode does not depend on
(a) doping density (b) diode design 6. In a common base amplifier the phase difference between
the input signal voltage and the output voltage is
(c) temperature (d) forward bias
3. The energy band gap is maximum in (a) 0 (b) p/4
(a) metals (c) p/2 (d) p
(b) superconductors 7. Inverter converts
(c) insulators (a) alternating current into direct current
(d) semiconductors (b) direct current into alternating current
4. The part of a transistor which is most heavily doped to (c) current at low voltage to current at high voltage
produce large number of majority carriers is (d) None of these
(a) emmiter
8. The Donor level in a semiconductor is placed
(b) base
(c) collector (a) half-way in the forbidden energy gap
(d) can be any of the above three (b) in the forbidden energy gap close to the upper edge of
the valence band
Semiconductor Electronics D- 45
(c) in the conduction band close to the lower edge to the 17. The potential barrier, in the depletion layer, is due to
conduction band (a) ions (b) holes
(d) in the forbidden energy gap close to the lower edge of (c) electrons (d) both (b) and (c)
the conduction band
18. Zener diode is used as
9. If the distance between the conduction band and valence
band is 1 eV. This combination is (a) half wave rectifier (b) full wave rectifier
(a) semiconductor (b) conductor (c) A.C. voltage stabilizer(d) D.C. voltage stabilizer
(c) metal (d) insulator 19. For a transistor amplifier, the voltage gain
10. Carbon, silicon and germanium have four valence electrons (a) remains constant for all frequencies
each. These are characterised by valence and conduction (b) is high at high and low frequencies and constant in the
bands separated by energy band gap respectively equal to middle frequency range
(Eg)C, (Eg)Si and (Eg)Ge. Which of the following statements
(c) is low at high and low frequencies and constant at mid
is true?
frequencies
(a) (Eg)Si < (Eg)Ge < (Eg)C (b) (Eg)C < (Eg)Ge < (Eg)Si
(c) (Eg)C > (Eg)Si > (Eg)Ge (d) (Eg)C = (Eg)Si = (Eg)Ge (d) None of these
11. In an unbiased p-n junction, holes diffuse from the p-region 20. In a semiconductor, the concentration of electrons is
to n-region because 8 × 1014/cm3 and that of the holes is 5 × 1012 cm3. The
(a) free electrons in the n-region attract them. semiconductor is
(b) they move across the junction by the potential (a) p-type (b) n-type
difference. (c) intrinsic (d) Cannot say
(c) hole concentration in p-region is more as compared to 21. When a semiconductor is heated, its resistance
n-region.
(a) decreases (b) increases
(d) all the above
12. For a transistor amplifier, the voltage gain (c) remains unchanged (d) either (b) or (c)
(a) remains constant for all frequencies. 22. The forbidden gap in the energy bands of germanium at
(b) is high at high and low frequencies and constant in the room temperature is about
middle frequency range. (a) 1.1 eV (b) 0.1 eV
(c) is low at high and low frequencies and constant at mid (c) 0.67 eV (d) 6.7 eV
frequencies. 23. To obtain a p-type germanium semiconductor, it must be
(d) none of the above doped with
13. p-n junction diode works as a insulator, if connected
(a) arsenic (b) antimony
(a) to A.C. (b) in forward bias
(c) in reverse bias (d) None of these (c) indium (d) phosphorus
14. In an n-type silicon, which of the following statement is 24. Which impurity is doped in Si to form n-type semi-
true? conductors?
(a) Electrons are majority carriers and trivalent atoms are (a) Al (b) B
the dopants. (c) As (d) None of these
(b) Electrons are minority carriers and pentavalent atoms 25. In extrinsic semiconductors
are the dopants. (a) the conduction band and valence band overlap
(c) Holes are minority carriers and pentavalent atoms are
(b) the gap between conduction band and valence band is
the dopants.
more than 16 eV
(d) Holes are majority carriers and trivalent atoms are the
dopants. (c) the gap between conduction band and valence band is
15. Which of the statements is true for p-type semiconductos? near about 1 eV
(a) Electrons are majority carriers and trivalent atoms are (d) the gap between conduction band and valence band
the dopants. will be 100 eV and more
(b) Electrons are minority carriers and pentavalent atoms 26. Function of rectifier is
are the dopants. (a) to convert A.C. into D.C.
(c) Holes are minority carriers and pentavalent atoms are
(b) to convert D.C. into A.C.
the dopants.
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(d) Holes are majority carriers and trivalent atoms are the
dopants. (d) None of these
16. When a forward bias is applied to a p-n junction, it 27. Zener breakdown takes place if
(a) raises the potential barrier. (a) doped impurity is low
(b) reduces the majority carrier current to zero. (b) doped impurity is high
(c) lowers the potential barrier. (c) less impurity in n-part
(d) None of these (d) less impurity in p-part
D- 46 Semiconductor Electronics
28. Which one of the following is not a correct statement about 38. When a p-n junction diode is reverse biased the flow of
semiconductors? current across the junction is mainly due to
(a) The electrons and holes have different mobilities in a (a) diffusion of charges
semiconductor (b) drift of charges
(b) In an n-type semiconductor, the Fermi level lies closer (c) depends on the nature of material
to the conduction band edge (d) both drift and diffusion of charges
(c) Silicon is a direct band gap semiconductor 39. When an n–p–n transistor is used as an amplifier then
(d) Silicon is has diamond structure (a) electrons flow from emitter to collector
29. The energy band gap is minimum in (b) holes flow from emitter to collector
(a) metals (b) superconductors (c) electrons flow from collector to emitter
(c) insulators (d) semiconductors. (d) electrons flow from battery to emitter
30. An oscillator is nothing but an amplifer with 40. An n-p-n transistor conducts when
(a) both collector and emitter are negative with respect to
(a) positive feedback (b) negative feedback
the base
(c) large gain (d) no feedback
(b) both collector and emitter are positive with respect to
31. When a solid with a band gap has a donor level just below
the base
its empty energy band, the solid is
(c) collector is positive and emitter is negative with respect
(a) an insulator to the base
(b) a conductor (d) collector is positive and emitter is at same potential as
(c) p-type semiconductor the base
(d) n-type semiconductor 41. Reverse bias applied to a junction diode
32. Regarding a semiconductor which one of the following is (a) increases the minority carrier current
wrong? (b) lowers the potential barrier
(a) There are no free electrons at room temperature (c) raises the potential barrier
(b) There are no free electrons at 0K (d) increases the majority carrier current
(c) The number of free electrons increases with rise of 42. In semiconductors, at room temperature
temperature (a) the conduction band is completely empty
(d) The charge carriers are electrons and holes (b) the valence band is partially empty and the conduction
33. p-n junction is said to be forward biased, when band is partially filled
(a) the positive pole of the battery is joined to the (c) the valence band is completely filled and the
p-semiconductor and negative pole to the conduction band is partially filled
n-semiconductor (d) the valence band is completely filled
(b) the positive pole of the battery is joined to the 43. Application of a forward bias to a p–n junction
n-semiconductor and p-semiconductor (a) widens the depletion zone.
(c) the positive pole of the battery is connected to (b) increases the potential difference across the depletion
n- semiconductor and p- semiconductor zone.
(d) a mechanical force is applied in the forward direction (c) increases the number of donors on the n side.
34. At absolute zero, Si acts as (d) increases the electric field in the depletion zone.
(a) non-metal (b) metal 44. A piece of copper and another of germanium are cooled from
(c) insulator (d) None of these room temperature to 80 K. The resistance of
35. When n-type semiconductor is heated (a) each of them increases
(a) number of electrons increases while that of holes (b) each of them decreases
(c) copper increases and germanium decreases
decreases
(d) copper decreases and germanium increases
(b) number of holes increases while that of electrons
45. In an intrinsic semiconductor
decreases
(a) only electrons are responsible for flow of current
(c) number of electrons and holes remain same (b) both holes and electrons carry current
(d) number of electrons and holes increases equally (c) both holes and electrons carry current with electrons
36. To use a transistor as an amplifier being majority carriers
(a) The emitter base junction is forward biased and the (d) only holes are responsible for flow of current
base collector junction is reverse biased 46. If the conductivity of a semiconductor is only due to break
(b) no bias voltage is required up of the covalent bonds due to thermal excitation, then the
(c) both junctions are forward biased semiconductor is called
(d) both junctions are reverse biased (a) intrinsic (b) extrinsic
37. The part of the transistor which is heavily doped to produce (c) donor (d) acceptor
large number of majority carriers is 47. The mobility of conduction electrons is greater than that of
(a) emitter holes, since electrons
(b) base (a) are lighter
(c) collector (b) are negatively charged
(d) any of the above depending upon the nature of (c) require smaller energy for moving through crystal lattice
transistor (d) undergo smaller number of collisions
Semiconductor Electronics D- 47
48. In the symbol of a transistor , the arrow head points in the (a) the emitter junction is reverse biased in n-p-n.
direction of flow of (b) the emitter junction injects minority carriers into base
(a) holes (b) electrons region of the p-n-p
(c) majority carriers (d) minority carriers (c) the emitter injects holes into the base of the p-n-p and
49. Transistors are essentially electrons into the base region n-p-n
(a) power driven devices (d) the emitter injects holes into the base of n-p-n
(b) current driven devices 52. n-p-n transistors are preferred to p-n-p transistors because:
(c) voltage driven devices (a) they have low cost
(d) resistance driven devices (b) they have low dissipation energy
50. In a transistor (c) they are capable of handling large power
(a) emitter is more highly doped than collector (d) electrons have high mobility than holes and hence high
(b) collector is more highly doped than emitter mobility of energy
(c) both are equally doped 53. An alternating current can be converted into direct current
(d) None of the above by a
51. One way in which the operation of an n-p-n transistor differs (a) rectifier (b) transformer
from that of a p-n-p (c) dynamo (d) motor
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b ) 11 (c) 21 (a) 31 (d ) 41 (c) 51 (c)
2 (b ) 12 (c) 22 (c) 32 (a) 42 (c) 52 (d)
3 (c) 13 (c) 23 (c) 33 (a) 43 (c) 53 (a)
4 (a) 14 (c) 24 (c) 34 (c) 44 (d)
5 (d ) 15 (d) 25 (c) 35 (d ) 45 (b)
6 (a) 16 (c) 26 (a) 36 (a) 46 (a)
7 (b ) 17 (a) 27 (b) 37 (a) 47 (c)
8 (d ) 18 (c) 28 (c) 38 (b ) 48 (a)
9 (a) 19 (c) 29 (a) 39 (a) 49 (b)
10 (c) 20 (b) 30 (a) 40 (c) 50 (a)
1 Nature of Matter
1. Substance (or chemical substance) : A “substance” is a 5. Mixture : A mixture is a substance which consists of two
kind of matter that can not be separated into other kinds or more elements or compounds not chemically combined
of matter by any physical process. e.g. gold, silver, iron, together. e.g. Air is a mixture of nitrogen, oxygen, inert
sodium chloride, calcium carbonate etc. gases, water vapour, carbon dioxide etc.
2. Pure substance: is one that is a single substance and has a 6. Types of mixtures : Mixtures are impure substances. They
uniform composition. Such a substance always have the are of two types:
same texture and taste. e.g. water, salt, sugar etc. (i) Homogeneous mixture: It has a uniform composition
throughout and its components can not be
3. Testing the purity of a substance : The purity of
distinguished visually.
substance can easily be checked by checking its melting
e.g. a well mixed sample of vinegar.
points in case of a solid substance or by checking its
(ii) Heterogeneous mixture: It is one that is not uniform
boiling points in case of a liquid substance.
throughout. Different samples of a heterogeneous
4. Types of pure substances : Two different types of pure mixture may have different composition. e.g. a mixture
substances are of salt and pepper.
(i) Element: An element is a substance which can not be 7. Solution : It is a homogeneous mixture of two or more
split up into two or more simpler substances by usual substances whose composition can be varied. e.g. solution
chemical methods of applying heat, light or electric of common salt in water, solution of ammonia in water.
energy. e. g. hydrogen, oxygen, sodium, chlorine etc. Some other examples are lemonade, coke, pepsi etc.
(ii) Compound: A compound is a substance made up of 8. Separating the components of a mixture : Various methods
two or more elements chemically combined in a fixed are used for separating the constituents of a mixture.
ratio by weight e.g. H2O (water), NaCl (sodium chloride) Depending upon the type of mixture (i.e. whether it is a
etc. homogeneous mixture or heterogeneous mixture) different
methods used are given below :
EXERCISE
1. Air is regarded as a mixture because 14. Physical properties of a mixture
(a) its pressure may very (a) vary with the amount of substance.
(b) its temperature may change (b) depend on the volume of the substance
(c) its volume changes under different conditions (c) depend on the organization of the substance
(d) its composition may vary (d) vary depending upon its components
2. Which of the following is a compound ? 15. Compounds
(a) Stainless steel (b) Bronze (a) are the same as mixtures
(c) Graphite (d) Hydrogen sulphide (b) can be separated by their physical properties
3. The process used to separate oil and water is (c) contain only one type of element
(a) distillation (b) sublimation (d) are different kinds of atoms chemically combined with
(c) separating funnel (d) chromatography each other.
4. In which of the following the constituents are present in 16. White gold is used in jewelry and contains two elements,
any ratio? gold and palladium. A jeweler has two different samples
(a) Mixture (b) Compound that are both identical in appearance and have a uniform
(c) Solution (d) Colloid composition throughout. What can be said about the
5. A mixture of common salt, sulphur, sand and iron filings is samples?
shaken with carbon disulphide and filtered through a filter (a) They are homogeneous mixtures and be classified as
paper. The filtrate is evaporated to dryness in a china dish. metallic alloys.
What will be left in the dish after evaporation? (b) The materials are heterogeneous mixtures and can be
(a) Sand (b) Sulphur classified by their components
(c) Iron filings (d) Common salt (c) The samples have variable compositions and are
6. Two substances A and B when brought together form a classified as metallic solutions.
substance C with the evolution of heat. The properties of C (d) The samples are heterogeneous mixtures that can be
are entirely different from those of A and B. The substance separated using magnetic properties.
C is 17. Which of the following is an example of a heterogeneous
(a) a compound (b) an element substance?
(c) a mixture (d) none of these. (a) Bottled water (b) Table salt
7. Camphor can be purified by (c) Pieces of copper (d) Candle
(a) distillation (b) filtration 18. Which of the following is an example of a homogeneous
(c) sedimentation (d) sublimation substance?
8. Which one of the following will result in the formation of a (a) Granite (b) Copper sulphate
mixture? (c) Oil-water solution (d) Muddy water
(a) Crushing of a marble tile into small particles 19. Filtration can be used to separate
(b) Breaking of ice cubes into small pieces (a) solids from solids (b) liquids from solids
(c) Adding sodium metal to water (c) liquids from liquids (d) liquids from gases
(d) Adding milk in water 20. Melting points can separate materials because
9. Purity of a solid substance can be checked by its (a) substances melt at different temperatures
(a) boiling point (b) melting point (b) molecules vibrate rapidly when heated
(c) solubility in water (d) solubility in alcohol (c) heat causes molecules to disintegrate
10. A mixture of ethanol and water can be separated by (d) many substances fuse at the melting point
(a) filtration (b) decantation 21. Distillation is a good separation technique for
(c) fractional distillation (d) sublimation (a) solids (b) liquids
11. Salt can be obtained from sea water by (c) solid alloys (d) gases
(a) filtration (b) decantation 22. Solubility is a good separation technique for
(c) evaporation (d) sublimation (a) pure metals (b) noble gases
12. A sample contains two substances and has uniform (c) different salts (d) metallic alloys
properties. The sample is 23. Magnetism is most beneficial for separating
(a) gases and non-metallic liquids
(a) a compound (b) a heterogeneous mixture
(b) magnetic solids and solids such as sulfur
(c) an element (d) a homogeneous mixture
(c) non-metallic solids and solids such as sulfur
13. Which of the following is considered to be a pure
(d) non-magnetic solids from non-magnetic liquids
substance?
24. Select the one that is a chemical change.
(a) Granite (b) Sodium chloride
(a) Melting of wax (b) Freezing of water
(c) Muddy water (d) Milk of magnesia
(c) Cooking of food (d) None of these
D- 52 Nature of Matter
25. Select the one that is a physical change. 31. Solutions with low concentrations of solutes are
(a) Digestion of food (b) Growth of plant (a) concentrated (b) dilute
(c) Rusting of iron (d) None of these (c) solvents (d) None of these
26. On passing through a colloidal solution, the beam of light 32. Which of the following statements is true about a colloidal
gets .......... system?
(a) reflected (b) refracted (a) It carries a net electric charge
(c) scattered (d) absorbed (b) It consists of one phase only
27. The size of colloidal particles usually lies in the range (c) It can be made out of two gases
(a) 10–5 - 10–7 cm (b) 10–7 - 10–9 cm (d) It is electrically neutral as a whole
–3
(c) 10 - 10 cm –5 (d) 10–2 - 10–6 cm 33. Cloud or fog is an example of colloidal system of
28. Brass is an example of (a) liquid dispersed in gas (b) gas dispersed in gas
(a) compound (b) element (c) solid dispersed in gas (d) solid dispersed in liquid
(c) homogeneous mixture (d) heterogeneous mixture 34. Normal solution is :
29. Select the one that is not a chemical change ? (a) inert solution
(a) Dissolution of ammonia in water. (b) acidic solution
(b) Dissolution of carbon dioxide in water. (c) one litre containing one equivalent
(c) Dissolution of oxygen in water. (d) basic solution
(d) None of these is a chemical change. 35. Which of the following is a colloid ?
30. A change is said to be a chemical change when (a) Sugar solution (b) Urea solution
(a) it is accompanied by energy change (c) Silicic acid (d) NaCl solution
(b) it is accompanied by formation of new substances 36. When dispersed phase is liquid and dispersion medium is
(c) it is accompanied by change in physical properties gas then the colloidal system is called
(d) All the above are correct (a) smoke (b) clouds
(c) jellies (d) emulsions
ANSW ER KEY
1 (d) 7 (d) 13 (b) 19 (b) 25 (d) 31 (b)
2 (d) 8 (d) 14 (d) 20 (a) 26 (c) 32 (d)
3 (c) 9 (b) 15 (d) 21 (b) 27 (a) 33 (a)
4 (a) 10 (c) 16 (a) 22 (c) 28 (c) 34 (c)
5 (b) 11 (c) 17 (d) 23 (b) 29 (c) 35 (c)
6 (a) 12 (d) 18 (b) 24 (c) 30 (d) 36 (b)
2 Structure of Atom
1. Law of conservation of mass :This law was stated by 7. Molecule : It is the smallest particle of an element or
Lavoisier in 1744. It states that “In all physical and compound that is capable of independent existence and
chemical changes, the total mass of reactants is equal to shows all the properties of that substance.
total mass of products.” [The molecules of an element is made up of only one and
2. Law of constant proportions (or constant composition) : same type of atoms, while the molecule of a compound is
This law was first stated by Proust in 1797. According to made up of dissimilar atoms]
the law “a chemical compound is always found to be
made up of the same elements combined together in the 8. Atomicity : The number of atoms present in a molecule
same proportions by weight” e.g. the ratio of hydrogen of an element or a compound is known as its atomicity.
and oxygen in pure water is always 1 : 8 by weight. This e.g. the atomicity of oxygen is 2 while atomicity ozone
law is also called law of definite proportions. is 3.
3. Law of multiple proportions : This law was given by John 9. Ion : It is an electrically charged atom or group of atom.
Dalton (1803) and states that "when two elements combine It is formed by the loss or gain of electrons by an atom.
to form two or more compounds, the different mass of one of Ions are of two types :
the elements and the fixed mass of the one with which it (i) Cation : It is positively charged ion and is formed by
combines always form a whole number ratio". This law the loss of electron from an atom e.g. H+, Na+, Ca2+,
explains the concept of formation of more than one Al3+, NH4+ etc.
compound by two elements. (ii) Anion : It is negatively charged ion and is formed by
4. Dalton’s Atomic theory : Postulates of Dalton’s Atomic the gain of electrons by an atom, e.g.
Theory
(i) Matter is made up of extremely small indivisible Cl–, O2–, C–, F–, CO32– PO3–
4 etc.
particles called atoms.
10. Valency : The combining power (or capacity) of an
(ii) Atoms of the same substance are identical in all
respects i.e., they possess same size, shape, mass, element is known as its valency.
chemical properties etc. 11. Formula of simple and molecular compounds
(iii) Atoms of different substances are different in all Binary compounds are those compounds which are made
respects i.e., they possess different size, shape, mass up of two different elements e.g. NaCl, KBr, CaO etc.
etc. Following rules are to be followed for writing the formula.
(iv) Atom is the smallest particle that takes part in a (i) The valencies or charges on the ions must be balanced.
chemical reaction. (ii) For a compound made up of a metal and a non-metal
(v) Atoms of different elements may combine with each the symbol of metal is written first.
other in a fixed simple, whole number ratio to form (iii) In compounds formed with polyatomic ions, the ion is
compound atoms. enclosed in a bracket before writing the number to
(vi) Atoms can neither be created nor destroyed i.e., atoms indicate the ratio.
are indestructible. 12. Sub-Atomic Particles
5. Atom : It is the smallest particle of an element which can
(i) Electrons: Electron was discovered in cathode ray
take part in a chemical change. It may or may not be
experiment.
capable of independent existence.
(ii) The term electron was coined by G.J. Stoney
6. Symbol : The abbreviation used for lengthy names of
(iii) Protons were discovered in anode ray experiment.
elements are termed as their symbols.
Anode rays are also called positive rays or canal rays.
The symbol of an element is the first letter or the first and
Protons was discovered by Wilhelm Wien in 1902. It
another letter of English name or Latin name of the element. was identified by J.J. Thomson.
While writing a symbol, the first letter is always capital and (iv) Neutron was discovered by James Chadwick in 1932.
the second is always small.
D- 54 Structure of Atom
13. Valency : The electrons present in the outermost shell of • The cathode rays are constituted by fast moving
an atom are known as valence electrons. These electrons electrons.
determine the valency of an atom. • These rays travel in a straight line.
Valency is equal to the number of valence electrons. • These rays posses mechanical energy.
In case the number of valence electrons is close to its full
• These rays produce heat when focussed on metals.
capacity. Then,
• These rays produce flourescenes when focussed on
Valency = 8 - valence electrons metals.
If outermost shell is completely filled then valency is zero. • They affects the photographic plate.
Valency is the combining capacity of an atom. • They are deflected by electric and magnetic field.
14. Atomic number (Z) : Atomic number of an element is • They ionize the gases through which they pass.
equal to the number of protons present in the nucleus of
• They travel in a straight line.
an atom.
Atomic number (Z) = number of protons • They can produce mechanical effects.
= number of electrons. • Anode rays are positively charged.
15. Mass number (A) : It refers to the total number of neutrons • The nature of anode rays depends upon the gas taken
and protons (i.e., sum of protons and neutrons) called in the discharge tube.
collectively as nucleus, present in an atom. • The mass of anode rays particles is almost equal to the
Mass number (A) = number of protons + number of neutron mass of an atom from which it is formed.
16. Isotopes : Atoms of the same element having same atomic Sub-atomic Particles :
number but different mass numbers are known as Isotopes Electron, proton and neutron are subatomic particles.
e.g. 35 and 36 1 2 12 and 14
17 Cl 17 Cl , 1 H and 1H , 6 C 6 C etc. The credit for discovery of these particles goes to
17. Applications of Isotopes : Isotopes are used in various Electron — J.J. Thomson and Proton — E. Goldstein
fields. For example. Another subatomic particle which is neutral and has a
(i) Isotope of uranium is used as a fuel in nuclear reactor mass approx. equal to that of a proton was called
(ii) Isotope of cobalt is used in treatment of cancer neutron and was discovered by Chadwick. The
(iii) Isotope of iodine is used in treatment of goitre. neutron is a neutral particle found in the nucleus of an
18. Isobars : Atoms of different elements having same mass atoms. Atom of all elements contain neutron (except
numbers are known as Isobars, e.g K-40 and Ar-40 hydrogen atom which does not contain neutron). The
19. The discovery of cathode rays was done by J.J. Thomson relative mass of neutron is 1 amu and it carries no
an English physicist. charge (i.e., it is neutral)
Properties of cathode rays :
EXERCISE
1. The formation of SO2 and SO3 explain 13. The cathode ray experiment was done for the first time by
(a) the law of conservation of mass (a) J.J. Thomson (b) John Dalton
(b) the law of multiple proportions (c) Goldstein (d) Rutherford
(c) the law of definite properties 14. The nucleus of an atom contains
(d) Boyle’s law (a) protons (b) electrons
2. One gram of which of the following contains largest number (c) protons and neutrons (d) neutrons
of oxygen atoms? 15. By whom was neutron discovered?
(a) O (b) O2 (a) Bohr (b) Chadwick
(c) O3 (d) All contains same (c) Rutherford (d) Dalton
3. The law of definite proportions was given by – 16. In an atom valence electron are present in
(a) John Dalton (b) Humphry Davy (a) outermost orbit (b) next to outermost orbit
(c) Proust (d) Michael Faraday (c) first orbit (d) any one of its orbit
4. Molecular mass is defined as the 17. Which of the following statements is incorrect for cathode
(a) mass of one atom compared with the mass of one rays?
molecule (a) They move in straight line
(b) mass of one atom compared with the mass of one atom (b) Their nature depends upon the nature of gas present
of hydrogen in the discharge tube.
(c) mass of one molecule of any substance compared with (c) They cost shadow of solid objects placed in their path
the mass of one atom of C-12 (d) They get deflected towards positive charge.
(d) None of these 18. The isotopes of an element have
5. The chemical symbol for barium is (a) same number of neutrons
(a) B (b) Ba (b) same atomic number
(c) Be (d) Bi (c) same mass number
6. A group of atoms chemically bonded together is a (an) (d) None of these
(a) molecule (b) ion 19. Which of the following pairs are isotopes?
(a) Oxygen and ozone
(c) salt (d) element
(b) Ice and steam
7. Adding electrons to an atom will result in a (an)
(c) Nitric oxide and nitrogen dioxide
(a) molecule (b) anion
(d) Hydrogen and deuterium
(c) cation (d) salt
20. Which of the following have equal number of neutrons and
8. When an atom loses electrons, it is called a (an) _____ and
protons?
has a ______ charge.
(a) Hydrogen (b) Deuterium
(a) anion, positive (b) cation, positive
(c) Fluorine (d) Chlorine
(c) anion, negative (d) cation, positive
21. The number of electrons in an element with atomic number
9. The molecular formula P2O5 means that X and atomic mass Y will be
(a) a molecule contains 2 atoms of P and 5 atoms of O (a) (X – Y) (b) (Y – X)
(b) the ratio of the mass of P to the mass of O in the (c) (X + Y) (d) X
molecule is 2:5 22. Which of the following has a charge of +1 and a mass of
(c) there are twice as many P atoms in the molecule as 1 amu ?
there are O atoms (a) A neutron (b) A proton
(d) the ratio of the mass of P to the mass of O in the (c) An electron (d) A helium nucleus
molecule is 5 : 2 23. Which of the following describes an isotope with a mass
10. The percentage of copper and oxygen in samples of CuO number of 99 that contains 56 neutrons in its nucleus ?
obtained by different methods were found to be the same. 99 43
The illustrate the law of (a) 56 Ba (b) 56 Ba
(a) constant proportions (b) conservation of mass
(c) 99
43 Tc (d) 56 43 Tc
(c) multiple proportions (d) reciprocal proportions
11. The total number of atoms represented by the compound 24. Which of the following isotopes is used as the standard for
CuSO4.5H2O is atomic mass ?
(a) 27 (b) 21 (a) 12C (b) 16O
(c) 5 (d) 8 (c) 13C (d) 1H
12. The correct symbol for silver is 25. Which of the following is not a basic particle of an element?
(a) Ag (b) Si (a) An atom (b) A molecule
(c) Ar (d) Al (c) An ion (d) None of these
D- 56 Structure of Atom
26. Members of which of the following have similar chemical (a) (i), (ii) and (iii) (b) (i), (iii) and (iv)
properties ? (c) (ii), (iii) and (iv) (d) (i), (ii) and (iv)
(a) Isotope 30. Which one of the following laws explains the formation of
(b) Isobars carbon monoxide and carbon dioxide from carbon and
(c) Allotropes oxygen?
(d) Both isotopes and allotropes (a) Law of conservation of mass
27. While performing cathode ray experiments, it was observed (b) Law of multiple proportions
that there was no passage of electric current under normal (c) Law of reciprocal proportions
conditions. Which of the following can account for this (d) Law of difinite proportions
observation ? 31. The atomic weights are expressed in terms of atomic mass
(a) Dust particles are present in air unit. Which one of the following is used as a standard?
(b) Carbon dioxide is present in air (a) 1H1 (b) 12C6
(c) 16 O8 (d) 35Cl17
(c) Air is a poor conductor of electricity under normal
conditions 32. Which would be the electrical charge on a sulphur atom
(d) None of these containing 18 electrons ?
28. Which one of the following statement is not true ? (a) 2– (b) 1–
(a) Most of the space in an atom is empty (c) 0 (d) 2+
(b) The total number of neutrons and protons is always 33. The atomic number of an element is 11 and its mass number
equal in a neutral atom is 23. The correct order representing the number of electrons,
(c) The total number of electrons and protons in an atom protons and neutrons respectively in this atom is
is always equal (a) 11, 11, 12 (b) 11, 12, 11
(d) The total number of electrons in any energy level can (c) 12, 11, 11 (d) 23, 11, 23.
be calculated by the formula 2n2 34. In an atom valence electron are present in
29. Dalton's atomic theory successfully explained (a) outermost orbit (b) next to outermost orbit
(c) first orbit (d) any one of its orbit
(i) Law of conservation of mass
35. In a chemical change the total weight of the reacting
(ii) Law of constant composition
substances compared to total weight of products is
(iii) Law of radioactivity
(a) never the same (b) always less
(iv) Law of multiple proportion
(c) always more (d) always the same
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b) 7 (b) 13 (a) 19 (d) 25 (b) 31 (b)
2 (c) 8 (b) 14 (c) 20 (b) 26 (c) 32 (a)
3 (c) 9 (a) 15 (b) 21 (d) 27 (c) 33 (a)
4 (c) 10 (a) 16 (a) 22 (b) 28 (b) 34 (a)
5 (b) 11 (b) 17 (b) 23 (c) 29 (d) 35 (d)
6 (a) 12 (a) 18 (b) 24 (a) 30 (b)
EXERCISE
1. The early attempt to classify elements as metals and non- 13. The most metallic element in the fourth period is
metals was made by (a) Ca (b) K
(a) Mendeleev (b) Lother Meyer (c) S (d) P
(c) Lavoisier (d) Henry Moseley 14. The elements of group sixteen are called
2. Newlands could classify elements only upto (a) halogens (b) chalcogens
(a) copper (b) chlorine (c) pnicogens (d) noble gases
(c) calcium (d) chromium 15. Which of the following is correct set of Dobereiner Triads?
3. Mendeleev classified elements in (a) Na, Si, Cl (b) Be, Mg, Ca
(a) increasing order of atomic groups (c) F, Cl, I (d) Li, Na, Be
(b) eight periods and eight groups 16. The metal which is hard and has high m.p. and used in
(c) seven periods and eight groups electric bulbs is
(a) Ni (b) Pt
(d) eight periods and seven groups
(c) Fe (d) W
4. The long form of periodic table consists of
17. The lightest liquid metal is
(a) seven periods and eight groups
(a) Hg (b) Ga
(b) seven periods and eighteen groups (c) Cs (d) Fr
(c) eight periods and eighteen groups 18. Which is not true about noble gases?
(d) eighteen periods and eight groups (a) They are non-metallic in nature
5. All the members in a group in long form of periodic table (b) They exist in atomic form
have the same (c) They are radioactive in nature
(a) valence (d) Xenon is the most reactive among them
(b) number of valence electrons 19. Elements of which group form anions most readily?
(c) chemical properties (a) Oxygen family (b) Nitrogen family
(d) All of these (c) Halogens (d) Alkali metals
6. Which of the following properties generally decrease along 20. On moving horizontally across a period, the number of
a period? electrons in the outermost shell increases from ...... to ....... .
(a) Atomic size (a) 2, 8 (b) 2, 18
(b) Non-metallic character (c) 1, 8 (d) 1, 18
(c) Metallic character 21. Which of the following is not a representative element?
(d) Both (a) and (c) (a) Fe (b) K
7. An element ‘M’ has an atomic number 9 and its atomic mass (c) Ba (d) N
19. The ion of M will be represented by 22. The scientist who made maximum contribution towards
(a) M (b) M2+ periodic table was
(c) M – (d) M2– (a) Chadwick (b) Rutherford
8. The element with smallest size in group 13 is (c) Dalton (d) Mendeleev
(a) beryllium (b) carbon 23. Which of the following elements A, B, C, D and E with
atomic number 3, 11, 15, 18 and 19 respectively belong to
(c) aluminium (d) boron
the same group?
9. The elements with atomic numbers 2, 10, 18, 36, 54 and 86
(a) A, B, C (b) B, C, D
are all
(c) A, D, E (d) A, B, E
(a) halogen (b) noble gases
24. Element A belongs to Group VII in p-block and element B
(c) noble metals (d) light metals
belongs to Group I in s-block of the periodic table. Out of
10. The number of elements in the third period of periodic table the following assumptions, the correct one is :
is (a) A and B are metals
(a) 2 (b) 8 (b) A and B are non-metals
(c) 18 (d) 32 (c) A is a metal and B is a non-metal
11. Which of these choices is not a family of elements? (d) A is a non-metal and B is a metal
(a) Halogens (b) Metals 25. The element with atomic number 14 is hard and forms acidic
(c) Inert gases (d) All of these oxide and a covalent halide. To which of the following
12. The element which has least tendency to lose electron is categories does the element belong?
(a) H (b) Li (a) Metal (b) Metalloid
(c) He (d) Na (c) Non-metal (d) Left-hand side element
D- 60 Classification of Elements and Periodicity in Properties
26. Which of the following properties do not match elements 34. Which is a metalloid?
of halogen family ? (a) Pb (b) Sb
(a) They have seven electrons in their valence shell (c) Bi (d) Zn
(b) They are diatomic in their molecular form 35. Which one of the following elements exhibit maximum
(c) They are highly reactive chemically number of valence electrons?
(d) They are metallic in nature (a) Na (b) Al
27. Which fact is not valid for Dobereiner's triads? (c) Si (d) P
(a) The atomic weight of middle element is roughly average 36. Which of the following elements does not lose an electron
of the other two elements
easily?
(b) The properties of middle element is roughly average
(a) Na (b) F
of the other two elements
(c) The elements of triads belong to the same group of (c) Mg (d) Al
modern periodic table 37. To which block is related an element having electronic
(d) The elements of triads have same valency electrons. configuration 1s2 2s22p6 3s23p63d10 4s1 in the periodic
28. Which of the following statements is incorrect from the table–
point of view of modern periodic table ? (a) s–block (b) p–block
(a) Elements are arranged in the order of increasing atomic (c) d–block (d) f–block
number 38. If the valene shell electronic configuration for an element is
(b) There are eighteen vertical columns called groups ns2np5, this element will belong to the group of –
(c) Transition elements fit in the middle of long periods (a) alkali metals (b) inert metals
(d) Noble gases are arbitrarily placed in eighteenth group (c) noble gases (d) halogens
29. Which of the following group of elements belongs to alkali 39. Which shows variable valency –
metals? (a) s–block elements (b) p–block elements
(a) 1, 12, 30, 4, 62 (b) 37, 19, 3, 55 (c) d–block elements (d) Radioactive elements
(c) 9, 17, 35, 53 (d) 12, 20, 56, 88 40. The noble gases are unreactive because
30. Which of the following elements will form acidic oxide? (a) they react with sodium
(a) Sodium (b) Magnesium (b) they have a full outer shell of electrons
(c) Aluminium (d) Sulphur (c) they have a half outer shell of neutrons
31. Which one of the following is most electropositive element? (d) they are too thin
(a) Sodium (b) Calcium 41. Which scientist came up with the concept of a periodic
(c) Aluminium (d) Silicon table that included all of the known elements?
32. The atomic number of an element tells you the number of (a) Joseph Priestly (b) Dmitri Mendeleev
................ in a neutral atom. (c) Antoine Lavoisier (d) Albert Einstein
(a) positrons (b) neutrons 42. If the two members of a Dobereiner triad are phosphorus
(c) electrons (d) All of these and antimony, the third member of this triad is –
33. As you move down the group, the alkali metals become (a) arsenic (b) sulphur
(a) brighter (b) hotter (c) iodine (d) calcium
(c) more reactive (d) less reactive
Classification of Elements and Periodicity in Properties D- 61
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 11 (b) 21 (a) 31 (a) 41 (b)
2 (c) 12 (c) 22 (d) 32 (c) 42 (a)
3 (c) 13 (b) 23 (d) 33 (c)
4 (b) 14 (b) 24 (d) 34 (b)
5 (d) 15 (b) 25 (b) 35 (d)
6 (d) 16 (d) 26 (d) 36 (b)
7 (c) 17 (c) 27 (b) 37 (a)
8 (d) 18 (c) 28 (d) 38 (d)
9 (b) 19 (c) 29 (b) 39 (c)
10 (b) 20 (c) 30 (d) 40 (b)
CHAPTER
1. The term acid, in fact, comes from the latin term acere, which 3. Strength of Acids and Bases
means “Sour”. In everyday life we come across many The strength of an acid or a base can be easily estimated by
compounds that chemists classify as acids.
making use of universal indicator which is a mixture of
Bases are compounds which taste bitter eg. milk of several indicators. The universal indicator show different
magnesia.
colours at different concentrations of hydrogen ions in
Salts also have wide applications for example ammonium solution.
chloride is used as electrolyte in dry cells, sodium
bicarbonote (baking powder) in the manufacture of glass 4. pH Scale : It is a scale that is used for measuring H+ion
etc. (Hydrogen ion) concentration of a solution.
2. Properties of acids and bases The term pH stands for “potential” of “hydrogen”. It is the
A. Properties of acids amount of hydrogen ions in a particular solution.
Chemical properties : For acids pH < 7
(i) Action of metals For bases pH > 7
Metals generally react with dilute acids to form their
respective salt and hydrogen. For neutral substances pH = 7
EXERCISE
1. Bleaching powder is soluble in cold water giving a milky 15. ‘Alum’ is an example of –
solution due to – (a) single salt (b) double salt
(a) available chlorine (c) acids (d) none of these
(b) lime present in it 16. Which of the following is ‘quicklime’ –
(c) calcium carbonate formation (a) CaO (b) Ca(OH)2
(d) the absorption of carbon dioxide from atmosphere (c) CaCO3 (d) CaCl2.6H2O
2. The acid used in making of vinegar is – 17. Slaked lime is prepared by adding water to –
(a) formic acid (b) acetic acid (a) bleaching powder (b) lime water
(c) sulphuric acid (d) nitric acid (c) milk of lime (d) quicklime
3. Reaction of an acid with a base is known as – 18. Plaster of paris has the formula –
(a) decomposition (b) combination (a) CaSO4.½H2O (b) CaSO4.H2O
(c) redox reaction (d) neutralization (c) CaSO4.1½H2O (d) CaSO4.2H2O
4. Antacids contain – 19. Plaster of paris is obtained –
(a) weak base (b) weak acid (a) by adding water to calcium sulphate
(c) strong base (d) strong acid (b) by adding sulphuric acid to calcium hydroxide
5. Bleaching powder gives smell of chlorine because it – (c) by heating gypsum to a very high temperature
(a) is unstable (d) by heating gypsum to 373 K.
(b) gives chlorine on exposure to atmosphere 20. Which of the following is considered a mineral acid ?
(c) is a mixture of chlorine and slaked lime (a) Oxalic acid (b) Lactic acid
(d) contains excess of chlorine (c) Citric acid (d) Phosphoric acid
6. Plaster of paris is made from – 21. Which of the following is an alkali ?
(a) lime stone (b) slaked lime (a) Ca(OH)2 (b) KOH
(c) quick lime (d) gypsum (c) Mg(OH)2 (d) CaCO3
7. Chemical formula of baking soda is – 22. When the stopper of a bottle containing colourless liquid
(a) MgSO4 (b) Na2CO3 was removed, the bottle gave smell like that of vinegar. The
(c) NaHCO3 (d) MgCO3 liquid in the bottle could be
8. Washing soda has the formula – (a) hydrochloric acid
(a) Na2CO3.7H2O (b) Na2CO3.10H2O (b) sodium hydroxide solution
(c) Na2CO3.H2O (d) Na2CO3 (c) acetic acid solution
9. Plaster of Paris hardens by – (d) saturated sodium hydrogen carbonate solution
(a) giving of CO2 (b) changing into CaCO3 23. Which of the following is not required to find the pH of a
given sample ?
(c) combining with water (d) giving out water
(a) pH paper (b) Litmus paper
10. A solution reacts with crushed egg–shells to give a gas
that turns lime–water milky. The solution contains (c) Universal indicator (d) Standard pH chart
24. Universal indicator solution is named as such because
(a) NaCl (b) HCl
(a) it is available universally
(c) LiCl (d) KCl
(b) it has a universal appearance
11. Which of the following is acidic in nature –
(c) it can be used for entire pH range
(a) apple juice (b) soap solution
(d) all the above are correct
(c) slaked lime (d) lime
25. Select the one that is having pH < 7.
12. Which of the following acid is present in sour milk ?
(a) lime juice (b) lime water
(a) glycolic acid (b) lactic acid
(c) human blood (d) antacid.
(c) citrus acid (d) tartaric acid 26. Acids and bases are important because of
13. Acid turn blue litmus – (a) their use in industry
(a) green (b) red (b) their effects on human health
(c) yellow (d) orange (c) their effect on farmer’s crop
14. The reaction of metal with acid results in the formation of– (d) all the above are correct.
(a) only hydrogen gas 27. Which of the following is a weak base ?
(b) only salt (a) NaOH (b) KOH
(c) both salt and hydrogen gas (c) NH4OH (d) none of these
(d) none of these
Acids, Bases and Salts D- 65
28. Which of the following compounds is basic in nature ? 41. A base which dissolves in water is called
(a) Ca(OH)2 (b) CaCl2.6H2O (a) soluble base (b) alkali
(c) NaCl (d) CuSO4.5H2O (c) acid (d) oxide
29. If pH of A, B, C and D are 9.5, 2.5, 3.5 and 5.5 respectively, 42. Acid rain is caused due to ...................
then strongest acid is (a) CO2, O2, SO2 (b) CO2, NO2, H2
(a) A (b) C (c) SO2 N2, O2 (d) CO2, SO2, NO2
(c) D (d) B 43. Acid contained in the sting of an ant is....................
30. Aqueous solution of which of the following salt will change (a) acetic acid (b) formic acid
the colour of red litmus to blue?
(c) lactic acid (d) ascorbic acid
(a) Na2CO3 (b) Na2CO3.10H2O
44. Natural indicator litmus is extracted from
(c) Both (a) and (b) (d) None of these
(a) lichens (b) earthworms
31. Which of the following is known as dead burnt plaster?
(a) Quick lime (b) Slaked lime (c) ants (d) algae
(c) Lime stone (d) Gypsum 45. When vinegar reacts with baking soda the gas evolved is
32. Which of the following pairs of substances are chemically (a) hydrogen (b) oxygen
same? (c) carbon dioxide (d) nitrogen dioxide
(a) Lime water and milk of lime 46. On which of the following acid rain has adverse effects?
(b) Dead burnt plaster and gypsum (a) Marble structures (b) Historical monuments
(c) Both the above (c) Aquatic life (d) All of these
(d) None of the above 47. pH of human body varies within the range of
33. Baking powder is (a) 6.0 to 6.5 (b) 5.5 to 5.8
(a) a mixture (b) a compound (c) 7.0 to 7.8 (d) 7.0 to 11.0
(c) an element (d) a salt 48. Calamine solution contains
34. The chemical name of bleaching powder is (a) zinc hydroxide
(a) calcium chloride (b) zinc carbonate
(b) calcium oxychloride (c) sodium hydrogen carbonate
(c) calcium chloroxide (d) magnesium hydroxide
(d) none of above 49. Why bases are kept in glass bottles?
35. Which of the following is not a hydrated salt? (a) Bases produce OH– ions in aqueous solutions
(a) Blue vitriol (b) Baking soda
(b) Basic solutions are conducting in nature
(c) Washing soda (d) Epsom salt
(c) Bases are corrosive in nature
36. Which of the following is a strong acid:
(d) Basis have soapy texture
(a) Acetic acid (b) Citric acid
50. Which of the following statement regarding bases is false?
(c) Nitric acid (d) Tartaric acid
37. The presence of which of the following acid causes (a) Bases produce hydroxide ions when dissolved in water
indigestion: (b) Bases are soapy to touch
(a) Citric acid (b) Oxalic acid (c) Bases are extremly corrosive in nature
(c) Acetic acid (d) Hydrochloric acid (d) Basic solutions are non conducting in nature
38. When few drops of lemon are mixed with milk 51. Which of the following statement is true?
(i) it turns sour (a) Acids are bitter in taste
(ii) no change takes place (b) Bases are sour in taste
(iii) properties of milk are changed (c) The reaction between acid and a base is exothermic
(iv) properties of milk remain same reaction
Which of the above statements is/are correct? (d) The reaction between an acid and a base is
(a) (ii) and (iii) (b) (i) and (ii) endothermic reaction.
(c) (i) and (iii) (d) (i) only 52. Common salt besides being used in kitchen can also be
39. Which of the following is a strong base? used as the raw material for making
(a) Ammonium hydroxide (NH4OH) (i) washing soda (ii) bleaching powder
(b) Sodium hydroxide (NaOH) (iii) baking soda (iv) slaked lime
(c) Water (H2O) (a) (i) and (ii) (b) (i), (ii) and (iv)
(d) Sulfuric acid (H2SO4) (c) (i) and (iii) (d) (i), (iii) and (iv)
40. Acids are ...................... in taste while bases are .................... 53. To protect tooth decay we are advised to brush our teeth
in taste regularly. The nature of the tooth paste commonly used is
(a) sweet, salty (b) sweet, sour (a) acidic (b) neutral
(c) sour, salty (d) sour, bitter (c) basic (d) corrosive
D- 66 Acids, Bases and Salts
ANSW ER KEY
1 (b) 11 (a) 21 (b) 31 (b) 41 (b) 51 (c)
2 (b) 12 (b) 22 (c) 32 (a) 42 (d) 52 (c)
3 (d) 13 (b) 23 (b) 33 (a) 43 (b) 53 (c)
4 (a) 14 (c) 24 (c) 34 (b) 44 (a)
5 (b) 15 (b) 25 (a) 35 (b) 45 (c)
6 (d) 16 (a) 26 (d) 36 (c) 46 (d)
7 (c) 17 (d) 27 (c) 37 (d) 47 (c)
8 (b) 18 (a) 28 (a) 38 (c) 48 (b)
9 (c) 19 (d) 29 (d) 39 (b) 49 (c)
10 (b) 20 (d) 30 (c) 40 (d) 50 (d)
5 Metals and
Non-metals
1. Metals and Non-metals : There are more than 114 elements (iii) Metals are very important for the economy of a country.
present in the periodic table. These elements can be broadly Some metals, such as titanium, chromium, manganese and
classified into two categories i.e., metals and non-metals. Out zirconium are strategic metals. These metals and their
of 114 elements, 22 are non-metals. alloys find wide applications in atomic energy, space
2. Physical properties of metals : science projects, jet engines and high grade steels.
(i) They are usually shiny i.e. have a metallic luster. (iv) Gold and silver ornaments are obtained from small pieces
of metals by hammering.
(ii) Metals have a high density
4. Noble metal : Noble metals are metals that are resistant to
(iii) Metals are ductile i.e. they can be drawn into wires.
corrosion or oxidation, unlike most base metals. Examples
(iv) Metals are malleable i.e. they can be founded into thin
include tantalum, gold, platinum, and rhodium.
sheets.
5. Precious metal : A precious metal is a rare metallic chemical
(v) Metals are good conductors of electricity.
element of high economic value precious metals include the
(vi) Metals have high melting point and are generally in solid platinum group metals: ruthenium, rhodium, palladium,
state at room temperature. osmium, iridium, and platinum, of which platinum is the most
(vii)Metals are good conductors of heat and sound. widely traded.
3. Uses of mxetals : 6. Alloy : An alloy is a mixture of two or more elements in solid
(i) Metals are very important for modern humans it is not solution in which the major component is a metal. Most pure
possible to imagine our life without them. metals are either too soft, brittle or chemically reactive for
practical use. Combining different ratios of metals as alloys
(ii) Metals are used in manufacturing of bridges, railways,
modify the properties of pure metals to produce desirable
aeroplanes, diesel mobile units (DMU), electric mobile
characteristics. The aim of making alloys is generally to make
units (EMU), motor cars, electric motors, telephones,
them less brittle, harder, resistant to corrosion, or have a more
televisions, interplanetary space vehicles, or even
desirable color and luster. Examples of alloys are steel (iron
common articles like cooking utensils and coins.
and carbon), brass (copper and zinc), bronze (copper and tin),
and duralumin (aluminium and copper).
Alloy Composition Uses
1. Brass Cu = 80%, Zn = 20% For making utensils and cartridges.
2. Bronze Cu = 90%, Sn = 10% For making statues, medals, ships, coins and machines
3. Solder Sn = 50%, Pb = 50% For joining metals, solding wire and electronic components etc.
4. Duralumin Al = 95.5%, Cu = 3%, Used in bodies of aircrafts, kitchen ware and automobile
Mn = 1.0%, Mg = 0.5% parts etc.
5. German Silver Cu = 60%, Zn = 20%, Ni = 20% For making utensils and ornaments
6. Gun metal Cu = 90%, Sn = 10% For Gears and castings etc.
7. Bell metal Cu = 80%, Sn = 20% For bells, gangs etc.
8. Magnalium Al = 90%, Mg = 10% For balance beams, light instruments.
9. Type metal Pb = 82%, Sb = 15%, Sn = 3% For casting type
10. Stainless steel Fe, Ni, Cr, C For utensils, cutlery etc.
D- 68 Metals and Non-metals
7. Physical properties of non-metals : (viii) Physical methods are:
(i) They are dull, however diamond, graphite and iodine are (a) Hand-picking: It is used in the case when the impurities
lustrous. are quite distinct from the ore so that these may be
(ii) They are poor conductors of heat and electricity. Graphite differentiated by naked eye.
is a good conductor. (b) Hydraulic washing or Levigation or Gravity separation:
(iii) They are weak and brittle (they easily break or shatter). The separation is based on the difference in the specific
(iv) They have a low density (they feel light for their size). gravities of the gangue particles and the ore particles.
(v) They do not make a ringing sound when they are hit. (c) Electromagnetic separation: When one component either
(vi) Melting points and boiling points are usually low. the ore or impurity is magnetic in nature, this method can
(vii) Non-metals are usually soft. (Diamond is an exception, it be used for separation.
is quite hard. It is a crystalline solid). (d) Froth floatation process: This method is used for the
(viii) They exist in allotropic forms. concentration of sulphide ores.
8. Uses of Non-Metals (ix) Chemical method (Leaching) involves the treatment of
(i) Oxygen is essential for survival of life. the ore with a suitable reagent as to make it soluble while
(ii) Hydrogen is used to convert vegetable oil into vegetable impurities remain insoluble. The ore is recovered from the
ghee by hydrogenation. solution by suitable chemical method.
(iii) Nitrogen is used to preserve food and for manufacturing (x) Extraction process used to obtain metals in free state
proteins by plants. from concentrated ores is called extraction.
(iv) Carbon in the form of diamond is used for cutting rocks (xi) Extraction of crude metal from the concentrated ore
and in the form of graphite as electrode and in involves following chemical processes.
manufacturing of lead pencils. (a) Conversion of ore into metallic oxides.
(v) Sulphur is used in vulcanization of rubber, as fungicide • Calcination involves heating the ore below its fusion
and in manufacture of dyes, gun powder etc. temperature in the absence of air. It can remove
(vi) Chlorine is used as water disinfectant and in the moisture from hydrated oxide or CO2 from carbonates.
manufacture of pesticides like gammaxene. It makes the ore porous.
9. Extraction of Metals • Roasting is the heating of the ore in the presence of
(i) Minerals: The natural substance in which the metals or air below its fusion temperature.
their compounds occur in the earth is called minerals. (b) Reduction to free metal:
(ii) Ores: The minerals from which the metals can be • Smelting: This involves the reduction of the ore to
conveniently and economically extracted are called ores. the molten metal at a high temperature. For the
(iii) Native ores: These ores contain metals in the free state, extraction of electropositive metals such as Pb, Fe,
e.g., silver, gold, platinum, etc. Sn, powerful reducing agent like C, H2 CO, Al, Mg,
(iv) Metallurgy: The whole process of obtaining a pure metal etc., are used.
from one of its ore is known as metallurgy. • Self reduction process : These processes are also
(v) Gangue or matrix: Ores usually contain soil, sand, stones called auto-reduction process.
and others useless silicates. These undesired impurities • Electrolytic process: The oxides of highly
present in ores are called gangue or matrix. electropositive metals like Na, K, Mg, Ca, Al, etc., are
(vi) The removal of unwanted earthy and silicious impurities extracted by electrolysis of their oxides, hydroxides
from the ore is called ore-dressing or concentration of or chlorides in fused state. For example, Al is obtained
ores and the process used to concentrate an ore is called by the electrolysis of alumina mixed with cryolite.
the benefication process. (xii) Refining is the process of purifying the extracted metals.
(vii) Concentration of ore is achieved by (xiii)Chromatography is based on the principle that the
(a) physical methods, and different components of a mixture are adsorbed to
(b) chemical methods different extents on an adsorbent.
Metals and Non-metals D- 69
The table given here lists some common ores of some metals
Sl. No. Name of Formula of Type of ore Metal obtained
the ore the ore from the ore
1. Bauxite Al 2O3.2H 2 O Oxide Aluminium (Al)
2. Haematite Fe2 O3 Oxide Iron (Fe)
3. Magnetite Fe3O4 Oxide Iron (Fe)
4. Zincite ZnO Oxide Zinc (Zn)
5. Cuprite Cu 2 O Oxide Copper (Cu)
6. Litharge PbO Oxide Lead (Pb)
7. Malachite CuCO3 .Cu(OH) 2 Carbonate Copper (Cu)
8. Magnesite MgCO3 Carbonate Magnesium (Mg)
9. Lime stone CaCO3 Carbonate Calcium (Ca)
10. Cinnabar HgS Sulphide Mercury (Hg)
11. Chalcopyrite CuFeS2 Sulphide Copper (Cu)
12. Zinc blende ZnS Sulphide Zinc (Zn)
13. Galena PbS Sulphide Lead (Pb)
14. Common salt NaCl Chloride Sodium (Na)
(Halide)
15. Fluorspar CaF2 Fluoride Calcium (Ca)
(Halide)
16. Horn silver AgCl Chloride Silver (Ag)
(Halide)
17. Chalcocite Cu2S Sulphide Copper (Cu)
10. Corrosion of Metals : Corrosion is an oxidation reaction (i) Alloying : Iron or steel along with other metals can
with atmospheric oxygen in the presence of water on the also be protected by ‘alloying’ or mixing with other
surface of a metal. Rusting is metals (e.g., chromium) to make non-rusting alloys.
3 (ii) Galvanizing : Coating iron or steel with a thin zinc
Fe(s) + O2 (g) + xH 2O(l) ¾¾ ® Fe 2O3 .xH 2O(s)
2 layer is called ‘galvanizing’.
i.e., rust is hydrated iron (III) oxide. 12. Purity of Gold :
24-Carat gold : The carat (abbreviation ct or Kt) is a measure
11. Prevention of Corrosion : Iron and steel (alloy of iron) are
of the purity of gold alloys. Carat is used to refer to the
most easily protected by paint which provides a barrier
measure of mass for gemstones.
between the metal and air/water. Moving parts on machines
can be protected by a water repellent oil or grease layer.
Other important methods are
D- 70 Metals and Non-metals
EXERCISE
1. The most abundant metal in the earth’s crust is - 14. Removal of impurities from ore is known as -
(a) iron (b) copper (a) crushing and grinding
(c) aluminium (d) mercury (b) concentration of ore
2. The only metal that is liquid at room temperature is - (c) calcination
(a) mercury (b) sodium (d) roasting
(c) zinc (d) tungsten 15. Which reducing agent is used in chemical reduction?
3. Chemically rust is (a) C (b) CO
(a) hydrated ferric oxide only (c) Al (d) All of these
(b) hydrated ferrous oxide only 16. Aluminium is used in thermite welding because -
(c) ferric oxide only (a) aluminium is a light metal
(d) ferrous oxide only (b) aluminium has more affinity for oxygen
4. Alumina is chief ore of which of the following metal? (c) aluminium is a strong oxidising agent
(a) Na (b) K (d) aluminium is a reactive metal
(c) Ca (d) Al 17. The process of extraction of metal from its ores, is known as
5. Horn silver is (a) concentration (b) calcination
(a) an oxide ore of silver (c) purification (d) metallurgy
(b) a sulphite ore of silver 18. The process to heat the ore in the presence of excess supply
(c) a carbonate ore of silver of air below its melting point is called
(d) a chloride ore of silver (a) roasting (b) calcination
6. Naturally occuring substances from which a metal can be (c) smelting (d) liquation
profitably (or economically) extracted are called?
19. Brass is a mixture of
(a) Minerals (b) Ores
(a) copper and zinc
(c) Gangue (d) Salts
(b) copper and tin
7. Cinnabar is an ore of
(c) copper, nickel and zinc
(a) Hg (b) Cu
(d) aluminium, copper and traces of Mg and Mn
(c) Pb (d) Zn
20. Sodium is obtained by the electrolysis of
8. Which of the following is not an ore ?
(a) an aqueous solution of sodium chloride
(a) Bauxite (b) Malachite
(b) an aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide
(c) Zinc blende (d) Pig iron
(c) fused sodium chloride
9. Which of the following mineral does not contain Al ?
(d) fused sodium sulphate
(a) Cryolite (b) Mica
21. The chief ore of aluminium is
(c) Feldspar (d) Fluorspar
(a) bauxite (b) cryolite
10. Formula of magnetite is
(c) alunite (d) feldspar
(a) Fe2O3 (b) FeS2
(c) FeCO3 (d) Fe3O4 22. One of the constituents of amalgam is
11. Which ore contains both iron and copper? (a) aluminium (b) copper
(a) Cuprite (b) Chalcocite (c) iron (d) mercury
(c) Chalcopyrite (d) Malachite 23. The metal used to built bridges is
12. Calcination is the process of heating the ore (a) gold (b) silver
(a) in a blast furnace (b) in absence of air (c) platinum (d) iron
(c) in presence of air (d) none of these 24. Which of the following is a good conductors of heat and
electricity?
13. Which of the following is an oxide ore?
(a) Graphite (b) Oxygen
(a) Bauxite (b) Cuprite
(c) Chlorine (d) Nitrogen
(c) Haematite (d) All of these
Metals and Non-metals D- 71
AN SW ER KEY
1 (c) 11 (c) 21 (a) 31 (d) 41 (d)
2 (a) 12 (b) 22 (d) 32 (c) 42 (a)
3 (a) 13 (d) 23 (d) 33 (b) 43 (c)
4 (d) 14 (b) 24 (a) 34 (c) 44 (c)
5 (d) 15 (d) 25 (c) 35 (c) 45 (c)
6 (b) 16 (b) 26 (d) 36 (c) 46 (d)
7 (a) 17 (d) 27 (b) 37 (d) 47 (c)
8 (d) 18 (a) 28 (c) 38 (c)
9 (d) 19 (a) 29 (a) 39 (d)
10 (d) 20 (c) 30 (d) 40 (d)
6 Environmental
Pollution
1. The pollutants may be inorganic, biological or radiological It attacks marble, limestone,vegetation, paper and textiles
in nature. and injurious to human beings.
(i) Bio-degradable pollutants are domestic wastes which (iii) Oxides of nitrogen : NO 2 and NO, Source - combustion of
are rapidly decomposed by micro-organisms.
coal, gasoline, natural gas, petroleum refining, chemical
(ii) Non-biodegradable pollutants include chemicals,
plants, manufacturing explosives and fertilizers, tobacco
mercuric salts, lead compounds, pesticides, etc.
smoke.
(iii) Natural pollution is caused by radioactive substances,
volcanic eruptions, forests and mines fires floods, etc. Breathing NO 2 causes chlorosis to plants and chronic
(iv) Artificial pollution is caused by industries, thermal lung conditions leading to death. NO 2 reacts with moisture
plants, automobile, exhausts, sewage, etc.
to form acids.
2. Environment : The conditions existing around animal or
human life. 2NO2 + H 2 O ¾
¾® HNO 2 + HNO 3 ,
Atmosphere: The gaseous envelop surrounding the
earth. It has been classified into following regions:- 3 HNO 2 ¾ ¾® 2NO + HNO 3 + H 2 O
(i) Stratosphere : The layer of the earth’s atmosphere (iv) Smoke, dust :
above the troposphere and below the Sources : cement works, iron and steel works, gas works,
mesosphere. power generating stations.
(ii) Troposphere : The lowest region of the Smog : It is a mixture of smoke and fog in suspended
atmosphere extending from earth’s surface to the droplet form. It is of two types :
lower boundary of the stratosphere. In this region, (a) London smog or classical smog : It is coal smoke plus
human beings along with other organisms live. It fog. The fog part is mainly SO2 and SO3. It has sulphuric
contains water vapour and is greatly affected by acid aerosol. It causes bronchial irritation and acid rain.
air pollution. It is reducing in nature.
Note : The other two layers are Thermosphere and (b) Photochemical smog or Los Angeles smog : The
Mesosphere. oxidised hydrocarbons and ozone in presence of
3. Air pollution : The major air pollutants are humidity cause photochemical smog.
(i) Carbon monoxide (CO) : It is produced by incomplete Hydrocarbons + O2, NO2, NO, O, O3 ® Peroxides,
combustion of gasoline in motor vehicles, wood, coal, formaldehyde, peroxyacetylnitrate (PAN), acrolein etc.
inceneration and forest fires. It is oxidising in nature and causes irritation to eyes,
It is treacherous and deadly poisonous gas. It induces lungs, nose, asthamatic attack and damage plants.
headache, visual difficulty coma and death. It blocks the Acid rain : The oxides of C, N and S present in the
normal transport of oxygen from the lungs to other parts of atmosphere, dissolve in water and produce acids and
the body. lower the pH of water below 5.5.
(ii) Sulphur dioxide ( SO 2 ) : It is produced by petrol 2-
H 2 O + CO 2 ¾
¾® H 2CO 3 2 H + + CO3
combustion, coal combustion, petrol refining and smelting
operations. 2 H 2 O + 2 SO 2 + O 2 ® 2 H 2SO 4 2 H + + SO 24 -
It hinders the movement of air in and out of lungs. It is
particularly poisonous to trees causing chlorosis and -
2 H 2 O + 4 NO 2 + O 2 ® 4 HNO 3 H + + NO3
dwarfing. In presence of air it is oxidised to SO 3 which is The acids are toxic to vegetation, react with marble
also irritant. and damage buildings.
2 SO 2 + O 2 (air) ¾
¾® 2 SO 3 CaCO3 + H 2SO 4 ¾ ¾® CaSO 4 + H 2 O + CO 2
In presence of moisture SO 3 is converted into highly Acids corrode water pipes and produce salts with
corrosive sulphuric acid. heavy metals ions viz Cu, Pb, Hg and Al toxic in nature.
(v) Green House effect : The retention of heat by the earth and
SO 3 + H 2 O (moisture ) ¾
¾® H 2SO 4 atmosphere from the sun and its prevention to escape into
D- 74 Environmental Pollution
the outer space is known as green house effect. (d) Atomic explosion and processing of radioactive
Global warming is average increase in the temperature of materials.
earth due to increase in concentration of green house gases (e) Suspended particles (organic or inorganic) viruses,
(CO2, O3, NOx etc). bacterias, algae, protozoa, etc.
Consequences of global warming : (f) Wastes from fertilizer plants such as phosphates,
(i) Global warming would result in rise in sea level due to nitrates ammonia, etc.
increased rate of melting of glaciers and floods. (g) Clay : Ores, minerals, fine particles of soil.
(ii) Increase in infectious diseases like malaria, dengue, (ii) Aerobic and anaerobic oxidation : The oxidation of organic
etc. compounds present in sewage in presence of good amount
(vi) Ozone layer and its depletion : The ozone layer, existing of dissolved or free oxygen (approx. 8.5 ml/l) by aerobic
between 20 to 35 km above the earth’s surface, shield the bacterials is called aerobic oxidation. When dissolved or
earth from the harmful U. V. radiations from the sun. The U. V. free oxygen is below a certain value the sewage is called
radiations cause skin cancer, cataract of eye, and harm to stale. Anaerobic bacterias bring out putrefaction producing
vegetation. H2S, NH3, CH4, (NH4)2S, etc. This type of oxidation is called
Depletion of ozone is caused by oxides of nitrogen anaerobic oxidation.
N2O + h u ¾ ¾® NO + N (iii) Biological Oxygen Demand (BOD) : It is defined as the
amount of free oxygen required for biological oxidation of
reactive nitric oxide
the organic matter by aerobic conditions at 20°C for a period
NO + O 3 ¾
¾® NO 2 + O 2 , of five days. Its unit is mg/l or ppm. An average sewage has
O3 + h u ¾ BOD of 100 to 150 mg/l.
¾® O 2 + O,
(iv) Chemical Oxygen Demand (COD) : It is a measure of all
NO 2 + O ¾
¾® NO + O 2 types of oxidisable impurities present in the sewage. COD
values are higher than BOD values.
2 O3 + h u ¾¾® 3 O 2 (Net reaction)
5. Soil pollution : The addition of substances in an indefinite
The presence of chlorofluorocarbons also increase the proportion changing the productivity of the soil is known
decomposition of O 3 . as soil or land pollution.
Sources of soil pollution :
C F2 Cl 2 + h u ¾
¾® CF2 Cl + Cl
(i) Agricultural pollutants : Chemicals like pesticides,
CFCl3 + h u ¾
¾® CFCl 2 + Cl, fertilizers, bacteriacides, fumigants, insecticides,
herbicides, fungicides.
Cl + O 3 ¾
¾® ClO + O,
(ii) Domestic refuge and industrial wastes.
ClO + O ¾
¾® Cl + O 2 (iii) Radioactive wastes from research centres, and
hospitals.
O3 + O ¾ ¾® 2 O 2 (Net reaction)
(iv) Soil conditioners containing toxic metals like Hg, Pb,
(vii) Control of air pollution : It can be controlled by As, Cd, etc.
1. Dissolving HCl, HF, SiF4 in water and SO 2 , Cl 2 , (v) Farm wastes from poultries, dairies and piggery farms.
(vi) Improper disposal of human and animal extreta.
H 2S in alkaline solution.
(vii) Pollutants present in air from chemical works.
2. Adsorbing gas and liquid molecules over activated 6. Pesticides : The chemical substances used to kill or stop
charcoal and silica gel. the growth of unwanted organisms are called pesticides.
3. Chemical reactions. They are further classified as
4. Use of precipitators to settle charge particles. (i) Insecticides : They are used to kill insects. The most
5. Use of settling chambers under the action of gravity. common insecticides are
6. Use of natural gas in place of diesel, petrol, etc. (i) D.D.T (ii) BHC, 666, game xene
4. Water pollution : The contamination of water by foreign (iii) Baygon (iv) Sevin Carbaryl
substances which would constitute a health hazard and (v) Parathion (vi) Methoxychlor
make it harmful for all purposes (domestic, industrial or (vii) Aldrin
agriculture etc.) is known as water pollution. The polluted (ii) Herbicides : They are used to kill weeds
water may have offensive odour, bad taste, unpleasant (i) 2, 4-dichlorophenoxy acid
colour, murky oily, etc. (ii) Triazines
(i) Sources of water pollution (iii) NaClO3
(a) Domestic sewage : Discharges from kitchens, baths, Sodium chlorate
lavatories, etc.
(b) Industrial waters : Wastes from manufacturing (iv) Na 3 AsO 3
processes which includes acids, alkalines, pesticides, Sodium arsenite
insecticides, metals like copper, Zinc, lead, mercury, The (iii) and (iv) are not used now-a-days.
fungicides, etc. Addition of phosphate fertilizers to water leads to
(c) Oil : From oil spills or washings of automobiles. nutrient enrichment (eutrophication).
Environmental Pollution D- 75
EXERCISE
1. Dinitrogen and dioxygen are main constituents of air but 9. Which of the following statements is wrong?
these do not react with each other to form oxides of nitrogen (a) Ozone is not responsible for green house effect.
because __________. (b) Ozone can oxidise sulphur dioxide present in the
(a) the reaction is endothermic and requires very high atmosphere to sulphur trioxide.
temperature. (c) Ozone hole is thinning of ozone layer present in
stratosphere.
(b) the reaction can be initiated only in presence of a
(d) Ozone is produced in upper stratosphere by the action
catalyst. of UV rays on oxygen.
(c) oxides of nitrogen are unstable. 10. Which of the following statements is correct?
(d) N2 and O2 are unreactive. (a) Ozone hole is a hole formed in stratosphere from which
2. The pollutants which came directly in the air from sources ozone oozes out.
are called primary pollutants. Primary pollutants are (b) Ozone hole is a hole formed in the troposphere from
sometimes converted into secondary pollutants. Which of which ozone oozes out.
the following belongs to secondary air pollutants? (c) Ozone hole is thinning of ozone layer of stratosphere
(a) CO (b) Hydrocarbon at some places.
(c) Peroxyacetyl nitrate (d) NO (d) Ozone hole means vanishing of ozone layer around
3. Which of the following is not a consequence of greenhouse the earth completely.
11. Biochemical Oxygen Demand, (BOD) is a measure of organic
effect?
material present in water. BOD value less than 5 ppm
(a) Climatic conditions will be changed
indicates a water sample to be __________.
(b) Plants in warmer climates with adequate rainfall would (a) rich in dissolved oxygen
grow faster (b) poor in dissolved oxygen
(c) The incidence of infectious diseases is likely to (c) highly polluted
increase (d) not suitable for aquatic life
(d) Malaria will be controlled as the mosquitoes will not 12. Photochemical smog occurs in warm, dry and sunny climate.
survive. One of the following is not amongst the components of
4. Which of the following gases is not a green house gas? photochemical smog, identify it.
(a) CO (b) O3 (a) NO2
(c) CH4 (d) H2O vapour (b) O3
5. The substance having the largest concentration in acid (c) SO2
(d) Unsaturated hydrocarbon
rain?
13. Phosphate pollution is caused by
(a) H2CO3 (b) HNO3 (a) sewage and agricultural fertilizers
(c) HCl (d) H2SO4 (b) weathering of phosphate rocks only
6. The non-viable particulate is among the following is (c) agriculutral fertilizers only
(a) Dust (b) Bacteria (d) phosphate rocks and sewage
(c) Moulds (d) Fungi 14. The type of pollution caused by spraying of DDT
7. Which of the following statements is not true about classical (a) Air and soil (b) Air and water
smog? (c) Air (d) Air, water and soil
(a) Its main components are produced by the action of 15. Which among the following statements is false?
sunlight on emissions of automobiles and factories. (a) Oil slick in sea water increases D.O. value.
(b) Produced in cold and humid climate. (b) The main reason for river water pollution is industrial
and domestic sewage discharge.
(c) It contains compounds of reducing nature.
(c) Surface water contains a lot of organic matter mineral
(d) It contains smoke fog and sulphur dioxide
nutrients and radioactive materials.
8. Which of the following statements about photochemical (d) Oil spill in sea water causes heavy damage to fishery.
smog is wrong? 16. Sewage containing organic waste should not be disposed
(a) It has high concentration of oxidising agents in water bodies because it causes major water pollution.
(b) It has low concentration of oxidising agent Fishes in such a polluted water die because of
(c) It can be controlled by controlling the release of NO2, (a) large number of mosquitoes
hydrocarbons ozone, etc. (b) increase in the amount of dissolved oxygen
(d) Plantation of some plants like pinus helps in controlling (c) decrease in the amount of dissolved oxygen in water
photochemical smog. (d) clogging of gills by mud
D- 76 Environmental Pollution
17. Which of the following practices will not come under green 25. When rain is accompanied by a thunderstorm, the collected
chemistry? rain water will have a pH value
(a) If possible, making use of soap made of vegetable oils (a) slightly lower than that of rain water without
instead of using synthetic detergents. thunderstorm
(b) Using H2O2 for bleaching purpose instead of using (b) slightly higher than that when the thunderstorm is
not there
chlorine based bleaching agents.
(c) uninfluenced by occurrence of thunderstorm
(c) Using bicycle for travelling small distances instead of
(d) which depends upon the amount of dust in air
using petrol/ diesel based vehicles.
26. The smog is essentially caused by the presence of
(d) Using plastic cans for neatly storing substances. (a) Oxides of sulphur and nitrogen
18. Identify the wrong statement in the following: (b) O2 and N2
(a) Chlorofluorocarbons are responsible for ozone layer (c) O2 and O3
depletion. (d) O3 and N2
(b) Greenhouse effect is responsible for global warming. 27. Identify the wrong statement in the following.
(c) Acid rain is mostly because of oxides of nitrogen and (a) Chlorofluorocarbons are responsible for ozone layer
sulphur. depletion.
(d) Ozone layer does not permit infrared radiation from (b) Greenhouse effect is responsible for global warming.
the sun to reach the earth. (c) Ozone layer does not permit infrared radiation from
19. Water is often treated with chlorine to the sun to reach the earth.
(a) remove hardness (d) Acid rain is mostly because of oxides of nitrogen and
(b) increase oxygen content sulphur.
(c) kill germs 28. Identify the incorrect statement from the following.
(d) remove suspended particles (a) Ozone absorbs the intense ultraviolet radiation of the
sun.
20. The greenhouse effect is because of the
(b) Depletion of ozone layer is because of its chemical
(a) presence of gases, which in general are strong infrared
reactions with chlorofluoro alkanes.
absorbers, in the atmosphere (c) Ozone absorbs infrared radiation.
(b) presence of CO2 only in the atmosphere (d) Oxides of nitrogen in the atmosphere can cause the
(c) pressure of O3 and CH4 in the atmosphere depletion of ozone layer.
(d) N2O and chlorofluorohydrocarbons in the atmosphere 29. What is DDT among the following ?
21. Which of the following is/are the hazardous pollutant(s) (a) Greenhouse gas
present in automobile exhaust gases? (b) A fertilizer
(i) N2 (ii) CO (c) Biodegradable pollutant
(iii) CH4 (iv) Oxides of nitrogen (d) Non-biodegradable pollutant
(a) (ii) and (iii) (b) (i) and (ii) 30. The gas leaked from a storage tank of the Union Carbide
(c) (ii) and (iv) (d) (i) and (iii) plant in Bhopal gas tragedy was
22. Green chemistry means such reactions which (a) Methyl isocyanate (b) Methylamine
(a) produce colour during reactions (c) Ammonia (d) Phosgene
(b) reduce the use and production of hazardous chemicals 31. The substance which is not regarded as a pollutant?
(c) are related to the depletion of ozone layer (a) NO2 (b) CO2
(d) study the reactions in plants (c) O3 (d) Hydrocarbons
32. The greatest affinity for haemoglobin is shown by which
23. Which one of the following statement is not true?
of the following :
(a) pH of drinking water should be between 5.5 – 9.5.
(a) NO (b) CO
(b) Concentration of DO below 6 ppm is good for the
(c) O2 (d) CO2
growth of fish.
33. Which of the following is not involved in the formation of
(c) Clean water would have a BOD value of less than 5 photochemical smog?
ppm. (a) Hydrocarbon (b) NO
(d) Oxides of sulphur, nitrogen and carbon are the most (c) SO2 (d) O3
widespread air pollutant. 34. The false statement among the followings :
24. Frequent occurrence of water blooms in a lake indicates (a) The average residence time of NO is one month
(a) nutrient deficiency (b) Limestone acts as a sink for SOx
(b) oxygen deficiency (c) SOx can be removed from flue gases by passing
(c) excessive nutrient availability through a solution of citrate ions
(d) absence of herbivores in the lake (d) Ammonia acts as a sink for NOx
Environmental Pollution D- 77
35. The statement which is not correct about control of 38. BOD is connected with
particulate pollution (a) microbes and organic matter
(a) In electrostatic precipitator, the particulates are made (b) organic matter
to acquire positive charge which are then attracted by (c) microbes
(d) None of these
the negative electrode and removed
39. Eutrophication causes reduction in
(b) Gravity settling chamber removes larger particles from (a) dissolved oxygen (b) nutrients
the air (c) dissolved salts (d) All of these
(c) Cyclone collector removes fine particles in the diameter 40. Which among the following statements is false?
range 5-20 microns (a) Oil slick in sea water increases D.O. value
(d) Wet scrubbers are used to wash away all types of (b) The main reason for river water pollution is industrial
particulates and domestic sewage discharge
(c) Surface water contains a lot of organic matter mineral
36. Which of the following statements about polar stratosphere
nutrients and radioactive materials
clouds (PSCs) is not correct? (d) Oil spill in sea water causes heavy damage to fishery
(a) PSCs do not react with chlorine nitrate and HCl 41. Presence of which of the following fuel gas in the exhaust
(b) Type I clouds are formed at about –77ºC and contain fumes shows incomplete combustion of fuel?
solid HNO3 . 3H2O (a) Sulphur dioxide
(c) Type II clouds are formed at about –85ºC and contain (b) Carbon monoxide and water vapour
some ice (c) Carbon monoxide
(d) Nitrogen dioxide
(d) A tight whirlpool of wind called Polar Vortex is formed
42. Which one of the following statements about ozone and
which surrounds Antarctica ozone layer is true?
37. Minamata disease is due to pollution of (a) Ozone layer is beneficial to us because ozone cuts
(a) aresenic into the atmosphere out the ultraviolet radiation of the sun
(b) organic waste into drinking water (b) The conversion of ozone to oxygen is an endothermic
(c) oil spill in water reaction
(c) Ozone has a triatomic linear molecule
(d) industrial waste mercury into fishing water (d) None of these
D- 78 Environmental Pollution
ANSW ER KEY
1 (a) 7 (a) 13 (a) 19 (c) 25 (a) 31 (b) 37 (d)
2 (c) 8 (b) 14 (d) 20 (a) 26 (a) 32 (a) 38 (a)
3 (d) 9 (a) 15 (a) 21 (c) 27 (c) 33 (c) 39 (a)
4 (a) 10 (c) 16 (c) 22 (b) 28 (c) 34 (a) 40 (a)
5 (d) 11 (a) 17 (d) 23 (b) 29 (d) 35 (a) 41 (c)
6 (a) 12 (c) 18 (d) 24 (b) 30 (a) 36 (a) 42 (a)
15. (a) Oil slick in sea water decreases D.O value. reactive nitric oxide
18. (d) Ozone layer acts as a shield and does not allow NO + O 3 ¾
¾® NO 2 + O2
ultraviolet radiation from sun to reach earth. It does
not prevent infra-red radiation from sun to reach earth, O3 + h u ¾
¾® O 2 + O
thus option (d) is wrong statement and so it is the
correct answer. NO 2 + O ¾
¾® NO + O 2
19. (c) water is often treated with Cl2 to kill germs. 2 O3 + h u ¾
¾® 3 O 2 (Net reaction)
20. (a) Green house gases such as CO2, ozone, methane, the The presence of oxides of nitrogen increase the
chlorofluorocarbon compounds and water vapour form
decomposition of O3.
a thick cover around the earth which prevents the IR
rays emitted by the earth to escape. It gradually leads 29. (d) DDT is a non-biodegradable pollutant.
to increase in temperature of atmosphere.
30. (a) Methyl isocyanate, CH3 – N = C = O
21. (c) CO and oxides of Nitrogen are poisnous gases present 31. (b) CO2 is generally not regarded as an pollutant.
in automobile exhaust gases.
32. (a) Haemoglobin has great affinity for NO.
22. (b) Green chemistry may be defined as the programme of
developing new chemical products and chemical 33. (c) Photochemical smog does not involve SO2.
processes or making improvements in the already 34. (a) The average residence time of NO is 4 days.
existing compounds and processes so as to make less
harmful to human health and environment. This means 35. (a) Particulates acquire negative charge and are attracted
the same as to reduce the use and production of by the positive electrode.
hazardous chemicals. 36. (a) PSCs react with chlorine nitrate and HCl to give HOCl
i.e. correct answer is option (b). and Cl2.
23. (b) The ideal value of D.O for growth of fishes is 8 mg/ l . 37. (d) Minamata is caused by Hg poisoning.
7mg /l is desirable range, below this value fishes get 38. (a) BOD is connected with microbes and organic matter.
susceptible to disease. A value of 2 mg/ l or below is
lethal for fishes. 39. (a) Eutrophication causes reduction in D.O.
25. (a) Normal rain water has pH 5.6 Thunderstorm results in 40. (a) Oil slick in sea water decreases D.O value.
the formation NO and HNO3 which lowers the pH. 41. (c) Presence of CO in the exhaust fumes shows incomplete
26. (a) Smog is caused by oxides of sulphur and nitrogen. combustion.
27. (c) Ozone layer acts as a shield and does not allow
ultraviolet radiation from sun to reach earth. It does
not prevent infra-red radiation from sun to reach earth.
CHAPTER
7 General Concepts
of Chemistry
EXERCISE
1. Na2S2O3 represent the compound 13. Which of the following involves combination of two
(a) sodium sulphate (b) sodium sulphite elements?
(c) sodium thiosulphate (d) None of these (a) CaO + CO2 ¾¾ ® CaCO3
2. Which one is a bivalent ion? (b) 4Na + O2 ¾¾ ® 2Na2O
(a) sodium (b) calcium (c) 2SO2 + O2 ¾¾ ® 2SO3
(c) sulphide (d) Both (b) and (c) (d) NH3 + HCl ¾¾ ® NH4Cl
3. The chromate and dicharomate ions are respectively 14. When hydrogen sulphide gas is passed through a blue
(a) CrO 2- and Cr2 O2- (b) Cr2 O72– and CrO 4– solution of copper sulphate, a black precipitate of copper
4 7
sulphide is formed. This is an example of
(c) CrO 4– and CrO5– (d) CrO 2–4 and Cr2 O5
2– (a) combination reaction
(b) displacement reaction
4. The formula of sodium pyrophosphate is
(c) decomposition reaction
(a) Na2P2O7 (b) Na3PO4
(d) double decomposition reaction
(c) Na4P2O7 (d) Na3PO3
15. Which one is a decomposition reaction ?
5. The branch of chemistry which deals with study of physical
heat
properties and conditions is (a) 2HgO ¾¾¾® 2Hg + O2
(a) physical chemistry heat
(b) CaCO3 ¾¾¾ ® CaO + CO2
(b) analytical chemistry Electrolysis
(c) nuclear chemistry (c) 2H2O ¾¾¾¾¾¾ ® 2H2 + O2
(d) pharmaceutical chemistry (d) All the above reactions are decomposition reaction
6. The branch of chemistry which deals with study of the 16. The reactions in which two compounds exchange their
methods of detection and determination of elements and radicals to form two new compounds are called
compounds is (a) displacement reaction
(a) Physical chemistry (b) Nuclear chemistry (b) decomposition reaction
(c) Analytical chemistry (d) Bio chemistry (c) double displacement reaction
7. Valency of an atom or radicals is (d) isomerisation reaction
(a) ionisation energy (b) electron affinity of atom 17. CuO + H2 ¾¾ ® Cu + H2O
(c) its combining capacity (d) size of atom Above reaction is an example of
8. When electrons are added the resulting ion is called (a) Redox reaction
(a) basic radical (b) acidic radicals (b) synthesis reaction
(c) neutral radical (d) None of these (c) neutralisation reaction
9. Which of the following is most unreactive ? (d) decomposition reaction
(a) Mg 18. In the reaction :
(b) Mg+ PbO + C ¾¾ ® Pb + CO
(c) Mg2+ (a) PbO is oxidised (b) PbO is oxidant
(d) All above species are inert (c) C is reductant (d) Both (b) and (c)
10. Chemical formula of Aluminium sulphate is 19. Chemical equations are balanced in accordance with the
(a) Al2(SO4)3 (b) AlSO4 (a) Dalton’s law
(c) Al3(SO4)2 (d) None of these (b) Law of conservation of mass
11. Select the one that represents a displacement reaction. (c) Law of definite composition
(a) NaCl + AgNO3 ¾¾ ® AgCl + NaNO3 (d) None of these
¾¾ ®
20. Which is not a balanced equation ?
(b) Zn + CuSO4 ZnSO4 + Cu
(a) NaOH + HCl ¾¾ ® NaCl + H2O
(c) HCl + NaOH ¾¾ ® NaCl + H2O
(d) C + O2 ¾¾ ® CO2 (b) Mg + CuSO4 ¾¾ ® MgSO4 + Cu
12. Which one is a combination reaction ? (c) Fe + Cl2 ¾¾ ® FeCl3
(a) Formation of a mixture of carbon monoxide and (d) Mg + 2HNO3 ¾¾ ® Mg(NO3)2 + H2
hydrogen. When steam is passed over red hot iron. 21. Which of the following statements is true about chemical
(b) Reaction of water with sodium metal to form sodium equation ?
hydroxide and hydrogen. (a) Mass is conserved
(c) Ca(OH)2 + Na2CO3 ¾¾ ® 2NaOH + CaCO3 ¯ (b) Atoms are conserved
(d) Preparation of stannic chloride (Tin (iv) chloride) by (c) Mass as well as atoms are conserved
passing chlorine gas into molten tin (Sn). (d) Molecules are conserved
D- 82 General Concepts of Chemistry
22. A molal solution is one that contains 1 mole of a solute in 31. An organic compound containing C, H and O gave on
(a) one litre of the solvent analysis C – 40% and H – 6.66%. Its empirical formula would
(b) 1000 g of the solvent be
(c) one litre of the solution
(a) C3H6O (b) CHO
(d) 22.4 litres of the solution
23. The total number of atoms represented by the compound (c) CH2O (d) CH4O
CuSO4.5H2O is 32. Slow eating away of iron articles in the presence of moist air
(a) 27 (b) 21 is called
(c) 5 (d) 8 (a) galvanisation (b) crystallisation
24. The molecular formula P2O5 means that (c) rusting (d) neutralisation
(a) a molecule contains 2 atoms of P and 5 atoms of O 33. Which of the following reaction is endothermic?
(b) the ratio of the mass of P to the mass of O in the (a) C + O2 ¾¾ ® CO
2
molecule is 2:5
(b) CaCO3 ¾¾ ® CaO + CO
2
(c) there are twice as many P atoms in the molecule as there
are O atoms (c) CH4 + 2O2 ¾¾ ® CO + 2H O
2 2
(d) the ratio of the mass of P to the mass of O in the (d) CaO + H2O ¾¾ ® Ca(OH)
2
molecule is 5 : 2 34. The observation that does not indicate a chemical reaction
25. The empirical formula and molecular mass of a compound is
are CH2O and 180 g respectively. What will be the molecular (a) change of temperature
formula of the compound ? (b) change of colour
(a) C9H18O9 (b) CH2O (c) evolution of a gas
(c) C6H12O6 (d) C2H4O2 (d) None of these
26. The empirical formula of a compound is CH2. One mole of 35. Which one of the following is not an exothermic reaction ?
this compound has a mass of 42 grams. Its molecular formula (a) Respiration
is : (b) Slaking of lime
(a) C3H6 (b) C3H8 (c) Burning of a candle
(c) CH2 (d) C2H2 (d) Dipping of iron block in water
27. Which of the following statements is not correct? 36. Which of the following statement is not correct ? To
(a) A chemical equations tells us about the substances
prevent food from getting rancid, we
involved in a reaction.
(b) A chemical equations informs us about the symbols (a) store the food in air-tight containers
and formula of substances involved in a reaction (b) add antioxidants
(c) A chemical equations tells us about the atom or (c) flush bags of chips with an inert gas
molecules of the reactants and products involved in a (d) increase the temperature of the food
reaction 37. In the following equations :
(d) All are correct
NaCO3 + xHCl ¾¾ ® 2NaCl + CO 2 + H 2O,
28. AgNO3 (aq) + NaCl(aq) ¾¾ ® AgCl(s) + NaNO3 (aq) the value x is
Above reaction is - (a) 1 (b) 2
(a) precipitation reaction (c) 3 (d) 4
(b) double displacement reaction 38. Which of the following is not an endothermic process?
(c) combination reaction (a) Boiling of water
(d) Both (a) and (b) (b) Dissolving salts in water
29. A redox reaction is one in which - (c) Dissolving conc. H2SO4 in water
(a) both the substance are reduced (d) Evaporation of water
(b) both the substance are oxidised 39. Rusting of an iron is an example of
(c) an acid is neutralised by the base (a) reduction (b) ionization
(d) one substance is oxidised while the other is reduced (c) oxidation (d) dissociation
30. An organic compound containing C, H and N gave the 40. Which of the following does not corrode when exposed
following analysis :
to the atmosphere?
C = 40% ; H = 13.33% ; N = 46.67%
(a) Iron (b) Copper
Its empirical formula would be
(c) Gold (d) Silver
(a) C2H7N2 (b) CH5N
(c) CH4N (d) C2H7N
General Concepts of Chemistry D- 83
ANSW ER KEY
1 (c) 7 (c) 13 (b) 19 (b) 25 (c) 31 (c) 37 (b)
2 (d) 8 (b) 14 (d) 20 (c) 26 (a) 32 (c) 38 (c)
3 (a) 9 (c) 15 (d) 21 (c) 27 (d) 33 (b) 39 (c)
4 (c) 10 (a) 16 (c) 22 (b) 28 (d) 34 (d) 40 (c)
5 (a) 11 (b) 17 (a) 23 (b) 29 (d) 35 (d)
6 (c) 12 (d) 18 (d) 24 (a) 30 (c) 36 (d)
CHAPTER
Classification : Chemical fertilizers are broadly classified Both soaps and detergents are soluble in water and act
into the following three types : as surfactants which reduce the surface tension of water
(i) Nitrogenous fertilizers : Ammonium sulphate, urea to a great extent. This increases the water - fabric
etc. interaction as a consequence of which dirt particles, grease
spots etc are washed away effectively. In other words
(ii) Phosphatic fertilizers : Super phosphate, ammonium
soaps and detergents enhance the cleansing action of
phosphate
water.
(iii) Potash fertilizers : Potassium chloride, potassium 4. Portland cement : It was first discovered in England. It is
sulphate. essentially a mixture of lime stone and clay. It was called
3. Soaps and detergents Portland cement because in presence of water it sets to a
Soap : Fatty acid salts of sodium and potassium are hard stone-like mass resembling with the famous Portland
known as soaps. These are prepared by the action of rock. The approximate composition of Portland cement is
fatty acids with sodium hydroxide or potassium hydroxide. Calcium oxide (CaO) 62%
Fatty acid + sodium hydroxide ® Soap + glycerol. Silica (SiO2) 22%
Detergents are sodium salt of long chain sulphonic acids Alumina (Al2O3) 7.5%
or alkyl hydrogen sulphate. Magnesia (MgO) 2.5%
Ferric oxide (Fe2O3) 2.5%
Advantages of detergents over soaps
The above compounds are provided by the two raw
(i) Detergents can be used for laundering even with materials, namely lime stone (which provides CaO) and clay
hard water as they are soluble even in hard water. (which provides SiO2, Al2O3 and Fe2O3). In cement, almost
(ii) Detergents possess better cleansing properties than entire amount of lime in present in the combined state as
soaps. calcium silicate (2CaO. SiO2 and 3CaO. SiO2) and calcium
Disadvantages of detergents over soap : Detergents are aluminates (3CaO. Al2O3 and 4 CaO. Al2O3).
prepared from hydrocarbons, while soaps are prepared (i) Cement containing excess amount of lime cracks during
from edible fatty oils. Thus they are non biodegradable. setting; while cement containing less amount of lime
Saponification : It is the process of making of soap by is weak in strength.
the hydrolysis of fats and oils with alkalis. (ii) Cement with excess of silica is slow-setting and that
having an excess of alumina is quick-setting.
(iii) Cement containing no iron is white but hard to burn.
Cement is manufactured by two processes, viz. wet and dry. A small amount (2–3%) of gypsum is added to slow down the setting
of the cement so that it gets sufficiently hardened. Setting of cement is an exothermic process and involves hydration of calcium
aluminates and calcium silicates.
Vitamin generic
Solublility Deficiency disease Overdose disease
descriptor name
Nightblindness and
Vitamin A Fat Keratomalacia Hypervitaminosis
Beriberi, Wernicke-Korsakoff Drowsiness of music
Vitamin B1 Water syndrome relaxation with large doses
Vitamin B2 Water Ariboflavinosis
Liver damage (doses >
Vitamin B3 Water Pellagra 2g/day) and other problems
Diarrohea; possibly nausea
Vitamin B5 Water Paresthesia and heartburn
Anemia peripheral neuropathy
nerve damage (dose > 100
Vitamin B6 Water mg/day) Impairment of proprioception
Vitamin B7 Water Dematitis, enteritis
May mask symptoms of
vitamine12 associated with
Deficiency during pregnancy is birth defects, such as neural
Vitamin B9 Water deficiency, other effects tube defects
Vitamin B12 Water Megaloblastic anemia No known toxicity
Vitamin C Water Scurvy Vitamin C megadosage
Vitamin D Fat Rickets and Osteomalancia Hypervitamin osis D
Deficiency is very rare; mild Increased congestive heart
Vitamin E Fat hemolytic anemia in newborn failure seen in one large
Increases coagulation in
Vitamin K Fat Bleeding diathesis patients taking warfarin.
EXERCISE
1. Deficiency of vitamin A results in
7. Which of the following statements, is not correct, about
(a) lose in apetite (b) skin diseases
glass?
(c) sterility (d) retarted growth (a) Because of its high viscosity glass exists in solid state
2. Which one of the following contains cobalt ? (b) There is no definite melting point for glass.
(a) Riboflavin (b) Vitamin B12 (c) The silicate units in glass are arranged in a way that is
(c) Vitamin A (d) Vitamin B6 quite similar to the arrangement found in liquids.
3. Night-blindness is caused due to the deficiency of (d) Glass is a solid because it has a regular crystalline
(a) Vitamin D (b) Vitamin A arrangement.
(c) Vitamin C (d) Vitamin B 8. The property of plasticity is shown by clay , when it is
4. Alkaline hydrolysis of esters is known as (a) mixed with proper proportion of water
(b) heated strongly
(a) esterification (b) saponification
(c) dried at room temperature after kneading
(c) dehydration (d) alkalination
(d) glazed
5. Deficiency of vitamin E causes 9. One of the properties of glass is its transparency. This
(a) Beriberi (b) Scurvy property of glass is due to
(c) Hemolytic anemia (d) None of these (a) its high viscosity.
6. Scurvy is caused due to the deficiency of vitamin (b) regular arrangement of silicate units in glass.
(a) B1 (b) C (c) irregular arrangement of silicate units in glass.
(c) K (d) A (d) its high coefficient of thermal expansion.
Some Important Man made Materials D- 87
10. Washing soaps are potassium and sodium salts of 22. Which one among the following is the main ingredient in
(a) dicarboxylic acids (b) fatty acids cement?
(c) mineral acids (d) None of these (a) Gypsum (b) Limestone
11. When glass is heated, it (c) Clay (d) Ash
(a) does not melt at a fixed temperature 23. Glass is actually
(a) a crystalline solid (b) an ionic solid
(b) vapourises
(c) an elastic solid (d) a vitrified liquid
(c) melts only above 1000°C 24. The major component used in preparation of different types
(d) None of these of glasses is
12. Glass is a transparent substance obtained by heating silica (a) silica (b) sodium borate
with oxides or carbonates of metals. Glass is a mixture of (c) calcium silicate (d) sodium silicate
(a) phosphates (b) sulphates 25. The reaction that takes place in soap making is called
(c) oxides (d) silicates saponification. Basically soap is sodium or potassium
13. Potash (Potassium carbonate) is used as a fertilizer. It is salts of
also known as (a) long chain monocarboxylic acids
(a) azo compound (b) oil of vitriol (b) glycerol
(c) pearl ash (d) Glauber’s salt (c) long chain dicarboxylic acids
(d) long chain tricarboxylic acids
14. Soft soaps are
26. The most important raw materials used in the manufacture
(a) sodium and potassium salt of cement are
(b) sodium salt of fatty acids (a) potassium nitrate, charcoal and sulphur
(c) potassium salt of fatty acids (b) limestone, clay and gypsum
(d) potassium salt of sulphonic acids (c) transition metal oxides, sodium hydroxide or potassium
15. Soaps are hydroxide
(a) sodium salts of sulphuric acids containing carbon (d) limestone, sodium carbonate and silica
atoms 10 to 16 27. Given below is an approximate composition of a substance :
(b) sodium salts of fatty acids containing carbon atoms CaO 60-70%
16 to 18 SiO2 20-25%
(c) sodium salts of trihydroxy alcohols Al2O3 5-10%
Fe2O3 2-3%
(d) none of these
The substance is
16. Soaps are sodium salts of fatty acids. Which of the following (a) plaster of Paris (b) cement
fatty acid does not form soap? (c) marble stone (d) quartz
(a) Butyric acid (b) Oleic acid 28. The principle of cleaning by soap is
(c) Palmitic acid (d) Stearic acid (a) surface tension (b) floatation
17. Which one of the following is not contained in portland (c) viscosity (d) elasticity
cement ? 29. By which one among the following mechanisms, soap
(a) Ca3Al2O6 (b) Ca3SiO5 removes dirt (soil) from cloth?
(c) Ca2SiO4 (d) Ca3(PO4)2 (a) Soap dissolves the soil as such
18. What is the reason for white cement to be white? (b) Soap reacts with soil and converts them into soluble
(a) It does not contain carbon silicates
(c) Soap takes away the oily part of the soil and thus
(b) It does not contain silicon
separates the soil from the cloth
(c) It does not contain iron (d) The soap molecules bind with the soil, lift the soil and
(d) It does not contain calcium keep it suspended which can then be rinsed away
19. Which one of the following is not present in cement? 30. Consider the following statements
(a) Clay (b) Alumina 1. Soap cannot be used in acidic water.
(c) Alum (d) Gypsum 2 Ionic part of a soap is —COO–· Na+.
20. Which substance is used to retard the setting action of 3. Soap dissolves in water faster then detergent.
cement? Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(a) CaO (b) Al2O3 (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3
(c) CaSO4, 2H2O (d) Na2O + K2O (c) 3 only (d) 1 only
21. Which of the statements about glass are correct? 31. What is the composition of nitrolim – a chemical fertilizer ?
(a) Nitrogen and limestone
1. Glass is a super-cooled liquid having infinite viscosity.
(b) Calcium carbide and nitrogen
2. Violet coloured glass is obtained by adding MnO2. (c) Calcium carbide and carbon
3. Glass is a man-made silicate. (d) None of these
4. Glass is a crystalline substance. 32. Which one of the following correctly defines the state of
Select the correct answer using the codes given below. glass?
(a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4 (a) Crystalline solid (b) Super cooled liquid
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1 and 3 (c) Condensed gas (d) Liquid crystal
D- 88 Some Important Man made Materials
33. Flint glass is obtained from which of the following ? 35. Washing soap can be prepared by saponification with alkali
(a) Zinc and barium borosilicate of which of the following oil
(b) Sand, red lead and potassium carbonate (a) Rose oil (b) Paraffin oil
(c) Sodium aluminum borosilicate (c) Groundnut oil (d) Kerosene oil
(d) Pure silica and zinc oxide 36. The aqueous solution of one of the following vitamins is
34. Which of the following statements about vitamin B12 is dark in colour
incorrect ? (a) B1 (b) B2
(a) It has a cobalt atom (c) B6 (d) B12
(b) It occurs in plants 37. Which one of the following is a vitamin?
(c) It is also present in rain water (a) Benzoic acid (b) Ascorbic acid
(d) It is needed for human body in very small amounts (c) Oxalic acid (d) Formic acid
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 7 (d) 13 (c) 19 (c) 25 (d) 31 (d) 37 (b)
2 (b) 8 (a) 14 (c) 20 (c) 26 (b) 32 (b)
3 (b) 9 (c) 15 (b) 21 (d) 27 (b) 33 (b)
4 (b) 10 (b) 16 (a) 22 (b) 28 (a) 34 (c)
5 (c) 11 (a) 17 (d) 23 (c) 29 (d) 35 (c)
6 (b) 12 (d) 18 (c) 24 (a) 30 (a) 36 (d)
9 General Organic
Chemistry
1. Wohler prepared the first organic compound urea while preparing ammonium cyanate.
2. Classification of organic compounds:
Organic Compounds
Alicyclic Aromatic
Benzenoid Non-benzenoid
3. Isomerism. The existence of two or more chemical compounds with the same molecular formula but having different properties
owing to different arrangement of atoms within the molecule is termed as isomerism.
ISOMERISM
Chain Conformational
Positional Configurational
Functional
Geometrical
Metamerism
Cis
Trans
Optical
Enantiomerism
Diastereomerism
D- 90 General Organic Chemistry
4. Hydrocarbons : All those compounds which contain just carbon and hydrogen are called hydrocarbons.
5. Functional group : The atom or group of atoms which determine the properties of a compound is known as functional group. e.g.
–OH (alcohol), –CHO (aldehyde), > C = C < (alkene), – C º C – (alkyne), etc.
6. Homologous Series : A series of compounds in which the same functional group substitutes hydrogen in a carbon chain is
called a homologous series. e.g. CH3Cl and C2H5Cl differ by a –CH2 unit.
7. Nomenclature : Chemists developed a set of rules, for naming organic compounds based on their structures which is known as
IUPAC rules.
The IUPAC name of an organic compounds consists of three parts.
Prefix – word root – Suffix
Word root : A word root indicates the nature of basic carbon skeleton.
• In case a functional group is present, it is indicated in the name of the compound with either as a prefix or as a suffix.
• While adding the suffix to the word root the terminal ‘e’ of carbon chain is removed
• If the carbon chain is unsaturated then the final ‘ane’ in the name of the carbon chain is substituted by ‘ene’ or ‘yne’
respectively for double and triple bonds.
EXERCISE
1. Two adjacent members of a homologous series have : 16. Which is a general formula of alkenes?
(a) a difference of –CH2 in their structure (a) CnH2n+2 (b) CnH2n
(b) a difference of 14 a.m.u. in molecular mass (c) CnH2n–2 (a) None of these
(c) same general methods of preparation
(d) all of the above 17. Organic compounds will always contain
2. Alkenes are characterized by (a) carbon (b) hydrogen
(a) C – C bonds (b) C = C bonds (c) nitrogen (d) sulphur
(c) C º C bonds (d) cyclic structure 18. Methane, ethane and propane are said to form a homologous
3. Which of the following contains carbonyl group? series because all are
(a) Ketones (b) Aldehydes
(a) hydrocarbons
(c) Esters (d) All of these
(b) saturated compounds
4. The functional group present in CH3COOC2H5 is
(a) ketonic (b) aldehydic (c) aliphatic compounds
(c) ester (d) carboxylic (d) differ from each other by a CH2 group
5. Butanone is a four-carbon compound with the functional 19. General formula of alkyne is
group (a) CnH2n+2 (b) CnH2n
(a) carboxylic acid (b) aldehyde (c) CnH2n–2 (d) CnHn
(c) ketone (d) alcohol
6. Which of the following is incorrectly matched? 20. Which among the following are unsaturated hydrocarbons?
(a) Vinegar ® carboxylic acid (i) H3C — CH2 — CH 2 — CH3
(b) C2H6 ® alkane
(c) Ethanol ® alcohol (ii) H3C — C º C — CH3
(d) Methanol ® ketone
7. If a hydrocarbon has any double bond, it is (iii) H3C — CH — CH 3
|
(a) alkyne (b) alkane
CH3
(c) alkene (d) All the above
8. Alkynes are characterized by –
(a) C – C bonds (b) C = C bonds (iv) H3C — C == CH 2
|
(c) C º C bonds (d) cyclic structure CH3
9. How many different isomers are possible for a hydrocarbon
with the molecular formula C4H10? (a) (i) and (iii) (b) (ii) and (iii)
(a) 1 (b) 2 (c) (ii) and (iv) (d) (iii) and (iv)
(c) 3 (d) 5 21. Pentane has the molecular formula C5H12. It has
10. The general formula CnH2nO2 could be for open chain
(a) diketones (b) carboxylic acids (a) 5 covalent bonds (b) 12 covalent bonds
(c) diols (d) dialdehydes (c) 16 covalent bonds (d) 17 covalent bonds
11. The IUPAC name of CH3CH2COCl is 22. The heteroatoms present in
(a) propanoyl chloride (b) ethanoyl chloride CH3 — CH2 — O — CH2— CH2 Cl are
(c) acetyl chloride (d) chloroethane
12. General formula of alkenes and alkyl radicals are (i) oxygen (ii) carbon
respectively: (iii) hydrogen (iv) chlorine
(a) CnH2n and CnH2n+1 (b) CnH2n and CnH2n+2 (a) (i) and (ii) (b) (ii) and (iii)
(c) CnH2n–1 and CnH2n (d) CnH2n+1 and CnH2n+2 (c) (iii) and (iv) (d) (i) and (iv)
13. The IUPAC name of CH3COOC2H5 will be – 23. Isomers of a substance must have the same
(a) ethyl acetate (b) ethyl ethanoate (a) structural formula
(c) methyl propanoate (d) none of these
(b) physical properties
14. While cooking, if the bottom of the vessel is getting
(c) chemical properties
blackened on the outside, it means that
(d) molecular formula
(a) the food is not cooked completely.
(b) the fuel is not burning completely.
(c) the fuel is wet.
(d) the fuel is burning completely.
D- 92 General Organic Chemistry
ANSW ER KEY
1 (d) 7 (c) 13 (b) 19 (c)
2 (b) 8 (c) 14 (b) 20 (c)
3 (d) 9 (b) 1 5 (b) 21 (c)
4 (c) 10 (b) 16 (a) 22 (d)
5 (c) 11 (a) 17 (a) 23 (d)
6 (d) 12 (a) 1 8 (d)
1 Diversity in Living
Organisms
• Biodiversity refers number and types of wide variety of • The term Phylum is used for animals while Division is
plants and animals present on earth. commonly employed for plants.
• In 1773, Swedish botanist Carolus Linnaeus formulated • Kingdom is the highest taxonomic category. All plants are
the system of Binomial Nomenclature in his book ‘Species included in Kingdom Plantae. All animals are included in
plantarum’. In binomial system, each name is expressed in Kingdom Animalia.
two parts i.e., generic name and specific name. • Herbarium is a collection of pressed and dried plant
• Taxonomy is the branch of biology that deals with the specimens that are preserved on paper sheets.
framing of laws and principles for classifying the organisms • In Botanical garden, various plants groups are grown for
on the basis of their characteristics and evolutionary scientific study, conservation, public education, aesthetics,
relationships. and recreation. The famous botanical gardens are at Kew
• The hierarchial system of classification was introduced by (England), Indian Botanical Garden, Howrah (India) and
Linnaeus. National Botanical Research Institute, Lucknow (India).
Kingdom ® Phylum or Division ® Class ® Order ® • Museum is a building used for the preservation, storage
Family ® Genus ® Species and exhibition of inanimate objects.
• Species is defined as “the smallest real basic unit of • Zoological park or zoological garden or zoo is a place where
taxonomy which is reproductively isolated from other group wild animals are kept in protected environment under human
of individuals”. care. These animals are kept for public exhibition.
• Genus is a group of closely related species that are alike in History of Classification
broad features of their organisation.
• Biological classification was first proposed by Aristotle
• Family is a group of related genera having several common
who used simple morphological characters to classify plants
characters.
and animals.
• Generally, Order and other higher taxonomic categories are
• Linnaeus initially separated plants and animals in two
identified based on the aggregates of characters.
Kingdoms i.e., Kingdom Plantae and Kingdom Animalia.
• A Class is made of one or more related orders.
• Most accepted System of classification is Five system
classification which was given by Whittaker.
Basic Features of Whittaker ’s Five Kingdoms
Kingdom Cellular Organisation Movement Nutrition Reproduction
1. Monera Unicellular, without By flagella (tubulin- Absorptive or Asexual
(All Prokaryotes) nucleus or membranous dynein system) photosynthetic
organelle.
2. Protista Unicellular, eukaryote By flagella, cillia, Absorptive, Both sexual and
(Protozoans, with nucleus and pseudopodia and photosynthetic & asexual
unicellular algae) membranous mucilage holozoic
organelles. propulsion
3. Fungi Multicellular eukaryote Non-motile Heterotrophic Asexual and
(Multicellular coenocytic, no plastids, (saprophytic/ sexual both
decomposers) cells wall of cellulose, parasitic)
chitin.
4. Plantae Multicellular, higher Non-motile Autotrophic or Asexual and
(All plants) organisation photosynthetic sexual both
eukaryotes, cellulosic
cell wall, plastids
present.
5. Animalia Multicellular, higher Highly motile with Heterotrophic Both sexual and
(All animals) organization, all type of motile (holozoic or asexual but in
eukaryotes without cell machinery saprozoic) higher forms
wall and chlorophyll. only sexual
D- 94 Diversity in Living Organisms
Types of Classification
• Artificial classification system : It was used by Linneaus. The artificial classification system was based on vegetative characters
or on the androecium structure.
• Natural classification system : It was based on natural affinities among organisms. Both external and internal features were
taken into account. It was used by George Bentham and Joseph Dalton Hooker.
• Phylogenetic classification system : This system of classification is based upon evolutionary relationship and uses morpho-
logical characters, origin and evolution of the different organisms. It was proposed by Hutchinson.
Viruses
• The term ‘virus’ has been derived from latin, which means poison or venom or viscous fluid. They are obligate parasites, i.e., can
live inside living host only. They have either RNA or DNA. They have character of both living and non-living.
Plant Kingdom
Phylum-Porifera Phylum-Chordata
• Sponges are aquatic, mostly marine, solitary or colonial and • The fundamental four characters of phylum chordata are
sessile. presence of notochord, a dorsal hollow nerve cord, paired
pharyngeal gill slits and post anal tail either in the embryonic
• Examples of some sponges are : Sycon (scypha), Spongilla
or adult stage.
(fresh water sponge) and Euspongia (bath sponge).
• Examples: Herdmania (sea squirt), Branchiostoma.
Phylum-Coelenterata (Cnidaria)
Subphylum vertebrata is divided into two sections:
• All are aquatic and are mostly marine (exception-Hydra are
found in fresh-water), solitary or colonial, sessile, or free- Section 1 Agnatha (The jawless vertebrates)
swimming and radially symmetrical animals. Class : Cyclostomata
• Example-Physalia (Portuguese man of war), Adamsia (Sea • Mouth jawless suctorial and round.
anemone), Pennatula (Sea-pen), Gorgonia (Sea-fan) and • All living members are ectoparasites on some fishes.
Meandrina (Brain coral). Ex. Petromyzon (lamprey), Myxine (hag fish).
Phylum-Ctenophora Section 2 Gnathostomata (The jawed vertebrates)
• These are diploblastic, radial symmetrical animals with tissue Superclass : Pisces (Bear fins)
level of organization.
Class : Chondrichthyes
• Examples–Hormiphora (sea walnut), Pleurobranchia (sea
gooseberry), Cestum (venus girdle), Beroe. • They have a cartilagenous skeleton.
Phylum-Platyhelminthes • Some of them possess electric organs e.g. Torpedo.
• Examples: Scoliodon (Dog fish), Trygon (Sting ray).
• These are mostly endoparasites, bilateral symmetrical,
triploblastic and acoelomate animals with organ level of Class : Osteichthyes
organisation. • They have a bony skeleton.
• Examples : Marine – Exocoetus (Flying fish), Hippocampus
• Examples– Taenia (Tape worm), Fasciola (liver fluke).
(Sea horse), Lophius (Angler fish), Fresh water fishes –
Phylum-Aschelminthes Labeo (Rohu), Catla (Katla).
• They may be free-living, aquatic and terrestrial or parasitic Superclass : Tetrapoda (Bear Limbs)
in plants and animals.
Class : Amphibia
• Examples: Ascaris (Round worm), Wuchereria (filarial worm), • Adapted for both water and land life.
Ancylostoma (Hook worm), Enterobius (Pin worm). • They are oviparous and development indirect through
Phylum-Annelida distinct larval stage called tadpole. Exambles : Bufo (Toad),
Rana (Frog), Hyla (Tree frog), Salamandra (Salamander),
• It is characterised by metameric segmentation forming ring
Ichthyophis (Limbless amphibia).
like segments.
Class: Reptilia
• Example: Neries, Pheretima (Earthworm) and Hirudinaria
(Blood sucking leech). • The class name refers to their creeping or crawling mode of
locomotion.
Phylum-Arthropoda • They are oviparous ; Development direct.
• They are bilateral symmetry, triploblastic animals, which Examples: Crocodilus (Crocodile), Bangarus (Krait)
have organ-system level of organisation. Class: Aves
• Example: Apis (Honey bee), Bombyx (Silkworm), Laccifer • Birds are bipedal feathered animals.
(Lac insect). • Endoskeleton is fully ossified (bony) and the long bones
are hollow with air cavities (pneumatic).
Phylum-Mollusca Examples : Corvus (crow), Pavo (Peacock).
• They are aquatic (marine or fresh water), or terrestrial having Class: Mammalia
an organ-system level of organisation. • These are warm blooded (homiothermous) animals having
• Ex. Pila, Octopus (devil fish), Loligo (sea squid). hair and mammary glands.
• They are viviparous with few exceptions and development
Phylum-Echinodermata is direct.
• All existing echinoderms are marine, generally live at sea Example : Oviparous – Tachyglossus = Echidna (spiny
bottom. Anteater). Viviparous – Pteropus (Flying fox), Camelus
• Ex. Asterias (star fish), Cucumaria (commonly called as sea (Camel), Macaca (Monkey).
cucumber), Antedon (water lily or feather star).
Plant Morphology
Phylum-Hemichordata The Root
• They are bilaterally symmetrical, triploblastic, and • It is the underground system, usually below the soil and
entrocoelous animals. originates from the radicle.
• Ex. Balanoglossus (acorn worm or tongue worm), • The primary functions of root are fixation of plant firmly on
Saccoglossus. soil, absorption of water and conduction of mineral nutrients.
D- 96 Diversity in Living Organisms
Modified Tap Roots • Tuberous root : e.g., sweet potato.
• Fusiform : e.g. radish.
Shoot System
• Napiform : e.g. sugar beet.
• Conical : e.g. carrot. • It is negatively geotropic and positively phototropic.
• Tuberous root : e.g. tapioca. • Stem facilitates conduction of water, mineral and food
• Nodulated : e.g. Rhizobium. material. It also produces and supports leaves and
Modified Branched Root reproductive structure.
• Pneumatophores : Pneumatophores or respiratory roots are Modified Stems
short, vertical and negatively geotropic (grow in an upward
direction) that occur in certain halophytes, which grow in Underground
saline marshes (mangroves). e.g. Rhizophora. • Tuber: e.g. potato.
Modified for Mechanical Functions • Bulb : e.g. onion.
• Prop root : e.g. banyan. • Rhizome : e.g. ginger.
• Stilt root : e.g. screwpine. • Corm :e.g. Amorphophallus.
• Climbing root : e.g. betel. Sub-aerial
• Clinging root : e.g. orchid. • Runner : e.g. Oxalis.
• Floating root : e.g., Jussiaea. • Offset : e.g. Pistia.
• Contractile root : e.g., onion. • Stolon : e.g. Mentha.
• Root thorn : e.g., coconut. • Sucker : e.g. Chrysanthemum.
Modified Adventitious Root Aerial or Metamorphosed
Modified for Physiological Functions • Thorn : e.g. Duranta.
• Parasitic root : e.g., Cuscuta. • Stem-tendril : e.g. grape.
• Epiphytic root : e.g., Orchids. • Phylloclade : e.g. Opuntia.
Leaf
The leaf is a specialised organ of photosynthesis, transpiration and gaseous exchange.
Venation
Venation is the arrangement of the veins and the veinlets in a leaf.
• Reticulate Venation: The veins are arranged in a net like manner, e.g., dicots.
• Parallel Venation: Here the veins are arranged parallel to each other, e.g., monocots.
Modifications of Leaves
Phyllotaxy
(Arrangement of Leaves)
Inflorescence
• An inflorescence is the mode of arrangement of flowers on peduncle or mother axis.
Types of Inflorescence
EXERCISE
1. Study of form and structure of organisms is 7. Which bacteria is utilized in gober gas plant?
(a) Ecology (b) Taxonomy (a) Methanogens
(c) Anatomy (d) Morphology (b) Nitrifying bacteria
2. Group of organisms that closely resemble each other and (c) Ammonifying bacteria
freely interbreed in nature, constitute a (d) Denitrifying bacteria
(a) species (b) genus 8. Which one of the following statements about viruses is
(c) family (d) taxon correct?
(a) Viruses possess their own metabolic system.
3. Herbarium is
(b) Viruses contain either DNA or RNA.
(a) a garden where medicinal plants are grown
(c) Viruses are facultative parasites.
(b) garden where herbaceous plants are grown
(d) Viruses are readily killed by antibiotics.
(c) dry garden 9. Which one of the following organisms is not an example of
(d) chemical to kill plants eukaryotic cells ?
4. Organisms which display properties of both living and (a) Paramoecium caudatum
non-living are (b) Escherichia coli
(c) Euglena viridis
(a) Viruses (b) Diatoms
(d) Amoeba proteus
(c) Lichens (d) Bacteria 10. Which of the following does not contain chlorophyll?
5. The taxonomic unit ‘Phylum’ in the classification of animals (a) Fungi (b) Algae
is equivalent to which hierachial level in classification of (c) Bryophyta (d) Pteridophyta
plants 11. Which of the following is called amphibians of plant
(a) Class (b) Order kingdom?
(c) Division (d) Family (a) Bryophytes (b) Pteridophytes
6. Whittaker is famous for (c) Gymnosperms (d) Algae
(a) Two kingdom classification 12. The plant group that produces spores and embryo but lacks
vascular tissues and seeds is
(b) Four kingdom classification
(a) Pteridophyta (b) Rhodophyta
(c) Five kingdom classification
(c) Bryophyta (d) Phaeophyta
(d) Distinguishing in Bacteria & Blue green algae
D- 98 Diversity in Living Organisms
13. A plant having seeds but lacking flowers and fruits belongs 29. The famous botanical garden ‘Kew’ is located in
to (a) England (b) Lucknow
(a) Pteridophytes (b) Mosses (c) Berlin (d) Australia
(c) Ferns (d) Gymnosperms
30. Which of the following groups of plants play an important
14. Agar is commercially obtained from
role in plant succession on bare rocks/soil?
(a) red algae (b) green algae
(c) brown algae (d) blue-green algae (a) Algae (b) Bryophytes
15. An alga very rich in protein is (c) Pteridophytes (d) Gymnosperms
(a) Spirogyra (b) Ulothrix 31. Which of the following groups of plants are propagated
(c) Oscillatoria (d) Chlorella through underground root?
16. The largest flower found is known as (a) Bryophyllum and Kalanchoe
(a) Rafflesia (b) Tecoma (b) Ginger, Potato, Onion and Zamikand
(c) Musa (d) Cauliflower
(c) Pistia, Chrysanthemum and Pineapple
17. A common characteristic of all vertebrates is
(d) Sweet potato, Asparagus, Tapioca and Dahlia
(a) presence of skull
(b) division of body into head, neck, trunk and tail 32. ICBN stands for
(c) presence of two pairs of functional appendages (a) International Code of Botanical Nomenclature
(d) body is covered with an exoskeleton (b) International Congress of Biological Names
18. The long bones are hollow and connected by air passages (c) Indian Code of Botanical Nomenclature
these are characteristics of (d) Indian Congress of Biological Names.
(a) Mammals (b) Reptiles
33. Leaves of dicotyledonous plants possess ________
(c) Birds (d) All land vertebrates
venation, while ____________ venation is the
19. In which one of the following sets of animals do all the four
characteristic of most monocotyledons.
give birth to young ones?
(a) Platypus, Penguin, Bat, Hippopotamus (a) reticulate and parallel respectively
(b) Shrew, Bat, Cat, Kiwi (b) parallel and reticulate respectively
(c) Kangaroo, Hedgehog, Dolphin, , Loris (c) reticulate and perpendicular respectively
(d) Lion, Bat, Whale, Ostrich (d) obliquely and parallel respectively.
20. Which of the following animal is not a insect ? 34. In class of Amphibia, respiration occurs through
(a) Ticks (b) Honey bee (a) gills (b) lungs
(c) Beetle (d) Wasp
(c) skin (d) All of these
21. Which of the following group of animals maintains high
and constant body temperature such as mammals ? 35. Which of the following class of algae mostly found in salt
(a) Reptiles (b) Amphibians water?
(c) Birds (d) Fishes (a) Phaeophyceae (b) Rhodophyceae
22. Insects have (c) Chlorophyceae (d) Both (a) and (b)
(a) 2 pairs of legs (b) 3 pairs of legs 36. Which of the following are correctly matched with respect
(c) 4 pairs of legs (d) 1 pair of legs to their taxonomic classification?
23. Cymose is (a) Centipede, Millipede, Spider, Scorpion-Insecta
(a) thalamus (b) fruit
(b) House fly, Butterfly, Tse tse fly, Silverfish-Insecta
(c) inflorescence (d) ovary
(c) Spiny Anteater, Sea urchin, Sea cucumber-Echinodermata
24. Which is not a stem modification ?
(a) Rhizome of ginger (b) Corm of Colocasia (d) Flying fish, Cuttlefish, Silverfish-Pisces
(c) Pitcher of Nepenthes (d) Tuber of potato 37. During the post-fertilisation period the ovules develop into
25. A modification of leaf is __________ and the ovary matures into a _________.
(a) Tendrils (b) Phylloclade (a) A – seeds; B – fruit
(c) Cladode (d) Corm (b) A – fruit; B – seeds
26. Artificial system of classification was first used by (c) A – flower; B – seed
(a) Linnaeus (b) De Candolle
(d) A – seeds; B – flower
(c) Pliny the Edler (d) Bentham and Hooker
27. Binomial Nomenclature was given by 38. One of the following is a very unique feature of the
(a) Lamarck (b) Ernst Mayr mammalian body
(c) Carolus Linneaus (d) Cuvier (a) Presence of diaphragm
28. Which of the following is not a pteridophyte? (b) Four chambered heart
(a) Ginkgo (b) Selaginella (c) Rib cage
(c) Polypodium (d) Azolla (d) Homeothermy
Diversity in Living Organisms D- 99
39. Which one of the following groups of animals is correctly 40. Which of the following plants is growing in swampy areas,
matched with its one characteristic feature without even a where many roots come out of the ground and grow
single exception ? vertically upwards?
(a) Reptilia : possess 3 - chambered heart with one (a) Potato (b) Opuntia
incompletely divided ventricle (c) Rhizophora (d) Grass
(b) Chordata : possess a mouth provided with an upper
and lower jaw
(c) Chondrichthyes : possess cartilagious endoskeleton
(d) Mammalia : give birth to young one.
ANSWER KEY
1 (d) 11 (a) 21 (c) 31 (d)
2 (a) 12 (c) 22 (b) 32 (a)
3 (c) 13 (d) 23 (c) 33 (a)
4 (a) 14 (a) 24 (c) 34 (d)
5 (c) 15 (d) 25 (a) 35 (a)
6 (c) 16 (a) 26 (c) 36 (b)
7 (a) 17 (a) 27 (c) 37 (a)
8 (b) 18 (c) 28 (a) 38 (a)
9 (b) 19 (c) 29 (a) 39 (c)
10 (a) 20 (a) 30 (b) 40 (c)
CHAPTER
Cell is a basic structural and functional unit of life. • The golgi apparatus principally performs the function of
• Robert Hooke in 1665 coined the word ‘cell’. packaging materials to be delivered either to the intra-cellular
• Anton von Leeuwenhoek first saw and described a live cell. targets or secreted outside the cell.
• Robert Brown later had discovered the nucleus.
• Cell theory was proposed by Schleiden and Schwann in Lysosomes
1855 to explain the concept of the cellular nature of living • Lysosomes are popularly called “suicide bags”.
organism.
Prokaryotic Cells Vacuoles
• Prokaryotic cells are morphologically most primitive. • In plant cells, the vacuoles can occupy up to 90 percent of
• Prokaryotic cells are devoid of membrane bound organelles the volume of the cell. The vacuole is bound by a single
like plastids, mitochondria and advanced (9+2) flagella. membrane called tonoplast. They are responsible for
• Prokaryotic cells are represented by bacteria, cyanobacteria maintenance of turgour pressure.
(blue green algae) mycoplasma and PPLO (pleuro-
pneumonia like organisms). Mitochondria
Eukaryotic Cells • Mitochondria are also called as powerhouse of cells.
• A eukaryotic cell consists of the following components:
Plastids
Cell Wall
• Plastids are found in plants and few protists Euglena.
• The cell wall is a non-living, semi-rigid, external protective
covering of the cell. Ribosomes
• Cell wall is entirely lacking in animals. • Ribosomes are smallest cell organelles. They are protein
• It is made up of cellulose secreted by the cell itself. synthesising factories.
Cell Mebrane There are two types of ribosomes viz.,
• The cell membrane is a living, thin, elastic and semi- – Prokaryotic or 70S ribosomes
permeable membranous covering of plant and animal cells. – Eukaryotic or 80S ribosomes
Fluid mosaic model of plasma membrane Nucleus
• S.J.Singer and G. Nicolson in 1972 proposed the most
• Nucleus is centrally located, spherical and largest
accepted model of membrane structure. The plasma
membrane is a lipid-bilayer with proteins embedded in it. component of the all eukaryotic cell. It contains the genetic
• Lipids are amphipathic, i.e., they are structurally asymmetric material of the cell.
with polar hydrophilic and non-polar hydrophobic group. Structure of Nucleus
• One of the most important function of plasma membrane is • A typical nucleus consists of four structures: (i) nuclear
the transport of the molecules across it. membrane, (ii) nucleoplasm (iii) chromatin and (iv) the
Endoplasmic Reticulum (ER) nucleolus.
There are two types of endoplasmic reticulum i.e.,
Satellite
• Smooth or agranular ER – They do not have attached Secondary
ribosomes on their surface. constriction
• Rough or granular ER – They bear ribosomes on their Short arm Short arm
surface, for protein synthesis. Centromere
Centromere
Golgi Apparatus
• Golgi apparatus or Golgi complex is a stack of flattened, Long arm
membrane bounded, parallely arranged organelles that occur Telocentric Acrocentric Sub- Metacentric
in the association of endoplasmic reticulum in the metacentric
cytoplasmic matrix. Fig. : Types of chromosomes based on
the position of centromere
Cells and Tissues D- 101
Phases of Cell Cycle Anaphase I : Homologous chromosome with its two chromatids
moves towards the opposite poles of the cell and separate from
Interphase :
each other.
• It has following three sub-phases:
Telophase I : The nuclear membrane and nucleolus reappear.
• G1 phase: It (G stands for gap) includes the synthesis of
Meiosis II
substrate and enzyme necessary for DNA synthesis.
• S phase: During this phase the amount of DNA per cell Prophase II : The nuclear membrane and the nucleolus disappear.
doubles. The chromosomes condense further.
• G2 phase: Proteins are synthesized in preparation for mitosis Metaphase II : The chromosomes get arranged on the equator of
while cell growth continues. the spindle.
• G0 phase : Cells that do not divide further exit G1 phase to Anaphase II : The daughter chromosomes move towards the
enter an inactive stage known as G0. opposite poles.
M Phase (Mitosis Phase) Telophase II : Cytoplasm divides and 4 haploid daughter cells
arise.
It is also called as equational division as the number of
chromosomes in the parent and progeny cells is the same. The Tissues
4 Stages of M phase are : (usually divided into several stages or A group of structurally similar or dissimilar cells that perform a
phases) common function and have a common origin is called a tissue.
Prophase : Initiation of assembly of spindle formation begins. Simple Permanent Plant Tissue
Metaphase : Chromosomes align at the equatorial plate of cells.
These tissues are of 3 types:
Anaphase : The two daughter chromatids, now free of each other,
Parenchyma : The cell wall is thin and made up of cellulose. It
move towards their respective poles.
helps in storage of food, conduction of substances, provides
Telophase : The nucleolus condense and reappear. The spindle turgidity to softer parts of plants.
fibres disperse. The nuclear envelope is assembled around the
Collenchyma : It provides mechanical support to the organs
chromatin mass endoplasmic reticulum reform again.
and resists bending in wind.
Cytokinesis : Karyokinesis (division of nucleus into two) is
Sclerenchyma : These are dead, mechanical and act as skeleton
followed by cytokinesis i.e., division of cytoplasm into two
in plants. It is hardest plant tissue, madeup of highly thick walled
daughter cells.
cells with no nucleus and no cytoplasm. This uniform thicknening
Meiosis is made up of mainly lignin and cellulose or both.
It occurs in reproductive cells and has two parts:
Conducting tissue in plants
Meiosis I • Xylem cells conduct water and minerals from roots to
Prophase I : It is the longest stage and includes 5 stges : – shoots.
Leptotene : The chromosomes become gradually visible under • Phloem cells transport food or photosynthates from leaves
the light microscope. to all parts of plants.
Zygotene : The pairing of homologous chromosomes takes place. Animal Tissues
Pachytene : Crossing over is the exchange of genetic material The structure of the cells vary according to their function.
between two homologous chromosomes.
Therefore, the tissues are different and are broadly classified into
four types:
D- 102 Cells and Tissues
Epithelial Tissue squamous (alveoli, capillaries)
cuboidal (tubules and ducts)
simple simple
columnar ciliated
microvilli
Covering
keratinised squamous (skin)
stratified
unkeratinised squamous (lining mouth, vagina)
Classification transitional (urinary bladder)
endocrine
Glandular unicellular (goblet cells)
exocrine simple
multicellular
Connective Tissue compound (tubular and alveolar)
loose : general connective tissue of body
reticular : supports lymphoid tissue
Connective tissue
dense fibrous : strong, forms tendons, ligaments, etc.
elastic : possesses extension and recoil properties, e.g. lungs
adipocytes (fat cells)
composition
loose connective tissue matrix
Adipose tissue protective packing material, e.g. kidneys
functions as heat insulator (skin)
energy store
matrix
composition chondrocytes (cartilage cells)
Cartilage fibres
hyaline : covers articular surfaces, forms framework, e.g. larynx elastic, ear.
type
fibrocartilage, e.g. intervertebral discs
Blood
Granulocytes Agranulocytes
EXERCISE
1. Difference between the prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells is 11. Which of the following would you not find in a bacterial
in having cell ?
(a) cell wall (b) nuclear membrane (a) DNA (b) Cell membrane
(c) ribosome (d) None of these (c) Golgi apparatus (d) Ribosomes
2. The function of nucleolus is the synthesis of 12. Which of the following could be found in both the nucleus
(a) DNA (b) m-RNA and the cytoplasm?
(c) r-RNA (d) t-RNA (a) Nucleolus (b) Ribosomes
3. Which one of the following has its own DNA? (c) RNA (d) Both RNA & ribosomes
(a) Mitochondria (b) Dictyosome 13. Which one of the following structures is an organelle within
(c) Lysosome (d) Peroxisome an organelle?
4. Regarding the sequence of cell cycle, which one is correct (a) Ribosome (b) Peroxisome
(a) G1, G2, S and M (b) S, G1, G2 and M (c) ER (d) Mesosome
(c) G1, S, G2 and M (d) G2, S, G1 and M 14. The process of mitosis is divided into 4 phases. Identify
5. The exchange of genetic material between chromatids of the correct order in which these phases appear in mitosis
paired homologous chromosomes during first meiotic (a) Anaphase, metaphase, telophase and prophase
division is called (b) Telophase, anaphase, metaphase and prophase
(a) transformation (b) chiasmata (c) Metaphase, prophase, anaphase and telophase
(c) crossing over (d) synapsis (d) Prophase, metaphase, anaphase and telophase
6. Chloroplast containing parenchyma is called 15. Which of the following cells is found in the cartilagineous
(a) chlorenchyma (b) collenchyma tissue of the body?
(c) aerenchyma (d) amylanchyma (a) Mast cells (b) Basophils
7. Chromosomes contain hereditary units called
(c) Osteocytes (d) Chondrocytes
(a) genes (b) ribosomes
(c) DNA (d) RNA 16. Survival of plants in terrestrial environment has been made
8. Which cell organelle is known as the control centre of the possible by the presence of
cell ? (a) intercalary meristem (b) conducting tissue
(a) Nucleus (b) Chloroplast (c) apical meristem (d) parenchymatous tissue
(c) Mitochondria (d) Endoplasmic reticulum
17. The tissues that helps in the movement of our body is
9. Who observed and coined the word 'cell' for the first time?
(a) Robert Cook (b) Robert Brown (a) muscular tissue (b) skeletal tissue
(c) Robert Hooke (d) Leeuwenhoek (c) nervous tissue (d) All of these
10. What part of the cell serves as the intracellular highway? 18. The connective tissue that connects muscle to bone is called
(a) Endoplasmic reticulum (b) Golgi apparatus (a) ligament (b) tendon
(c) Cell membrane (d) Mitochondria (c) cartilage (d) areolar
D- 104 Cells and Tissues
19. Cartilage and bone are types of 25. Which one is not a carbohydrate?
(a) muscular tissue (b) connective tissue (a) Chitin (b) Methionine
(c) skeletal tissue (d) epithelial tissue (c) Glycogen (d) Starch
20. Intercalated disc is present in 26. Branches of botany dealing with the internal organization
(a) striated muscle (b) smooth muscle of plants known as
(c) cardiac muscle (d) Both (b) and (c) (a) Physiology (b) Ecology
21. Cells which take part in secondary growth are named as (c) Anatomy (d) Cytology
(a) phloem (b) xylem 27. Xylem functions as a conducting tissue for water and
(c) cambium (d) medullary ray minerals from _________to the ______and__________.
22. Which of the following is responsible for mechanical support (a) roots, stems, leaves (b) stems, roots, leaves
and enzyme transport ? (c) leaves, stems, roots (d) leaves, stems, leaves
(a) Dictyosome (b) Cell membrane 28. Most diverse macromolecules, found in the cell both
(c) ER (d) Mitochondria physically and chemically are
23. Cell wall in higher plants is made up of (a) proteins (b) carbohydrates
(a) Cellulose + lignin (b) Cellulose + pectin (c) nucleic acids (d) lipids.
(c) Cellulose + suberin (d) Cellulose + lipid 29. Lipids are insoluble in water because lipid molecules are
24. ATP molecule is a (a) hydrophilic (b) hydrophobic
(a) Nucleosome (b) Nucleoside (c) neutral (d) zwitter ions
(c) Nucleotide (d) Deoxyribose sugar 30. Which one is the most abundant protein in the animal world?
(a) Trypsin (b) Haemoglobin
(c) Collagen (d) Insulin
ANSWER KEY
1 (b) 9 (c) 17 (d) 25 (b)
2 (c) 10 (a) 18 (b) 26 (c)
3 (a) 11 (c) 19 (b) 27 (a)
4 (c) 12 (d) 20 (c) 28 (a)
5 (c) 13 (a) 21 (c) 29 (b)
6 (a) 14 (d) 22 (c) 30 (c)
7 (a) 15 (d) 23 (b)
8 (a) 16 (b) 24 (c)
3 Plant Physiology
• Isotonic solution : When concentration of outer solution • Hydroponics : The system of growing plants in soilless
(in which cell is placed) is equal to concentration of cell culture (also called solution culture or tank farming) is known
sap. as hydroponics.
D- 106 Plant Physiology
Role of Essential Elements (Macro and Micro) and their Deficiency Symptoms
S. NAME OF IN WHICH FORM FUNCTIONS DEFICIENCY SYMPTOMS
No. ELEMENT THEYARE
ABSORBED
1. Nitrogen NO2–, NO3– or NH4+ Major constituent of Chlorosis (yellowing of older leaves)
proteins, nucleic acids,
vitamins and minerals.
2. Phosphorous (H2PO42–, Constituent of cell Delay in seed germination
or HPO42–) membrane, nucleic acids, purple or red spots on leaves
nucleotides and some
proteins.
3. Potassium K+ Involved in protein Chlorosis in intervernial
synthesis, closing & area, loss of apical
opening of stomata. dominance
Maintenance of
turgidity of cells.
4. Calcium Ca++ Used in synthesis Stunted growth, necrosis of
of cell wall (middle meristematic regions.
lamella)
5. Magnesium Mg++ Activate enzymes Chlorosis between leaf veins,
in respiration, photo necrosis on older leaves.
-synthesis, DNA and
RNA synthesis.
Constituents of the
porphyrin ring of
chlorophyll structure.
6. Boron 3–
BO3 and B4O7 2– Necessary for uptake Death of root and shoot tips,
and utilization of Ca2+, abscission of flowers.
pollen generation.
7. Chlorine Cl– Determine solute Stunted root growth, reduced fruiting.
concentration (with Na+
and K+) and anion-
cation balance in cells,
essential for photolysis of water.
Metabolism of Nitrogen : • Photosynthesis occurs particularly in specialised cells
Fixation of N2 called mesophyll cell. These cells contain chloroplast, which
• Ammonia is rapidly converted first to nitrites (by is the actual sites for photosynthesis.
Nitrobacter) by the process nitrification. • The two forms of chlorophyll ‘a’ are chl a 683 (P680) and
2NH3 + 3O2 ® 2NO2– + 2H+ + 2H2O chl a 703 (P700) with peak absorption at 683 and 703
2NO2– + O2 ® 2NO3– respectively are anchored in thylakoids membranes. They
• Nitrate is then either available to the plant, or converted to are the reaction centres.
nitrogen gas in the process of denitrification (by Electron Transport : It was first formulated by Hill (1939). It is a
Pseudomonas). series of electron carrier over which electrons pass in a downhill
• Fixation is done by both free living e.g. Azotobacters, journey releasing energy at every step that is used in generating
Clostridium, Cyanobacteria like Nostoc, Anabaena and an electrochemical proton gradient which helps in synthesising
symbiotic bacteria Rhizobium. ATP.
• Nodules act as the site for N 2 fixation. It contains Photorespiration : Light stimulated oxidation of photosynthetic
leghaemoglobin (a pink pigment) and enzyme nitrogenase intermediates to CO2 is known as photorespiration. The course
(Mo-Fe protein). of photorespiration is related to chloroplasts, peroxisomes and
• During this process, the N 2 atmospheric(dinitrogen) is mitochondria. This is a wasteful process & occurs in C3 plants.
Respiration : The phenomenon of breaking of the C–C bond of
reduced by the addition of hydrogen atoms to ammonia.
N2 + 8e– + 8H+ + 16 ATP ® 2NH3 + H2 + 16ADP + 16Pi complex organic molecules through oxidation and releasing of
Photosynthesis energy for cellular use, is called respiration.
• It is actually oxidation reduction process in which water is C6H12O6 + 6O2 ® 6CO2 + 6 H2O + energy ( 2870 kg)
oxidised and CO2 is reduced to carbohydrates. Glycolysis : The scheme of glycolysis was given by Gustav
• The reduction of CO2 to carbohydrates needs assimilatory Embden, Otto Meyerhof and J. Parnas, hence it is referred to as
powers, i.e., ATP and NADPH2. the EMP pathway. It occurs in the cytoplasm of the cell.
Plant Physiology D- 107
Glucose Growth
ATP (6C) • It can be broadly defined as “permanent and irreversible
ADP increase in size of living structure which is accompanied by
Glucose-6-phosphate an increase in dry weight and the amount of protoplasm”.
(6C)
• Growth rate can show two types of increase i.e., arithmatic
increase and geometrical growth.
Fructose-6-phosphate
(6C) Arithmatic Increase
ATP
Lt = L0 + rt where, Lt = length at time ‘t’; L0 = length at time
ADP
Fructose1, 6- bisphosphate
‘zero’; r = growth rate /elongation per unit time; t = time of
(6C) growth.
Geometrical Growth
Triose phosphate
Triose phosphate
(Dihydroxy acetone
W1 = W0 ert where, W1 = Final size (weight, height, number
(glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate) etc.); W0 = Initial size at the beginning of the period; e = base of
phosphate)
(3C) NAD+ (3C) natural logarithms; r = growth rate; t = time of growth.
NADH
Development is growth accompanied by differentiation.
2 ´ Triose bisphosphate
(1, 3-bisphosphoglyceric acid) Differentiation: The cells are derived from root apical and shoot
ADP
(3C) apical meristems and cambium differentiate and mature to perform
specific functions.
ATP
Dedifferentiation : The living differentiated cells loose their
2 ´ Triose phosphate
(3-phosphoglyceric acid) capacity of division. These cells may regain their capacity to
(3C) divide under certain conditions.
Redifferentiation : The products of dedifferentiated cells which
lose the capability to divide but mature to perform specific
2 ´ 2-phosphoglycerate
functions are called redifferentiated cells.
H2O Plant Growth Regulators
2 ´ phosphoenolpyruvate
Auxins
ADP • Auxins induce elongation in shoot cells and inhibition of
ATP elongation of root cells.
2 ´ Pyruvic acid • Synthetic auxins are indole butyric acid (IBA), indole
(3C) propionic acid (IPA), 2,4- dichlorophenoxy acetic acid-
Fig. Steps of Glycolysis (2,4 D); naphthalene acetic acid (NAA).
• At the removal of apical bud the lateral buds grow vigorously.
Fermentation : When O2 is limiting, NADH and pyruvic acid begin
It shows that apical bud suppresses the growth of lateral
to accumulate. Under this condition, plants carry out fermentation
(anaerobic respiration), leading to the formation of CO2 and either bud (axillary bud) just below it. This is known as apical
ethanol or lactic acid. dominance.
Citric acid cycle or tricarboxylic acid cycle or kreb’s cycle : It • Initiating and promoting cell division in certain tissues such
occurs in mitochondrial matrix. as cambium.
• Promotes elongation of stem and coleoptile.
Pyruvate
(3C) • Auxin generally inhibits flowering but in case of pineapple
spray of auxins induces early flowering.
Gibberellins
• GA3 was one of the first gibberellin to be discovered and
Acetyl coenyme A
(2C) remains the most intensively studied form. All GAs are acidic
in nature. They occur in various plant organs such as roots,
stems, leaves, buds, immature seeds and callus tissues of
Oxaloacetic acid
(4C) Citric acid higher plants.
+ (6C) • The most typical and striking effect of gibberellin is on the
NADH+H CO2
+
+ NAD elongation of stem. The internodes increase in length.
NAD
NADH+H
+
• Gibberellin causes the plants to bolt and flower.
a-ketoglutaric acid
(5C) • Gibberellins have been found be more effective than auxins
Malic acid CITRIC ACID CYCLE
(4C) in causing parthenocarpic development of fruits e.g.,
CO 2 tomatos, apples and pears.
Cytokinins
+
NAD
FADH 2
+
+
NADH+H • Miller in 1954 isolated the first crystals of a ‘cell division
FAD ADP
Succinic acid inducing substance’ from the autoclaved herring sperm
(4C) ATP DNA. Since this substance has specific effect on cytokinesis
it is called as kinetin (a modified form of adenine).
Fig. The Citric acid cycle
D- 108 Plant Physiology
• Permanent cell division occurs only in presence of Vernalisation
cytokinins. It also plays important role in causing expansion • In some plants early flowering is induced by pretreatment
of cells. of seeds with a certain low temperature.
• Cytokinins not only breaks dormancy but also promotes Seed Dormancy
the germination of seeds. • Dormancy may be defined as the inactive state of the seed
Abscisic Acid in which the growth of the embryo is temporarily suspended
• Carns and Addicott (1963) isolated two substances Abscisin for a specific length of time.
I and Abscisin II from the cotton balls, that were responsible Flower
for accelerated abscission of leaves. • Flowers are highly modified shoots, bearing nodes and
• ABA inhibits seed germination and growth of excised modified floral leaves, which are meant essentially for sexual
embryos. reproduction in plant.
• ABA stimulates stomatal closure by inhibiting the K+ • A typical mature embryo sac of angiosperm is 7-celled, 8
uptake by guard cell. nucleate structure i.e., 3 antipodal cells, 3-egg apparatus
• ABA increases tolerance of plants to various kinds of cells (consists of 2 synergids and 1 egg cell) and one central
stresses. cell (2 polar nuclei).
Ethylene Double Fertilization
• Ethylene is only gaseous hormone (CH2 = CH2) that is • Fusion of male and female gametes is called fertilization.
synthesized in large amounts by tissues undergoing • One of these male gametes fuses with egg to form diploid
senescence and ripening fruits. zygote (2n) while the other fuses with two polar nuclei of
• Ethylene inhibits elongation of stem, causes swelling of the central cell to produce triploid primary endosperm
nodes and nullifies geotropism. nucleus (PEN) (3n). Since, the latter involves fusion of three
• It is highly effective in inducing fruit ripening when it is haploid nucleus, therefore it is called triple fusion.
produced in large amount which coincides with respiratory • In some angiosperms, two types of fusion occur in the same
climactric i.e., a brief rise to a very high level of respiration. embryo sac “syngamy” leading to the formation of zygote
This rise indicates the beginning of senescence and death. & “triple fusion” forming primary endosperm cell, this
Photoperiodism phenomenon is called “double-fertilization”.
• The term photoperiodism is used by Garner and Allard, • Endosperm is the nutritive tissue which provides
1920 for the ability of plant to detect and respond the relative nourishment to the embryo in seed plant.
length of day and night to which the plant is exposed. The • Seed is a fertilized ovule. After fertilization ovary begins to
site of perception of light/dark duration are leaves. grow and gradually matures into fruit.
• Most of the plants are short day plants that include Cosmos, • Polyembryony - Given by Leeuwenhoek (1917) in Orange
Dahlia, Chrysanthemum, rice, etc. The long day plants are More than one embryo in a seed.
wheat, barley, sugar beat, larkspur, etc. Cucumber,
sunflower, tobacco, tomato etc. are some examples of
intermediate day plants.
EXERCISE
1. The physical process involved in the release of molecular 5. Hydroponics is a technique in which plants are grown in
oxygen from leaves is (a) green house
(a) diffusion (b) transpiration (b) water saturated sand
(c) osmosis (d) capillarity (c) balanced nutrient solution
2. If a cell swells, after being placed in solution, the solution is (d) purified distilled water
(a) neutral (b) hypotonic 6. Respiration in plants
(c) hypertonic (d) isotonic (a) occurs only during day
3. Chlorophyll is present
(b) results in the formation of vitamins
(a) in the grana of chloroplasts
(c) is characteristic of all living cells
(b) on the surface of chloroplasts
(d) often requires CO2
(c) dispersed through out the chloroplasts
(d) in the stroma of chloroplasts 7. Chief function of leaves are
4. Translocation of carbohydrate nutrients usually occurs in (a) transpiration and photosynthesis
the form of (b) respiration and photosynthesis
(a) glucose (b) maltose (c) respiration and digestion
(c) starch (d) sucrose (d) respiration and transpiration
Plant Physiology D- 109
8. Which element is required in comparatively least quantity 23. N2 + 8e– + 8H+ + 16 ATP ® 2NH4 + H2 + 16ADP + 16Pi
for the growth of plant? The above equation refers to
(a) Zn (b) N (a) ammonification (b) nitrification
(c) P (d) Ca (c) nitrogen fixation (d) denitrification
9. End product of glycolysis is 24. In PS-I the reaction centre Chl a has absorption maxima at
(a) acetyl CoA (b) pyruvic acid _____________, while in PS-II the reaction centre Chl a
(c) glucose-1-phosphate (d) fructose-1-phosphate
has absorption maxima at ___________.
10. The ultimate gain of light reaction is
(a) ATP and NADPH2 (b) NADPH2 (a) P680, P700 (b) P700, P680
(c) only ATP (d) only O2 (c) P800, P600 (d) P700, P900
11. End product of fermentation of sugars is 25. Ethylene gas is used for
(a) H2O and CO2 (b) CO2 (a) growth of plants.
(c) alcohol and CO2 (d) alcohol (b) delaying fruit’s abscission.
12. Stomata open and close due to (c) ripening of fruits.
(a) circadian rhythm (d) stopping the leaf abscission.
(b) genetic clock
26. Which one is the correct summary equation of
(c) pressure of gases inside the leaves
(d) turgor pressure of guard cells photosynthesis?
13. Which of the following plant is found to have minimum (a) C6H12O6 + 6O2 ¾¾ ® 6CO2 + 6H2O + energy
transpiration ? (b) C6H12O6 + 6O2 + 6H2O ¾¾ ®
(a) Cactus (b) Hydrilla 6CO2 + 12H2O + energy
(c) Mango (d) Guava
Light
14. Photosynthetically active radiation is represented by the (c) 6CO2 + 6H2O ¾¾¾¾¾ ®
Chlorophyll 6H2O + C6H12O6
range of wavelength of
(a) 340 – 450 nm (b) 400 – 700 nm
Light
(c) 500 – 600 nm (d) 400 – 950 nm (d) 6CO2 + 12H2O ¾¾¾¾¾ ®
Chlorophyll
15. Which of the following is not performed by root hairs ?
6O2 + C6H12O6 + 6H2O
(a) Water uptake (b) Oxygen uptake
27. Which one of the following is primarily concerned with cell
(c) Mineral uptake (d) CO2 uptake
division ?
16. In rainy season, door gets swelled due to
(a) imbibition (b) diffusion (a) GA3 (b) IAA
(c) transpiration (d) respiration (c) Cytokinin (d) Ethylene
28. Growth is primarily affected by two climatic factors which
17. The force responsible for upward conduction of water
are –
against gravity comes from (a) Light and temperature
(a) transpiration (b) translocation (b) Temperature and relative humidity
(c) respiration (d) photosynthesis (c) Light and wind
18. Double fertilization means (d) Rainfall and temperature
(a) fusion of male gametes and ovum 29. The hormone reducing transpiration rate by inducing
(b) fusion of two polar bodies stomatal closure is
(c) a male gamete fused with egg and second male gamete (a) ABA (b) ethylene
fused with secondary nucleus (c) cytokinin (d) auxin
(d) all the above 30. Which part of the plant do not perform photosynthesis?
19. Which of the following is not caused by deficiency of (a) Cactus stem (b) Guard cell of stomata
mineral nutrition? (c) Mesophyll cells of leaf (d) Leaf epidermis
(a) Necrosis (b) Chlorosis 31. Effect of low temperature which shortens vegetative period
and hasten flowering is
(c) Etiolation (d) Shortening of internodes
(a) photoperiodism (b) transpiration
20. Generally plants absorbed N2 in the form of
(c) vernalization (d) photolysis
(a) NO2– (b) NO3–
(c) N º N (d) HNO2 32. Which of the following elements is not required by plants
for their normal healthy growth?
21. Which of the following element is a constituent of protein ?
(a) Calcium (b) Magnesium
(a) Sulphur (b) Potassium (c) Lead (d) Iron
(c) Lead (d) Phosphorus 33. The hormone responsible for phototropism is
22. Haploid, diploid and triploid conditions respectively can (a) Ethylene (b) Abscisic acid
be traced in (c) Auxin (d) Gibberellic acid
(a) egg, nucellus, endosperm 34. In which part of a flower do both meiosis and fertilization
(b) antipodal, egg, endosperm occur?
(c) endosperm, nucellus, synergids (a) Ovule (b) Stigma
(d) antipodal, synergids and integuments
(c) Anther (d) Petal
D- 110 Plant Physiology
35. Bidirectional translocation of minerals takes place in 38. Two pigment system theory of photosynthesis was
(a) Xylem (b) Phloem proposed by or Concept of evidence for existence of two
(c) Parenchyma (d) Cambium photosystems in photosynthesis was given by
36. Soil can easily become deficient in____________ (a) Hill (b) Blackman
because these ions are negatively charged and do not (c) Emerson (d) Arnon
stick to negatively charged clay particles. 39. Which mineral nutrients are called critical element for crops?
(a) Nitrate (b) Calcium (a) N, P, K (b) C, H, O
(c) Ammonium (d) Magnesium (c) N, S, Mg (d) K, Ca, Fe
37. In an anaerobic condition, yeast cells breakdown glucose 40. Which of the following would not have an effect on flowering
to of a particular plant species?
(a) CO2 + H2O (b) C2H5OH and CO2 (a) Plant age (b) Nutritional status
(c) CO2 + Lactic acid (d) CO2 + Pyruvic acid (c) Temperature (d) Prevailing wind
ANSWER KEY
1 (a) 6 (c) 11 (c) 16 (a) 21 (a) 26 (d) 31 (c) 36 (a)
2 (b) 7 (a) 12 (d) 17 (a) 22 (a) 27 (c) 32 (c) 37 (b)
3 (a) 8 (a) 13 (a) 18 (c) 23 (c) 28 (a) 33 (c) 38 (c)
4 (d) 9 (b) 14 (b) 19 (c) 24 (b) 29 (a) 34 (a) 39 (a)
5 (c) 10 (a) 15 (d) 20 (b) 25 (c) 30 (d) 35 (b) 40 (d)
4 Human Physiology
• The food that we consume must be broken down into Dental formula for adult human
simpler absorbable forms so that they can be easily absorbed
and transported to various parts of our body through blood.
This task is accomplished by the digestive system.
Digestion of Food
Name of the Digestive Name of the enzymes Substrate End product
Saliva Ptyalin (Salivary amylase) Starch Maltose
Pancreatic iuice Amylopsin (pancreatic amylase) Starch, Glycogen Maltose and Glucose
Intestinal juice Sucrase (invertase), Maltase, Sucrose; Maltose, Lactose Glucose and fructose, Glucose,
Lactase Glucose and galactose
Gastric iuice Pepsin, Rennin Proteins, Casein Proteoses and peptones, Calcium
caseinate
Pancreatic iuice Trypsin, Chymotrypsin, Carboxyl Proteins, Proteins Peptides Proteoses and peptides Peptides
peptidases Amino acid.
Intestinal juice Amino peptidase, Dipeptidase Peptides Amino acids, Amino acids
Vitamin required by the body
Vitamin Chemical Name Function In Body Deficiency Disease
B1 Thiamine pyrophosphate Part of coenzyme for respiration Beri-beri: nerve and heart disorders
B2 Riboflavin Part of coenzyme FAD needed for respiration Ariboflavinosis: skin and eye disorders
B12 Cyanocobalamin Coenzyme needed for making red blood cells, Pernicious anaemia
bone, blood and nerve changes
B5 Nicotinic acid ('niacin') Part of coenzymes NAD, NADP used in Pellagra: skin, gut and nerve disorders
respiration
C Ascorbic acid Not precisely known Scurvy: degeneration of skin teeth and
blood vessels.
A Retinol Not fully known but forms part of visual Xeropthalmia: 'dry eyes'
pigment, rhodopsin
D Cholecalciferol Stimulates calcium absorption by small intestine, Rickets: bone deformity
needed for proper bone growth
E Tocopherol Not precisely known Infertility
K Phylloquinone Involved in blood clotting Possible haemorrage
Inorganic Elements in the Human Diet
Element Common ions Functions in human body
Calcium Ca
2+ Calcium ions are needed for stability of cell membranes , as cofactors for s ome
enzymes and are involved in mus cle contraction and blood clotting.
Phos phorus H 2PO4 Bones component of many organic molecules like DNA , RNA and A TP.
Potas sium K+ ü These ions are important in determining the balance of electrical charges in body
ï
Sodium Na + ý fluids.
Chlorine - ï
Cl þ
Iron Fe , Fe
2+ 3+ Component of haemoglobin and cytochrome molecules .
Iodine I
– Component of hormone thyroxin.
Copper Cu 2 + ü Trace elements as enzyme cofactors , for example, Cu
2+
is co-factor for cytochrome
M anganes 2+ ï
Mn ý oxidase.
Zinc Zn 2 + ïþ
D- 112 Human Physiology
• Marasmus is produced by a simultaneous deficiency of Circulatory Pathways
proteins and calories. In Marasmus, protein deficiency The circulatory patterns are of two types –
impairs growth and replacement of tissue proteins; extreme • Open circulatory system is present in arthropods and
emaciation of the body and thinning of limbs results, the molluscs in which blood pumped by the heart passes
skin becomes dry, thin and wrinkled. Growth rate and body through large vessels into open spaces or body cavities
weight decline considerably.
called sinuses. Annelids and chordates have a closed
• Kwashiorkar is produced by protein deficiency
circulatory system in which the blood pumped by the heart
unaccompanied by calorie deficiency. Like marasmus,
is always circulated through a closed network of blood
kwashiorkor shows wasting of muscles, thinning of limbs,
vessels. All vertebrates possess a muscular chambered
failure of growth and brain development.
heart. Fishes have a 2-chambered heart with an atrium and
Human Respiratory System a ventricle. Amphibians and the reptiles (except crocodiles)
• Human respiratory system consists of external nostrils, nasal have a 3-chambered heart with two atria and a single
cavity, nasopharynx, larynx, trachea, bronchiole and lungs. ventricle, whereas crocodiles, birds and mammals possess
a 4-chambered heart with two artia and two ventricles.
Transport of gases
Heart Beat and Pulse
• 97% of oxygen is transported from the lungs to the tissues
• The human heart beats at the rate of about 72-80 per minute
in combination with haemoglobin (Hb + O2 ¾¾® HbO2,
in the resting condition.
oxyhaemoglobin). 3% is transported in dissolved condition
by the plasma. Electrocardiograph
• ECG is the graphic record of electronic current produced by
There are three ways of transport of CO2. the excitation of cardiac muscles.
• 5%–7% (approximately) of CO2 is transported, being • A normal electrocardiogram is composed of a P wave, QRS
dissolved in the plasma of blood. complex and T wave. P wave indicate the depolarisation of
• CO2 react with the water to form carbonic acid (H2CO3) by the atria. QRS complex expresses the ventricular
the enzyme carbonic anhydrase (present in RBC). depolarisation. T wave indicate an repolarisation of ventrcle.
• CO2 reacts with amine radicals (NH2 ) of haemoglobin Disorders of Circulatory System
molecule and forms a carbamino–haemoglobin (HbCO2)
molecule. Nearly 23% of CO2 is transported through this Hypertension
mode. • A continuous or sustained rise in arterial pressure is known
Disorders of respiratory system as hypertension. High blood pressure compels heart to work
excessive and then can tend to congestive heart disease.
Bronchial Asthma : It is characterised by the spasm of smooth
muscles of the wall of bronchiole. Atherosclerosis
Emphysema : It is an inflation of bronchiole, which results into • In this, calcium salts precipitated with cholesterol of the
loss of elasticity of these parts. forming or formed opaque making the wall of arteries stiff
Occupational Lung Disease : It is caused because of the exposure and rigid and is referred to as the hardening of the arteries.
of potentially harmful substances persuntion in the environment, It may lead to heart attack and death.
where people work. Two common occupational diseases are –
silicosis and asbestosis. Excretion
Blood Groups • The process of excreting ammonia is -Ammonotelism.
• ABO grouping : It is based on the presence or absence of Kidney plays a minor role in the elimination of ammonia
two surface antigens on the RBCs namely A and B. e.g., teleost fishes, tadpoles, aquatic soft bodied
invertebrates. Organism undergoing ammonotelism are
Table : Blood Groups and Donor Compatibility
called ammonotelic.
Blood Antigens Antibodies Donor's • The process of excreting urea is - Ureotelism. Examples are
mammals, many terrestrial adult amphibians and
Group on RBCs in Plasma Group cartilaginous fishes (shark).
A A anti-B A, O
• The process of elimination of uric acid is -Uricotelism
B B anti-A B, O Examples are land snails, insects, birds and many reptiles.
AB A, B nil AB, A, B, O • Each kidney has nearly one million complex tubular
O nil anti-A, B O structures called nephrons, which are the functional units
of kidney. These filter the blood to produce urine.
Rh Grouping : Another antigen, the Rh antigen are also observed Disorders of the Excretory System
on the surface of RBCs of majority of humans (Rh + individuals). • Malfunctioning of kidneys can lead to accumulation of urea
A special case of Rh incompatibility has been observed between in blood, a condition called uremia, which is highly harmful
Rh– blood of a pregnant mother with Rh+ blood of foetus. and may lead to kidney failure.
Human Physiology D- 113
• In such patients, urea can be removed by a process called • This kind of joint are classified into six major categories.
hemodialysis. Blood drained from a convenient artery is – Plane (gliding joint) : Present between carpals. Only
pumped into a dialysing unit called artificial kidney. sliding motion in all direction is allowed.
• Renal calculi : Stone or insoluble mass of crystallized salts – Hinge joint : Present between Knee joint
(oxalates, etc.) formed within the kidney.
– Pivot joint : Present between atlas and axis
• Glomerulonephritis : Inflammation of glomeruli of kidney.
– Saddle joint : Present between carpal and metacarpal
Skeletal System – Ball and Socket joint : Present between humerus and
pectoral girdle.
Human Skeleton (comprising 206 bones) Disorders of Muscular and Skeletal System
divided into
• Myasthenia gravis - Autoimmune disorder. It affects
neuromuscular transmission.
Axial Skeleton Appendicular Skeleton
• Muscular dystrophy - Progressive skeletal muscle
made up of made up of weakness, defects in muscle proteins, the death of muscle
cells and tissue.
Skull Vertebral Sternum Ribs • Rheumatoid Arthritis : Inflammation of synovial membrane.
column Girdles Limbs
• Osteoarthritis : Degeneration of articular cartilage.
Axial Skeleton : Skeleton which occurs in the mid axial or • Gout : Caused by excess formation of uric acid and their
longitudinal part of the body. deposition in the joints.
(i) Skull is made up of 29 bones. It is composed of • Osteoporosis : Low bone mass, increased fragility and
• Cranium (8 bones) : Frontal - 1; Parietal - 2; proneness to fracture.
Occipital - 1; Temporal - 2; Sphenoid - 1; Ethmoid - 1. Neural Control and Coordination
• Facial bones (14 in number) : Nasal - 2; Maxillae - 2; • The neural sysem is the control system of the body which
Zygomatic - 2; Lacrymals - 2; Mandibles - 1; consists of highly specialized cells called neurons.
Inferior turbinals - 2; Vomer - 1; Palatines - 2. • A neuron consists of main cell body and cytoplasmic
Hyoid Tongue bone - 1 processes arising from it.
• Ear ossicles (6 bones) : Malleus -2; Incus - 2; The human brain is divisible into three parts:
Stapes - 2.
• Forebrain : It comprises the olfactory lobes, cerebrum and
(ii) Vertebral column : 33 in babies, 26 in adults. Grouped into
diencephalon.
5 categories :
Cerebrum is the largest and complex part. It consists of the
Cervical - 7; Thoracic - 12; Lumber - 5; Sacral - 5; Coccygeal
left and right hemispheres connected by a bundle of
- 4 (fused in adults).
myelinated fibres, called corpus callosum. The outer layer of
(iii) Sternum : Composed of 3 parts ® Manubrium, body of the cerebrum is called the cortex.
sternum and xiphoid process .
• Diencephalon : The main parts of the diencephalon are
(iv) Ribs : They are twelve pairs. First seven pairs are true ribs.
epithalamus, thalamus and hypothalamus.
The 8th, 9th and 10th ribs are called false ribs or
vertebrochondrial ribs. The last 11th and 12th pairs are called • The hypothalamus is the highest centre of autonomic
floating ribs. nervous system. It governs emotional reactions and exercise
control over sleep mechanism.
Appendicular Skeleton : Present laterally or attached to the axial
skeleton. •. Midbrain : It is formed of corpora quadrigemina and cerebral
peduncles. Cerebral penduncles are bundles of fibres
(i) Girdles : 2 types - pectoral and pelvic.
connecting the cerebral cortex with other parts of brain and
Pectoral girdle : made of two parts - clavicle and scapula. spinal cord.
Pelvic girdle : made of three bones - ilium, pubis and ischium.
• Hind brain : It comprises of :
(ii) Limb bones : Hind limbs and fore limbs - both made up of 30
bones each. – Cerebellum : It controls the balance and posture of the
body.
Fore limbs : Humerus (1); Radius-Ulna (2); Carpals (8);
Metacarpals (5); Phalanges (14); Phalanges formula = 2, 3, – Pons varolii - The pons is concered with maintenance
3, 3, 3. Hind limbs : Femur (1); Tibia-Fibula (2); Patella (1); of normal rhythm of respiration.
Tarsals (7); Metatarsals (5); Phalanges (14). – Medulla oblongata - Medullary centres (reflex centres)
are present for controlling the functions of important
Joints organs, e.g., cardiac centres (heart), respiratory centre,
• A joint is a location at which two bones make contact and is vasomotor centre (for regulating diameter of blood
essential for all types of movements, involving the bony vessels) and reflex centres (for swallowing, vomiting,
parts of the body. peristalsis, secretion and activity of alimentary canal,
salivation, coughing etc.)
Synovial Joints - Movable Joints : They are characterised by the
presence of a closed space or cavity between the bones.
D- 114 Human Physiology
Chemical Coordination in Animal (Hormones)
Pancreas
• Located posterior to stomach, close to duodenum.
• Endocrine Pancreas : Consists of islets of Langerhans. The islet of Langerhans have two main types of cells.
ENDOCRINE PANCREATIC SECRETIONS :
NAME OF THE CELLS PRODUCT FUNCTION
1. Beta (b) cells Insulin and Amylin Lower blood sugar level.
2. Alpha (a) cells Glucagon Raise blood sugar level.
Human Physiology D- 115
Testes Reproduction
Function : Produces a group of hormones called androgens • It is the ability of living organisms to produce a new offspring
mainly testosterone. similar to themselves.
• Androgen regulates the development, maturation and • The major reproductive events in human beings are
functions of the male accessory sex organs. (i) Gametogenesis – Formation of gametes.
(ii) Insemination – Transfer of sperms into female genital
Ovary tract.
Functions : Ovary produces one ovum during each menstrual (iii) Fertilisation – Fusion of male and female gametes lead-
cycle. It produces 2 groups of steroid hormones called. ing to formation of zygote.
(i) Estrogen (iv) Implantation – Formation and development of blasto-
(ii) Progesterone cyst and its attachment to the uterine wall.
• Stimulating growth and activities of female secondary (v) Gestation – Embryonic development; gestation is the
sex organs. time from conception to birth.
• Supports Pregnancy. (vi) Parturition – Delivery of baby (the process of birth).
• Also regulates female sexual behaviour.
• Production of milk.
EXERCISE
1. Which part of the alimentary canal does not secrete any 9. In which of the following reptiles four chambered heart is
enzyme? present ?
(a) Mouth (b) Oesophagus (a) Lizard (b) Snake
(c) Stomach (d) Duodenum (c) Scorpion (d) Crocodile
2. The food that gives more calories per unit mass of food is 10. Melatonin is produced by
(a) thymus (b) skin
(a) protein (b) carbohydrates
(c) pituitary (d) pineal gland
(c) fat (d) water
11. Child death may occur in the marriage between
3. Percentage of oxygen supplied by haemoglobin is
(a) Rh+ man and Rh + woman
(a) 97% (b) 100% (b) Rh+ man and Rh – woman
(c) 49% (d) 3% (c) Rh– man and Rh – woman
4. Which one of the following correctly represents the normal (d) Rh– man and Rh + woman
adult human dental formula ? 12. Which one of the following organs in the human body is
3 1 3 1 2 1 3 3 most affected due to shortage of oxygen?
(a) , , , (b) , , , (a) Intestine (b) Skin
3 1 2 1 2 1 2 3
(c) Kidney (d) Brain
2 1 2 3 3 1 3 3 13. The pH of blood is
(c) , , , (d) , , , (a) between 7-8 (b) between 2-4
2 1 2 3 3 1 3 3
(c) between 12-14 (d) between 2-5
5. In expiration, diaphragm becomes 14. Antibodies are
(a) flattened (b) relaxed (a) carbohydrates (b) immunoglobulins
(c) straightened (d) arched (c) globular proteins (d) extrinsic proteins
6. Elbow joint is an example of 15. Air is breathed through
(a) hinge joint (b) gliding joint (a) Trachea — lungs — larynx — pharynx — alveoli
(c) ball and socket joint (d) pivot joint (b) Nose — larynx — pharynx — bronchus — alveoli —
7. The toxic effect of CO is due to its greater affinity for bronchioles
haemoglobin as compared to O2 approximately by (c) Nostrils — pharynx — larynx — trachea — bronchi —
bronchioles — alveoli
(a) 2 times (b) 20 times
(d) Nose — mouth — lungs
(c) 200 times (d) 1000 times
16. Which of the following disease is not concerned with
8. A patient is generally advised to specially, consume more disorders of circulatory system?
meat, lentils, milk and eggs in diet only when he suffers
(a) Heart failure
from
(b) Angina
(a) Scurvy (b) Kwashiorkor
(c) Coronary artery disease
(c) Rickets (d) Anaemia (d) Uremia
D- 116 Human Physiology
17. Neurons receive signals through their __________ and 29. Thoracic cage is made up of
send signals to other neurons through their __________. (a) ribs, vertebral column & diaphragm
(a) dendrites ... receptors (b) ribs, diaphragm & sternum
(b) end feet ... cell bodies and dendrites (c) vertebral column, diaphragm & sternum
(c) cell bodies and dendrites ... axons (d) ribs, vertebral column & sternum
(d) transmitter vesicles ... axons 30. The junction between an axon and dendrite is called
18. Functional and structural unit of kidney is (a) cyton (b) synapse
(a) nephron (b) seminiferous tubule (c) relay (d) conduction zone
31. A certain road accident patient with unknown blood group
(c) acini (d) None of these
needs immediate blood transfusion. His one doctor friend
19. Asthma is caused due to
at once offers his blood.What was the blood group of the
(a) Infection of lungs donor?
(b) Spasm in bronchial muscles (a) Blood group B (b) Blood group AB
(c) Bleeding into pleural cavity (c) Blood group O (d) Blood group A
(d) infection of trachea 32. Which one is not a reflex action?
20. Dialysis is done in the condition when person is suffering (a) Closing of eye lids against fricking
from (b) Release of saliva on seeing sweets
(a) diabetes (b) uremia (c) Perspiration due to heat
(c) polyuria (d) haemoptysis (d) Obeying the order to run
21. Which part of human brain is concerned with the regulation 33. Which one is not correct ?
of body temperature? (a) Humans - Uriotelic (b) Birds - Uricotelic
(a) Cerebellum (b) Cerebrum (c) Lizards - Uricotelic (d) Whale - Ammonotelics
(c) Hypothalamus (d) Medulla Oblongata 34. Main similarity between hormone and enzyme is
22. Which of the following organs can be called as a sort of (a) both act at particular pH
"blood bank" ? (b) both are proteins
(a) Lungs (b) Heart (c) both are required in small amounts
(c) Liver (d) Spleen (d) both can be used again and again
35. Which of the following commonly called emergency gland
23. Universal blood recipient is
of body?
(a) blood group O (b) blood group AB
(a) Thymus (b) Testis
(c) blood group A (d) blood group B (c) Adrenal (d) Pituitary
24. Bones are mainly made up of 36. Other function performed by kidney apart from excretion is
(a) calcium and phosphorous (a) Osmoregulation (b) Temperature regulation
(b) calcium and sulphur (c) Hormonal regulation (d) Spermatogenesis
(c) calcium and magnesium 37. Appearance of facial hairs in a woman may be due to the
(d) calcium and iron effect of
25. ECG records (a) temperature (b) ultraviolet radiation
(a) rate of heart beat (c) hormone (d) pollution
(b) potential difference 38. Glucagon is secreted by
(c) ventricular concentration (a) b (beta) cells of islets of langerhans
(d) volume of blood pumped (b) a (alpha) cells of islets of langerhans
26. During strenuous exercise, glucose is converted into (c) b cells of pancreas
(a) glycogen (b) pyruvic acid (d) adrenal cortex
(c) starch (d) lactic acid 39. Parathormone deficiency produces muscle ramps or tetany
27. In human testosterone is produced by as a result of
(a) tunica albuginea (b) leydig cell (a) lowered blood Ca2+
(c) seminiferous tubule (d) sertoli cell (b) enhanced blood Na+
28. In adult, normal blood pressure is (c) enhanced blood glucose
(a) 80/120 mm Hg (b) 100/80 mm Hg (d) enhanced blood Ca2+
40. Thymosin stimulates
(c) 120/80 mm Hg (d) 100/120 mm Hg
(a) milk secretion (b) erythrocytes
(c) T-lymphocytes (d) melanocytes
Human Physiology D- 117
ANS W ER KEY
1 (b) 6 (a) 11 (b) 16 (d) 21 (c) 26 (d) 31 (c) 36 (a)
2 (c) 7 (c) 12 (d) 17 (c) 22 (d) 27 (b) 32 (c) 37 (c)
3 (a) 8 (b) 13 (a) 18 (a) 23 (b) 28 (c) 33 (d) 38 (b)
4 (c) 9 (d) 14 (b) 19 (b) 24 (a) 29 (d) 34 (c) 39 (a)
5 (d) 10 (d) 15 (c) 20 (b) 25 (b) 30 (b) 35 (c) 40 (c)
CHAPTER
5 Genetics and
Evolution
Study of heredity and variation is called genetics. Human Blood Groups and Multiple Allele
• Term genetics was given by - Bateson. • The system of blood groups in humans was discovered by
• Father of genetics - Gregor Johann Mendel. Karl Landsteiner in 1900s.
• Father of experimental genetics - Thomas Hunt Morgan. • There are four phenotypes of Blood namely A, B, AB and O
• Father of human genetics - Archibald Garrod. produced by three different alleles IA, IB and i of a gene.
Some Terms in Genetics • The allele IA and IB are equally dominant and do not interfere
with expression of each other hence the allele IA IB are said
Gene : It is segment of DNA. It is basic unit of heredity. to be co-dominant because both are expressed in the
Back cross : It is cross which is performed between hybrid and phenotype AB.
one of its parents. • Linkage is the phenomenon of certain genes staying together
Test cross : Test cross is crossing of offspring with unknown during inheritance through generations without any change
dominant phenotype with the individual homozygous recessive or separation due to their being present on the same
for the trait. chromosomes.
Monohybrid cross : It is a cross between two organisms of a • Linkage in the genes can be identified by test cross.
species which is made to study the inheritance of a single pair of • The rearrangements of linked genes due to crossing over is
alleles or factors of a character. known as recombination. Recombination also occurs due to
Monohybrid ratio : Monohybrid ratio is usually 3 : 1 (phenotypic chance separation of chromosomes during gametogenesis
ratio) or 1 : 2 : 1 (genotype ratio) in which 25% of the individuals and their random coming together during fertilization.
carry the recessive trait, 25% pure dominant and 50% have hybrid
dominant trait. Sex Determination
Dihybrid cross : It is a cross between two organisms of a species • Henking discovered X body in spermatogenesis of few
which is made to study the inheritance of two pairs of factors or insects and it was given name of X chromosome. Due to
alleles of two genes. involvment of X and Y chromosomes in determination of
Dihybrid ratio : Dihybrid ratio is 9 : 3 : 3 : 1 (phenotypic ratio) sex, they were called sex chromosomes.
where 9/16 first recessive and second dominant and 1/16 carry • Rest of the chromosomes which determine other metabolic
both the recessive traits. character of the body are called autosomes.
• Mendel conducted cross hybridization experiments on
Mutation
Garden Pea plant (Pisum sativum). The first was the
Principle of segregation, which claimed that each trait was • Phenomenon that results in alteration of DNA sequence and
specified by paired hereditary determinants (alleles of genes) consequently results in change in genotype and phenotype
that separate from each other during gamete formation. This of an organism is called mutation.
law is also called Law of purity of gametes or Law of splitting • Mutagens are various chemical and physical factors that
of hybrids. induce mutations, e.g., UV radiations, carcinogenic chemicals
• Gregor Mendel was the first individual to apply a modern like nicotine, nitric oxide (NO).
scientific approach to the study of heredity. Mendel Genetic Disorder
proposed two basic principles of trasmission genetics.
• Mendel’s second basic conclusion was the Principle of • A genetic disorder is a disease that is caused by an
independent assortment, which stated that the segregation abnormality in an individual’s DNA.
of one pair of genes-controlling a given trait - was not Haemophilia
influenced by the segregation of other gene pairs. The
• A protein involved in clotting of blood is affected in an
chormosome theory provided a physical basis for the
affected individual; if person gets a cut, will result in non-
principle of independent assortment. Genes located on stop bleeding.
different chromosomes move to gametes independently of • Females are heterozygous and carriers of haemophilia.
each other during meiosis.
Genetics and Evolution D- 119
Sickle Cell Anaemia Phenylketonuria
• It is due to inheritance of defective allele coding for • Affected individual lacks enzyme phenylalanine
b-globin. It results in the transformation of HbA into HbS in hydroxylase that converts amino acid phenylalanine to
which glutamic acid is replaced by valine at 6th position in tyrosine.
each of two b-chains of haemoglobin. • It is characterized by severe mental retardation,
• It is an excellent example of single mutation. hypopigmentation of skin & hair, eczema, etc.
Chromosomal Mutation
Name of Chromosomal
disorder or Alteration Symptoms or Associated Traits
syndrome involved
Down’s Trisomy 21 Characteristic facial features, short stature, heart defects, respiratory
Syndrome infections, mental retardation.
Klinefelter’s XXX (or XXYY, Sterility, small testes, feminine body contours, normal intelligence or
Syndrome XXXY, etc) mental retardation.
Turner’s Monosomy X Short stature, sex organs do not mature, no secondary sex characteristics,
Syndrome (XO) normal intelligence.
Cri du chat Deletion in Mental retardation, small head, unusual cry.
Syndrome Chromosome 5
EXERCISE
1. Mutation rates are affected by 7. How many pairs of contrasting characters in pea pod were
(a) temperature chosen by Mendel?
(b) X-rays (a) 2 (b) 3
(c) gamma and beta radiation (c) 4 (d) 7
(d) All of the above 8. From a cross AABb x aaBb, the genotypes
2. A dihybrid condition is
AaBB : AaBb : Aabb : aabb will be obtained in the following
(a) tt Rr (b) Tt rr
ratio
(c) tt rr (d) Tt Rr
3. In case of incomplete dominance the monohybrid ratio of (a) 1: 1 : 1 : 1 (b) 1: 2 : 1 : 0
phenotypes in F2 generation is (c) 0: 3 : 1 : 0 (d) 1: 1 : 1 : 0
(a) 1 : 2 : 1 (b) 3 : 1 : 1 9. A nucleotide is formed of
(c) 9 : 3 : 3 : 1 (d) 2 : 3 : 1 (a) purine, pyrimidine and phosphate
4. The number of autosomes in human female ovum is (b) purine, sugar and phosphate
(a) 11 (b) 12 (c) nitrogenous bases, sugar and phosphate
(c) 22 (d) 23
(d) pyrimidine, sugar and phosphate
5. Which one of the following represents a test cross ?
(a) Ww × WW (b) Ww × Ww 10. The process of translation is
(c) Ww × ww (d) WW × WW (a) ribosome synthesis
6. How many different kinds of gametes will be produced by a (b) protein synthesis
plant having the genotype AABbCC? (c) DNA synthesis
(a) Nine (b) Two (d) RNA synthesis
(c) Three (d) Four
Genetics and Evolution D- 121
11. Which one of the following pairs of nitrogenous bases of 22. Genetic variation in a population arises due to
nucleic acids, is wrongly matched with the category (a) Mutations only
mentioned against it? (b) Recombination only
(a) Thymine, Uracil - Pyrimidines (c) Mutations as well as recombination
(b) Uracil, Cytosine - Pyrimidines (d) Reproductive isolation and selection
(c) Guanine, Adenine - Purines 23. The first organisms were
(d) Adenine, Thymine - Purines
(a) Chemoautotrophs
12. Ligase helps in
(b) Chemoheterotrophs
(a) removal of few genes
(b) translation (c) Autotrophs
(c) inserting few genes in DNA (d) Eukaryotes
(d) bringing transversion in chromosomes 24. What was the most significant trend in evolution of modern
13. A nucleoside differs from a nucleotide in not having man (Homo sapiens) from his ancestors ?
(a) phosphate (a) Upright posture
(b) sugar
(b) Shortening of jaws
(c) nitrogen base
(c) Binocular vision
(d) phosphate and sugar
14. Nucleotide arrangement in DNA can be seen by (d) lncreasing brain capacity
(a) X-ray crystallography 25. The factors which represent the contrasting pairs of
(b) Electron microscope characters are called
(c) Ultracentrifuge (a) dominant and recessive
(d) Light microscope (b) alleles
15. Scientific name of man is
(c) homologous pairs
(a) Canis familiaris (b) Homo habilis
(d) determinants
(c) Homo erectus (d) Homo sapiens
16. The primitive atmosphere of earth contained water vapours, 26. Who proved that DNA is basic genetic material?
hydrogen, ammonia and
(a) Griffith
(a) CO2 (b) O2
(c) N2 (d) CH4 (b) Watson
17. The book ‘Origin of Species’ is written by (c) Boveri and Sutton
(a) Aristotle (b) Darwin
(c) Watson (d) Lamarck (d) Hershey and Chase
18. Which was absent in the atmosphere at the time of origin of 27. The two strands of DNA are held together by
life ? (a) peptide bonds (b) phosphodiester bonds
(a) NH3 (b) H2 (c) hydrogen bonds (d) S – S bonds
(c) O2 (d) CH4 28. According to special creation theory the earth is about
19. Homologous organs are (a) 4000 yrs old (b) 4.5 M yrs old
(a) wings of insects and bat (c) 4.5 B yrs old (d) 10000 yrs old
(b) gills of fish and lungs of rabbit
29. Which of the following is not a part of Darwin’s theory of
(c) pectoral fins of fish and fore limbs of horse
evolution?
(d) wings of grosshopper and crow
20. The kind of evolution in which two species of different (a) Genetic drift
geneology come to resemble one another closely, is termed (b) Natural selection
as (c) Survival of the fittest
(a) progressive evolution
(d) Struggle for existence
(b) convergent evolution
(c) parallel evolution 30. In Down's syndrome of a male child, the sex complement is
(d) retrogressive evolution (a) XO (b) XY
21. Which one is linked to evolution? (c) XX (d) XXY
(a) Extinction (b) Competition
(c) Variation (d) Reproduction
D- 122 Genetics and Evolution
ANS W ER KEY
1 (d) 6 (b) 11 (d) 16 (d) 21 (c) 26 (d)
2 (d) 7 (d) 12 (c) 17 (b) 22 (c) 27 (c)
3 (a) 8 (b) 13 (a) 18 (c) 23 (b) 28 (a)
4 (c) 9 (c) 14 (a) 19 (c) 24 (d) 29 (a)
5 (c) 10 (b) 15 (d) 20 (b) 25 (b) 30 (b)
6 Biology in
Human Welfare
• Pisciculture is the rearing, breeding and catching of fishes. Table : Crop varieties bred by hybridization and selection for
disease resistance to fungi, bacteria and viral disease.
• Aquaculture is rearing and management of useful aquatic
• Examples of insect pest resistance crops bred by
plants and animals like fishes, oysters, mussels and prawns,
hybridization are
etc.
(i) Pusa Gaurav variety of Brassica is resistant to aphids.
Bee keeping or Apiculture (ii) Pusa Sawani and Pusa A-4 varieties of Okra (Bhindi)
• Apiculture is rearing and breeding of honeybees for the are resistant to shoot and fruit borer.
production of honey. (iii) Pusa sem 2 and Pusa sem 3 varieties of flat bean are
• The commonest species of honeybee is Apis indica. resistance to aphids and fruit borer.
Single Cell Protein (SCP)
Animal Breeding
• Single cell protein refers to the dried microbial cells or total
• Animal breeding is the production of new breeds of
protein extracted from pure microbial cell culture (algae,
domesticated animals with improved traits.
bacteria, yeasts and filamentous fungi) which can be used
– Inbreeding : Mating between the closely related
as food supplement to humans or animals.
animals of same breed.
– Out-breeding : Mating between the animals which are Tissue Culture
not closely related. • Plant cells and plant organs can be cultured in vitro (e.g., in
– Out-crossing : Mating between the animals of the same test tube or any other container) on a suitable medium (e.g.,
breed which do not have a common ancestor. agar medium), is called plant tissue culture.
– Cross-breeding : Mating between the superior animals • A plant part excised from its original location and used for
of different breeds of the same species. initiating a culture is known as explant. The explants, media,
• MOET (Multiple Ovulation Embryo Transfer) technique is vessels and instruments used in tissue culture must be
a programme which improves the chances of successful sterilised to make them free from any microbes.
production of hybrids. Microbes in Human Welfare
Plant Breeding • Microbes can be grown on culture nutritive media to form
colonies which are used for mass production of certain
• Plant breeding refers to the modification and improvement desirable products and for scientific study of metabolism,
of genetic material of plants resulting in the development of genetics and structure of micro-organisms.
crops which are more beneficial to human beings.
D- 124 Biology in Human Welfare
Lactobacillus lacti : Milk fermentation • Three techniques of genetic engineering are:
Lactobacillus acidophilus : Cheese production (i) rDNA (recombinant DNA technology)
Streptococcus thermophilus : Yoghurt production (ii) Gene cloning/gene amplification
Streptokinase – Streptococcus Dissolution of (iii) Gene therapy
blood clots • Tools of (recombinant DNA technology) rDNA technology
Streptodornase are
Insulin, Interferon Recombinant DNA Human therapy (i) Vector – Plasmid, Bacteriophage, Cosmid, BAC, YAC
variety of E. coli (ii) Host – with Ori C [origin of replication]
(iii) Restriction endonuclease – with well defined
• Baker’s yeast, beer, Saccharomyces Baking and
recognition site
wine, bread cerevisiae brewing
• Vectors are cloning vehicles required to transfer DNA of
industry
interest from one organism to another.
• SCP [single cell S. lipolytica Food
• Plasmids are extra-chromosomal, circular, double stranded
protein] supplement autonomously replicating sequence in bacterial cell.
• Citric acid Aspergillus niger Food product
• Bacteriophage is virus which infect bacteria. They have
preservative special sticky “cos” site to accept foreign DNA.
• Invertase Mucor Preparation of • Cosmid can be defined as the hybrid vectors derived from
adhesives, plasmids which contain cos site of phage 1.
candy making • BAC (Bacterial Artificial Chromosome) : Episome + Foreign
• Antibiotics are chemical substances, which are produced DNA.
by some microbes and can kill or retard growth of other • YAC (Yeast Artificial Chromosome) : Yeast DNA + Marker
disease causing microbes. gene from competent bacteria.
• Alexander Flemming while working on Staphylococci • Marker sequences are the ones whose phenotype gives
plates observed that in one of unwashed culture plate, it observable change, e.g., Tetracycline resistance gene,
could not grow because of chemical produced by mould alcohol fermentation gene.
Penicilliun notatum grown on it which produces chemical • Palindromic sequence are the ones which read same in one
penicillin. orientation on both the strands.
Microbes in Production of Biogas For e.g., 5' — GAATTC — 3'
• Produced by methanogens, which are anaerobic bacteria 3' — CTTAAG — 5'
growing on cellulosic material and produce large amount of is palindrome as it reads same on both strand in 5' ® 3'
methane alongwith CO2 and H2 e.g., Methanococcus, direction. Same is true for 3' ® 5' direction.
Methanobacterium. Restriction Enzymes
• Bt Cotton is genetically modified cotton having Bacillus • Enzymes that recognizes a specific sequence of double
thuringiensis genes. Bacterium Bacillus thuringiensis (Bt) stranded DNA and cut the DNA at that site are called
is used as microbial control agent in order to control butterfly restriction enzymes. They are often referred as molecular
caterpillars. scissors.
Microbe as Biofertilisers • Restriction endonuclease was found by Arber in 1963 in
bacteria. First was EcoRI found in colon bacterium
• Rhizobium species in root nodules of leguminous plant. Escherichia coli. Recognition sequence of EcoRI is
• Azospirillium and Azotobacter are free living species in 5' — GAATTC — 3'.
soil. • Agrobacterium tumefaciens is cloning vector for plants
• Cyanobacteria such as Anabaena, Nostoc and Oscillatoria which is T-DNA (transforming DNA) to transform normal
(autotrophic micorbes) in paddy field. plant cell into tumour and direct them to form mass of cells
Biotechnology called galls which start secreting chemical required by
• It deals with large scale production and marketing of bacteria.
products and processes using living organisms, cells or Applications of Biotechnology are
enzymes.
• GM crop production
• Examples of Biotechnology are GMO [Genetically modified
organisms], IVF (in vitro fertilization), Test tube babies, Animals
DNA vaccines and gene therapy. • Transgenics
Plants
• Genetic engineering can be defined as the generation of • Therapeutics
new combination of heritable material by the insertion of
• Gene therapy
desired genes or DNA sequences, produced by whatever
means outside the cell, into any carrier system so as to • Molecular diagnosis
allow their incorporation into a host organism in which they GM Crop Production – Genetically Modified Crop
do not normally occur but in which they are able to perform (i) Purpose of introduction of GM crop was to minimise use of
normal behaviour and propagation. fertilisers and chemicals so that their harmful effect on
environment could be reduced.
Biology in Human Welfare D- 125
(iii) Examples GM crops are Bt cotton and Pest resistant plants. Therapeutics
Bt cotton : It is a pest resistant plant which resist attack of Insulin production
Lepidopterans insects. The plant Bt toxin gene which cause • Insulin is a hormone used for diabetics patient.
death of insect larvae by causing cell lysis and swelling of • Insulin was extracted from pancreas of cattle, pigs in limited
epithelium of midgut. quantity.
• Bt toxin is biologically produced by bacterium called • PCR is a gene amplification technique that has found wide
Bacillus thuringiensis (Bt). This toxin is insecticidal protein spread use in medicine & molecular biology.
crystal produced in bacteria (inactive form in bacteria) • ELISA is a laboratory test, which can quickly determine
during a particular phase of growth. antigen or antibody levels in blood or other fluids.
• Transgenic plants are organisms containing a foreign gene
• A single stranded DNA/RNA attached with radioactive
from a different species received by genetic engineering .
molecule is called molecular probe. Molecular probe are
• Examples of Transgenic plants are
Transgenic plants Character introduced used for detection of gene by complementary hybridising
Flavr savr tomato Long shelf life in cloned cell, followed by autoradiography.
Soyabean, corn Herbicide tolerance Biopiracy
Brinjal, tomato Insect resistance • Biopiracy is use of bioresource by multinational companies
Tobacco, potato Viral resistance and other organisation without proper authorization from
Golden rice Rich in vitamin A countries and people concerned without compensatory
payment.
EXERCISE
1. The animal husbandry deals with the care, breeding and 9. Which gas is responsible for the puffed-up appearance of
management of dough ?
(a) Domesticated animals (a) CO2 (b) O2
(b) Fishes (c) SO2 (d) NO2
(c) Honey bees and silk worms 10. Streptokinase which is used as a ‘clot buster’ obtained from
(d) All of these (a) Streptococcus (b) Staphylococcus
2. Murrah, Mehsana, Jaffarbadi are breeds of (c) Lactobacillus (d) Saccharomyces
(a) Buffalo (b) Cow 11. Ganga and Yamuna action plan is initiated by
(c) Cattle (d) Horse (a) Ministry of environment and forest.
3. The most common species for bee-keeping in India is (b) Ministry of agriculture.
(a) Apis florae (b) Apis mellifera (c) Ministry of wild-life conservation.
(c) Apis dorsata (d) Apis indica (d) None of these
4. Blue revolution is related to the following field 12. BOD refers to
(a) Dairy products (b) Fisheries (a) Bacteria Oxygen Demand
(b) Biochemical Oxygen Demand
(c) Egg production (d) Agriculture
(c) Biochemical Operation Demand
5. Three crops that contribute maximum to global food grain (d) Biological Organism Demand
production are 13. The technology of biogas production was developed in
(a) Wheat, rice and maize India mainly due to the efforts of
(b) Wheat, rice and barley (a) Indian Agricultural/ Research Institute (IARI) and
(c) Wheat, maize and sorghum Khadi and Village Industries Commission (KVIC)
(d) Rice, maize and sorghum (b) National Botanical Research Institute (NBR1)
6. Jaya and Ratna developed for green revolution in India are (c) Indian Council of Medical Research (ICMR)
the varieties of (d) Indian Council of Agricultural Research (ICAR)
(a) maize (b) rice 14. Cheese and Yogurt are products obtained by
(c) wheat (d) bajra (a) distillation (b) pasteurization
7. Yeast Saccharomyces cervisiae is used in the industrial (c) fermentation (d) dehydration
production of 15. Two microbes found to be very useful in genetic engineering
(a) butanol (b) citric acid are
(c) tetracycline (d) ethanol (a) Vibrio cholerae and a tailed bacteriophage
8. Most of eubacterial antibiotics are obtained from (b) Diplococcus sp. and Pseudomonas sp.
(a) Rhizobium (b) Bacillus (c) Crown gall bacterium and Caenorhabditis elegans
(c) Streptomyces (d) Cephalosporium (d) Escherichia coli and Agrobacterium tumefaciens
D- 126 Biology in Human Welfare
16. Domestication of honey bees is called 23. First cloned animal
(a) Sericulture (b) Apiculture (a) Dolly sheep (b) Polly sheep
(c) Tissue culture (d) Pisciculture (c) Molly sheep (d) Dog
17. Silk worm is a 24. Which one of the following is not an antibiotic ?
(a) fly (b) worm (a) Streptomycin
(c) moth (d) beetle (b) Citric acid
18. Which one of the following statement is true? (c) Griseofulvin
(a) The greater the BOD of waste water, more is its pollut- (d) Cephalosporin
ing potential. 25. Jatropha is a
(b) The greater the BOD of waste water, less is its pollut- (a) biodiesel crop
ing potential. (b) biopetro crop
(c) The lesser the BOD of waste water, more is its pollut- (c) fibre crop
ing potential. (d) food crop
(d) The lesser the BOD of waste water, less is its 26. IPM is
polluting potential. (a) International Pest Management Programme.
19. The example of non-renewable source of energy is (b) International Pesticide Management Programme.
(a) alcohol fuel (b) petroleum (c) Integrated Pest Management Programme.
(c) biogas (d) fuel wood (d) Internal Pest Management Programme.
20. The term antibiotic was coined by 27. What are the advantage of gobar gas over conventional
(a) Alexander Flemming utilization?
(b) S. Waksman (a) More efficient source of energy
(c) Louis Pasteur (b) Used as good fertilizer
(d) Edward Jenner (c) Reduces the chances of spreading of pathogens
21. Important objective of biotechnology in agriculture section (d) All of the above
is 28. Organic farming is the technique of raising crops through
(a) to produce pest resistant varieties of plant use of
(b) to increase the nitrogen content (a) Manures (b) Resistant varieties
(c) to decrease the seed number (c) Biofertilisers (d) All of these
(d) to increase the plant weight 29. Chemically, the silk is
22. Which of the following is the pair of biofertilizers? (a) Cellulose (b) Resin
(a) Azolla and blue green algae
(c) Protein (d) Lipid
(b) Nostoc and legume
(c) Rhizobium and grasses 30. Biogas consists of
(d) Salmonella and E. coli (a) carbon monoxide, methane and hydrogen.
(b) carbon dioxide, methane and hydrogen.
(c) carbon monoxide, ethane and hydrogen.
(d) carbon dioxide, ethane and hydrogen.
CHAPTER
7
Diseases and their
Defence Mechanism
• Health is a state of complete physical, social and mental • Disease is any condition which interferes with the normal
well being and not merely the absence of disease or infirmity. structure and function of the body that is manifested by a
characteristics sets of symptoms and sign.
DISEASE
Communicable
(d) Ig G – Stimulation of phagocytes and complement system, • Genetic vaccines involve one or more genes from diseases
passive immunity to foetus. carrying agent (pathogen) and splicing these gene into
(e) Ig M – Activation of B cells. plasmids (closed rings of DNA). These rings are then
delivered into small groups of cell, often by infection into
muscle cells or by propulsion into via so called ‘gene gun’.
Immunization
Allergy and Autoimmunity
• Inoculation of vaccines to prevent diseases is called
immunization. • Allergy is an important side effect of immunity.
• Vaccines are preparations of living or killed micro-organisms • Autoimmune disease result when the immune system attack
or their products. Vaccines are of two types – live vaccines and destroys ‘self’ cells and molecules. Eg., rheumatoid
and killed vaccines. arthritis.
EXERCISE
1. Vaccines are
(a) treated bacteria or viruses or one of their proteins 9. Expand ELISA
(b) MHC (major histocompatibility complex) proteins (a) Enzyme Linked Immuno - Sorbent Assay
(c) curative medicines (b) Enzyme Linked Ion Sorbent Assay
(d) monoclonal antibodies (c) Enzyme Linked Inductive Assay
2. Which of the following is a sexually transmitted disease ? (d) None of the above
(a) Q fever (b) Leprosy 10. Which one of the following is an Indian medicinal plant ?
(c) Whooping cough (d) Gonorrhoea (a) Saccharum officinarum
(b) Rauwolfia serpentina
3. Which of the following is a pair of viral diseases?
(c) Oryza sativa
(a) Common cold, AIDS (b) Dysentery, common cold
(d) Solanum melongena
(c) Typhoid, tuberculosis (d) Ringworm, AIDS
11. AIDS is caused by HIV that principally infects
4. Which of the following is most infectious disease?
(a) Hepatitis - B (b) AIDS (a) all lymphocytes (b) activator B cells
(c) Amoebiosis (d) Malaria (c) cytotoxic T cells (d) T 4 lymphocytes
5. The formation of antibodies within our body is called 12. Widal test is used for the diagnosis of
(a) active immuntiy (b) passive immunity (a) malaria (b) pneumonia
(c) innate immunity (d) acquired immunity (c) tuberculosis (d) typhoid
6. ‘Malaria’ a common disease world wide is caused by a 13. Who invented vaccine for small pox ?
(a) bacterium (b) virion (a) Robert Koch (b) Robert Hooke
(c) protozoa (d) fungi (c) Edward Jener (d) Louis Pasteur
14. Which of the following diseases is also known as infantile
7. Which of the following diseases is due to an allergic reaction?
paralysis?
(a) Goitre (b) Skin cancer
(a) Lock jaw (b) Rabies
(c) Hay fever (d) Enteric fever
(c) Polio (d) Chicken pox
8. Which immunoglobin (Ig) is produced in primary immune
response? 15. Which of the following is not a communicable disease ?
(a) IgA (b) IgE (a) Typhoid (b) Malaria
(c) IgG (d) IgM (c) AIDS (d) Goitre
D- 130 Diseases and their Defence Mechanism
16. Against which of the following does interferon act ? (b) Causes gastric ulcers
(a) Bacteria (b) Virus (c) Raises blood pressure
(c) Fungi (d) Snake venom (d) is carcinogenic
17. Which of the following disease is a hormonal disorder ? 27. In persons addicted to alcohol, the liver gets damaged because it
(a) Anaemia (b) Cholera (a) has to detoxify the alcohol
(c) Diabetes (d) Goitre (b) stores excess of glycogen
18. AIDS day is (c) is over stimulated to secrete more bile
(a) June 1 (b) May 1 (d) accumulates excess of fats
(c) December 1 (d) December 20 28. Community health aims at
19. Which one of the following pairs of disease can spread through (a) better health and family planning
blood transfusion? (b) better hygiene and clean environment
(a) Cholera and hepatitis (c) removing communicable diseases
(b) Hepatitis and AIDS (d) All of the above
(c) Diabetes mellitus and malaria 29. Tuberculosis is caused by
(d) Hay fever and AIDS (a) Bacterium (b) Virus
20. Which of the following diseases is caused by Protozoa ? (c) Protozoan (d) Malnutrition
(a) Chicken pox (b) Measles 30. ‘Plague’ is transmitted by
(c) Filariasis (d) Sleeping sickness (a) House fly (b) Tse-tse fly
21. Cancer of blood is called (c) Rat flea (d) Mosquito
(a) Leukemia (b) Lymphoma 31. ‘Black death’ is related with
(c) Sarcoma (d) Hybridoma (a) Plague (b) Cancer
22. DPT vaccine is given for (c) Tuberculosis (d) Measles
(a) Tetanus, polio, plague 32. Cholera, leprosy and diptheria are
(b) Diptheria, whooping cough and leprosy (a) Bacteria diseases (b) Viral diseases
(c) Diptheria, pneumonia, tetanus (c) Fungal diseases (d) Functional diseases
(d) Diptheria, whooping cough, tetanus 33. The group of diseases spread by houseflies is
23. Which is an autoimmune disease? (a) Malaria, Cholera, Scabies
(a) Cancer (b) Asthma (b) Rabies, Rickets, Diarrhoea
(c) Erythroblastosis foetalis (d) Rheumatoid arthritis (c) Typhoid, Dysentery, Tuberculosis
24. The jaundice is a physiological liver disease. It is caused by a (d) Ringworm, Scurvy, Vomiting
(a) Bacterium (b) Virus 34. Which of the following is a communicable disease?
(c) Protozoan (d) Helminth (a) Leucoderma (white patches on the skin)
25. A certain patient is suspected to be suffering from Acquired (b) Diabetes mellitus
Immuno Deficiency Syndrome. Which diagnostic technique will (c) Beri-beri
you recommend for its detection? (d) Dysentery
(a) ELISA (b) MRI 35. Which scientist is credited with the development of medical
(c) Ultra sound (d) Widal test vaccinations?
26. Tobacco smoke contains carbon monoxide which (a) Robert Koch (b) Charles Darwin
(a) reduces the oxygen-carrying capacity of blood (c) Edward Jenner (d) William Harvey
ANSW ER KEY
1 (a) 6 (c) 11 (d) 16 (b) 21 (a) 26 (a) 31 (a)
2 (d) 7 (c) 12 (d) 17 (c) 22 (d ) 27 (c) 32 (a)
3 (a) 8 (d) 13 (c) 18 (c) 23 (c) 28 (d ) 33 (c)
4 (a) 9 (a) 14 (c) 19 (b) 24 (a) 29 (a) 34 (a)
5 (a) 10 (b) 15 (d) 20 (d) 25 (a) 30 (c) 35 (c)
(c) Gamma diversity : Diversity over the total landscape Air Pollution
or geographical area.
Imporrtant Air Pollutants and their Impact
• Biodiversity increases, as we move from high to low lattitude (1) SO2, H2S : Lichens are most sensitive to SO2. Eye irritation,
as (i.e., from poles to equator). destroys bronchial cilia. Causes acid rain thus decreasing
Causes of Loss of Biodiversity the pH of soil.
(i) Natural extinction: Some species disappear and are replaced (2) Carbon Monoxide : Reduces O2 carrying capacity of blood
by other species when environmental conditions change. by forming carboxy haemoglobin.
(ii) Mass extinction: Disappearance of large number of species (3) Nitrogen oxides : Collapse of leaves. Nitrogen oxides reacts
because of some catastrophe. with hydrocarbons like methane, ethane, toluene, etc. to
(iii) Anthropogenic extinction : Disappearance or extinction of form peroxyacetyl nitrate or PAN (C2H3O5N).
species due to human activity. Photochemical smog : The mixture of PAN with ozone and various
organic radicals.
Conservation of Biodiversity
(4) Ozone : NO2 ® NO + O, O2 + O ® O3.
• There are 2 basic methods of biodiversity conservation:
• Causes premature senescence in plants.
(i) In situ (on site)
• Damage pulmonary organ in animals.
(ii) Ex situ (off site)
(5) Cadmium
In situ conservation
• Example of protected areas are National Park, wild life • Causes cancer of liver and lungs.
sancturies and biosphere reserve. • itai - itai (ouch ouch) disease (painful joints)
Ex situ conservation Water Pollution
• Ex situ conservation includes botanical gardens, zoos,
• The term water pollution refers to any type of aquatic
pollen seed, seedling, tissue culture and DNA banks.
contamination between the following 2 extremes -
• Cryopreservation is an in vitro conservation technique by
• A highly enriched, over productive biotic community, such
which vegetatively propagated crops like potato are
as river or lake with nutrients from sewage or fertilizer
preserved in liquid nitrogen at a temperature of –196°C.
(cultural eutrophication) or,
• IUCN and WWF are leading International Organisations
• A body of water poisoned by toxic chemicals which eliminate
concerned with biodiversity conservation.
living organisms or even exclude all forms of life.
Sanctuaries and National Parks : A sanctuary or a National park
may be defined as an area declared by state, for the purpose of Causes of Water Pollution
protecting, propagating or developing wild life therein, or it’s (1) Sewage
natural environment for their scientific, educational & recreational (2) Industrial waste
value. (3) Agrochemicals
Biosphere Reserves : Launched in 1975 as a part of UNESCO’s • Methaemoglobinuria or Blue baby syndrome : The
“Man & Biosphere” programme. They are special category of surface run off water from agricultural fields contain
protected area wherein people are an integral component of the high percentage of nitrates. When it enters the body of
system. foetus, it reacts with the haemoglobin and forms
• It consists of 3 zones methaemoglobin which has a highly reduced oxygen
carrying capacity.
Transitional zone
(Area of people settlement, cropping, etc.) • Excess of fluoride - causes skeletal fluorosis (teeth and
skeletal deformity)
Buffer zone (Human activity like research
and educational activities allowed) • Arsenic - Black foot disease
Core zone (Undisturbed by human activity) • Mercury - Minimata disease (numbness of limbs, lips
and tongue)
Pollution : (4) Thermal pollution or Calefaction :
It is an undersirable change in physical, chemical or biological • The source is the heat from thermal & nuclear power
characteristics of environment which adversely affects the plants.
biological species including Man. • Gives thermal shocks which affect the aquatic life.
Waste products are of 2 categories Biological Magnification (Amplification) : It is the increase in
(1) Biodegradable waste : These are such waste substances the effect of any non degradable chemical as it passes on in the
which are acted upon by microorganisms and broken into food chain. E.g. - Polychlorinated biophenyl, DDT.
simpler components. E.g. - Most of the organic waste. Biological (Biochemical) Oxygen Demand (BOD) : It is the
measure of oxygen required by aerobic decomposers for
(2) Non - biodegradable waste : These are such waste substances
biochemical degradation of organic materials (biodegradable) in
which are not acted upon by micro-organisms and remain in
water. This demand of oxygen is directly proportional to increasing
the same form for a long period of time. E.g. - Polythene,
input of organic wastes in water.
glass, DDT, etc.
D- 134 Ecology and Environment Awareness
Noise Pollution Global Warming
• Noise is an undesired sound. Sound pollution starts from 80 • The mean annual global temperature is 14oC. Any significant
decibel. rise in this temperature is regarded as global warming. Major
• A constant exposure to noise level of 80 db causes : Mental green house gases are CO2, Methane, Chlorofluorocarbons
irritation, Hypertension, Temporary deafness. (refrigerators, sprays), Nitrous oxide (NO2).
Organic farming
• Integrated approach, a cyclical, zero waste procedure, where Ozone Depletion
waste products from one process are cycled in as nutrients
for other processes. This allows maximum utilization of • Dobson unit is the unit for measurement of O3 level in
resource and increases efficiency of production. stratosphere.
Radioactive wastes – 1 DV = 0.1 mm of compressed O3 at NTP.
• This waste is generated as a result of generation of electricity – Normal O3 level should be greater than 400 DV.
from nuclear energy in nuclear reactors. Radiation emitted Major O3 depleting substances
out by waste is lethal at high doses and cause mutation and
• Chlor ofluorocarbon (C 1 componen t destr oys O 3 ),
genetic disorder at high doses which can be transmitted
Chloroform, CCl4, Methane, N2O (Nitrous oxide).
generation after generation.
– O3 layer protects life from harmful U.V. radiations.
Greenhouse Effect and Global Warming – 3 forms of U.V. radiations :
• Greenhouse gases such as CO2, CH4, N2 O and CFC’s (a) U.V. C - 100 nm to 280 nm
present in atmosphere radiate part of radiowave radiations – Completely absorbed by O3.
emitted by earth back to the earth. This downflux is called
greenhouse flux which keeps the earth warm and (b) U.V. B - 280 nm to 315 nm
phenomenon is called greenhouse effect. – O3 layer transforms it into infrared.
Effect of Greenhouse Effect – Thinning of O3 layer leads to more penetration of
• Temperature of earth has increased by 0.6°C in last 3 U.V. B.
decades. This increase in temperature is leading to Harmful impact of U.V. B :
deleterious change in environment and resulting in climatic * Cataract * Skin Cancer (Melanoma)
changes (El Nino Effect), leading to increased melting of
(c) U.V. A - 315 nm to 400 nm.
polar ice caps as well as of other places like Himalayas
snow caps. – Reaches the surface of earth
• CO2 fertilization effect – Increase in the growth rate of – harmless.
plants in response to elevated concentrations of CO2 is • Montreal protocol (1987) ® Stop use of ozone depleting
known as carbondioxide fertilisation effect. Kyotoprotocol substances.
(1997) was signed to reduce the emission of green house
• London protocol (1990)
gases. Under the protocol, industrialized countries as a
whole will cut their overall CO2 emission by at least 5.2% • Chernobyl tragedy - Radioactive pollution - Russia.
below 1990 level.
Ecology and Environment Awareness D- 135
EXERCISE
1. The term 'Ecology' was coined by 15. How much portion of the PAR is captured by the plants?
(a) Haeckel (b) Odum (a) 5 – 10% (b) 7 – 10%
(c) Warming (d) Dudgeon (c) 8 – 10% (d) 2 – 10%
2. The age of pyramid with broad base indicates 16. The animals which occupy the same trophic level are
(a) high percentage of young individuals (a) Lion & Bees
(b) low percentage of young individuals (b) Deer & Bees
(c) high percentage of old individuals (c) Snakes & Earthworm
(d) low percentage of old individuals (d) Crow & Cow
3. Desert regions are characterized by ___ centimeters of 17. In simple ecosystem with grass, deer and tiger in food chain,
rainfall per year. how much amount of food available to the tiger if the grass
(a) less than 5 (b) less than 15 production is one tonne ?
(c) less than 25 (d) over 50 (a) 100 kg (b) 10 kg
4. Resemblance of one organism to another for protection and (c) 1 kg (d) 100 gm
hiding is 18. In a food chain herbivores/deer are
(a) Mimicry (b) Predation (a) Primary producers (b) Primary consumers
(c) Adaptation (d) Camouflage (c) Secondary consumers (d) Decomposers
5. Which is not a part of atmosphere ? 19. 10% law of flow of energy in ecosystem was proposed by
(a) Light (b) Temperature (a) Lindeman (b) Carl Mobius
(c) Edaphic factor (d) Precipitation (c) Tansley (d) Darwin
6. Human population growth ________. 20. More than 70% of world’s freshwater is contained in
(a) has an S-shaped curve (a) polar ice
(b) is currently in a logistic phase (b) glaciers and mountains
(c) is currently exponential (c) antarctica
(d) has reached carrying capacity (d) greenland
7. The term ‘precipitation’ includes 21. Which one of the following animals may occupy more than
(a) Rain one trophic levels in the same ecosystem at the same time?
(b) Hails (a) Sparrow (b) Lion
(c) Snow (c) Goat (d) Frog
(d) All forms of water that fall to the ground 22. Which one of the following is not a gaseous
8. Interactions in which the consumer lives within the host biogeochemical cycle in ecosystem ?
and does slow damage to the host are referred to as (a) Sulphur cycle (b) Phosphorus cycle
(a) commensalism (b) parasitism (c) Nitrogen cycle (d) Carbon cycle
(c) mutualism (d) competition 23. Which of the following animal has become almost extinct in
9. An assocation between two individuals or population where India ?
both the benefitted and where neither can survive without (a) Wolf (b) Rhinoceros
the other is (c) Hippopotamus (d) Cheetah
(a) Commensalism (b) Amensalism 24. Diversity of habitat over the total landscape is called
(c) Proto-cooperation (d) Mutualism (a) b diversity (b) g diveristy (gamma)
10. Which most often limits the primary productivity of the (c) landscape diversity (d) ecosystem diversity
ecosystem ? 25. Habitat loss and fragmentation, over exploitation, alien
(a) Solar radiation/light (b) Oxygen species invasion and co-extinction are causes for
(c) Consumers (d) Nitrogen (a) Population explosion (b) Migration
11. Which of the following is the most stable ecosystem? (c) Biodiversity loss (d) Pollution
(a) Mountain (b) Desert 26. Which Biosphere reserve known as "Valley of Flower" ?
(c) Forest (d) Ocean (a) Nilgiri (b) Sunderbans
12. Energy flow in an ecosystem is (c) Uttarakhand (d) Nokrek
(a) unidirectional (b) bidirectional 27. Plant genes of endangered species are stored in
(c) multidirectional (d) All of these (a) gene library (b) gene bank
13. Which one is nature's cleaner ? (c) herbarium (d) None of these
(a) Consumers 28. Which National park is the new home of the Indian one-
(b) Producers horned rhinoceros ?
(c) Decomposers and scavengers (a) Dudhwa (b) Jim Corbett
(d) Symbionts (c) Kanha (d) Bandhavgarh
14. Who is referred to as the farmer’s friend ? 29. 'Project Tiger' in India was started in
(a) Ant (b) Sparrow (a) 1970 (b) 1972
(c) Earthworm (d) Rabbit (c) 1981 (d) 1985
D- 136 Ecology and Environment Awareness
30. Which one of the following is an example of Ex-situ (b) increased combustion of oils and coal
conservation? (b) deforestation
(a) Wildlife sanctuary (b) Seed bank (d) All of the above
(c) Sacred groves (d) National park 37. Green house gases include
31. Which one of the following areas in India, is a hot spot of0 (a) CO2, CFC, CH4 and NO2
biodiversity ? (b) CO2, O2, N2, NO2 and NH3
(a) Eastern Ghats (b) Gangetic Plain (c) CH4, N2, CO2 and NH3
(c) Sunderbans (d) Western Ghats (d) CFC, CO2, NH3 and N2
32. Noise pollution is created if noise is in excess to – 38. Acid rain is caused due to increase in concentration of
(a) 70-75 dB (b) 50-60 dB (in atmosphere)
(c) 80-99 dB (d) 40-65 dB (a) SO2 and NO2 (b) CO and CO2
33. Which of the following is most harmful pollutant ? (c) CO and SO3 (d) O3 and dust
(a) NO2 (b) CO2 39. Deforestation causes
(c) SO2 (d) CO (a) soil erosion
34. Volcano is _____________ source of pollution. (b) loss of biodiversity
(a) artificial (b) natural (c) disturbance in hydrological cycle
(c) Both (a) and (b) (d) man-made (d) All of the above
35. Ozone layer is formed in which zone of atmosphere 40. Which constituent of the atmosphere is likely to change if
(a) Mesosphere (b) Stratosphere the forest cover is removed ?
(c) Troposphere (d) Ionosphere (a) O2 level is increased
36. Today the concentration of green house gases is very high (b) CO2 level is increased
because of (c) O2 level is significantly increases
(a) use of refrigerator (d) CO2 level is significantly decreased
ANSWER KEY
1 (a) 11 (d) 21 (a) 31 (d)
2 (a) 12 (a) 22 (b) 32 (c)
3 (c) 13 (c) 23 (d) 33 (c)
4 (a) 14 (c) 24 (b) 34 (b)
5 (c) 15 (d) 25 (c) 35 (b)
6 (c) 16 (d) 26 (a) 36 (d)
7 (d) 17 (b) 27 (b) 37 (a)
8 (b) 18 (b) 28 (a) 38 (a)
9 (d) 19 (a) 29 (b) 39 (d)
10 (a) 20 (a) 30 (b) 40 (b)